compare-sections: New -r option.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
889
890 @smallexample
891 @value{GDBP} -silent
892 @end smallexample
893
894 @noindent
895 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
896 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
897
898 @noindent
899 Type
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} -help
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
907 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
908
909 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
910 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
911 @samp{-x} option is used.
912
913
914 @menu
915 * File Options:: Choosing files
916 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
917 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
918 @end menu
919
920 @node File Options
921 @subsection Choosing Files
922
923 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
924 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
925 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
926 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
927 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
928 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
929 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
930 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
931 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
932 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
933 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
934 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
935 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
936
937 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
938 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
939 argument and ignore it.
940
941 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
942 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
943 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
944 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
945 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
946
947 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
948 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
949 @c it.
950
951 @table @code
952 @item -symbols @var{file}
953 @itemx -s @var{file}
954 @cindex @code{--symbols}
955 @cindex @code{-s}
956 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
957
958 @item -exec @var{file}
959 @itemx -e @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--exec}
961 @cindex @code{-e}
962 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
963 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
964
965 @item -se @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--se}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
968 file.
969
970 @item -core @var{file}
971 @itemx -c @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--core}
973 @cindex @code{-c}
974 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
975
976 @item -pid @var{number}
977 @itemx -p @var{number}
978 @cindex @code{--pid}
979 @cindex @code{-p}
980 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
981
982 @item -command @var{file}
983 @itemx -x @var{file}
984 @cindex @code{--command}
985 @cindex @code{-x}
986 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
987 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
988 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
989
990 @item -eval-command @var{command}
991 @itemx -ex @var{command}
992 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
993 @cindex @code{-ex}
994 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
995
996 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
997 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
998
999 @smallexample
1000 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1001 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1002 @end smallexample
1003
1004 @item -init-command @var{file}
1005 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1006 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1007 @cindex @code{-ix}
1008 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1009 after loading gdbinit files).
1010 @xref{Startup}.
1011
1012 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1013 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1014 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1015 @cindex @code{-iex}
1016 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1017 after loading gdbinit files).
1018 @xref{Startup}.
1019
1020 @item -directory @var{directory}
1021 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1022 @cindex @code{--directory}
1023 @cindex @code{-d}
1024 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1025
1026 @item -r
1027 @itemx -readnow
1028 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1029 @cindex @code{-r}
1030 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1031 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1032 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1033
1034 @end table
1035
1036 @node Mode Options
1037 @subsection Choosing Modes
1038
1039 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1040 batch mode or quiet mode.
1041
1042 @table @code
1043 @anchor{-nx}
1044 @item -nx
1045 @itemx -n
1046 @cindex @code{--nx}
1047 @cindex @code{-n}
1048 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1049 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1050
1051 @table @code
1052 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1053 This is the system-wide init file.
1054 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1055 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1056 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1057 have been processed.
1058 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1059 This is the init file in your home directory.
1060 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1061 command options have been processed.
1062 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1063 This is the init file in the current directory.
1064 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1065 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1067 @end table
1068
1069 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1070 For documentation on how to write command files,
1071 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1072
1073 @anchor{-nh}
1074 @item -nh
1075 @cindex @code{--nh}
1076 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1077 in your home directory.
1078 @xref{Startup}.
1079
1080 @item -quiet
1081 @itemx -silent
1082 @itemx -q
1083 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1084 @cindex @code{--silent}
1085 @cindex @code{-q}
1086 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1087 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1088
1089 @item -batch
1090 @cindex @code{--batch}
1091 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1092 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1093 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1094 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1095 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1096 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1097 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1098
1099 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1100 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1101 make this more useful, the message
1102
1103 @smallexample
1104 Program exited normally.
1105 @end smallexample
1106
1107 @noindent
1108 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1109 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1110 mode.
1111
1112 @item -batch-silent
1113 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1114 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1115 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1116 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1117 for an interactive session.
1118
1119 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1120 messages, for example.
1121
1122 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1123 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1124
1125 @item -return-child-result
1126 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1127 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1128 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1129
1130 @itemize @bullet
1131 @item
1132 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1133 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1134 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1135 @item
1136 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1137 @item
1138 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1139 the exit code will be -1.
1140 @end itemize
1141
1142 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1143 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1144 interface.
1145
1146 @item -nowindows
1147 @itemx -nw
1148 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1149 @cindex @code{-nw}
1150 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1151 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1152 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1153
1154 @item -windows
1155 @itemx -w
1156 @cindex @code{--windows}
1157 @cindex @code{-w}
1158 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1159 used if possible.
1160
1161 @item -cd @var{directory}
1162 @cindex @code{--cd}
1163 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1164 instead of the current directory.
1165
1166 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1167 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1168 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1169 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1170 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1171
1172 @item -fullname
1173 @itemx -f
1174 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1175 @cindex @code{-f}
1176 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1177 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1178 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1179 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1180 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1181 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1182 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1183 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1184 frame.
1185
1186 @item -annotate @var{level}
1187 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1188 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1189 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1190 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1191 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1192 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1193 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1194 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1195 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1196
1197 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1198 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1199
1200 @item --args
1201 @cindex @code{--args}
1202 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1203 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1204 This option stops option processing.
1205
1206 @item -baud @var{bps}
1207 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1208 @cindex @code{--baud}
1209 @cindex @code{-b}
1210 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1211 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1212
1213 @item -l @var{timeout}
1214 @cindex @code{-l}
1215 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1216 for remote debugging.
1217
1218 @item -tty @var{device}
1219 @itemx -t @var{device}
1220 @cindex @code{--tty}
1221 @cindex @code{-t}
1222 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1223 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1224
1225 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1226 @item -tui
1227 @cindex @code{--tui}
1228 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1229 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1230 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1231 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1232 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1233 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1234
1235 @c @item -xdb
1236 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1237 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1238 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1239 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1240 @c systems.
1241
1242 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1243 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1244 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1245 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1246 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1247 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1248
1249 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1250 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1251 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1252 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1253 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1254 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1255
1256 @item -write
1257 @cindex @code{--write}
1258 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1259 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1260 (@pxref{Patching}).
1261
1262 @item -statistics
1263 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1264 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1265 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1266
1267 @item -version
1268 @cindex @code{--version}
1269 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1270 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1271
1272 @item -configuration
1273 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1274 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1275 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1276 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1277
1278 @end table
1279
1280 @node Startup
1281 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1282 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1283
1284 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1285
1286 @enumerate
1287 @item
1288 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1289 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1290
1291 @item
1292 @cindex init file
1293 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1294 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1295 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1296 that file.
1297
1298 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1299 @item
1300 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1301 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1302 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1303 that file.
1304
1305 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1306 @item
1307 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1308 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1309 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1310 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1311 gets loaded.
1312
1313 @item
1314 Processes command line options and operands.
1315
1316 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1317 @item
1318 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1319 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1320 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1321 This is only done if the current directory is
1322 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1323 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1324 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1325 @value{GDBN}.
1326
1327 @item
1328 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1329 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1330 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1331 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1332
1333 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1334 you must do something like the following:
1335
1336 @smallexample
1337 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1338 @end smallexample
1339
1340 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1341 off too late.
1342
1343 @item
1344 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1345 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1346 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1347
1348 @item
1349 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1350 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1351 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1352 @end enumerate
1353
1354 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1355 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1356 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1357 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1358 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1359 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1360
1361 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1362 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1363
1364 @cindex init file name
1365 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1366 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1367 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1368 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1369 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1370 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1371 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1372 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1373
1374
1375 @node Quitting GDB
1376 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1377 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1379
1380 @table @code
1381 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1382 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1383 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1384 @itemx q
1385 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1386 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1387 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1388 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1389 error code.
1390 @end table
1391
1392 @cindex interrupt
1393 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1394 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1395 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1396 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1397 until a time when it is safe.
1398
1399 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1400 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1401 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1402
1403 @node Shell Commands
1404 @section Shell Commands
1405
1406 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1407 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1408 just use the @code{shell} command.
1409
1410 @table @code
1411 @kindex shell
1412 @kindex !
1413 @cindex shell escape
1414 @item shell @var{command-string}
1415 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1416 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1417 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1418 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1419 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1420 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1421 @end table
1422
1423 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1424 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1425 @value{GDBN}:
1426
1427 @table @code
1428 @kindex make
1429 @cindex calling make
1430 @item make @var{make-args}
1431 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1432 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1433 @end table
1434
1435 @node Logging Output
1436 @section Logging Output
1437 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1438 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1439
1440 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1441 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex set logging
1445 @item set logging on
1446 Enable logging.
1447 @item set logging off
1448 Disable logging.
1449 @cindex logging file name
1450 @item set logging file @var{file}
1451 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1452 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1453 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1454 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1455 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1457 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1458 @kindex show logging
1459 @item show logging
1460 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1461 @end table
1462
1463 @node Commands
1464 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1465
1466 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1467 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1468 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1469 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1470 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1471
1472 @menu
1473 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1474 * Completion:: Command completion
1475 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1476 @end menu
1477
1478 @node Command Syntax
1479 @section Command Syntax
1480
1481 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1482 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1483 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1484 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1485 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1486 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1487
1488 @cindex abbreviation
1489 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1490 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1491 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1492 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1493 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1494 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1495 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1496
1497 @cindex repeating commands
1498 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1499 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1500 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1501 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1502 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1503 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1504 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1505
1506 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1507 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1508 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1509
1510 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1511 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1512 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1513 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1514 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1515
1516 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1517 @cindex comment
1518 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1519 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1520 Files,,Command Files}).
1521
1522 @cindex repeating command sequences
1523 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1524 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1525 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1526 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1527 for editing.
1528
1529 @node Completion
1530 @section Command Completion
1531
1532 @cindex completion
1533 @cindex word completion
1534 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1535 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1536 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1537 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1538
1539 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1540 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1541 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1542 enter it). For example, if you type
1543
1544 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1545 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1546 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1547 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1548 @smallexample
1549 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1550 @end smallexample
1551
1552 @noindent
1553 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1554 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1555
1556 @smallexample
1557 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1558 @end smallexample
1559
1560 @noindent
1561 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1562 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1563 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1564 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1565 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1566 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1567
1568 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1569 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1570 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1571 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1572 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1573 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1574 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1575 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1576 example:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1580 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1581 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1582 make_abs_section make_function_type
1583 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1584 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1585 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1586 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1587 @end smallexample
1588
1589 @noindent
1590 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1591 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1592 command.
1593
1594 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1595 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1596 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1597 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1598 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1599
1600 @cindex quotes in commands
1601 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1602 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1603 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1604 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1605 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1606 @value{GDBN} commands.
1607
1608 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1609 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1610 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1611 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1612 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1613 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1614 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1615 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1616 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1617 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1618 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1622 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1623 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1624 @end smallexample
1625
1626 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1627 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1628 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1629 place:
1630
1631 @smallexample
1632 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1633 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1634 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1635 @end smallexample
1636
1637 @noindent
1638 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1639 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1640 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1641
1642 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1643 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1644 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1645 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1646
1647 @cindex completion of structure field names
1648 @cindex structure field name completion
1649 @cindex completion of union field names
1650 @cindex union field name completion
1651 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1652 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1653 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1654 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1655 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1656 left-hand-side:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1660 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1661 to_data to_isatty to_write
1662 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1663 to_flush to_read
1664 @end smallexample
1665
1666 @noindent
1667 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1668 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1669 follows:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 struct ui_file
1673 @{
1674 int *magic;
1675 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1676 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1677 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1678 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1679 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1680 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1681 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1682 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1683 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1684 void *to_data;
1685 @}
1686 @end smallexample
1687
1688
1689 @node Help
1690 @section Getting Help
1691 @cindex online documentation
1692 @kindex help
1693
1694 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1695 using the command @code{help}.
1696
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1699 @item help
1700 @itemx h
1701 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1702 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 (@value{GDBP}) help
1706 List of classes of commands:
1707
1708 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1709 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1710 data -- Examining data
1711 files -- Specifying and examining files
1712 internals -- Maintenance commands
1713 obscure -- Obscure features
1714 running -- Running the program
1715 stack -- Examining the stack
1716 status -- Status inquiries
1717 support -- Support facilities
1718 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1719 stopping the program
1720 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1721
1722 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1723 commands in that class.
1724 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1725 documentation.
1726 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1727 (@value{GDBP})
1728 @end smallexample
1729 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1730
1731 @item help @var{class}
1732 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1733 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1734 help display for the class @code{status}:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1738 Status inquiries.
1739
1740 List of commands:
1741
1742 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1743 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1744 info -- Generic command for showing things
1745 about the program being debugged
1746 show -- Generic command for showing things
1747 about the debugger
1748
1749 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1750 documentation.
1751 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1752 (@value{GDBP})
1753 @end smallexample
1754
1755 @item help @var{command}
1756 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1757 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1758
1759 @kindex apropos
1760 @item apropos @var{args}
1761 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1762 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1763 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1764
1765 @smallexample
1766 apropos alias
1767 @end smallexample
1768
1769 @noindent
1770 results in:
1771
1772 @smallexample
1773 @c @group
1774 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1775 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1776 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1777 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1778 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1779 @c @end group
1780 @end smallexample
1781
1782 @kindex complete
1783 @item complete @var{args}
1784 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1785 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1786 command you want completed. For example:
1787
1788 @smallexample
1789 complete i
1790 @end smallexample
1791
1792 @noindent results in:
1793
1794 @smallexample
1795 @group
1796 if
1797 ignore
1798 info
1799 inspect
1800 @end group
1801 @end smallexample
1802
1803 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1804 @end table
1805
1806 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1807 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1808 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1809 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1810 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1811 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1812 Index}.
1813
1814 @c @group
1815 @table @code
1816 @kindex info
1817 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1818 @item info
1819 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1820 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1821 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1822 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1823 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1824 @w{@code{help info}}.
1825
1826 @kindex set
1827 @item set
1828 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1829 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1830 @code{set prompt $}.
1831
1832 @kindex show
1833 @item show
1834 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1835 @value{GDBN} itself.
1836 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1837 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1838 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1839 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1840
1841 @kindex info set
1842 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1843 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1844 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1845 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1846 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1847 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1848 @end table
1849 @c @end group
1850
1851 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1852 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1853
1854 @table @code
1855 @kindex show version
1856 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1857 @item show version
1858 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1859 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1860 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1861 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1862 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1863 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1864 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1865 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1866 @value{GDBN}.
1867
1868 @kindex show copying
1869 @kindex info copying
1870 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1871 @item show copying
1872 @itemx info copying
1873 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1874
1875 @kindex show warranty
1876 @kindex info warranty
1877 @item show warranty
1878 @itemx info warranty
1879 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1880 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1881
1882 @kindex show configuration
1883 @item show configuration
1884 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1885 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1886 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1887 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1888 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1889 your report.
1890
1891 @end table
1892
1893 @node Running
1894 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1895
1896 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1897 debugging information when you compile it.
1898
1899 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1900 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1901 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1902 kill a child process.
1903
1904 @menu
1905 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1906 * Starting:: Starting your program
1907 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1908 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1909
1910 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1911 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1912 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1913 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1914
1915 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1916 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1917 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1918 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1919 @end menu
1920
1921 @node Compilation
1922 @section Compiling for Debugging
1923
1924 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1926 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1927 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1928 and addresses in the executable code.
1929
1930 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1931 the compiler.
1932
1933 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1934 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1935 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1936 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1937 executables containing debugging information.
1938
1939 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1940 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1941 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1942 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1943 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1944
1945 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1946 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1947 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1948
1949 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1950 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1951 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1952 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1953 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1954 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1955
1956 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1957 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1958 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1959
1960 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1961 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1962 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1963 format in @value{GDBN}.
1964
1965 @need 2000
1966 @node Starting
1967 @section Starting your Program
1968 @cindex starting
1969 @cindex running
1970
1971 @table @code
1972 @kindex run
1973 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1974 @item run
1975 @itemx r
1976 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1977 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1978 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1979 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1980 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1981
1982 @end table
1983
1984 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1985 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1986 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1987 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1988 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1989 message like this one:
1990
1991 @smallexample
1992 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1993 Try "help target" or "continue".
1994 @end smallexample
1995
1996 @noindent
1997 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1998 first (@pxref{load}).
1999
2000 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2001 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2002 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2003 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2004 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2005 divided into four categories:
2006
2007 @table @asis
2008 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2009 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2010 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2011 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2012 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2013 the arguments.
2014 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2015 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2016 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2017 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2018 below for details).
2019
2020 @item The @emph{environment.}
2021 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2022 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2023 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2024 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2025
2026 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2027 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2028 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2029 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2030
2031 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2032 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2033 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2034 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2035 set a different device for your program.
2036 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2037
2038 @cindex pipes
2039 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2040 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2041 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2042 wrong program.
2043 @end table
2044
2045 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2046 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2047 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2048 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2049 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2050
2051 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2052 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2053 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2054 your current breakpoints.
2055
2056 @table @code
2057 @kindex start
2058 @item start
2059 @cindex run to main procedure
2060 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2061 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2062 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2063 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2064 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2065 procedure, depending on the language used.
2066
2067 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2068 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2069 the @samp{run} command.
2070
2071 @cindex elaboration phase
2072 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2073 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2074 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2075 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2076 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2077 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2078 will remain to halt execution.
2079
2080 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2081 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2082 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2083 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2084 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2085
2086 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2087 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2088 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2089 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2090 elaboration code before running your program.
2091
2092 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2093 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2094 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2095 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2096 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2097 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2098 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2099 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2100 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2101 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2102 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2103 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2104
2105 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2106 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2107 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2108 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2109
2110 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2111 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2112 environment:
2113
2114 @smallexample
2115 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2116 (@value{GDBP}) run
2117 @end smallexample
2118
2119 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2120 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2121
2122 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2123 @item set startup-with-shell
2124 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2125 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2126 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2127 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2128 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2129 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2130 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2131 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2132 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2133 startup failures such as:
2134
2135 @smallexample
2136 (@value{GDBP}) run
2137 Starting program: ./a.out
2138 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2139 @end smallexample
2140
2141 @noindent
2142 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2143 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2144 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2145 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2146 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2147 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2148
2149 @kindex set disable-randomization
2150 @item set disable-randomization
2151 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2152 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2153 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2154 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2155 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2156
2157 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2159
2160 @smallexample
2161 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2162 @end smallexample
2163
2164 @item set disable-randomization off
2165 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2166 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2167 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2168 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2169 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2170 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2171
2172 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2173 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2174 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2175 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2176 a code at its expected addresses.
2177
2178 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2179 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2180 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2181 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2182 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2183 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2184 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2185 a randomly chosen address.
2186
2187 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2188 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2189 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2190 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2191 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2192
2193 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2194 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2195
2196 @item show disable-randomization
2197 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2198 the virtual address space of the started program.
2199
2200 @end table
2201
2202 @node Arguments
2203 @section Your Program's Arguments
2204
2205 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2206 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2207 @code{run} command.
2208 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2209 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2210 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2211 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2212 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2213
2214 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2215 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2216 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2217 the program, not by the shell.
2218
2219 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2220 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2221
2222 @table @code
2223 @kindex set args
2224 @item set args
2225 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2226 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2227 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2228 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2229 it again without arguments.
2230
2231 @kindex show args
2232 @item show args
2233 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2234 @end table
2235
2236 @node Environment
2237 @section Your Program's Environment
2238
2239 @cindex environment (of your program)
2240 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2241 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2242 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2243 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2244 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2245 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2246 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2247
2248 @table @code
2249 @kindex path
2250 @item path @var{directory}
2251 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2252 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2253 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2254 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2255 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2256 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2257 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2258
2259 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2260 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2261 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2262 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2263 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2264 @var{directory} to the search path.
2265 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2266 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2267
2268 @kindex show paths
2269 @item show paths
2270 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2271 environment variable).
2272
2273 @kindex show environment
2274 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2275 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2276 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2277 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2278 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2279
2280 @kindex set environment
2281 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2282 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2283 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2284 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may be any string; the
2285 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2286 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2287 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2288 null value.
2289 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2290 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2291
2292 For example, this command:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 set env USER = foo
2296 @end smallexample
2297
2298 @noindent
2299 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2300 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2301 are not actually required.)
2302
2303 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2304 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2305 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2306 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2307 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2308
2309 @kindex unset environment
2310 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2311 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2312 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2313 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2314 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2315 @end table
2316
2317 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2318 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2319 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2320 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2321 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2322 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2323 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2324 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2325 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2326 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2327
2328 @node Working Directory
2329 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2330
2331 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2332 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2333 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2334 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2335 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2336 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2337
2338 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2339 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2340 Specify Files}.
2341
2342 @table @code
2343 @kindex cd
2344 @cindex change working directory
2345 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2346 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2347 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2348
2349 @kindex pwd
2350 @item pwd
2351 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2352 @end table
2353
2354 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2355 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2356 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2357 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2358 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2359 current working directory of the debuggee.
2360
2361 @node Input/Output
2362 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2363
2364 @cindex redirection
2365 @cindex i/o
2366 @cindex terminal
2367 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2368 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2369 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2370 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2371 running your program.
2372
2373 @table @code
2374 @kindex info terminal
2375 @item info terminal
2376 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2377 program is using.
2378 @end table
2379
2380 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2381 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2382
2383 @smallexample
2384 run > outfile
2385 @end smallexample
2386
2387 @noindent
2388 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2389
2390 @kindex tty
2391 @cindex controlling terminal
2392 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2393 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2394 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2395 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2396 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2397
2398 @smallexample
2399 tty /dev/ttyb
2400 @end smallexample
2401
2402 @noindent
2403 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2404 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2405 that as their controlling terminal.
2406
2407 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2408 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2409 terminal.
2410
2411 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2412 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2413 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2414 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2415
2416 @cindex inferior tty
2417 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2418 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2419 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2420 program.
2421
2422 @table @code
2423 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2424 @kindex set inferior-tty
2425 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2426
2427 @item show inferior-tty
2428 @kindex show inferior-tty
2429 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2430 @end table
2431
2432 @node Attach
2433 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2434 @kindex attach
2435 @cindex attach
2436
2437 @table @code
2438 @item attach @var{process-id}
2439 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2440 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2441 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2442 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2443 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2444
2445 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2446 executing the command.
2447 @end table
2448
2449 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2450 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2451 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2452 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2453
2454 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2455 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2456 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2457 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2458 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2459 Specify Files}.
2460
2461 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2462 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2463 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2464 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2465 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2466 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2467 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2468
2469 @table @code
2470 @kindex detach
2471 @item detach
2472 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2473 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2474 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2475 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2476 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2477 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2478 executing the command.
2479 @end table
2480
2481 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2482 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2483 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2484 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2485 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2486 Messages}).
2487
2488 @node Kill Process
2489 @section Killing the Child Process
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @kindex kill
2493 @item kill
2494 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2495 @end table
2496
2497 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2498 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2499 is running.
2500
2501 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2502 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2503 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2504 outside the debugger.
2505
2506 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2507 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2508 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2509 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2510 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2511 breakpoint settings).
2512
2513 @node Inferiors and Programs
2514 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2515
2516 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2517 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2518 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2519 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2520 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2521 from multiple executables.
2522
2523 @cindex inferior
2524 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2525 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2526 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2527 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2528 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2529 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2530 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2531 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2532 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2533 threads running in it.
2534
2535 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2536 inferiors}}:
2537
2538 @table @code
2539 @kindex info inferiors
2540 @item info inferiors
2541 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2542
2543 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2544
2545 @enumerate
2546 @item
2547 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2548
2549 @item
2550 the target system's inferior identifier
2551
2552 @item
2553 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2554
2555 @end enumerate
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2559 indicates the current inferior.
2560
2561 For example,
2562 @end table
2563 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2564
2565 @smallexample
2566 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2567 Num Description Executable
2568 2 process 2307 hello
2569 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2576 @item inferior @var{infno}
2577 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2578 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2579 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2580 @end table
2581
2582
2583 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2584 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2585 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2586 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2587 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2588 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2589
2590 @table @code
2591 @kindex add-inferior
2592 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2593 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2594 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2595 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2596 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2597 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2598
2599 @kindex clone-inferior
2600 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2601 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2602 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2603 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2604 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2605
2606 @smallexample
2607 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2608 Num Description Executable
2609 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2610 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2611 Added inferior 2.
2612 1 inferiors added.
2613 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2614 Num Description Executable
2615 2 <null> helloworld
2616 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2617 @end smallexample
2618
2619 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2620
2621 @kindex remove-inferiors
2622 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2623 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2624 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2625 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2626
2627 @end table
2628
2629 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2630 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2631 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2632 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2633
2634 @table @code
2635 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2636 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2637 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2638 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2639 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2640 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2641
2642 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2643 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2644 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2645 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2646 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2647 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2648 @end table
2649
2650 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2651 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2652 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2653 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2654
2655
2656 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2657 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2658
2659 @table @code
2660 @kindex set print inferior-events
2661 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2662 @item set print inferior-events
2663 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2664 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2665 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2666 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2667 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2668 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2669
2670 @kindex show print inferior-events
2671 @item show print inferior-events
2672 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2673 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2674 @end table
2675
2676 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2677 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2678 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2679
2680
2681 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2682 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2683 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2684 info program-spaces}} command.
2685
2686 @table @code
2687 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2688 @item maint info program-spaces
2689 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2690 @value{GDBN}.
2691
2692 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2693
2694 @enumerate
2695 @item
2696 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2697
2698 @item
2699 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2700 the @code{file} command.
2701
2702 @end enumerate
2703
2704 @noindent
2705 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2706 indicates the current program space.
2707
2708 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2709 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2710 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2711
2712 @smallexample
2713 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2714 Id Executable
2715 2 goodbye
2716 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2717 * 1 hello
2718 @end smallexample
2719
2720 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2721 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2722 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2723 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2724 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2725
2726 @smallexample
2727 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2728 Id Executable
2729 * 1 vfork-test
2730 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2731 @end smallexample
2732
2733 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2734 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2735 @end table
2736
2737 @node Threads
2738 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2739
2740 @cindex threads of execution
2741 @cindex multiple threads
2742 @cindex switching threads
2743 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2744 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2745 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2746 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2747 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2748 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2749 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2750
2751 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2752 programs:
2753
2754 @itemize @bullet
2755 @item automatic notification of new threads
2756 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2757 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2758 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2759 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2760 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2761 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2762 messages on thread start and exit.
2763 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2764 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2765 isn't compatible with the program.
2766 @end itemize
2767
2768 @quotation
2769 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2770 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2771 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2772 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2773 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2774 like this:
2775
2776 @smallexample
2777 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2778 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2779 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2780 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2781 @end smallexample
2782 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2783 @c doesn't support threads"?
2784 @end quotation
2785
2786 @cindex focus of debugging
2787 @cindex current thread
2788 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2789 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2790 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2791 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2792 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2793
2794 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2795 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2796 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2797 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2798 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2799 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2800 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2801 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2802 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2803 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2807 @end smallexample
2808
2809 @noindent
2810 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2811 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2812 further qualifier.
2813
2814 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2815 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2816 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2817 @c program?
2818 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2819 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2820 @c threads ab initio?
2821
2822 @cindex thread number
2823 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2824 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2825 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2826
2827 @table @code
2828 @kindex info threads
2829 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2830 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2831 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2832 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2833 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2834
2835 @enumerate
2836 @item
2837 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2838
2839 @item
2840 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2841
2842 @item
2843 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2844 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2845 program itself.
2846
2847 @item
2848 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2849 @end enumerate
2850
2851 @noindent
2852 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2853 indicates the current thread.
2854
2855 For example,
2856 @end table
2857 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2861 Id Target Id Frame
2862 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2863 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2864 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2865 at threadtest.c:68
2866 @end smallexample
2867
2868 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2869 Solaris-specific command:
2870
2871 @table @code
2872 @item maint info sol-threads
2873 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2874 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2875 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2876 @end table
2877
2878 @table @code
2879 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2880 @item thread @var{threadno}
2881 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2882 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2883 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2884 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2885 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2886
2887 @smallexample
2888 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2889 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2890 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2891 8 printf ("hello\n");
2892 @end smallexample
2893
2894 @noindent
2895 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2896 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2897 threads.
2898
2899 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2900 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2901 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2902 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2903 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2904 information on convenience variables.
2905
2906 @kindex thread apply
2907 @cindex apply command to several threads
2908 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2909 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2910 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2911 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2912 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2913 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2914 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2915 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2916
2917 @kindex thread name
2918 @cindex name a thread
2919 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2920 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2921 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2922 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2923
2924 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2925 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2926 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2927 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2928 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2929
2930 @kindex thread find
2931 @cindex search for a thread
2932 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2933 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2934 matches the supplied regular expression.
2935
2936 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2937 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2938 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2939 is the LWP id.
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2943 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2944 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2945 Id Target Id Frame
2946 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2947 @end smallexample
2948
2949 @kindex set print thread-events
2950 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2951 @item set print thread-events
2952 @itemx set print thread-events on
2953 @itemx set print thread-events off
2954 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2955 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2956 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2957 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2958 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2959
2960 @kindex show print thread-events
2961 @item show print thread-events
2962 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2963 have started and exited.
2964 @end table
2965
2966 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2967 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2968 programs with multiple threads.
2969
2970 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2971 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2972
2973 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
2974 @table @code
2975 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2976 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2977 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2978 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2979 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2980 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2981 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2982 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2983 macro.
2984
2985 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2986 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2987 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2988 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
2989 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
2990 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2991
2992 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2993 refers to the default system directories that are
2994 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
2995 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
2996 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2997
2998 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2999 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3000 was loaded in the inferior process.
3001
3002 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3003 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3004 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3005 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3006 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3007 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3008 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3009
3010 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3011 only on some platforms.
3012
3013 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3014 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3015 Display current libthread_db search path.
3016
3017 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3018 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3019 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3020 @item set debug libthread-db
3021 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3022 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3023 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3024 @end table
3025
3026 @node Forks
3027 @section Debugging Forks
3028
3029 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3030 @cindex multiple processes
3031 @cindex processes, multiple
3032 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3033 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3034 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3035 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3036 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3037 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3038 will cause it to terminate.
3039
3040 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3041 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3042 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3043 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3044 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3045 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3046 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3047 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3048 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3049 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3050
3051 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3052 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3053 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3054 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3055
3056 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3057 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3058
3059 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3060 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3061
3062 @table @code
3063 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3064 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3065 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3066 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3067 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3068
3069 @table @code
3070 @item parent
3071 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3072 unimpeded. This is the default.
3073
3074 @item child
3075 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3076 unimpeded.
3077
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3081 @item show follow-fork-mode
3082 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3083 @end table
3084
3085 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3086 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3087 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3088
3089 @table @code
3090 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3091 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3092 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3093 retain debugger control over them both.
3094
3095 @table @code
3096 @item on
3097 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3098 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3099 independently. This is the default.
3100
3101 @item off
3102 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3103 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3104 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3105 is held suspended.
3106
3107 @end table
3108
3109 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3110 @item show detach-on-fork
3111 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3112 @end table
3113
3114 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3115 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3116 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3117 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3118 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3119 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3120
3121 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3122 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3123 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3124 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3125 and Programs}.
3126
3127 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3128 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3129 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3130 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3131 the child process's @code{main}.
3132
3133 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3134 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3135
3136 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3137 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3138 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3139 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3140 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3141 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3142 command.
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3146 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3147
3148 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3149 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3150
3151 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3152
3153 @table @code
3154 @item new
3155 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3156 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3157 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3158 original inferior.
3159
3160 For example:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3164 (gdb) info inferior
3165 Id Description Executable
3166 * 1 <null> prog1
3167 (@value{GDBP}) run
3168 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3169 Program exited normally.
3170 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3171 Id Description Executable
3172 * 2 <null> prog2
3173 1 <null> prog1
3174 @end smallexample
3175
3176 @item same
3177 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3178 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3179 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3180 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3181 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3182
3183 For example:
3184
3185 @smallexample
3186 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3187 Id Description Executable
3188 * 1 <null> prog1
3189 (@value{GDBP}) run
3190 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3191 Program exited normally.
3192 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3193 Id Description Executable
3194 * 1 <null> prog2
3195 @end smallexample
3196
3197 @end table
3198 @end table
3199
3200 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3201 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3202 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3203
3204 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3205 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3206
3207 @cindex checkpoint
3208 @cindex restart
3209 @cindex bookmark
3210 @cindex snapshot of a process
3211 @cindex rewind program state
3212
3213 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3214 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3215 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3216 later.
3217
3218 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3219 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3220 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3221 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3222 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3223
3224 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3225 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3226 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3227 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3228 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3229 start again from there.
3230
3231 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3232 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3233
3234 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3235
3236 @table @code
3237 @kindex checkpoint
3238 @item checkpoint
3239 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3240 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3241 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3242
3243 @kindex info checkpoints
3244 @item info checkpoints
3245 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3246 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3247 listed:
3248
3249 @table @code
3250 @item Checkpoint ID
3251 @item Process ID
3252 @item Code Address
3253 @item Source line, or label
3254 @end table
3255
3256 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3257 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3258 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3259 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3260 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3261 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3262 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3263
3264 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3265 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3266 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3267 the debugger.
3268
3269 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3270 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3271 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3272
3273 @end table
3274
3275 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3276 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3277 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3278 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3279 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3280 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3281 previously read data can be read again.
3282
3283 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3284 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3285 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3286 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3287 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3288 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3289
3290 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3291 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3292 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3293 different execution path this time.
3294
3295 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3296 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3297 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3298 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3299 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3300 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3301 potentially pose a problem.
3302
3303 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3304
3305 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3306 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3307 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3308 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3309 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3310 next.
3311
3312 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3313 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3314 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3315 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3316 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3317
3318 @node Stopping
3319 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3320
3321 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3322 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3323 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3324
3325 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3326 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3327 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3328 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3329 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3330 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3331 explicitly request this information at any time.
3332
3333 @table @code
3334 @kindex info program
3335 @item info program
3336 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3337 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3338 @end table
3339
3340 @menu
3341 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3342 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3343 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3344 Skipping over functions and files
3345 * Signals:: Signals
3346 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3347 @end menu
3348
3349 @node Breakpoints
3350 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3351
3352 @cindex breakpoints
3353 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3354 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3355 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3356 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3357 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3358 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3359 program.
3360
3361 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3362 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3363 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3364 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3365 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3366 call).
3367
3368 @cindex watchpoints
3369 @cindex data breakpoints
3370 @cindex memory tracing
3371 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3372 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3373 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3374 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3375 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3376 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3377 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3378 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3379 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3380 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3381 same commands.
3382
3383 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3384 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3385 Automatic Display}.
3386
3387 @cindex catchpoints
3388 @cindex breakpoint on events
3389 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3390 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3391 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3392 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3393 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3394 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3395 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3396
3397 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3398 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3399 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3400 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3401 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3402 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3403 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3404 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3405 enable it again.
3406
3407 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3408 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3409 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3410 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3411 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3412 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3413 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3414
3415 @menu
3416 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3417 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3418 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3419 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3420 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3421 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3422 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3423 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3424 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3425 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3426 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3427 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3428 @end menu
3429
3430 @node Set Breaks
3431 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3432
3433 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3434 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3435 @c
3436 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3437
3438 @kindex break
3439 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3440 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3441 @cindex latest breakpoint
3442 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3443 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3444 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3445 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3446 convenience variables.
3447
3448 @table @code
3449 @item break @var{location}
3450 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3451 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3452 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3453 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3454 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3455
3456 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3457 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3458 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3459 that situation.
3460
3461 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3462 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3463 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3464
3465 @item break
3466 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3467 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3468 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3469 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3470 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3471 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3472 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3473 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3474 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3475 inside loops.
3476
3477 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3478 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3479 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3480 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3481 existed when your program stopped.
3482
3483 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3484 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3485 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3486 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3487 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3488 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3489 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3490
3491 @kindex tbreak
3492 @item tbreak @var{args}
3493 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3494 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3495 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3496 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3497
3498 @kindex hbreak
3499 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3500 @item hbreak @var{args}
3501 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3502 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3503 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3504 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3505 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3506 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3507 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3508 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3509 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3510 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3511 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3512 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3513 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3514 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3515 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3516 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3517 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3518 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3519
3520 @kindex thbreak
3521 @item thbreak @var{args}
3522 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3523 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3524 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3525 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3526 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3527 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3528 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3529 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3530
3531 @kindex rbreak
3532 @cindex regular expression
3533 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3534 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3535 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3536 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3537 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3538 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3539 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3540 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3541 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3542
3543 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3544 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3545 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3546 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3547 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3548 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3549
3550 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3551 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3552 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3553 classes.
3554
3555 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3556 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3557 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3558
3559 @smallexample
3560 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3561 @end smallexample
3562
3563 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3564 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3565 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3566 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3567 every function in a given file:
3568
3569 @smallexample
3570 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3571 @end smallexample
3572
3573 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3574 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3575
3576 @kindex info breakpoints
3577 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3578 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3579 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3580 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3581 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3582 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3583 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3584
3585 @table @emph
3586 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3587 @item Type
3588 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3589 @item Disposition
3590 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3591 @item Enabled or Disabled
3592 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3593 that are not enabled.
3594 @item Address
3595 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3596 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3597 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3598 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3599 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3600 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3601 @item What
3602 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3603 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3604 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3605 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3606 @end table
3607
3608 @noindent
3609 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3610 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3611 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3612 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3613 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3614 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3615
3616 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3617 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3618 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3619 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3620
3621 @noindent
3622 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3623 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3624 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3625 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3626 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3627
3628 @noindent
3629 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3630 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3631 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3632 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3633 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3634 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3635
3636 @noindent
3637 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3638 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3639
3640 @end table
3641
3642 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3643 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3644 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3645 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3646
3647 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3648 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3649 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3650 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3651
3652 @itemize @bullet
3653 @item
3654 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3655
3656 @item
3657 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3658 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3659
3660 @item
3661 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3662 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3663
3664 @item
3665 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3666 several places where that function is inlined.
3667 @end itemize
3668
3669 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3670 the relevant locations.
3671
3672 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3673 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3674 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3675 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3676 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3677 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3678 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3679
3680 For example:
3681
3682 @smallexample
3683 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3684 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3685 stop only if i==1
3686 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3687 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3688 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3689 @end smallexample
3690
3691 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3692 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3693 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3694 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3695 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3696 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3697 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3698 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3699 that belong to that breakpoint.
3700
3701 @cindex pending breakpoints
3702 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3703 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3704 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3705 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3706 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3707 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3708 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3709 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3710 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3711 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3712 is not yet resolved.
3713
3714 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3715 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3716 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3717 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3718 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3719 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3720
3721 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3722 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3723 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3724 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3725
3726 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3727 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3728 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3729
3730 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3731 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3732 address specification to an address:
3733
3734 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3735 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3736 @table @code
3737 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3738 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3739 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3740
3741 @item set breakpoint pending on
3742 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3743 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3744
3745 @item set breakpoint pending off
3746 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3747 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3748 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3749
3750 @item show breakpoint pending
3751 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3752 @end table
3753
3754 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3755 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3756 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3757
3758 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3759 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3760 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3761 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3762 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3763 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3764 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3765 breakpoints.
3766
3767 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3768
3769 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3770 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3771 @table @code
3772 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3773 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3774 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3775 breakpoint must be used.
3776
3777 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3778 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3779 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3780 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3781 @end table
3782
3783 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3784 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3785 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3786 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3787 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3788 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3789 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3790 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3791 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3792
3793 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3794 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3795 @table @code
3796 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3797 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3798 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3799 removed from the target when it stops.
3800
3801 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3802 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3803 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3804 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3805 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3806
3807 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3808 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3809 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3810 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3811 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3812 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3813 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3814 @end table
3815
3816 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3817 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3818 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3819
3820 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3821 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3822
3823 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3824
3825 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3826 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3827 @table @code
3828 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3829 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3830 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3831 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3832 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3833
3834 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3835 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3836 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3837 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3838 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3839 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3840 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3841 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3842 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3843 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3844 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3845 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3846 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3847
3848 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3849 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3850 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3851 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3852 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3853 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3854 @end table
3855
3856
3857 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3858 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3859 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3860 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3861 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3862 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3863 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3864 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3865
3866
3867 @node Set Watchpoints
3868 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3869
3870 @cindex setting watchpoints
3871 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3872 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3873 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3874 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3875 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3876
3877 @itemize @bullet
3878 @item
3879 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3880
3881 @item
3882 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3883 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3884 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3885
3886 @item
3887 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3888 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3889 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3890 @end itemize
3891
3892 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3893 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3894 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3895 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3896 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3897 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3898 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3899 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3900 the expression changes.
3901
3902 @cindex software watchpoints
3903 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3904 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3905 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3906 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3907 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3908 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3909 culprit.)
3910
3911 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3912 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3913 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3914
3915 @table @code
3916 @kindex watch
3917 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3918 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3919 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3920 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3921 to watch the value of a single variable:
3922
3923 @smallexample
3924 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3925 @end smallexample
3926
3927 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3928 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3929 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3930 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3931 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3932 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3933
3934 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3935 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3936 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3937 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3938 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3939 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3940 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3941 error.
3942
3943 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3944 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3945 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3946 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3947 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3948 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3949 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3950 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3951 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3952 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3953 Examples:
3954
3955 @smallexample
3956 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3957 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3958 @end smallexample
3959
3960 @kindex rwatch
3961 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3962 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3963 by the program.
3964
3965 @kindex awatch
3966 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3967 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3968 or written into by the program.
3969
3970 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3971 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3972 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3973 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3974 @end table
3975
3976 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3977 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3978 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3979 a never-changing value:
3980
3981 @smallexample
3982 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3983 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3984 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3985 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3986 @end smallexample
3987
3988 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3989 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3990 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3991 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3992 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3993 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3994
3995 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3996 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3997 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3998 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3999 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4000 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4001 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4002 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4003
4004 @table @code
4005 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4006 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4007 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4008
4009 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4010 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4011 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4012 @end table
4013
4014 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4015 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4016 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4017
4018 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4019
4020 @smallexample
4021 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 @noindent
4025 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4026
4027 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4028 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4029 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4030 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4031 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4032 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4033 will print a message like this:
4034
4035 @smallexample
4036 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4037 @end smallexample
4038
4039 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4040 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4041 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4042 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4043 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4044 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4045 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4046 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4047
4048 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4049 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4050 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4051 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4052 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4053 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4054
4055 @smallexample
4056 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4057 @end smallexample
4058
4059 @noindent
4060 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4061
4062 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4063 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4064 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4065 expression with separately allocated resources.
4066
4067 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4068 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4069 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4070
4071 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4072 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4073 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4074 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4075 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4076 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4077 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4078 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4079 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4080
4081 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4082 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4083 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4084 watched expression from every thread.
4085
4086 @quotation
4087 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4088 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4089 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4090 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4091 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4092 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4093 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4094 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4095 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4096 @end quotation
4097
4098 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4099
4100 @node Set Catchpoints
4101 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4102 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4103 @cindex exception handlers
4104 @cindex event handling
4105
4106 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4107 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4108 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4109
4110 @table @code
4111 @kindex catch
4112 @item catch @var{event}
4113 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
4114
4115 @table @code
4116 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4117 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4118 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4119 @kindex catch throw
4120 @kindex catch rethrow
4121 @kindex catch catch
4122 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4123 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4124
4125 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4126 regular expression will be caught.
4127
4128 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4129 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4130 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4131 exception being thrown.
4132
4133 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4134 @value{GDBN}:
4135
4136 @itemize @bullet
4137 @item
4138 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4139 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4140 supported.
4141
4142 @item
4143 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4144 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4145 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4146 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4147 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4148 built.
4149
4150 @item
4151 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4152 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4153
4154 @item
4155 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4156 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4157 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4158 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4159
4160 @item
4161 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4162 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4163 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4164 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4165 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4166 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4167 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4168 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4169 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4170
4171 @item
4172 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4173
4174 @item
4175 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4176 @end itemize
4177
4178 @item exception
4179 @kindex catch exception
4180 @cindex Ada exception catching
4181 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4182 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4183 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4184 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4185 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4186
4187 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4188 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4189 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4190 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4191 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4192 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4193 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4194 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4195
4196 @item exception unhandled
4197 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4198 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4199
4200 @item assert
4201 @kindex catch assert
4202 A failed Ada assertion.
4203
4204 @item exec
4205 @kindex catch exec
4206 @cindex break on fork/exec
4207 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4208 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4209
4210 @item syscall
4211 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4212 @kindex catch syscall
4213 @cindex break on a system call.
4214 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4215 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4216 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4217 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4218 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4219 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4220 will be caught.
4221
4222 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4223 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4224 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4225 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4226
4227 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4228 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4229 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4230 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4231
4232 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4233 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4234 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4235 available choices.
4236
4237 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4238 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4239 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4240 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4241 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4242 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4243 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4244 behind the OS upgrades).
4245
4246 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4247 arguments to it:
4248
4249 @smallexample
4250 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4251 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4252 (@value{GDBP}) r
4253 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4254
4255 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4256 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4257 (@value{GDBP}) c
4258 Continuing.
4259
4260 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4261 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4262 (@value{GDBP})
4263 @end smallexample
4264
4265 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4266
4267 @smallexample
4268 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4269 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4270 (@value{GDBP}) r
4271 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4272
4273 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4274 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4275 (@value{GDBP}) c
4276 Continuing.
4277
4278 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4279 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4280 (@value{GDBP})
4281 @end smallexample
4282
4283 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4284 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4285 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4286
4287 @smallexample
4288 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4289 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4290 (@value{GDBP}) r
4291 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4292
4293 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4294 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4295 (@value{GDBP}) c
4296 Continuing.
4297
4298 Program exited normally.
4299 (@value{GDBP})
4300 @end smallexample
4301
4302 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4303 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4304 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4305 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4306
4307 @smallexample
4308 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4309 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4310 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4311 (@value{GDBP})
4312 @end smallexample
4313
4314 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4315 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4316 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4317 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4318 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4319 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4320
4321 @smallexample
4322 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4323 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4324 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4325 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4326 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4327 (@value{GDBP})
4328 @end smallexample
4329
4330 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4331
4332 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4333 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4334
4335 @smallexample
4336 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4337 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4338 @end smallexample
4339
4340 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4341
4342 @item fork
4343 @kindex catch fork
4344 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4345 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4346
4347 @item vfork
4348 @kindex catch vfork
4349 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4350 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4351
4352 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4353 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4354 @kindex catch load
4355 @kindex catch unload
4356 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4357 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4358 matches one of the affected libraries.
4359
4360 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4361 @kindex catch signal
4362 The delivery of a signal.
4363
4364 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4365 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4366 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4367
4368 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4369 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4370 signal names.
4371
4372 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4373 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4374 will be caught.
4375
4376 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4377 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4378 catchpoint.
4379
4380 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4381 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4382 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4383 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4384 commands.
4385
4386 @end table
4387
4388 @item tcatch @var{event}
4389 @kindex tcatch
4390 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4391 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4392
4393 @end table
4394
4395 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4396
4397
4398 @node Delete Breaks
4399 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4400
4401 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4402 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4403 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4404 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4405 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4406 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4407
4408 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4409 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4410 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4411 their breakpoint numbers.
4412
4413 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4414 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4415 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4416
4417 @table @code
4418 @kindex clear
4419 @item clear
4420 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4421 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4422 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4423 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4424
4425 @item clear @var{location}
4426 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4427 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4428 most useful ones are listed below:
4429
4430 @table @code
4431 @item clear @var{function}
4432 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4433 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4434
4435 @item clear @var{linenum}
4436 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4437 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4438 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4439 @end table
4440
4441 @cindex delete breakpoints
4442 @kindex delete
4443 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4444 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4445 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4446 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4447 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4448 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4449 @end table
4450
4451 @node Disabling
4452 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4453
4454 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4455 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4456 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4457 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4458 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4459
4460 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4461 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4462 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4463 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4464 do not know which numbers to use.
4465
4466 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4467 affects all of its locations.
4468
4469 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4470 different states of enablement:
4471
4472 @itemize @bullet
4473 @item
4474 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4475 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4476 @item
4477 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4478 @item
4479 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4480 disabled.
4481 @item
4482 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4483 N times, then becomes disabled.
4484 @item
4485 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4486 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4487 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4488 @end itemize
4489
4490 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4491 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4492
4493 @table @code
4494 @kindex disable
4495 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4496 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4497 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4498 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4499 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4500 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4501 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4502
4503 @kindex enable
4504 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4505 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4506 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4507
4508 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4509 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4510 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4511
4512 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4513 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4514 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4515 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4516 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4517 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4518 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4519
4520 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4521 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4522 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4523 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4524 @end table
4525
4526 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4527 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4528 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4529 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4530 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4531 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4532 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4533 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4534 Stepping}.)
4535
4536 @node Conditions
4537 @subsection Break Conditions
4538 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4539 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4540
4541 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4542 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4543 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4544 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4545 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4546 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4547 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4548 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4549
4550 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4551 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4552 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4553 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4554 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4555
4556 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4557 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4558 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4559 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4560 one.
4561
4562 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4563 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4564 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4565 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4566 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4567 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4568 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4569 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4570 conditions for the
4571 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4572 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4573
4574 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4575 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4576 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4577 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4578 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4579 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4580
4581 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4582 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4583 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4584 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4585 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4586
4587 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4588 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4589 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4590 with the @code{condition} command.
4591
4592 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4593 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4594 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4595 catchpoint.
4596
4597 @table @code
4598 @kindex condition
4599 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4600 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4601 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4602 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4603 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4604 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4605 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4606 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4607 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4608 prints an error message:
4609
4610 @smallexample
4611 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 @noindent
4615 @value{GDBN} does
4616 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4617 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4618 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4619
4620 @item condition @var{bnum}
4621 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4622 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4623 @end table
4624
4625 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4626 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4627 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4628 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4629 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4630 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4631 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4632 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4633 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4634 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4635 your program reaches it.
4636
4637 @table @code
4638 @kindex ignore
4639 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4640 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4641 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4642 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4643 takes no action.
4644
4645 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4646 a count of zero.
4647
4648 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4649 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4650 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4651 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4652
4653 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4654 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4655 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4656
4657 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4658 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4659 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4660 Variables}.
4661 @end table
4662
4663 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4664
4665
4666 @node Break Commands
4667 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4668
4669 @cindex breakpoint commands
4670 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4671 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4672 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4673 enable other breakpoints.
4674
4675 @table @code
4676 @kindex commands
4677 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4678 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4679 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4680 @itemx end
4681 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4682 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4683 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4684
4685 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4686 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4687
4688 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4689 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4690 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4691 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4692 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4693 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4694 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4695 Expressions}).
4696 @end table
4697
4698 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4699 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4700
4701 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4702 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4703 that resumes execution.
4704
4705 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4706 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4707 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4708 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4709 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4710
4711 @kindex silent
4712 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4713 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4714 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4715 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4716 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4717 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4718
4719 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4720 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4721 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4722
4723 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4724 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 break foo if x>0
4728 commands
4729 silent
4730 printf "x is %d\n",x
4731 cont
4732 end
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4736 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4737 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4738 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4739 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4740 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4741 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4742
4743 @smallexample
4744 break 403
4745 commands
4746 silent
4747 set x = y + 4
4748 cont
4749 end
4750 @end smallexample
4751
4752 @node Dynamic Printf
4753 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4754
4755 @cindex dynamic printf
4756 @cindex dprintf
4757 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4758 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4759 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4760 having to recompile it.
4761
4762 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4763 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4764 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4765 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4766 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4767 redirects to files and so forth.
4768
4769 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4770 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4771 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4772 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4773 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4774 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4775 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4776
4777 @table @code
4778 @kindex dprintf
4779 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4780 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4781 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4782 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4783
4784 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4785 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4786 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4787 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4788 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4789 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4790
4791 @item gdb
4792 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4793 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4794
4795 @item call
4796 @kindex dprintf-style call
4797 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4798 @code{printf}).
4799
4800 @item agent
4801 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4802 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4803 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4804 support running commands on the target.
4805
4806 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4807 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4808 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4809 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4810 command.
4811
4812 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4813 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4814 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4815 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4816 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4817 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4818
4819 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4820 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4821 you could do the following:
4822
4823 @example
4824 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4825 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4826 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4827 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4828 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4829 (gdb) info break
4830 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4831 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4832 continue
4833 (gdb)
4834 @end example
4835
4836 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4837 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4838 the variable settings.
4839
4840 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4841 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4842 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4843 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4844 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4845 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4846
4847 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4848 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4849 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4850
4851 @end table
4852
4853 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4854 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4855 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4856 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4857 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4858 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4859
4860 @node Save Breakpoints
4861 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4862
4863 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4864 breakpoints}} command.
4865
4866 @table @code
4867 @kindex save breakpoints
4868 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4869 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4870 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4871 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4872 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4873 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4874 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4875 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4876 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4877 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4878 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4879 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4880 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4881 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4882 that can no longer be recreated.
4883 @end table
4884
4885 @node Static Probe Points
4886 @subsection Static Probe Points
4887
4888 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4889 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4890 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4891 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4892 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4893 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4894 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4895
4896 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4897 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4898 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4899 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4900 in your applications.
4901
4902 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4903 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4904 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4905 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4906 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4907 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4908 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4909 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4910
4911 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4912 probes}, with optional arguments:
4913
4914 @table @code
4915 @kindex info probes
4916 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4917 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4918 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4919 probes from all providers are listed.
4920
4921 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4922 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4923 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4924
4925 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4926 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4927 given, all object files are considered.
4928
4929 @item info probes all
4930 List the available static probes, from all types.
4931 @end table
4932
4933 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4934 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4935 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4936 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4937 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4938 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4939 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4940 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4941 at the current probe point.
4942
4943 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4944 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4945 an error message.
4946
4947
4948 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4949 @node Error in Breakpoints
4950 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4951
4952 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4953 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4954
4955 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4956 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4957 @smallexample
4958 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4959 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4960 @end smallexample
4961
4962 @noindent
4963 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4964 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4965 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4966
4967 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4968 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4969
4970 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4971 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4972 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4973
4974 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4975 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4976 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4977 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4978
4979 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4980 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4981 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4982 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4983 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4984 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4985 first in the bundle.
4986
4987 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4988 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4989 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4990 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4991 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4992 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4993 is hit.
4994
4995 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4996 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4997
4998 @smallexample
4999 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5000 @end smallexample
5001
5002 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5003 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5004 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5005 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5006 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5007 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5008 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5009 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5010
5011 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5012 adjusted breakpoints:
5013
5014 @smallexample
5015 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5016 to 0x00010410.
5017 @end smallexample
5018
5019 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5020 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5021 frequently than expected.
5022
5023 @node Continuing and Stepping
5024 @section Continuing and Stepping
5025
5026 @cindex stepping
5027 @cindex continuing
5028 @cindex resuming execution
5029 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5030 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5031 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5032 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5033 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5034 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5035 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5036 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5037
5038 @table @code
5039 @kindex continue
5040 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5041 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5042 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5043 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5044 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5045 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5046 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5047 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5048 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5049 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5050
5051 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5052 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5053 @code{continue} is ignored.
5054
5055 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5056 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5057 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5058 @code{continue}.
5059 @end table
5060
5061 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5062 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5063 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5064 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5065
5066 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5067 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5068 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5069 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5070 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5071 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5072
5073 @table @code
5074 @kindex step
5075 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5076 @item step
5077 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5078 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5079 abbreviated @code{s}.
5080
5081 @quotation
5082 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5083 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5084 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5085 @c distinction here.
5086 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5087 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5088 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5089 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5090 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5091 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5092 below.
5093 @end quotation
5094
5095 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5096 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5097 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5098 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5099 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5100 called within the line.
5101
5102 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5103 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5104 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5105 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5106 was any debugging information about the routine.
5107
5108 @item step @var{count}
5109 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5110 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5111 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5112
5113 @kindex next
5114 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5115 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5116 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5117 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5118 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5119 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5120 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5121 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5122
5123 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5124
5125
5126 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5127 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5128 @c
5129 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5130 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5131 @c function are executed without stopping.
5132
5133 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5134 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5135 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5136
5137 @kindex set step-mode
5138 @item set step-mode
5139 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5140 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5141 @itemx set step-mode on
5142 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5143 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5144 information rather than stepping over it.
5145
5146 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5147 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5148 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5149
5150 @item set step-mode off
5151 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5152 debug information. This is the default.
5153
5154 @item show step-mode
5155 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5156 source line debug information.
5157
5158 @kindex finish
5159 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5160 @item finish
5161 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5162 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5163 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5164
5165 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5166 ,Returning from a Function}).
5167
5168 @kindex until
5169 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5170 @cindex run until specified location
5171 @item until
5172 @itemx u
5173 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5174 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5175 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5176 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5177 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5178 than the address of the jump.
5179
5180 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5181 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5182 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5183 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5184 through the next iteration.
5185
5186 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5187 stack frame.
5188
5189 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5190 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5191 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5192 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5193 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5194
5195 @smallexample
5196 (@value{GDBP}) f
5197 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5198 206 expand_input();
5199 (@value{GDBP}) until
5200 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5201 @end smallexample
5202
5203 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5204 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5205 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5206 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5207 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5208 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5209 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5210
5211 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5212 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5213 argument.
5214
5215 @item until @var{location}
5216 @itemx u @var{location}
5217 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
5218 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
5219 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5220 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5221 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5222 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5223 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5224 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5225 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5226 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5227 invocations have returned.
5228
5229 @smallexample
5230 94 int factorial (int value)
5231 95 @{
5232 96 if (value > 1) @{
5233 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5234 98 @}
5235 99 return (value);
5236 100 @}
5237 @end smallexample
5238
5239
5240 @kindex advance @var{location}
5241 @item advance @var{location}
5242 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5243 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5244 @ref{Specify Location}.
5245 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5246 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5247 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5248 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5249
5250
5251 @kindex stepi
5252 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5253 @item stepi
5254 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5255 @itemx si
5256 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5257
5258 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5259 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5260 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5261 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5262
5263 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5264
5265 @need 750
5266 @kindex nexti
5267 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5268 @item nexti
5269 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5270 @itemx ni
5271 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5272 proceed until the function returns.
5273
5274 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5275
5276 @end table
5277
5278 @anchor{range stepping}
5279 @cindex range stepping
5280 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5281 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5282 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5283 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5284 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5285 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5286 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5287 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5288 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5289 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5290 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5291 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5292 if necessary:
5293
5294 @table @code
5295 @kindex set range-stepping
5296 @kindex show range-stepping
5297 @item set range-stepping
5298 @itemx show range-stepping
5299 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5300
5301 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5302 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5303 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5304 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5305 default is @code{on}.
5306
5307 @end table
5308
5309 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5310 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5311 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5312
5313 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5314 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5315 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5316
5317 For example, consider the following C function:
5318
5319 @smallexample
5320 101 int func()
5321 102 @{
5322 103 foo(boring());
5323 104 bar(boring());
5324 105 @}
5325 @end smallexample
5326
5327 @noindent
5328 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5329 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5330 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5331 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5332
5333 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5334 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5335 is called from many places.
5336
5337 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5338 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5339 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5340 @code{foo}.
5341
5342 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5343 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @kindex skip function
5347 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5348 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5349 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5350 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5351 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5352
5353 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5354 will be skipped.
5355
5356 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5357 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5358
5359 @kindex skip file
5360 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5361 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5362 will be skipped over when stepping.
5363
5364 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5365 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5366 @end table
5367
5368 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5369 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5370
5371 @table @code
5372 @kindex info skip
5373 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5374 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5375 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5376 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5377
5378 @table @emph
5379 @item Identifier
5380 A number identifying this skip.
5381 @item Type
5382 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5383 @item Enabled or Disabled
5384 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5385 @item Address
5386 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5387 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5388 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5389 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5390 address here.
5391 @item What
5392 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5393 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5394 where it is defined.
5395 @end table
5396
5397 @kindex skip delete
5398 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5399 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5400 skips.
5401
5402 @kindex skip enable
5403 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5404 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5405 skips.
5406
5407 @kindex skip disable
5408 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5409 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5410 skips.
5411
5412 @end table
5413
5414 @node Signals
5415 @section Signals
5416 @cindex signals
5417
5418 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5419 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5420 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5421 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5422 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5423 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5424 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5425 requested an alarm).
5426
5427 @cindex fatal signals
5428 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5429 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5430 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5431 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5432 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5433 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5434
5435 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5436 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5437 signal.
5438
5439 @cindex handling signals
5440 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5441 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5442 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5443 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5444 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5445
5446 @table @code
5447 @kindex info signals
5448 @kindex info handle
5449 @item info signals
5450 @itemx info handle
5451 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5452 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5453 the defined types of signals.
5454
5455 @item info signals @var{sig}
5456 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5457
5458 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5459
5460 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5461 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5462 for details about this command.
5463
5464 @kindex handle
5465 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5466 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5467 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5468 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5469 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5470 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5471 say what change to make.
5472 @end table
5473
5474 @c @group
5475 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5476 Their full names are:
5477
5478 @table @code
5479 @item nostop
5480 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5481 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5482
5483 @item stop
5484 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5485 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5486
5487 @item print
5488 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5489
5490 @item noprint
5491 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5492 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5493
5494 @item pass
5495 @itemx noignore
5496 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5497 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5498 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5499
5500 @item nopass
5501 @itemx ignore
5502 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5503 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5504 @end table
5505 @c @end group
5506
5507 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5508 program until you
5509 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5510 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5511 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5512 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5513 program sees that signal when you continue.
5514
5515 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5516 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5517 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5518 erroneous signals.
5519
5520 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5521 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5522 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5523 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5524 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5525 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5526 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5527 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5528 Program a Signal}.
5529
5530 @cindex extra signal information
5531 @anchor{extra signal information}
5532
5533 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5534 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5535 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5536 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5537 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5538 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5539 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5540 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5541 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5542 system header.
5543
5544 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5545 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5546
5547 @smallexample
5548 @group
5549 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5550 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5551 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5552 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5553 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5554 type = struct @{
5555 int si_signo;
5556 int si_errno;
5557 int si_code;
5558 union @{
5559 int _pad[28];
5560 struct @{...@} _kill;
5561 struct @{...@} _timer;
5562 struct @{...@} _rt;
5563 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5564 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5565 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5566 @} _sifields;
5567 @}
5568 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5569 type = struct @{
5570 void *si_addr;
5571 @}
5572 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5573 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5574 @end group
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5578
5579 @node Thread Stops
5580 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5581
5582 @cindex stopped threads
5583 @cindex threads, stopped
5584
5585 @cindex continuing threads
5586 @cindex threads, continuing
5587
5588 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5589 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5590 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5591 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5592 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5593 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5594 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5595 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5596 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5597
5598 @menu
5599 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5600 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5601 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5602 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5603 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5604 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5605 @end menu
5606
5607 @node All-Stop Mode
5608 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5609
5610 @cindex all-stop mode
5611
5612 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5613 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5614 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5615 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5616 underfoot.
5617
5618 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5619 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5620 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5621
5622 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5623 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5624 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5625 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5626 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5627 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5628 stops.
5629
5630 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5631 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5632 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5633 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5634
5635 @cindex automatic thread selection
5636 @cindex switching threads automatically
5637 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5638 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5639 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5640 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5641 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5642 thread.
5643
5644 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5645 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5646
5647 @table @code
5648 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5649 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5650 @cindex lock scheduler
5651 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5652 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5653 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5654 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5655 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5656 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5657 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5658 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5659 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5660 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5661 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5662 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5663
5664 @item show scheduler-locking
5665 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5666 @end table
5667
5668 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5669 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5670 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5671 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5672 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5673 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5674 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5675 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5676 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5677 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5678 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5679 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5680 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5681 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5682
5683 @table @code
5684 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5685 @item set schedule-multiple
5686 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5687 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5688 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5689 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5690 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5691 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5692
5693 @item show schedule-multiple
5694 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5695 multiple processes.
5696 @end table
5697
5698 @node Non-Stop Mode
5699 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5700
5701 @cindex non-stop mode
5702
5703 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5704 @c with more details.
5705
5706 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5707 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5708 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5709 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5710 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5711 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5712
5713 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5714 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5715 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5716 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5717 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5718 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5719 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5720 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5721 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5722 independently and simultaneously.
5723
5724 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5725 or attach to your program:
5726
5727 @smallexample
5728 # Enable the async interface.
5729 set target-async 1
5730
5731 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5732 set pagination off
5733
5734 # Finally, turn it on!
5735 set non-stop on
5736 @end smallexample
5737
5738 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5739
5740 @table @code
5741 @kindex set non-stop
5742 @item set non-stop on
5743 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5744 @item set non-stop off
5745 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5746 @kindex show non-stop
5747 @item show non-stop
5748 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5749 @end table
5750
5751 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5752 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5753 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5754 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5755 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5756 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5757 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5758 default.
5759
5760 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5761 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5762 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5763
5764 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5765 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5766 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5767 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5768 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5769
5770 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5771 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5772 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5773 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5774 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5775
5776 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5777
5778 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5779 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5780 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5781 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5782 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5783 previously current thread.
5784
5785 @node Background Execution
5786 @subsection Background Execution
5787
5788 @cindex foreground execution
5789 @cindex background execution
5790 @cindex asynchronous execution
5791 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5792
5793 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5794 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5795 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5796 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5797 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5798 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5799
5800 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5801 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5802 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5803
5804 @table @code
5805 @kindex set target-async
5806 @item set target-async on
5807 Enable asynchronous mode.
5808 @item set target-async off
5809 Disable asynchronous mode.
5810 @kindex show target-async
5811 @item show target-async
5812 Show the current target-async setting.
5813 @end table
5814
5815 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5816 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5817
5818 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5819 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5820 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5821 are:
5822
5823 @table @code
5824 @kindex run&
5825 @item run
5826 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5827
5828 @item attach
5829 @kindex attach&
5830 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5831
5832 @item step
5833 @kindex step&
5834 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5835
5836 @item stepi
5837 @kindex stepi&
5838 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5839
5840 @item next
5841 @kindex next&
5842 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5843
5844 @item nexti
5845 @kindex nexti&
5846 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5847
5848 @item continue
5849 @kindex continue&
5850 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5851
5852 @item finish
5853 @kindex finish&
5854 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5855
5856 @item until
5857 @kindex until&
5858 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5859
5860 @end table
5861
5862 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5863 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5864 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5865 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5866 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5867 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5868
5869 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5870 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5871
5872 @table @code
5873 @kindex interrupt
5874 @item interrupt
5875 @itemx interrupt -a
5876
5877 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5878 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5879 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5880 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5884 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5885
5886 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5887 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5888 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5889
5890 @table @code
5891 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5892 @cindex thread breakpoints
5893 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5894 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5895 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5896 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5897 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5898 specify some source line.
5899
5900 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5901 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5902 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5903 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5904 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5905
5906 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5907 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5908 program.
5909
5910 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5911 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5912 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5913
5914 @smallexample
5915 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5916 @end smallexample
5917
5918 @end table
5919
5920 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5921 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5922 thread list. For example:
5923
5924 @smallexample
5925 (@value{GDBP}) c
5926 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5930 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5931 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5932 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5933 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5934 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5935 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5936 command.
5937
5938 @node Interrupted System Calls
5939 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5940
5941 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5942 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5943 @cindex premature return from system calls
5944 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5945 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5946 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5947 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5948 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5949 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5950 stop execution.
5951
5952 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5953 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5954 style anyways.
5955
5956 For example, do not write code like this:
5957
5958 @smallexample
5959 sleep (10);
5960 @end smallexample
5961
5962 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5963 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5964
5965 Instead, write this:
5966
5967 @smallexample
5968 int unslept = 10;
5969 while (unslept > 0)
5970 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5971 @end smallexample
5972
5973 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5974 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5975 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5976 @value{GDBN}.
5977
5978 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5979 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5980 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5981 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5982
5983 @node Observer Mode
5984 @subsection Observer Mode
5985
5986 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5987 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5988 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5989 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5990 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5991
5992 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5993 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5994 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5995 mode.
5996
5997 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5998 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5999 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6000 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6001 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6002
6003 @table @code
6004
6005 @kindex observer
6006 @item set observer on
6007 @itemx set observer off
6008 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6009 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6010 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6011 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6012
6013 @item show observer
6014 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6015
6016 @kindex may-write-registers
6017 @item set may-write-registers on
6018 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6019 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6020 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6021 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6022
6023 @item show may-write-registers
6024 Show the current permission to write registers.
6025
6026 @kindex may-write-memory
6027 @item set may-write-memory on
6028 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6029 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6030 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6031 defaults to @code{on}.
6032
6033 @item show may-write-memory
6034 Show the current permission to write memory.
6035
6036 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6037 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6038 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6039 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6040 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6041 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6042
6043 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6044 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6045
6046 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6047 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6048 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6049 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6050 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6051 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6052 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6053
6054 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6055 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6056
6057 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6058 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6059 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6060 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6061 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6062 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6063 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6064
6065 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6066 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6067
6068 @kindex may-interrupt
6069 @item set may-interrupt on
6070 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6071 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6072 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6073 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6074 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6075
6076 @item show may-interrupt
6077 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6078
6079 @end table
6080
6081 @node Reverse Execution
6082 @chapter Running programs backward
6083 @cindex reverse execution
6084 @cindex running programs backward
6085
6086 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6087 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6088 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6089 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6090
6091 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6092 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6093 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6094 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6095 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6096 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6097
6098 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6099 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6100 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6101 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6102 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6103 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6104 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6105 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6106 prior values@footnote{
6107 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6108 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6109 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6110
6111 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6112 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6113 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6114 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6115 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6116 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6117 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6118 }.
6119
6120 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6121 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6122
6123 @table @code
6124 @kindex reverse-continue
6125 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6126 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6127 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6128 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6129 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6130 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6131 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6132
6133 @kindex reverse-step
6134 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6135 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6136 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6137 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6138
6139 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6140 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6141 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6142 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6143 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6144 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6145
6146 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6147 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6148
6149 @kindex reverse-stepi
6150 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6151 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6152 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6153 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6154 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6155 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6156 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6157
6158 @kindex reverse-next
6159 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6160 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6161 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6162 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6163 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6164 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6165 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6166 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6167 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6168 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6169
6170 @kindex reverse-nexti
6171 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6172 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6173 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6174 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6175 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6176 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6177 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6178 frame) is reached.
6179
6180 @kindex reverse-finish
6181 @item reverse-finish
6182 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6183 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6184 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6185 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6186
6187 @kindex set exec-direction
6188 @item set exec-direction
6189 Set the direction of target execution.
6190 @item set exec-direction reverse
6191 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6192 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6193 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6194 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6195 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6196 @item set exec-direction forward
6197 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6198 This is the default.
6199 @end table
6200
6201
6202 @node Process Record and Replay
6203 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6204 @cindex process record and replay
6205 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6206
6207 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6208 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6209 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6210
6211 @cindex replay mode
6212 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6213 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6214 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6215 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6216 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6217 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6218 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6219 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6220 execution log.
6221
6222 @cindex record mode
6223 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6224 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6225 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6226 for future replay.
6227
6228 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6229 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6230 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6231 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6232 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6233 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6234
6235 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6236 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6237 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6238 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6239
6240 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6241 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6242
6243 @table @code
6244 @kindex target record
6245 @kindex target record-full
6246 @kindex target record-btrace
6247 @kindex record
6248 @kindex record full
6249 @kindex record btrace
6250 @kindex rec
6251 @kindex rec full
6252 @kindex rec btrace
6253 @item record @var{method}
6254 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6255 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6256 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6257 recording methods are available:
6258
6259 @table @code
6260 @item full
6261 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6262 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6263 execution.
6264
6265 @item btrace
6266 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6267 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6268 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6269 reverse execution.
6270
6271 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6272 @end table
6273
6274 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6275 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6276 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6277 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6278
6279 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6280 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6281
6282 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6283 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6284 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6285 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6286 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6287
6288 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6289 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6290 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6291 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6292 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6293 does not support these two modes.
6294
6295 @kindex record stop
6296 @kindex rec s
6297 @item record stop
6298 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6299 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6300 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6301
6302 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6303 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6304 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6305 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6306 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6307
6308 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6309 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6310 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6311 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6312 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6313
6314 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6315 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6316
6317 @kindex record goto
6318 @item record goto
6319 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6320 ways to specify the location to go to:
6321
6322 @table @code
6323 @item record goto begin
6324 @itemx record goto start
6325 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6326
6327 @item record goto end
6328 Go to the end of the execution log.
6329
6330 @item record goto @var{n}
6331 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6332 @end table
6333
6334 @kindex record save
6335 @item record save @var{filename}
6336 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6337 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6338 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6339
6340 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6341
6342 @kindex record restore
6343 @item record restore @var{filename}
6344 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6345 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6346
6347 @kindex set record full
6348 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6349 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6350 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6351 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6352
6353 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6354 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6355 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6356 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6357 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6358 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6359 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6360 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6361
6362 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6363 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6364 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6365
6366 @kindex show record full
6367 @item show record full insn-number-max
6368 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6369 recording method.
6370
6371 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6372 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6373 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6374 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6375 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6376 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6377 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6378 oldest one to be deleted.
6379
6380 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6381 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6382
6383 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6384 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6385
6386 @item set record full memory-query
6387 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6388 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6389 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6390 case.
6391
6392 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6393 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6394 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6395 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6396 results.
6397
6398 @item show record full memory-query
6399 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6400
6401 @kindex info record
6402 @item info record
6403 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6404 method:
6405
6406 @table @code
6407 @item full
6408 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6409 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6410
6411 @itemize @bullet
6412 @item
6413 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6414 @item
6415 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6416 @item
6417 Highest recorded instruction number.
6418 @item
6419 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6420 @item
6421 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6422 @item
6423 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6424 @end itemize
6425
6426 @item btrace
6427 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6428 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6429 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6430 @end table
6431
6432 @kindex record delete
6433 @kindex rec del
6434 @item record delete
6435 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6436 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6437 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6438 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6439
6440 @kindex record instruction-history
6441 @kindex rec instruction-history
6442 @item record instruction-history
6443 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6444 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6445 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6446 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6447 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6448
6449 @table @code
6450 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6451 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6452 @var{insn}.
6453
6454 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6455 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6456 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6457 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6458 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6459 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6460
6461 @item record instruction-history
6462 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6463
6464 @item record instruction-history -
6465 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6466
6467 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6468 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6469 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6470 number @var{end} is included.
6471 @end table
6472
6473 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6474
6475 @kindex set record
6476 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6477 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6478 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6479 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6480 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6481
6482 @kindex show record
6483 @item show record instruction-history-size
6484 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6485 instruction-history} command.
6486
6487 @kindex record function-call-history
6488 @kindex rec function-call-history
6489 @item record function-call-history
6490 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6491 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6492 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6493 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6494 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6495 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6496 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6497 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6498 given together.
6499
6500 @smallexample
6501 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6502 1 void foo (void)
6503 2 @{
6504 3 @}
6505 4
6506 5 void bar (void)
6507 6 @{
6508 7 ...
6509 8 foo ();
6510 9 ...
6511 10 @}
6512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6513 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6514 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6515 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6516 @end smallexample
6517
6518 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6519 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6520 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6521 to print:
6522
6523 @table @code
6524 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6525 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6526
6527 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6528 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6529 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6530 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6531 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6532
6533 @item record function-call-history
6534 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6535
6536 @item record function-call-history -
6537 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6538
6539 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6540 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6541 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6542 @end table
6543
6544 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6545
6546 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6547 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6548 Define how many lines to print in the
6549 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6550 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6551
6552 @item show record function-call-history-size
6553 Show how many lines to print in the
6554 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6555 @end table
6556
6557
6558 @node Stack
6559 @chapter Examining the Stack
6560
6561 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6562 stopped and how it got there.
6563
6564 @cindex call stack
6565 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6566 is generated.
6567 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6568 the arguments of the call,
6569 and the local variables of the function being called.
6570 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6571 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6572 stack}.
6573
6574 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6575 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6576
6577 @cindex selected frame
6578 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6579 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6580 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6581 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6582 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6583 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6584
6585 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6586 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6587 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6588
6589 @menu
6590 * Frames:: Stack frames
6591 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6592 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6593 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6594 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6595
6596 @end menu
6597
6598 @node Frames
6599 @section Stack Frames
6600
6601 @cindex frame, definition
6602 @cindex stack frame
6603 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6604 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6605 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6606 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6607 which the function is executing.
6608
6609 @cindex initial frame
6610 @cindex outermost frame
6611 @cindex innermost frame
6612 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6613 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6614 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6615 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6616 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6617 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6618 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6619 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6620
6621 @cindex frame pointer
6622 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6623 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6624 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6625 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6626 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6627 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6628
6629 @cindex frame number
6630 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6631 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6632 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6633 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6634 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6635
6636 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6637 @c underflow problems.
6638 @cindex frameless execution
6639 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6640 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6641 @smallexample
6642 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6643 @end smallexample
6644 generates functions without a frame.)
6645 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6646 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6647 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6648 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6649 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6650 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6651 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6652
6653 @table @code
6654 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6655 @cindex current stack frame
6656 @item frame @var{args}
6657 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6658 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6659 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6660 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6661
6662 @kindex select-frame
6663 @cindex selecting frame silently
6664 @item select-frame
6665 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6666 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6667 @code{frame}.
6668 @end table
6669
6670 @node Backtrace
6671 @section Backtraces
6672
6673 @cindex traceback
6674 @cindex call stack traces
6675 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6676 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6677 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6678 stack.
6679
6680 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6681 @table @code
6682 @kindex backtrace
6683 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6684 @item backtrace
6685 @itemx bt
6686 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6687 frames in the stack.
6688
6689 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6690 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6691
6692 @item backtrace @var{n}
6693 @itemx bt @var{n}
6694 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6695
6696 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6697 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6698 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6699
6700 @item backtrace full
6701 @itemx bt full
6702 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6703 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6704 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6705 number of frames to print, as described above.
6706
6707 @item backtrace no-filters
6708 @itemx bt no-filters
6709 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6710 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6711 @itemx bt no-filters full
6712 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6713 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6714 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6715 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6716 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6717 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6718 support.
6719 @end table
6720
6721 @kindex where
6722 @kindex info stack
6723 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6724 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6725
6726 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6727 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6728 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6729 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6730 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6731 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6732 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6733 multi-threaded program.
6734
6735 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6736 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6737 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6738 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6739 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6740 line number.
6741
6742 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6743 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6744
6745 @smallexample
6746 @group
6747 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6748 at builtin.c:993
6749 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6750 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6751 at macro.c:71
6752 (More stack frames follow...)
6753 @end group
6754 @end smallexample
6755
6756 @noindent
6757 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6758 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6759 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6760
6761 @noindent
6762 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6763 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6764 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6765 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6766 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6767
6768 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6769 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6770 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6771 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6772 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6773 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6774 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6775 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6776 such a backtrace might look like:
6777
6778 @smallexample
6779 @group
6780 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6781 at builtin.c:993
6782 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6783 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6784 at macro.c:71
6785 (More stack frames follow...)
6786 @end group
6787 @end smallexample
6788
6789 @noindent
6790 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6791 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6792
6793 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6794 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6795 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6796
6797 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6798 @cindex program entry point
6799 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6800 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6801 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6802 @code{main}@footnote{
6803 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6804 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6805 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6806 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6807 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6808 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6809
6810 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6811 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6812
6813 @table @code
6814 @item set backtrace past-main
6815 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6816 @kindex set backtrace
6817 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6818
6819 @item set backtrace past-main off
6820 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6821 default.
6822
6823 @item show backtrace past-main
6824 @kindex show backtrace
6825 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6826
6827 @item set backtrace past-entry
6828 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6829 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6830 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6831 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6832
6833 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6834 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6835 application. This is the default.
6836
6837 @item show backtrace past-entry
6838 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6839
6840 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6841 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6842 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6843 @cindex backtrace limit
6844 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6845 or zero means unlimited levels.
6846
6847 @item show backtrace limit
6848 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6849 @end table
6850
6851 You can control how file names are displayed.
6852
6853 @table @code
6854 @item set filename-display
6855 @itemx set filename-display relative
6856 @cindex filename-display
6857 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6858
6859 @item set filename-display basename
6860 Display only basename of a filename.
6861
6862 @item set filename-display absolute
6863 Display an absolute filename.
6864
6865 @item show filename-display
6866 Show the current way to display filenames.
6867 @end table
6868
6869 @node Frame Filter Management
6870 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6871 @cindex managing frame filters
6872
6873 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6874 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6875
6876 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6877 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6878
6879 @table @code
6880 @kindex info frame-filter
6881 @item info frame-filter
6882 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6883 their name, priority and enabled status.
6884
6885 @kindex disable frame-filter
6886 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6887 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6888 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6889 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6890 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6891 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6892 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6893 across all dictionaries are disabled. @var{filter-name} is the name
6894 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6895 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6896 may be enabled again later.
6897
6898 @kindex enable frame-filter
6899 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6900 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6901 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6902 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6903 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6904 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6905 all dictionaries are enabled. @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6906 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6907 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6908
6909 Example:
6910
6911 @smallexample
6912 (gdb) info frame-filter
6913
6914 global frame-filters:
6915 Priority Enabled Name
6916 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6917 100 Yes Reverse
6918
6919 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6920 Priority Enabled Name
6921 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6922
6923 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6924 Priority Enabled Name
6925 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6926
6927 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6928 (gdb) info frame-filter
6929
6930 global frame-filters:
6931 Priority Enabled Name
6932 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6933 100 Yes Reverse
6934
6935 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6936 Priority Enabled Name
6937 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6938
6939 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6940 Priority Enabled Name
6941 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6942
6943 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
6944 (gdb) info frame-filter
6945
6946 global frame-filters:
6947 Priority Enabled Name
6948 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6949 100 Yes Reverse
6950
6951 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6952 Priority Enabled Name
6953 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6954
6955 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6956 Priority Enabled Name
6957 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6958 @end smallexample
6959
6960 @kindex set frame-filter priority
6961 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
6962 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6963 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6964 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6965 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6966 dictionary resides. @var{priority} is an integer.
6967
6968 @kindex show frame-filter priority
6969 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6970 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6971 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6972 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6973 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6974 dictionary resides.
6975
6976 Example:
6977
6978 @smallexample
6979 (gdb) info frame-filter
6980
6981 global frame-filters:
6982 Priority Enabled Name
6983 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6984 100 Yes Reverse
6985
6986 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6987 Priority Enabled Name
6988 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6989
6990 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6991 Priority Enabled Name
6992 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6993
6994 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
6995 (gdb) info frame-filter
6996
6997 global frame-filters:
6998 Priority Enabled Name
6999 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7000 50 Yes Reverse
7001
7002 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7003 Priority Enabled Name
7004 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7005
7006 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7007 Priority Enabled Name
7008 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7009 @end smallexample
7010 @end table
7011
7012 @node Selection
7013 @section Selecting a Frame
7014
7015 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7016 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7017 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7018 of the stack frame just selected.
7019
7020 @table @code
7021 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7022 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7023 @item frame @var{n}
7024 @itemx f @var{n}
7025 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7026 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7027 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7028 @code{main}.
7029
7030 @item frame @var{addr}
7031 @itemx f @var{addr}
7032 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7033 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7034 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7035 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7036 switches between them.
7037
7038 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7039 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7040
7041 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7042 pointer and a program counter.
7043
7044 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7045 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7046
7047 @kindex up
7048 @item up @var{n}
7049 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7050 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
7051 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
7052
7053 @kindex down
7054 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7055 @item down @var{n}
7056 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7057 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
7058 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
7059 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7060 @end table
7061
7062 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7063 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7064 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7065 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7066
7067 @need 1000
7068 For example:
7069
7070 @smallexample
7071 @group
7072 (@value{GDBP}) up
7073 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7074 at env.c:10
7075 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7076 @end group
7077 @end smallexample
7078
7079 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7080 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7081 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7082 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7083 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7084 for details.
7085
7086 @table @code
7087 @kindex down-silently
7088 @kindex up-silently
7089 @item up-silently @var{n}
7090 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7091 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7092 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7093 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7094 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7095 distracting.
7096 @end table
7097
7098 @node Frame Info
7099 @section Information About a Frame
7100
7101 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7102 stack frame.
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @item frame
7106 @itemx f
7107 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7108 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7109 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7110 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7111 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7112
7113 @kindex info frame
7114 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7115 @item info frame
7116 @itemx info f
7117 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7118 including:
7119
7120 @itemize @bullet
7121 @item
7122 the address of the frame
7123 @item
7124 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7125 @item
7126 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7127 @item
7128 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7129 @item
7130 the address of the frame's arguments
7131 @item
7132 the address of the frame's local variables
7133 @item
7134 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7135 @item
7136 which registers were saved in the frame
7137 @end itemize
7138
7139 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7140 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7141 the usual conventions.
7142
7143 @item info frame @var{addr}
7144 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7145 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7146 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7147 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7148 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7149 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7150
7151 @kindex info args
7152 @item info args
7153 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7154
7155 @item info locals
7156 @kindex info locals
7157 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7158 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7159 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7160
7161 @end table
7162
7163
7164 @node Source
7165 @chapter Examining Source Files
7166
7167 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7168 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7169 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7170 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7171 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7172 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7173 source files by explicit command.
7174
7175 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7176 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7177 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7178
7179 @menu
7180 * List:: Printing source lines
7181 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7182 * Edit:: Editing source files
7183 * Search:: Searching source files
7184 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7185 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7186 @end menu
7187
7188 @node List
7189 @section Printing Source Lines
7190
7191 @kindex list
7192 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7193 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7194 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7195 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7196 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7197
7198 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7199
7200 @table @code
7201 @item list @var{linenum}
7202 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7203 current source file.
7204
7205 @item list @var{function}
7206 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7207 @var{function}.
7208
7209 @item list
7210 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7211 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7212 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7213 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7214 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7215
7216 @item list -
7217 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7218 @end table
7219
7220 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7221 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7222 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7223
7224 @table @code
7225 @kindex set listsize
7226 @item set listsize @var{count}
7227 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7228 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7229 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7230 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7231
7232 @kindex show listsize
7233 @item show listsize
7234 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7235 @end table
7236
7237 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7238 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7239 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7240 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7241 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7242
7243 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7244 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7245 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7246 to specify some source line.
7247
7248 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7249
7250 @table @code
7251 @item list @var{linespec}
7252 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7253
7254 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7255 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7256 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7257 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7258 the same source file as the first linespec.
7259
7260 @item list ,@var{last}
7261 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7262
7263 @item list @var{first},
7264 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7265
7266 @item list +
7267 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7268
7269 @item list -
7270 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7271
7272 @item list
7273 As described in the preceding table.
7274 @end table
7275
7276 @node Specify Location
7277 @section Specifying a Location
7278 @cindex specifying location
7279 @cindex linespec
7280
7281 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7282 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7283 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7284 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7285
7286 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7287 @value{GDBN} understands:
7288
7289 @table @code
7290 @item @var{linenum}
7291 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7292
7293 @item -@var{offset}
7294 @itemx +@var{offset}
7295 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7296 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7297 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7298 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7299 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7300 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7301 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7302 linespec.
7303
7304 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7305 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7306 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7307 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7308 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7309 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7310 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7311
7312 @item @var{function}
7313 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7314 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7315
7316 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7317 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7318
7319 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7320 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7321 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7322 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7323 functions in different source files.
7324
7325 @item @var{label}
7326 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7327 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7328 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7329 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7330 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7331
7332 @item *@var{address}
7333 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7334 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7335 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7336 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7337 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7338 source files.
7339
7340 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7341 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7342 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7343 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7344 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7345 of @var{address}:
7346
7347 @table @code
7348 @item @var{expression}
7349 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7350
7351 @item @var{funcaddr}
7352 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7353 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7354 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7355 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7356 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7357 (although the Pascal form also works).
7358
7359 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7360 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7361
7362 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7363 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7364 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7365 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7366 functions with identical names in different source files.
7367 @end table
7368
7369 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7370 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7371 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7372 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7373 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7374 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7375
7376 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7377 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7378 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7379 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7380 each one of those probes.
7381
7382 @end table
7383
7384
7385 @node Edit
7386 @section Editing Source Files
7387 @cindex editing source files
7388
7389 @kindex edit
7390 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7391 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7392 The editing program of your choice
7393 is invoked with the current line set to
7394 the active line in the program.
7395 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7396 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7397
7398 @table @code
7399 @item edit @var{location}
7400 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7401 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7402 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7403 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7404 command most commonly used:
7405
7406 @table @code
7407 @item edit @var{number}
7408 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7409
7410 @item edit @var{function}
7411 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7412 @end table
7413
7414 @end table
7415
7416 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7417 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7418 @footnote{
7419 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7420 following command-line syntax:
7421 @smallexample
7422 ex +@var{number} file
7423 @end smallexample
7424 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7425 the file where to start editing.}.
7426 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7427 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7428 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7429 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7430 @smallexample
7431 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7432 export EDITOR
7433 gdb @dots{}
7434 @end smallexample
7435 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7436 @smallexample
7437 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7438 gdb @dots{}
7439 @end smallexample
7440
7441 @node Search
7442 @section Searching Source Files
7443 @cindex searching source files
7444
7445 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7446 regular expression.
7447
7448 @table @code
7449 @kindex search
7450 @kindex forward-search
7451 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7452 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7453 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7454 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7455 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7456 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7457 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7458 @code{fo}.
7459
7460 @kindex reverse-search
7461 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7462 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7463 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7464 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7465 this command as @code{rev}.
7466 @end table
7467
7468 @node Source Path
7469 @section Specifying Source Directories
7470
7471 @cindex source path
7472 @cindex directories for source files
7473 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7474 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7475 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7476 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7477 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7478 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7479 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7480
7481 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7482 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7483 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7484 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7485 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7486 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7487 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7488 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7489 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7490 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7491 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7492
7493 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7494 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7495 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7496 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7497 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7498 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7499
7500 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7501 source files.
7502
7503 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7504 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7505 each line is in the file.
7506
7507 @kindex directory
7508 @kindex dir
7509 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7510 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7511 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7512
7513 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7514 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7515
7516 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7517 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7518 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7519 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7520 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7521 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7522 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7523 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7524 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7525 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7526 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7527 name to look up the sources.
7528
7529 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7530 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7531 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7532 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7533 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7534 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7535 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7536 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7537
7538 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7539 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7540 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7541 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7542 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7543 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7544 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7545
7546 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7547 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7548 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7549 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7550 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7551 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7552 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7553 command.
7554
7555 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7556 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7557 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7558 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7559 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7560 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7561 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7562
7563 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7564 @cindex default source path substitution
7565 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7566 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7567 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7568 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7569 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7570 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7571 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7572 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7573 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7574 together.
7575
7576 @table @code
7577 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7578 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7579 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7580 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7581 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7582 part of absolute file names) or
7583 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7584 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7585
7586 @kindex cdir
7587 @kindex cwd
7588 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7589 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7590 @cindex compilation directory
7591 @cindex current directory
7592 @cindex working directory
7593 @cindex directory, current
7594 @cindex directory, compilation
7595 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7596 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7597 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7598 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7599 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7600 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7601
7602 @item directory
7603 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7604
7605 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7606 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7607
7608 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7609 @kindex set directories
7610 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7611 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7612
7613 @item show directories
7614 @kindex show directories
7615 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7616
7617 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7618 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7619 @kindex set substitute-path
7620 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7621 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7622 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7623
7624 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7625 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7626
7627 @smallexample
7628 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7629 @end smallexample
7630
7631 @noindent
7632 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7633 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7634 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7635
7636 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7637 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7638 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7639 the substitution.
7640
7641 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7642
7643 @smallexample
7644 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7645 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7646 @end smallexample
7647
7648 @noindent
7649 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7650 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7651 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7652 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7653
7654
7655 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7656 @kindex unset substitute-path
7657 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7658 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7659 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7660
7661 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7662
7663 @item show substitute-path [path]
7664 @kindex show substitute-path
7665 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7666 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7667
7668 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7669 rules.
7670
7671 @end table
7672
7673 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7674 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7675 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7676
7677 @enumerate
7678 @item
7679 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7680
7681 @item
7682 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7683 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7684 directories in one command.
7685 @end enumerate
7686
7687 @node Machine Code
7688 @section Source and Machine Code
7689 @cindex source line and its code address
7690
7691 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7692 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7693 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7694 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7695 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7696 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7697 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7698 well as hex.
7699
7700 @table @code
7701 @kindex info line
7702 @item info line @var{linespec}
7703 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7704 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7705 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7706 @end table
7707
7708 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7709 the object code for the first line of function
7710 @code{m4_changequote}:
7711
7712 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7713 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7714 @smallexample
7715 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7716 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7717 @end smallexample
7718
7719 @noindent
7720 @cindex code address and its source line
7721 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7722 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7723 @smallexample
7724 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7725 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7726 @end smallexample
7727
7728 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7729 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7730 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7731 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7732 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7733 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7734 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7735 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7736 Variables}).
7737
7738 @table @code
7739 @kindex disassemble
7740 @cindex assembly instructions
7741 @cindex instructions, assembly
7742 @cindex machine instructions
7743 @cindex listing machine instructions
7744 @item disassemble
7745 @itemx disassemble /m
7746 @itemx disassemble /r
7747 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7748 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7749 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7750 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7751 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7752 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7753 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7754 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7755 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7756 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7760 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7761 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7762 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7763 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7764 @end table
7765
7766 @noindent
7767 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7768 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7769
7770 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7771 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7772
7773 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7774 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7775 @end table
7776
7777 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7778 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7779
7780 @smallexample
7781 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7782 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7783 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7784 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7785 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7786 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7787 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7788 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7789 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7790 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7791 End of assembler dump.
7792 @end smallexample
7793
7794 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7795 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7796
7797 @smallexample
7798 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7799 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7800 5 @{
7801 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7802 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7803 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7804 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7805 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7806
7807 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7808 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7809 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7810
7811 7 return 0;
7812 8 @}
7813 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7814 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7815 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7816
7817 End of assembler dump.
7818 @end smallexample
7819
7820 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7821
7822 @smallexample
7823 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7824 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7825 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7826 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7827 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7828 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7829 End of assembler dump.
7830 @end smallexample
7831
7832 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7833 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7834 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7835 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7836
7837 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7838 mnemonics or other syntax.
7839
7840 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7841 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7842 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7843 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7844 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7845
7846 @table @code
7847 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7848 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7849 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7850 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7851 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7852 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7853
7854 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7855 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7856 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7857 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7858
7859 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7860 @item show disassembly-flavor
7861 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7862 @end table
7863
7864 @table @code
7865 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7866 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7867 @item set disassemble-next-line
7868 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7869 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7870 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7871 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7872 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7873 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7874 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7875 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7876 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7877 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7878 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7879 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7880 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7881 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7882 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7883 instruction.
7884 @end table
7885
7886
7887 @node Data
7888 @chapter Examining Data
7889
7890 @cindex printing data
7891 @cindex examining data
7892 @kindex print
7893 @kindex inspect
7894 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7895 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7896 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7897 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7898 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7899 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7900
7901 @table @code
7902 @item print @var{expr}
7903 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7904 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7905 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7906 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7907 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7908 Formats}.
7909
7910 @item print
7911 @itemx print /@var{f}
7912 @cindex reprint the last value
7913 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7914 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7915 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7916 @end table
7917
7918 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7919 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7920 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7921
7922 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7923 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7924 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7925 Table}.
7926
7927 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7928 @kindex explore
7929 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7930 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7931 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7932 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7933 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7934 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7935 embedded in the higher level data types.
7936
7937 @table @code
7938 @item explore @var{arg}
7939 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7940 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7941 @end table
7942
7943 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7944 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7945 C program as
7946
7947 @smallexample
7948 struct SimpleStruct
7949 @{
7950 int i;
7951 double d;
7952 @};
7953
7954 struct ComplexStruct
7955 @{
7956 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
7957 int arr[10];
7958 @};
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 followed by variable declarations as
7963
7964 @smallexample
7965 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
7966 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
7967 @end smallexample
7968
7969 @noindent
7970 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
7971 @code{explore} command as follows.
7972
7973 @smallexample
7974 (gdb) explore cs
7975 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
7976 the following fields:
7977
7978 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
7979 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
7980
7981 Enter the field number of choice:
7982 @end smallexample
7983
7984 @noindent
7985 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
7986 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
7987 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
7988 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
7989 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
7990 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
7991 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
7992 field will be explored as if it were an array.
7993
7994 @smallexample
7995 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
7996 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
7997 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
7998 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
7999
8000 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8001 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8002
8003 Press enter to return to parent value:
8004 @end smallexample
8005
8006 @noindent
8007 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8008 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8009 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8010 to explore.
8011
8012 @smallexample
8013 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8014 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8015
8016 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8017
8018 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8019
8020 Press enter to return to parent value:
8021 @end smallexample
8022
8023 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8024 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8025 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8026 level data structure).
8027
8028 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8029 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8030 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8031 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8032 same example as above, your can explore the type
8033 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8034 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8035
8036 @smallexample
8037 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8038 @end smallexample
8039
8040 @noindent
8041 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8042 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8043 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8044 example.
8045
8046 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8047 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8048 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8049 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8050 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @item explore value @var{expr}
8054 @cindex explore value
8055 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8056 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8057 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8058 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8059 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8060
8061 @item explore type @var{arg}
8062 @cindex explore type
8063 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8064 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8065 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8066 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8067 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8068 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8069 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8070 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8071 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8072 @end table
8073
8074 @menu
8075 * Expressions:: Expressions
8076 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8077 * Variables:: Program variables
8078 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8079 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8080 * Memory:: Examining memory
8081 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8082 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8083 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8084 * Value History:: Value history
8085 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8086 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8087 * Registers:: Registers
8088 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8089 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8090 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8091 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8092 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8093 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8094 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8095 character set than GDB does
8096 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8097 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8098 @end menu
8099
8100 @node Expressions
8101 @section Expressions
8102
8103 @cindex expressions
8104 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8105 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8106 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8107 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8108 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8109 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8110 @ref{Compilation}.
8111
8112 @cindex arrays in expressions
8113 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8114 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8115 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8116 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8117 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8118 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8119
8120 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8121 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8122 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8123 languages.
8124
8125 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8126 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8127
8128 @cindex casts, in expressions
8129 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8130 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8131 at that address in memory.
8132 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8133
8134 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8135 to programming languages:
8136
8137 @table @code
8138 @item @@
8139 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8140 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8141
8142 @item ::
8143 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8144 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8145
8146 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8147 @cindex type casting memory
8148 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8149 @cindex casts, to view memory
8150 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8151 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8152 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
8153 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
8154 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
8155 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8156 @end table
8157
8158 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8159 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8160 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8161
8162 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8163 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8164 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8165 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8166 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8167 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8168 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8169
8170 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8171 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8172 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8173 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8174 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8175 as well.
8176
8177 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8178 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8179 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8180 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8181 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8182 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8183 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8184 choices.
8185
8186 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8187 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8188 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8189
8190 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8191 @smallexample
8192 @group
8193 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8194 [0] cancel
8195 [1] all
8196 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8197 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8198 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8199 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8200 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8201 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8202 > 2 4 6
8203 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8204 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8205 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8206 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8207 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8208 breakpoints.
8209 (@value{GDBP})
8210 @end group
8211 @end smallexample
8212
8213 @table @code
8214 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8215 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8216 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8217
8218 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8219 is ambiguous.
8220
8221 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8222 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8223 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8224 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8225 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8226 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8227 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8228 in the use of the menu.
8229
8230 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8231 when an ambiguity is detected.
8232
8233 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8234 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8235
8236 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8237 @item show multiple-symbols
8238 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8239 @end table
8240
8241 @node Variables
8242 @section Program Variables
8243
8244 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8245 in your program.
8246
8247 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8248 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8249
8250 @itemize @bullet
8251 @item
8252 global (or file-static)
8253 @end itemize
8254
8255 @noindent or
8256
8257 @itemize @bullet
8258 @item
8259 visible according to the scope rules of the
8260 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8261 @end itemize
8262
8263 @noindent This means that in the function
8264
8265 @smallexample
8266 foo (a)
8267 int a;
8268 @{
8269 bar (a);
8270 @{
8271 int b = test ();
8272 bar (b);
8273 @}
8274 @}
8275 @end smallexample
8276
8277 @noindent
8278 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8279 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8280 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8281 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8282
8283 @cindex variable name conflict
8284 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8285 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8286 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8287 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8288 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8289 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8290 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8291
8292 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8293 @ifnotinfo
8294 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8295 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8296 @end ifnotinfo
8297 @smallexample
8298 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8299 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8300 @end smallexample
8301
8302 @noindent
8303 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8304 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8305 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8306 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8307
8308 @smallexample
8309 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8310 @end smallexample
8311
8312 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8313 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8314 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8315 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8316 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8317
8318 @smallexample
8319 void
8320 foo (int a)
8321 @{
8322 if (a < 10)
8323 bar (a);
8324 else
8325 process (a); /* Stop here */
8326 @}
8327
8328 int
8329 bar (int a)
8330 @{
8331 foo (a + 5);
8332 @}
8333 @end smallexample
8334
8335 @noindent
8336 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8337 here is what you might see
8338 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8339
8340 @smallexample
8341 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8342 $1 = 10
8343 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8344 $2 = 5
8345 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8346 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8347 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8348 $3 = 5
8349 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8350 $4 = 0
8351 @end smallexample
8352
8353 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8354 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8355 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8356 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8357 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8358
8359 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8360 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8361 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8362 @code{some_global}.
8363
8364 @smallexample
8365 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8366 $1 = 23
8367 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8368 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8369 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8370 $2 = 27
8371 @end smallexample
8372
8373 @cindex wrong values
8374 @cindex variable values, wrong
8375 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8376 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8377 @quotation
8378 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8379 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8380 scope, and just before exit.
8381 @end quotation
8382 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8383 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8384 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8385 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8386 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8387 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8388 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8389 variable definitions may be gone.
8390
8391 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8392 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8393 when compiling.
8394
8395 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8396 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8397 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8398 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8399 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8400 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8401 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8402
8403 @smallexample
8404 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8405 @end smallexample
8406
8407 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8408 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8409 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8410 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8411 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8412
8413 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8414 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8415 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8416 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8417
8418 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8419 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8420 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8421 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8422 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8423
8424 @smallexample
8425 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8426 29 i++;
8427 (gdb) next
8428 30 e (i);
8429 (gdb) print i
8430 $1 = 31
8431 (gdb) print i@@entry
8432 $2 = 30
8433 @end smallexample
8434
8435 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8436 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8437 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8438 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8439 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8440 For program code
8441
8442 @smallexample
8443 char var0[] = "A";
8444 signed char var1[] = "A";
8445 @end smallexample
8446
8447 You get during debugging
8448 @smallexample
8449 (gdb) print var0
8450 $1 = "A"
8451 (gdb) print var1
8452 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8453 @end smallexample
8454
8455 @node Arrays
8456 @section Artificial Arrays
8457
8458 @cindex artificial array
8459 @cindex arrays
8460 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8461 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8462 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8463 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8464 program.
8465
8466 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8467 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8468 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8469 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8470 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8471 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8472 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8473 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8474 example. If a program says
8475
8476 @smallexample
8477 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8478 @end smallexample
8479
8480 @noindent
8481 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8482
8483 @smallexample
8484 p *array@@len
8485 @end smallexample
8486
8487 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8488 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8489 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8490 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8491 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8492
8493 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8494 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8495 The value need not be in memory:
8496 @smallexample
8497 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8498 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8499 @end smallexample
8500
8501 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8502 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8503 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8504 @smallexample
8505 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8506 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8507 @end smallexample
8508
8509 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8510 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8511 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8512 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8513 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8514 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8515 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8516 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8517 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8518 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8519
8520 @smallexample
8521 set $i = 0
8522 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8523 @key{RET}
8524 @key{RET}
8525 @dots{}
8526 @end smallexample
8527
8528 @node Output Formats
8529 @section Output Formats
8530
8531 @cindex formatted output
8532 @cindex output formats
8533 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8534 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8535 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8536 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8537 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8538
8539 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8540 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8541 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8542 letters supported are:
8543
8544 @table @code
8545 @item x
8546 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8547 hexadecimal.
8548
8549 @item d
8550 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8551
8552 @item u
8553 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8554
8555 @item o
8556 Print as integer in octal.
8557
8558 @item t
8559 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8560 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8561 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8562 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8563
8564 @item a
8565 @cindex unknown address, locating
8566 @cindex locate address
8567 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8568 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8569 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8570
8571 @smallexample
8572 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8573 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8574 @end smallexample
8575
8576 @noindent
8577 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8578 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8579
8580 @item c
8581 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8582 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8583 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8584 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8585
8586 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8587 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8588 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8589 data.
8590
8591 @item f
8592 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8593 using typical floating point syntax.
8594
8595 @item s
8596 @cindex printing strings
8597 @cindex printing byte arrays
8598 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8599 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8600 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8601 natural types.
8602
8603 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8604 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8605 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8606 array.
8607
8608 @item z
8609 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8610 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8611 to the size of the integer type.
8612
8613 @item r
8614 @cindex raw printing
8615 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8616 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8617 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8618 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8619 pretty-printer which might exist.
8620 @end table
8621
8622 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8623
8624 @smallexample
8625 p/x $pc
8626 @end smallexample
8627
8628 @noindent
8629 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8630 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8631
8632 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8633 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8634 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8635
8636 @node Memory
8637 @section Examining Memory
8638
8639 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8640 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8641
8642 @cindex examining memory
8643 @table @code
8644 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8645 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8646 @itemx x @var{addr}
8647 @itemx x
8648 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8649 @end table
8650
8651 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8652 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8653 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8654 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8655 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8656
8657 @table @r
8658 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8659 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8660 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8661 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8662 @c 4.1.2.
8663
8664 @item @var{f}, the display format
8665 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8666 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8667 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8668 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8669 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8670
8671 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8672 The unit size is any of
8673
8674 @table @code
8675 @item b
8676 Bytes.
8677 @item h
8678 Halfwords (two bytes).
8679 @item w
8680 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8681 @item g
8682 Giant words (eight bytes).
8683 @end table
8684
8685 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8686 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8687 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8688 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8689 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8690 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8691 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8692 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8693 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8694 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8695 be altered.
8696
8697 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8698 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8699 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8700 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8701 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8702 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8703 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8704 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8705 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8706 a value from memory).
8707 @end table
8708
8709 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8710 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8711 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8712 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8713 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8714
8715 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8716 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8717 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8718 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8719 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8720
8721 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8722 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8723 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8724 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8725 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8726 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8727 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8728 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8729 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8730
8731 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8732 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8733 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8734 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8735 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8736 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8737 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8738
8739 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8740 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8741
8742 @smallexample
8743 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8744 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8745 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8746 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8747 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8748 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8749 @end smallexample
8750
8751 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8752 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8753 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8754 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8755 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8756 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8757 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8758 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8759 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8760
8761 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8762 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8763 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8764
8765 @cindex remote memory comparison
8766 @cindex verify remote memory image
8767 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8768 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
8769 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
8770 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
8771 situations.
8772
8773 @table @code
8774 @kindex compare-sections
8775 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8776 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8777 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8778 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8779 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8780 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections. This command's
8781 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
8782 remote request.
8783 @end table
8784
8785 @node Auto Display
8786 @section Automatic Display
8787 @cindex automatic display
8788 @cindex display of expressions
8789
8790 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8791 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8792 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8793 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8794 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8795 The automatic display looks like this:
8796
8797 @smallexample
8798 2: foo = 38
8799 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8800 @end smallexample
8801
8802 @noindent
8803 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8804 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8805 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8806 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8807 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8808 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8809
8810 @table @code
8811 @kindex display
8812 @item display @var{expr}
8813 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8814 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8815
8816 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8817
8818 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8819 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8820 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8821 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8822 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8823
8824 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8825 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8826 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8827 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8828 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8829 @end table
8830
8831 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8832 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8833 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8834
8835 @table @code
8836 @kindex delete display
8837 @kindex undisplay
8838 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8839 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8840 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8841 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8842 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8843 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8844 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8845
8846 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8847 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8848
8849 @kindex disable display
8850 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8851 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8852 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8853 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8854 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8855 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8856 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8857 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8858
8859 @kindex enable display
8860 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8861 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8862 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8863 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8864 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8865 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8866 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8867
8868 @item display
8869 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8870 done when your program stops.
8871
8872 @kindex info display
8873 @item info display
8874 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8875 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8876 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8877 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8878 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8879 @end table
8880
8881 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8882 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8883 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8884 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8885 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8886 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8887 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8888 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8889 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8890 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8891 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8892
8893 @node Print Settings
8894 @section Print Settings
8895
8896 @cindex format options
8897 @cindex print settings
8898 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8899 and symbols are printed.
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8903
8904 @table @code
8905 @kindex set print
8906 @item set print address
8907 @itemx set print address on
8908 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8909 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8910 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8911 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8912 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8913 @code{set print address on}:
8914
8915 @smallexample
8916 @group
8917 (@value{GDBP}) f
8918 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8919 at input.c:530
8920 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8921 @end group
8922 @end smallexample
8923
8924 @item set print address off
8925 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8926 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8927
8928 @smallexample
8929 @group
8930 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8931 (@value{GDBP}) f
8932 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8933 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8934 @end group
8935 @end smallexample
8936
8937 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8938 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8939 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8940 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8941
8942 @kindex show print
8943 @item show print address
8944 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
8945 @end table
8946
8947 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
8948 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
8949 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
8950 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
8951 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
8952 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
8953 it prints a symbolic address:
8954
8955 @table @code
8956 @item set print symbol-filename on
8957 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
8958 @cindex symbol, source file and line
8959 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
8960 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8961
8962 @item set print symbol-filename off
8963 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
8964 default.
8965
8966 @item show print symbol-filename
8967 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
8968 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8969 @end table
8970
8971 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
8972 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
8973 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
8974
8975 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
8976 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
8977
8978 @table @code
8979 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
8980 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
8981 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
8982 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
8983 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
8984 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
8985 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
8986 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
8987
8988 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
8989 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
8990 symbolic address.
8991 @end table
8992
8993 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
8994 @cindex pointer, finding referent
8995 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
8996 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
8997 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
8998 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
8999 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9000 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9001
9002 @smallexample
9003 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9004 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9005 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9006 @end smallexample
9007
9008 @quotation
9009 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9010 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9011 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9012 @end quotation
9013
9014 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9015 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9016
9017 @table @code
9018 @item set print symbol on
9019 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9020 one exists.
9021
9022 @item set print symbol off
9023 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9024 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9025 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9026
9027 @item show print symbol
9028 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9029 address.
9030 @end table
9031
9032 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9033
9034 @table @code
9035 @item set print array
9036 @itemx set print array on
9037 @cindex pretty print arrays
9038 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9039 but uses more space. The default is off.
9040
9041 @item set print array off
9042 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9043
9044 @item show print array
9045 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9046 arrays.
9047
9048 @cindex print array indexes
9049 @item set print array-indexes
9050 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9051 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9052 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9053 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9054
9055 @item set print array-indexes off
9056 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9057
9058 @item show print array-indexes
9059 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9060 arrays.
9061
9062 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9063 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9064 @cindex number of array elements to print
9065 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9066 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9067 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9068 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9069 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9070 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9071 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9072 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9073
9074 @item show print elements
9075 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9076 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9077
9078 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9079 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9080 @cindex printing frame argument values
9081 @cindex print all frame argument values
9082 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9083 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9084 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9085 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9086 values are:
9087
9088 @table @code
9089 @item all
9090 The values of all arguments are printed.
9091
9092 @item scalars
9093 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9094 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9095 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9096 only scalar arguments are shown:
9097
9098 @smallexample
9099 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9100 at frame-args.c:23
9101 @end smallexample
9102
9103 @item none
9104 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9105 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9106
9107 @smallexample
9108 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9109 at frame-args.c:23
9110 @end smallexample
9111 @end table
9112
9113 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9114 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9115 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9116 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9117 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9118 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9119 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9120 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9121 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9122 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9123
9124 @item show print frame-arguments
9125 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9126
9127 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9128 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9129
9130 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9131 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9132 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9133 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9134 This is the default.
9135
9136 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9137 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9138
9139 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9140 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9141 @kindex set print entry-values
9142 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9143 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9144 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9145 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9146 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9147
9148 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9149 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9150 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9151 @code{no} setting.
9152
9153 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9154 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9155 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9156 this information.
9157
9158 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9159
9160 @table @code
9161 @item no
9162 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9163 point.
9164 @smallexample
9165 #0 equal (val=5)
9166 #0 different (val=6)
9167 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9168 #0 born (val=10)
9169 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9170 @end smallexample
9171
9172 @item only
9173 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9174 values are never printed.
9175 @smallexample
9176 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9177 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9178 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9179 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9180 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9181 @end smallexample
9182
9183 @item preferred
9184 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9185 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9186 value for such parameter.
9187 @smallexample
9188 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9189 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9190 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9191 #0 born (val=10)
9192 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9193 @end smallexample
9194
9195 @item if-needed
9196 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9197 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9198 parameter.
9199 @smallexample
9200 #0 equal (val=5)
9201 #0 different (val=6)
9202 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9203 #0 born (val=10)
9204 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9205 @end smallexample
9206
9207 @item both
9208 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9209 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9210 optimizations.
9211 @smallexample
9212 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9213 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9214 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9215 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9216 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9217 @end smallexample
9218
9219 @item compact
9220 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9221 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9222 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9223 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9224 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9225 @smallexample
9226 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9227 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9228 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9229 #0 born (val=10)
9230 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9231 @end smallexample
9232
9233 @item default
9234 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9235 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9236 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9237 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9238 @smallexample
9239 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9240 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9241 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9242 #0 born (val=10)
9243 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9244 @end smallexample
9245 @end table
9246
9247 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9248 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9249
9250 @item show print entry-values
9251 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9252 entry.
9253
9254 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9255 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9256 @cindex repeated array elements
9257 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9258 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9259 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9260 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9261 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9262 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9263 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9264 is 10.
9265
9266 @item show print repeats
9267 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9268 elements.
9269
9270 @item set print null-stop
9271 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9272 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9273 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9274 contain only short strings.
9275 The default is off.
9276
9277 @item show print null-stop
9278 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9279 @sc{null} character.
9280
9281 @item set print pretty on
9282 @cindex print structures in indented form
9283 @cindex indentation in structure display
9284 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9285 per line, like this:
9286
9287 @smallexample
9288 @group
9289 $1 = @{
9290 next = 0x0,
9291 flags = @{
9292 sweet = 1,
9293 sour = 1
9294 @},
9295 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9296 @}
9297 @end group
9298 @end smallexample
9299
9300 @item set print pretty off
9301 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9302
9303 @smallexample
9304 @group
9305 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9306 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9307 @end group
9308 @end smallexample
9309
9310 @noindent
9311 This is the default format.
9312
9313 @item show print pretty
9314 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9315
9316 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9317 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9318 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9319 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9320 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9321 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9322 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9323 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9324
9325 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9326 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9327 international character sets, and is the default.
9328
9329 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9330 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9331
9332 @item set print union on
9333 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9334 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9335 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9336
9337 @item set print union off
9338 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9339 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9340 instead.
9341
9342 @item show print union
9343 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9344 structures and other unions.
9345
9346 For example, given the declarations
9347
9348 @smallexample
9349 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9350 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9351 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9352 Bug_forms;
9353
9354 struct thing @{
9355 Species it;
9356 union @{
9357 Tree_forms tree;
9358 Bug_forms bug;
9359 @} form;
9360 @};
9361
9362 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9363 @end smallexample
9364
9365 @noindent
9366 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9367
9368 @smallexample
9369 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9370 @end smallexample
9371
9372 @noindent
9373 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9374
9375 @smallexample
9376 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9377 @end smallexample
9378
9379 @noindent
9380 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9381 and in Pascal.
9382 @end table
9383
9384 @need 1000
9385 @noindent
9386 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9387
9388 @table @code
9389 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9390 @item set print demangle
9391 @itemx set print demangle on
9392 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9393 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9394 linkage. The default is on.
9395
9396 @item show print demangle
9397 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9398
9399 @item set print asm-demangle
9400 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9401 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9402 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9403 The default is off.
9404
9405 @item show print asm-demangle
9406 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9407 or demangled form.
9408
9409 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9410 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9411 @kindex set demangle-style
9412 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9413 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9414 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9415
9416 @table @code
9417 @item auto
9418 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9419 This is the default.
9420
9421 @item gnu
9422 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9423
9424 @item hp
9425 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9426
9427 @item lucid
9428 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9429
9430 @item arm
9431 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9432 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9433 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9434 require further enhancement to permit that.
9435
9436 @end table
9437 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9438
9439 @item show demangle-style
9440 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9441
9442 @item set print object
9443 @itemx set print object on
9444 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9445 @cindex display derived types
9446 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9447 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9448 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9449 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9450 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9451 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9452 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9453
9454 @item set print object off
9455 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9456 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9457
9458 @item show print object
9459 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9460
9461 @item set print static-members
9462 @itemx set print static-members on
9463 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9464 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9465
9466 @item set print static-members off
9467 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9468
9469 @item show print static-members
9470 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9471
9472 @item set print pascal_static-members
9473 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9474 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9475 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9476 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9477
9478 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9479 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9480
9481 @item show print pascal_static-members
9482 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9483
9484 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9485 @item set print vtbl
9486 @itemx set print vtbl on
9487 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9488 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9489 @cindex VTBL display
9490 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9491 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9492 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9493
9494 @item set print vtbl off
9495 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9496
9497 @item show print vtbl
9498 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9499 @end table
9500
9501 @node Pretty Printing
9502 @section Pretty Printing
9503
9504 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9505 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9506 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9507
9508 @menu
9509 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9510 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9511 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9512 @end menu
9513
9514 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9515 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9516
9517 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9518 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9519 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9520
9521 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9522 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9523 pretty-printers with their names.
9524 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9525 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9526 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9527 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9528
9529 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9530 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9531 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9532 do anything special.
9533
9534 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9535
9536 @itemize @bullet
9537 @item
9538 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9539 all inferiors.
9540
9541 @item
9542 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9543 when debugging that program.
9544 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9545
9546 @item
9547 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9548 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9549 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9550 @end itemize
9551
9552 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9553 pretty-printers are selected,
9554
9555 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9556 for new types.
9557
9558 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9559 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9560
9561 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9562
9563 @smallexample
9564 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9565 $1 = @{
9566 static npos = 4294967295,
9567 _M_dataplus = @{
9568 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9569 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9570 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9571 @},
9572 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9573 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9574 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9575 @}
9576 @}
9577 @end smallexample
9578
9579 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9580
9581 @smallexample
9582 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9583 $2 = "abcd"
9584 @end smallexample
9585
9586 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9587 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9588 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9589
9590 @table @code
9591 @kindex info pretty-printer
9592 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9593 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9594 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9595
9596 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9597 whose pretty-printers to list.
9598 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9599 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9600 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9601 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9602 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9603
9604 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9605 to list.
9606
9607 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9608 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9609 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9610 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9611
9612 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9613 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9614 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9615 @end table
9616
9617 Example:
9618
9619 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9620 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9621 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9622 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9623
9624 @smallexample
9625 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9626 library1.so:
9627 foo
9628 library2.so:
9629 bar
9630 bar1
9631 bar2
9632 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9633 library2.so:
9634 bar
9635 bar1
9636 bar2
9637 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9638 1 printer disabled
9639 2 of 3 printers enabled
9640 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9641 library1.so:
9642 foo [disabled]
9643 library2.so:
9644 bar
9645 bar1
9646 bar2
9647 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9648 1 printer disabled
9649 1 of 3 printers enabled
9650 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9651 library1.so:
9652 foo [disabled]
9653 library2.so:
9654 bar
9655 bar1 [disabled]
9656 bar2
9657 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9658 1 printer disabled
9659 0 of 3 printers enabled
9660 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9661 library1.so:
9662 foo [disabled]
9663 library2.so:
9664 bar [disabled]
9665 bar1 [disabled]
9666 bar2
9667 @end smallexample
9668
9669 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9670 as can each individual subprinter.
9671
9672 @node Value History
9673 @section Value History
9674
9675 @cindex value history
9676 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9677 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9678 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9679 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9680 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9681 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9682 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9683 symbol table.
9684
9685 @cindex @code{$}
9686 @cindex @code{$$}
9687 @cindex history number
9688 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9689 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9690 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9691 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9692 history number.
9693
9694 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9695 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9696 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9697 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9698 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9699 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9700 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9701
9702 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9703 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9704
9705 @smallexample
9706 p *$
9707 @end smallexample
9708
9709 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9710 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9711
9712 @smallexample
9713 p *$.next
9714 @end smallexample
9715
9716 @noindent
9717 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9718 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9719
9720 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9721 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9722
9723 @smallexample
9724 print x
9725 set x=5
9726 @end smallexample
9727
9728 @noindent
9729 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9730 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9731
9732 @table @code
9733 @kindex show values
9734 @item show values
9735 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9736 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9737 values} does not change the history.
9738
9739 @item show values @var{n}
9740 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9741
9742 @item show values +
9743 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9744 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9745 @end table
9746
9747 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9748 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9749
9750 @node Convenience Vars
9751 @section Convenience Variables
9752
9753 @cindex convenience variables
9754 @cindex user-defined variables
9755 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9756 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9757 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9758 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9759 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9760
9761 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9762 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9763 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9764 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9765 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9766
9767 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9768 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9769 For example:
9770
9771 @smallexample
9772 set $foo = *object_ptr
9773 @end smallexample
9774
9775 @noindent
9776 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9777 @code{object_ptr}.
9778
9779 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9780 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9781 value with another assignment at any time.
9782
9783 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9784 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9785 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9786 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9787
9788 @table @code
9789 @kindex show convenience
9790 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9791 @item show convenience
9792 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9793 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9794 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9795
9796 @kindex init-if-undefined
9797 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9798 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9799 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9800 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9801 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9802 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9803 override default values used in a command script.
9804
9805 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9806 any side-effects do not occur.
9807 @end table
9808
9809 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9810 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9811 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9812
9813 @smallexample
9814 set $i = 0
9815 print bar[$i++]->contents
9816 @end smallexample
9817
9818 @noindent
9819 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9820
9821 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9822 values likely to be useful.
9823
9824 @table @code
9825 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9826 @item $_
9827 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9828 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9829 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9830 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9831 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9832 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9833 to the type of @code{$__}.
9834
9835 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9836 @item $__
9837 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9838 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9839 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9840
9841 @item $_exitcode
9842 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9843 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9844 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9845 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9846
9847 @item $_exitsignal
9848 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9849 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9850 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9851 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9852
9853 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9854 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9855 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9856 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9857 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9858
9859 @smallexample
9860 #include <signal.h>
9861
9862 int
9863 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9864 @{
9865 raise (SIGALRM);
9866 return 0;
9867 @}
9868 @end smallexample
9869
9870 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9871 or signalled would be:
9872
9873 @smallexample
9874 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9875 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9876 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9877 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9878 >echo The program has exited\n
9879 >else
9880 >echo The program has signalled\n
9881 >end
9882 >end
9883 (@value{GDBP}) run
9884 Starting program:
9885
9886 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9887 The program no longer exists.
9888 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9889 The program has signalled
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9893 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9894 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9895 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9896
9897 @smallexample
9898 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9899 The program has exited
9900 @end smallexample
9901
9902 @item $_exception
9903 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9904 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9905
9906 @item $_probe_argc
9907 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9908 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9909
9910 @item $_sdata
9911 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9912 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9913 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9914 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9915 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9916
9917 @item $_siginfo
9918 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9919 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9920 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9921 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9922 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9923
9924 @item $_tlb
9925 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9926 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9927 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9928 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9929 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9930 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9931
9932 @end table
9933
9934 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9935 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9936 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9937
9938 @node Convenience Funs
9939 @section Convenience Functions
9940
9941 @cindex convenience functions
9942 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9943 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9944 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
9945 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
9946 @value{GDBN}.
9947
9948 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
9949 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
9950
9951 @table @code
9952
9953 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
9954 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
9955 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
9956 returns zero.
9957
9958 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
9959 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
9960 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
9961 it is @code{void}:
9962
9963 @smallexample
9964 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9965 $1 = void
9966 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9967 $2 = 1
9968 (@value{GDBP}) run
9969 Starting program: ./a.out
9970 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
9971 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9972 $3 = 0
9973 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9974 $4 = 0
9975 @end smallexample
9976
9977 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
9978 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
9979 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
9980 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
9981 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
9982 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
9983 anymore.
9984
9985 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
9986 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
9987
9988 @smallexample
9989 void
9990 foo (void)
9991 @{
9992 @}
9993 @end smallexample
9994
9995 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
9996
9997 @smallexample
9998 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
9999 $1 = void
10000 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10001 $2 = 1
10002 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10003 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10004 $3 = void
10005 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10006 $4 = 1
10007 @end smallexample
10008
10009 @end table
10010
10011 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10012 @code{Python} support.
10013
10014 @table @code
10015
10016 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10017 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10018 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10019 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10020 Otherwise it returns zero.
10021
10022 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10023 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10024 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10025 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10026 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10027 regular expression support.
10028
10029 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10030 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10031 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10032 Otherwise it returns zero.
10033
10034 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10035 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10036 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10037
10038 @end table
10039
10040 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10041 convenience functions.
10042
10043 @table @code
10044 @item help function
10045 @kindex help function
10046 @cindex show all convenience functions
10047 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10048 @end table
10049
10050 @node Registers
10051 @section Registers
10052
10053 @cindex registers
10054 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10055 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10056 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10057 your machine.
10058
10059 @table @code
10060 @kindex info registers
10061 @item info registers
10062 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10063 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10064
10065 @kindex info all-registers
10066 @cindex floating point registers
10067 @item info all-registers
10068 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10069 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10070
10071 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10072 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10073 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10074 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10075 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10076 @end table
10077
10078 @cindex stack pointer register
10079 @cindex program counter register
10080 @cindex process status register
10081 @cindex frame pointer register
10082 @cindex standard registers
10083 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10084 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10085 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10086 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10087 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10088 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10089 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10090 you could print the program counter in hex with
10091
10092 @smallexample
10093 p/x $pc
10094 @end smallexample
10095
10096 @noindent
10097 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10098
10099 @smallexample
10100 x/i $pc
10101 @end smallexample
10102
10103 @noindent
10104 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10105 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10106 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10107 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10108 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10109 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10110 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10111
10112 @smallexample
10113 set $sp += 4
10114 @end smallexample
10115
10116 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10117 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10118 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10119 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10120 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10121 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10122 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10123
10124 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10125 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10126 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10127 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10128 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10129 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10130 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10131
10132 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10133 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10134 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10135 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10136 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10137 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10138 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10139 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10140 prints the data in both formats.
10141
10142 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10143 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10144 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10145 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10146 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10147 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10148 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10149
10150 @smallexample
10151 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10152 $1 = @{
10153 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10154 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10155 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10156 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10157 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10158 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10159 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10160 @}
10161 @end smallexample
10162
10163 @noindent
10164 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10165 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10166 value to a @code{struct} member:
10167
10168 @smallexample
10169 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10170 @end smallexample
10171
10172 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10173 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10174 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10175 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10176 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10177 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10178
10179 @cindex caller-saved registers
10180 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10181 @cindex volatile registers
10182 @cindex <not saved> values
10183 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10184 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10185 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10186 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10187 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10188 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10189 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10190 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10191 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10192 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10193 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10194 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10195 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10196 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10197 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10198 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10199 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10200 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10201 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10202 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10203 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10204 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10205 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10206
10207 @node Floating Point Hardware
10208 @section Floating Point Hardware
10209 @cindex floating point
10210
10211 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10212 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10213
10214 @table @code
10215 @kindex info float
10216 @item info float
10217 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10218 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10219 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10220 the ARM and x86 machines.
10221 @end table
10222
10223 @node Vector Unit
10224 @section Vector Unit
10225 @cindex vector unit
10226
10227 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10228 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10229
10230 @table @code
10231 @kindex info vector
10232 @item info vector
10233 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10234 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10235 @end table
10236
10237 @node OS Information
10238 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10239 @cindex OS information
10240
10241 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10242 you debug your program.
10243
10244 @cindex auxiliary vector
10245 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10246 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10247 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10248 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10249 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10250 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10251 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10252 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10253 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10254 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10255 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10256 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10257
10258 @table @code
10259 @kindex info auxv
10260 @item info auxv
10261 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10262 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10263 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10264 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10265 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10266 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10267 an unrecognized tag.
10268 @end table
10269
10270 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10271 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10272 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10273 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10274 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10275 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10276 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10277
10278 @table @code
10279 @kindex info os
10280 @item info os @var{infotype}
10281
10282 Display OS information of the requested type.
10283
10284 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10285
10286 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10287 @table @code
10288 @kindex info os processes
10289 @item processes
10290 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10291 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10292 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10293 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10294 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10295 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10296
10297 @kindex info os procgroups
10298 @item procgroups
10299 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10300 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10301 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10302 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10303 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10304 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10305 and the process group leader is listed first.
10306
10307 @kindex info os threads
10308 @item threads
10309 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10310 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10311 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10312 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10313 process is not listed.
10314
10315 @kindex info os files
10316 @item files
10317 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10318 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10319 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10320 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10321
10322 @kindex info os sockets
10323 @item sockets
10324 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10325 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10326 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10327 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10328 connection.
10329
10330 @kindex info os shm
10331 @item shm
10332 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10333 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10334 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10335 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10336 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10337 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10338 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10339
10340 @kindex info os semaphores
10341 @item semaphores
10342 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10343 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10344 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10345 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10346 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10347
10348 @kindex info os msg
10349 @item msg
10350 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10351 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10352 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10353 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10354 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10355 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10356 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10357 the message queue was last changed.
10358
10359 @kindex info os modules
10360 @item modules
10361 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10362 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10363 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10364 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10365 in memory.
10366 @end table
10367
10368 @item info os
10369 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10370 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10371 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10372 types, this command will report an error.
10373 @end table
10374
10375 @node Memory Region Attributes
10376 @section Memory Region Attributes
10377 @cindex memory region attributes
10378
10379 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10380 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10381 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10382 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10383 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10384 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10385 user can override the fetched regions.
10386
10387 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10388 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10389 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10390 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10391 all memory.
10392
10393 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10394 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10395
10396 @table @code
10397 @kindex mem
10398 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10399 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10400 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10401 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10402 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10403 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10404
10405 @item mem auto
10406 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10407 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10408
10409 @kindex delete mem
10410 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10411 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10412 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10413
10414 @kindex disable mem
10415 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10416 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10417 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10418 It may be enabled again later.
10419
10420 @kindex enable mem
10421 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10422 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10423
10424 @kindex info mem
10425 @item info mem
10426 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10427 for each region:
10428
10429 @table @emph
10430 @item Memory Region Number
10431 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10432 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10433 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10434
10435 @item Lo Address
10436 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10437
10438 @item Hi Address
10439 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10440
10441 @item Attributes
10442 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10443 @end table
10444 @end table
10445
10446
10447 @subsection Attributes
10448
10449 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10450 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10451 write accesses to a memory region.
10452
10453 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10454 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10455 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10456
10457 @table @code
10458 @item ro
10459 Memory is read only.
10460 @item wo
10461 Memory is write only.
10462 @item rw
10463 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10464 @end table
10465
10466 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10467 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10468 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10469 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10470 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10471
10472 @table @code
10473 @item 8
10474 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10475 @item 16
10476 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10477 @item 32
10478 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10479 @item 64
10480 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10481 @end table
10482
10483 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10484 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10485 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10486 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10487 @c
10488 @c @table @code
10489 @c @item hwbreak
10490 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10491 @c @item swbreak (default)
10492 @c @end table
10493
10494 @subsubsection Data Cache
10495 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10496 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10497 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10498 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10499 registers.
10500
10501 @table @code
10502 @item cache
10503 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10504 @item nocache
10505 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10506 @end table
10507
10508 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10509 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10510 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10511 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10512 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10513
10514 @table @code
10515 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10516 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10517 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10518 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10519 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10520 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10521 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10522 The default value is @code{on}.
10523 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10524 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10525 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10526 @end table
10527
10528
10529 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10530 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10531 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10532 @c
10533 @c @table @code
10534 @c @item verify
10535 @c @item noverify (default)
10536 @c @end table
10537
10538 @node Dump/Restore Files
10539 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10540 @cindex dump/restore files
10541 @cindex append data to a file
10542 @cindex dump data to a file
10543 @cindex restore data from a file
10544
10545 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10546 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10547 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10548 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10549 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10550 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10551 files.
10552
10553 @table @code
10554
10555 @kindex dump
10556 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10557 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10558 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10559 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10560
10561 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10562 @table @code
10563 @item binary
10564 Raw binary form.
10565 @item ihex
10566 Intel hex format.
10567 @item srec
10568 Motorola S-record format.
10569 @item tekhex
10570 Tektronix Hex format.
10571 @end table
10572
10573 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10574 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10575 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10576 form.
10577
10578 @kindex append
10579 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10580 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10581 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10582 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10583 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10584
10585 @kindex restore
10586 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10587 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10588 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10589 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10590 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10591
10592 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10593 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10594 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10595 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10596 from that location.
10597
10598 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10599 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10600 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10601 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10602
10603 @end table
10604
10605 @node Core File Generation
10606 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10607 @cindex dump core from inferior
10608
10609 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10610 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10611 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10612 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10613 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10614 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10615 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10616
10617 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10618 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10619 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10620
10621 @table @code
10622 @kindex gcore
10623 @kindex generate-core-file
10624 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10625 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10626 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10627 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10628 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10629 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10630
10631 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10632 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10633 @end table
10634
10635 @node Character Sets
10636 @section Character Sets
10637 @cindex character sets
10638 @cindex charset
10639 @cindex translating between character sets
10640 @cindex host character set
10641 @cindex target character set
10642
10643 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10644 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10645 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10646 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10647 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10648 @dfn{target character set}.
10649
10650 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10651 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10652 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10653 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10654 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10655 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10656 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10657 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10658 character and string literals in expressions.
10659
10660 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10661 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10662 target-charset} command, described below.
10663
10664 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10665 support:
10666
10667 @table @code
10668 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10669 @kindex set target-charset
10670 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10671 list of supported target character sets, type
10672 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10673
10674 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10675 @kindex set host-charset
10676 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10677
10678 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10679 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10680 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10681 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10682 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10683
10684 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10685 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10686 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10687
10688 @item set charset @var{charset}
10689 @kindex set charset
10690 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10691 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10692 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10693 for both host and target.
10694
10695 @item show charset
10696 @kindex show charset
10697 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10698
10699 @item show host-charset
10700 @kindex show host-charset
10701 Show the name of the current host character set.
10702
10703 @item show target-charset
10704 @kindex show target-charset
10705 Show the name of the current target character set.
10706
10707 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10708 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10709 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10710 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10711 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10712 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10713
10714 @item show target-wide-charset
10715 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10716 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10717 @end table
10718
10719 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10720 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10721 @file{charset-test.c}:
10722
10723 @smallexample
10724 #include <stdio.h>
10725
10726 char ascii_hello[]
10727 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10728 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10729 char ibm1047_hello[]
10730 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10731 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10732
10733 main ()
10734 @{
10735 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10736 @}
10737 @end smallexample
10738
10739 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10740 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10741 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10742
10743 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10744
10745 @smallexample
10746 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10747 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10748 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10749 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10750 @dots{}
10751 (@value{GDBP})
10752 @end smallexample
10753
10754 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10755 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10756 strings:
10757
10758 @smallexample
10759 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10760 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10761 (@value{GDBP})
10762 @end smallexample
10763
10764 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10765 initial character set:
10766 @smallexample
10767 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10768 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10769 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10770 (@value{GDBP})
10771 @end smallexample
10772
10773 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10774 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10775 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10776 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10777 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10778
10779 @smallexample
10780 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10781 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10782 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10783 $2 = 72 'H'
10784 (@value{GDBP})
10785 @end smallexample
10786
10787 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10788 literals you use in expressions:
10789
10790 @smallexample
10791 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10792 $3 = 43 '+'
10793 (@value{GDBP})
10794 @end smallexample
10795
10796 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10797 character.
10798
10799 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10800 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10801 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10802
10803 @smallexample
10804 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10805 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10806 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10807 $5 = 200 '\310'
10808 (@value{GDBP})
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10812 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10813
10814 @smallexample
10815 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10816 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10817 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10818 @end smallexample
10819
10820 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10821 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10822 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10823 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10824 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10825
10826 @smallexample
10827 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10828 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10829 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10830 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10831 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10832 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10833 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10834 $7 = 72 '\110'
10835 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10836 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10837 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10838 $9 = 200 'H'
10839 (@value{GDBP})
10840 @end smallexample
10841
10842 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10843 string literals you use in expressions:
10844
10845 @smallexample
10846 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10847 $10 = 78 '+'
10848 (@value{GDBP})
10849 @end smallexample
10850
10851 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10852 character.
10853
10854 @node Caching Target Data
10855 @section Caching Data of Targets
10856 @cindex caching data of targets
10857
10858 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10859 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10860 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10861 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10862 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10863 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10864 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10865 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10866 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10867 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10868 is executing.
10869 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10870 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10871 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10872 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10873 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
10874 in the code segment.
10875 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10876 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10877
10878 @table @code
10879 @kindex set remotecache
10880 @item set remotecache on
10881 @itemx set remotecache off
10882 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
10883 with old scripts.
10884
10885 @kindex show remotecache
10886 @item show remotecache
10887 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
10888
10889 @kindex set stack-cache
10890 @item set stack-cache on
10891 @itemx set stack-cache off
10892 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
10893 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
10894
10895 @kindex show stack-cache
10896 @item show stack-cache
10897 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
10898
10899 @kindex set code-cache
10900 @item set code-cache on
10901 @itemx set code-cache off
10902 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
10903 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
10904 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
10905
10906 @kindex show code-cache
10907 @item show code-cache
10908 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
10909 accesses.
10910
10911 @kindex info dcache
10912 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
10913 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
10914 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
10915 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
10916 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
10917 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
10918
10919 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
10920 printed in hex.
10921
10922 @item set dcache size @var{size}
10923 @cindex dcache size
10924 @kindex set dcache size
10925 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
10926
10927 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
10928 @cindex dcache line-size
10929 @kindex set dcache line-size
10930 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
10931 Must be a power of 2.
10932
10933 @item show dcache size
10934 @kindex show dcache size
10935 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
10936
10937 @item show dcache line-size
10938 @kindex show dcache line-size
10939 Show default size of dcache lines.
10940
10941 @end table
10942
10943 @node Searching Memory
10944 @section Search Memory
10945 @cindex searching memory
10946
10947 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
10948 @code{find} command.
10949
10950 @table @code
10951 @kindex find
10952 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10953 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10954 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
10955 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
10956 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
10957 @end table
10958
10959 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
10960 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
10961
10962 @table @r
10963 @item @var{s}, search query size
10964 The size of each search query value.
10965
10966 @table @code
10967 @item b
10968 bytes
10969 @item h
10970 halfwords (two bytes)
10971 @item w
10972 words (four bytes)
10973 @item g
10974 giant words (eight bytes)
10975 @end table
10976
10977 All values are interpreted in the current language.
10978 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
10979 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
10980
10981 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
10982 value's type in the current language.
10983 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
10984 pattern as a mixture of types.
10985 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
10986 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
10987 which is typically four bytes.
10988
10989 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
10990 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
10991 @end table
10992
10993 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
10994 (@code{"}).
10995 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
10996 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
10997
10998 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
10999 number of matches found.
11000
11001 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11002 @samp{$_}.
11003 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11004
11005 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11006
11007 @smallexample
11008 void
11009 hello ()
11010 @{
11011 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11012 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11013 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11014 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11015 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11016 @}
11017 @end smallexample
11018
11019 @noindent
11020 you get during debugging:
11021
11022 @smallexample
11023 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11024 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11025 1 pattern found
11026 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11027 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11028 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11029 2 patterns found
11030 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11031 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11032 1 pattern found
11033 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11034 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11035 1 pattern found
11036 (gdb) print $numfound
11037 $1 = 1
11038 (gdb) print $_
11039 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11040 @end smallexample
11041
11042 @node Optimized Code
11043 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11044 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11045 @cindex debugging optimized code
11046
11047 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11048 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11049 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11050 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11051 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11052 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11053 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11054
11055 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11056 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11057 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11058 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11059
11060 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11061 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11062 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11063 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11064 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11065 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11066
11067 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11068 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11069 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11070 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11071 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11072
11073 @menu
11074 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11075 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11076 @end menu
11077
11078 @node Inline Functions
11079 @section Inline Functions
11080 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11081
11082 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11083 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11084 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11085 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11086 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11087 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11088 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11089 @code{info frame} command.
11090
11091 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11092 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11093 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11094 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11095 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11096 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11097 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11098 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11099 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11100 local variables in the caller.
11101
11102 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11103 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11104 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11105 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11106 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11107 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11108 instructions are executed.
11109
11110 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11111 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11112 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11113 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11114
11115 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11116 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11117
11118 @itemize @bullet
11119 @item
11120 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11121 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11122 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11123 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11124 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11125 or inside the inlined function instead.
11126
11127 @item
11128 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11129 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11130 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11131 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11132
11133 @end itemize
11134
11135 @node Tail Call Frames
11136 @section Tail Call Frames
11137 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11138
11139 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11140 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11141 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11142 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11143 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11144
11145 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11146 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11147 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11148 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11149 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11150 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11151 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11152
11153 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11154 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11155 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11156 this information.
11157
11158 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11159 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11160
11161 @smallexample
11162 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11163 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11164 (gdb) info frame
11165 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11166 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11167 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11168 source language c++.
11169 Arglist at unknown address.
11170 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11171 @end smallexample
11172
11173 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11174 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11175 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11176 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11177 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11178 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11179
11180 @table @code
11181 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11182 @item set debug entry-values
11183 @kindex set debug entry-values
11184 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11185 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11186 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11187 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11188 result.
11189
11190 @item show debug entry-values
11191 @kindex show debug entry-values
11192 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11193 values at function entry and tail calls.
11194 @end table
11195
11196 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11197 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11198 reference by variable @code{x}):
11199
11200 @smallexample
11201 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11202 void (*x) (void) = c;
11203 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11204 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11205 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11206
11207 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11208 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11209 a () at t.c:3
11210 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11211 (gdb) bt
11212 #0 a () at t.c:3
11213 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11214 @end smallexample
11215
11216 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11217
11218 @smallexample
11219 int i;
11220 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11221 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11222 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11223 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11224 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11225 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11226 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11227 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11228
11229 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11230 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11231 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11232 (gdb) bt
11233 #0 f () at t.c:2
11234 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11235 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11236 @end smallexample
11237
11238 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11239 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11240
11241 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11242 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11243 @set ARROW @click{}
11244 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11245 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11246 @end ifset
11247 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11248 @set ARROW ->
11249 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11250 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11251 @end ifclear
11252
11253 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11254 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11255 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11256
11257 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11258 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11259 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11260 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11261 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11262 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11263
11264 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11265 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11266 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11267 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11268 omitted.
11269
11270 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11271 entry may fail:
11272
11273 @smallexample
11274 int v;
11275 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11276 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11277 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11278 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11279 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11280 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11281
11282 (gdb) bt
11283 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11284 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11285 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11286 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11287 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11288 @end smallexample
11289
11290 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11291 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11292 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11293 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11294 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11295
11296 @node Macros
11297 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11298
11299 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11300 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11301 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11302 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11303 where it was defined.
11304
11305 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11306 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11307 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11308 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11309
11310 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11311 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11312 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11313 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11314 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11315 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11316 see @ref{List}.
11317
11318 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11319 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11320 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11321
11322 @table @code
11323
11324 @kindex macro expand
11325 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11326 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11327 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11328 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11329 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11330 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11331 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11332 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11333 it can be any string of tokens.
11334
11335 @kindex macro exp1
11336 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11337 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11338 @cindex expand macro once
11339 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11340 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11341 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11342 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11343 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11344 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11345 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11346 can be any string of tokens.
11347
11348 @kindex info macro
11349 @cindex macro definition, showing
11350 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11351 @cindex macros, from debug info
11352 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11353 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11354 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11355 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11356 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11357 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11358
11359 @kindex info macros
11360 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11361 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11362 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11363 command-line where those definitions were established.
11364
11365 @kindex macro define
11366 @cindex user-defined macros
11367 @cindex defining macros interactively
11368 @cindex macros, user-defined
11369 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11370 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11371 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11372 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11373 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11374 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11375 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11376 @var{arglist}.
11377
11378 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11379 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11380 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11381 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11382 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11383
11384 @kindex macro undef
11385 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11386 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11387 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11388 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11389 in the program being debugged.
11390
11391 @kindex macro list
11392 @item macro list
11393 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11394 @end table
11395
11396 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11397 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11398 show our source files:
11399
11400 @smallexample
11401 $ cat sample.c
11402 #include <stdio.h>
11403 #include "sample.h"
11404
11405 #define M 42
11406 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11407
11408 main ()
11409 @{
11410 #define N 28
11411 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11412 #undef N
11413 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11414 #define N 1729
11415 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11416 @}
11417 $ cat sample.h
11418 #define Q <
11419 $
11420 @end smallexample
11421
11422 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11423 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11424 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11425 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11426 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11427 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11428 information.
11429
11430 @smallexample
11431 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11432 $
11433 @end smallexample
11434
11435 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11436
11437 @smallexample
11438 $ gdb -nw sample
11439 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11440 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11441 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11442 (@value{GDBP})
11443 @end smallexample
11444
11445 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11446 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11447 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11448
11449 @smallexample
11450 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11451 3
11452 4 #define M 42
11453 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11454 6
11455 7 main ()
11456 8 @{
11457 9 #define N 28
11458 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11459 11 #undef N
11460 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11461 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11462 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11463 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11464 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11465 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11466 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11467 #define Q <
11468 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11469 expands to: (42 + 1)
11470 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11471 expands to: once (M + 1)
11472 (@value{GDBP})
11473 @end smallexample
11474
11475 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11476 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11477 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11478 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11479
11480 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11481 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11482
11483 @smallexample
11484 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11485 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11486 (@value{GDBP}) run
11487 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11488
11489 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11490 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11491 (@value{GDBP})
11492 @end smallexample
11493
11494 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11495
11496 @smallexample
11497 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11498 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11499 #define N 28
11500 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11501 expands to: 28 < 42
11502 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11503 $1 = 1
11504 (@value{GDBP})
11505 @end smallexample
11506
11507 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11508 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11509 thereof) in force at each point:
11510
11511 @smallexample
11512 (@value{GDBP}) next
11513 Hello, world!
11514 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11515 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11516 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11517 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11518 (@value{GDBP}) next
11519 We're so creative.
11520 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11521 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11522 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11523 #define N 1729
11524 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11525 expands to: 1729 < 42
11526 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11527 $2 = 0
11528 (@value{GDBP})
11529 @end smallexample
11530
11531 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11532 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11533 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11534 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11535
11536 @smallexample
11537 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11538 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11539 -D__STDC__=1
11540 (@value{GDBP})
11541 @end smallexample
11542
11543
11544 @node Tracepoints
11545 @chapter Tracepoints
11546 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11547 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11548
11549 @cindex tracepoints
11550 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11551 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11552 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11553 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11554 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11555 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11556 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11557
11558 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11559 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11560 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11561 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11562 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11563 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11564 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11565 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11566 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11567 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11568 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11569
11570 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11571 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11572 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11573 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11574 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11575 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11576 Packets}.
11577
11578 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11579 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11580 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11581
11582 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11583
11584 @menu
11585 * Set Tracepoints::
11586 * Analyze Collected Data::
11587 * Tracepoint Variables::
11588 * Trace Files::
11589 @end menu
11590
11591 @node Set Tracepoints
11592 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11593
11594 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11595 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11596 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11597 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11598 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11599 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11600 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11601
11602 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11603 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11604 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11605 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11606 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11607 tracepoint was hit.
11608
11609 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11610 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11611 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11612 either.
11613
11614 @cindex fast tracepoints
11615 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11616 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11617 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11618
11619 @cindex static tracepoints
11620 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11621 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11622 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11623 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11624 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11625 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11626 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11627 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11628 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11629 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11630 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11631 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11632 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11633 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11634 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11635 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11636 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11637 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11638 static tracepoint marker.
11639
11640 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11641 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11642
11643 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11644 conditions and actions.
11645
11646 @menu
11647 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11648 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11649 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11650 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11651 * Trace State Variables::
11652 * Tracepoint Actions::
11653 * Listing Tracepoints::
11654 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11655 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11656 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11657 @end menu
11658
11659 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11660 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11661
11662 @table @code
11663 @cindex set tracepoint
11664 @kindex trace
11665 @item trace @var{location}
11666 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11667 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11668 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11669 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11670 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11671 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11672 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11673 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11674 in tracing}).
11675 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11676 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11677 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11678 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11679 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11680 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11681 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11682 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11683 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11684 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11685 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11686 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11687
11688 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11689
11690 @smallexample
11691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11692
11693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11694
11695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11696
11697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11698
11699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11700 @end smallexample
11701
11702 @noindent
11703 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11704
11705 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11706 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11707 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11708 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11709 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11710 information on tracepoint conditions.
11711
11712 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11713 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11714 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11715 @kindex ftrace
11716 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11717 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11718 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11719 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11720 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11721 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11722 message.
11723
11724 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11725 @code{trace}.
11726
11727 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11728 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11729 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11730 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11731 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11732 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11733 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11734 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11735
11736 @example
11737 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11738 @end example
11739
11740 @noindent
11741 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11742 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11743
11744 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11745 @cindex set static tracepoint
11746 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11747 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11748 @kindex strace
11749 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11750 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11751 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11752 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11753 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11754
11755 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11756 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11757 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11758 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11759 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11760 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11761 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11762 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11763 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11764 tracing engine:
11765
11766 @smallexample
11767 main ()
11768 @{
11769 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11770 @}
11771 @end smallexample
11772
11773 @noindent
11774 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11775 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11776
11777 @smallexample
11778 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11779 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11780 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11781 Data: "str %s"
11782 [etc...]
11783 @end smallexample
11784
11785 @noindent
11786 so you may probe the marker above with:
11787
11788 @smallexample
11789 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11790 @end smallexample
11791
11792 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11793 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11794 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11795 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11796 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11797 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11798 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11799 the @samp{Data:} field.
11800
11801 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11802 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11803 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11804
11805 @vindex $tpnum
11806 @cindex last tracepoint number
11807 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11808 @cindex tracepoint number
11809 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11810 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11811
11812 @kindex delete tracepoint
11813 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11814 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11815 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11816 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11817 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11818
11819 Examples:
11820
11821 @smallexample
11822 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11823
11824 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11825 @end smallexample
11826
11827 @noindent
11828 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11829 @end table
11830
11831 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11832 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11833
11834 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11835
11836 @table @code
11837 @kindex disable tracepoint
11838 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11839 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11840 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11841 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11842 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11843 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11844 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11845 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11846 next trace experiment.
11847
11848 @kindex enable tracepoint
11849 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11850 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11851 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11852 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11853 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11854 next time a trace experiment is run.
11855 @end table
11856
11857 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11858 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11859
11860 @table @code
11861 @kindex passcount
11862 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11863 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11864 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11865 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11866 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11867 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11868 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11869 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11870 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11871 user.
11872
11873 Examples:
11874
11875 @smallexample
11876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11877 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11878
11879 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11880 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11881 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
11883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
11884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
11885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
11886 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
11887 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
11888 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
11889 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
11890 @end smallexample
11891 @end table
11892
11893 @node Tracepoint Conditions
11894 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
11895 @cindex conditional tracepoints
11896 @cindex tracepoint conditions
11897
11898 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
11899 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
11900 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
11901 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
11902 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
11903 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
11904 is true.
11905
11906 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
11907 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
11908 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
11909 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
11910 just as with breakpoints.
11911
11912 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
11913 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
11914 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
11915 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
11916 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
11917 accesses, and so forth.
11918
11919 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
11920 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
11921 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
11922 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
11923 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
11924 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
11925 search through.
11926
11927 @smallexample
11928 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
11929 @end smallexample
11930
11931 @node Trace State Variables
11932 @subsection Trace State Variables
11933 @cindex trace state variables
11934
11935 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
11936 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
11937 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
11938 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
11939 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
11940 integers.
11941
11942 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
11943 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
11944 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
11945 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
11946
11947 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
11948 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
11949 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
11950 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
11951 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
11952 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
11953 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
11954 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
11955 variable with the same name.
11956
11957 @table @code
11958
11959 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
11960 @kindex tvariable
11961 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
11962 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
11963 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
11964 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
11965 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
11966 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
11967 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
11968 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
11969 value. The default initial value is 0.
11970
11971 @item info tvariables
11972 @kindex info tvariables
11973 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
11974 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
11975 currently running.
11976
11977 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
11978 @kindex delete tvariable
11979 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
11980 are specified.
11981
11982 @end table
11983
11984 @node Tracepoint Actions
11985 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
11986
11987 @table @code
11988 @kindex actions
11989 @cindex tracepoint actions
11990 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11991 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
11992 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
11993 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
11994 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
11995 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
11996 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
11997 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
11998 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
11999 @code{while-stepping}.
12000
12001 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12002 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12003 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12004
12005 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12006 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12007 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12008
12009 @smallexample
12010 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12011
12012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12013
12014 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12015 @end smallexample
12016
12017 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12018 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12019 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12020 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12021 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12022 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12023 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12024 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12025
12026 @smallexample
12027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12029 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12030 > collect bar,baz
12031 > collect $regs
12032 > while-stepping 12
12033 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12034 > end
12035 end
12036 @end smallexample
12037
12038 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12039 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12040 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12041 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12042 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12043 special arguments are supported:
12044
12045 @table @code
12046 @item $regs
12047 Collect all registers.
12048
12049 @item $args
12050 Collect all function arguments.
12051
12052 @item $locals
12053 Collect all local variables.
12054
12055 @item $_ret
12056 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12057 of a backtrace.
12058
12059 @item $_probe_argc
12060 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12061 tracepoint is located.
12062 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12063
12064 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12065 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12066 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12067 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12068
12069 @item $_sdata
12070 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12071 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12072 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12073 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12074 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12075 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12076 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12077 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12078 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12079
12080 @smallexample
12081 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12082 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12083 @end smallexample
12084
12085 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12086 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12087 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12088 @value{GDBN}.
12089 @end table
12090
12091 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12092 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12093 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12094
12095 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12096 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12097 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12098 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12099 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12100 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12101 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12102 @samp{mystr}.
12103
12104 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12105 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12106
12107 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12108 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12109 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12110 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12111 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12112 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12113 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12114 action were used.
12115
12116 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12117 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12118 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12119 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12120 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12121 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12122
12123 @smallexample
12124 > while-stepping 12
12125 > collect $regs, myglobal
12126 > end
12127 >
12128 @end smallexample
12129
12130 @noindent
12131 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12132 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12133 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12134 @code{stepping}.
12135
12136 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12137 @kindex set default-collect
12138 @cindex default collection action
12139 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12140 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12141 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12142 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12143 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12144 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12145
12146 @item show default-collect
12147 @kindex show default-collect
12148 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12149 tracepoint hit.
12150
12151 @end table
12152
12153 @node Listing Tracepoints
12154 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12155
12156 @table @code
12157 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12158 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12159 @cindex information about tracepoints
12160 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12161 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12162 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12163 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12164 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12165 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12166
12167 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12168 tracing:
12169
12170 @itemize @bullet
12171 @item
12172 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12173
12174 @item
12175 the state about installed on target of each location
12176 @end itemize
12177
12178 @smallexample
12179 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12180 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12181 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12182 while-stepping 20
12183 collect globfoo, $regs
12184 end
12185 collect globfoo2
12186 end
12187 pass count 1200
12188 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12189 collect $eip
12190 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12191 installed on target
12192 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12193 installed on target
12194 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12195 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12196 not installed on target
12197 (@value{GDBP})
12198 @end smallexample
12199
12200 @noindent
12201 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12202 @end table
12203
12204 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12205 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12206
12207 @table @code
12208 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12209 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12210 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12211 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12212 program.
12213
12214 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12215
12216 @table @emph
12217 @item Count
12218 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12219 stable identifier.
12220 @item ID
12221 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12222 @item Enabled or Disabled
12223 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12224 that are not enabled.
12225 @item Address
12226 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12227 @item What
12228 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12229 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12230 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12231 will be left blank.
12232 @end table
12233
12234 @noindent
12235 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12236
12237 @table @emph
12238 @item Data
12239 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12240 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12241 marker call.
12242 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12243 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12244 @end table
12245
12246 @smallexample
12247 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12248 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12249 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12250 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12251 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12252 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12253 Data: str %s
12254 (@value{GDBP})
12255 @end smallexample
12256 @end table
12257
12258 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12259 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12260
12261 @table @code
12262 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12263 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12264 @cindex collected data discarded
12265 @item tstart
12266 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12267 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12268 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12269 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12270 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12271 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12272 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12273 information, and so forth.
12274
12275 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12276 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12277 @item tstop
12278 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12279 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12280 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12281 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12282 needs to be stopped quickly.
12283
12284 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12285 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12286 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12287
12288 @kindex tstatus
12289 @cindex status of trace data collection
12290 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12291 @item tstatus
12292 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12293 collection.
12294 @end table
12295
12296 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12297
12298 @smallexample
12299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12301 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12302 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12303 > while-stepping 11
12304 > collect $regs
12305 > end
12306 > end
12307 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12308 [time passes @dots{}]
12309 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12310 @end smallexample
12311
12312 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12313 @cindex disconnected tracing
12314 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12315 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12316 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12317 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12318 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12319 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12320 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12321 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12322
12323 @table @code
12324 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12325 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12326 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12327 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12328 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12329 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12330 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12331 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12332
12333 @item show disconnected-tracing
12334 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12335 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12336
12337 @end table
12338
12339 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12340 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12341 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12342 it will continue after reconnection.
12343
12344 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12345 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12346 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12347 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12348 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12349 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12350 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12351 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12352 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12353 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12354
12355 @cindex circular trace buffer
12356 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12357 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12358 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12359 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12360 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12361 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12362 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12363 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12364 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12365 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12366 the next run.
12367
12368 @table @code
12369 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12370 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12371 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12372 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12373 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12374 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12375 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12376
12377 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12378 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12379 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12380 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12381 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12382 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12383
12384 @end table
12385
12386 @table @code
12387 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12388 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12389 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12390 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12391 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12392 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12393 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12394 likes. This is also the default.
12395
12396 @item show trace-buffer-size
12397 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12398 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12399 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12400 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12401 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12402 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12403 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12404 @end table
12405
12406 @table @code
12407 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12408 @kindex set trace-user
12409
12410 @item show trace-user
12411 @kindex show trace-user
12412
12413 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12414 @kindex set trace-notes
12415 Set the trace run's notes.
12416
12417 @item show trace-notes
12418 @kindex show trace-notes
12419 Show the trace run's notes.
12420
12421 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12422 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12423 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12424 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12425 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12426
12427 @item show trace-stop-notes
12428 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12429 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12430
12431 @end table
12432
12433 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12434 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12435
12436 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12437 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12438 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12439 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12440 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12441 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12442 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12443 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12444 mentioned here.
12445
12446 @itemize @bullet
12447
12448 @item
12449 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12450 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12451 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12452 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12453 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12454 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12455 cannot be collected either.
12456
12457 @item
12458 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12459 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12460 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12461 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12462 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12463 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12464 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12465 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12466 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12467 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12468
12469 @item
12470 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12471 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12472 in a misleading way.
12473
12474 @item
12475 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12476 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12477 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12478 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12479 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12480 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12481 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12482 by @code{ptr}.
12483
12484 @item
12485 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12486 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12487 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12488 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12489 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12490 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12491 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12492 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12493 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12494 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12495 invalid address.
12496
12497 @item
12498 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12499 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12500 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12501 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12502 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12503 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12504 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12505 it to zero.
12506
12507 @end itemize
12508
12509 @node Analyze Collected Data
12510 @section Using the Collected Data
12511
12512 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12513 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12514 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12515 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12516 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12517 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12518 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12519 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12520 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12521 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12522 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12523 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12524 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12525 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12526 the buffer will fail.
12527
12528 @menu
12529 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12530 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12531 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12532 @end menu
12533
12534 @node tfind
12535 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12536
12537 @kindex tfind
12538 @cindex select trace snapshot
12539 @cindex find trace snapshot
12540 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12541 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12542 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12543 snapshot is selected.
12544
12545 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12546
12547 @table @code
12548 @item tfind start
12549 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12550 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12551
12552 @item tfind none
12553 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12554
12555 @item tfind end
12556 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12557
12558 @item tfind
12559 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12560
12561 @item tfind -
12562 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12563 retracing earlier steps.
12564
12565 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12566 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12567 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12568 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12569 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12570
12571 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12572 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12573 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12574 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12575 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12576
12577 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12578 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12579 addresses (exclusive).
12580
12581 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12582 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12583 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12584
12585 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12586 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12587 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12588 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12589 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12590 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12591 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12592 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12593 @end table
12594
12595 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12596 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12597 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12598 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12599 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12600 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12601 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12602 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12603 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12604 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12605 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12606 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12607 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12608 tracepoint as the current one.
12609
12610 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12611 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12612 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12613 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12614 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12615
12616 @smallexample
12617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12619 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12620 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12621 > tfind
12622 > end
12623
12624 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12625 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12626 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12627 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12628 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12629 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12630 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12631 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12632 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12633 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12634 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12635 @end smallexample
12636
12637 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12638 the buffer:
12639
12640 @smallexample
12641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12643 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12644 > tfind line
12645 > end
12646
12647 Frame 0, X = 1
12648 Frame 7, X = 2
12649 Frame 13, X = 255
12650 @end smallexample
12651
12652 @node tdump
12653 @subsection @code{tdump}
12654 @kindex tdump
12655 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12656 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12657
12658 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12659 the current trace snapshot.
12660
12661 @smallexample
12662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12664 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12665 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12666 > end
12667
12668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12669
12670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12671 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12672 at gdb_test.c:444
12673 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12674
12675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12676 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12677 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12678 d1 0x18 24
12679 d2 0x80 128
12680 d3 0x33 51
12681 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12682 d5 0x22 34
12683 d6 0xe0 224
12684 d7 0x380035 3670069
12685 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12686 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12687 a2 0x100 256
12688 a3 0x322000 3284992
12689 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12690 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12691 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12692 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12693 ps 0x0 0
12694 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12695 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12696 fpstatus 0x0 0
12697 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12698 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12699 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12700 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12701 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12702 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12703 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12704 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12705 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12706
12707 (@value{GDBP})
12708 @end smallexample
12709
12710 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12711 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12712 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12713 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12714
12715 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12716 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12717 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12718 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12719 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12720 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12721 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12722 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12723 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12724 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12725
12726 @node save tracepoints
12727 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12728 @kindex save tracepoints
12729 @kindex save-tracepoints
12730 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12731
12732 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12733 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12734 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12735 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12736 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12737 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12738
12739 @node Tracepoint Variables
12740 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12741 @cindex tracepoint variables
12742 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12743
12744 @table @code
12745 @vindex $trace_frame
12746 @item (int) $trace_frame
12747 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12748 snapshot is selected.
12749
12750 @vindex $tracepoint
12751 @item (int) $tracepoint
12752 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12753
12754 @vindex $trace_line
12755 @item (int) $trace_line
12756 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12757
12758 @vindex $trace_file
12759 @item (char []) $trace_file
12760 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12761
12762 @vindex $trace_func
12763 @item (char []) $trace_func
12764 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12765 @end table
12766
12767 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12768 use @code{output} instead.
12769
12770 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12771 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12772 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12773 which are managed by the target.
12774
12775 @smallexample
12776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12777
12778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12779 > output $trace_file
12780 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12781 > tfind
12782 > end
12783 @end smallexample
12784
12785 @node Trace Files
12786 @section Using Trace Files
12787 @cindex trace files
12788
12789 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12790 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12791 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12792 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12793 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12794
12795 @table @code
12796
12797 @kindex tsave
12798 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12799 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12800 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12801 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12802 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12803 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12804 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12805 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12806 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12807 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12808 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12809 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12810 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12811 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12812 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12813
12814 @kindex target tfile
12815 @kindex tfile
12816 @kindex target ctf
12817 @kindex ctf
12818 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12819 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12820 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12821 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12822 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12823 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12824 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12825 @var{filename} or @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12826 the host.
12827
12828 @smallexample
12829 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12830 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12831 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12832 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12833 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12834 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12835 i = 0
12836 a = 0
12837 b = 1 '\001'
12838 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12839 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12840 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12841 $1 = 1
12842 @end smallexample
12843
12844 @end table
12845
12846 @node Overlays
12847 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12848 @cindex overlays
12849
12850 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12851 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12852 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12853 use overlays.
12854
12855 @menu
12856 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12857 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12858 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12859 mapped by asking the inferior.
12860 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12861 @end menu
12862
12863 @node How Overlays Work
12864 @section How Overlays Work
12865 @cindex mapped overlays
12866 @cindex unmapped overlays
12867 @cindex load address, overlay's
12868 @cindex mapped address
12869 @cindex overlay area
12870
12871 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12872 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12873 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12874 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12875 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12876
12877 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12878 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12879 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12880 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12881 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
12882 largest overlay as well.
12883
12884 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
12885 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
12886 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
12887 there.
12888
12889 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
12890 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
12891 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
12892
12893 @smallexample
12894 @group
12895 Data Instruction Larger
12896 Address Space Address Space Address Space
12897 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
12898 | | | | | |
12899 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
12900 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
12901 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
12902 | and heap | | | | | |
12903 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
12904 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
12905 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
12906 | | | | | |
12907 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
12908 address | | | | | |
12909 | overlay | <-' | | |
12910 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
12911 | | <---. | | load address
12912 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
12913 | | | |
12914 +-----------+ | |
12915 +-----------+
12916 | |
12917 +-----------+
12918
12919 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
12920 @end group
12921 @end smallexample
12922
12923 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
12924 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
12925 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
12926 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
12927 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
12928 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
12929 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
12930 program and the overlay area.
12931
12932 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
12933 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
12934 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
12935 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
12936 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
12937 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
12938 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
12939
12940 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
12941 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
12942 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
12943
12944 @itemize @bullet
12945
12946 @item
12947 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
12948 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
12949 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
12950 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
12951
12952 @item
12953 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
12954 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
12955 your program's performance.
12956
12957 @item
12958 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
12959 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
12960 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
12961 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
12962 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
12963 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
12964 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
12965
12966 @item
12967 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
12968 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
12969 instruction and data spaces.
12970
12971 @end itemize
12972
12973 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
12974 improved in many ways:
12975
12976 @itemize @bullet
12977
12978 @item
12979 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
12980 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
12981 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
12982 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
12983 area in the usual way.
12984
12985 @item
12986 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
12987 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
12988
12989 @item
12990 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
12991 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
12992 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
12993 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
12994 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
12995 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
12996 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
12997
12998 @end itemize
12999
13000
13001 @node Overlay Commands
13002 @section Overlay Commands
13003
13004 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13005 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13006 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13007 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13008 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13009 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13010
13011 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13012 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13013
13014 @table @code
13015 @item overlay off
13016 @kindex overlay
13017 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13018 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13019 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13020 overlay support is disabled.
13021
13022 @item overlay manual
13023 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13024 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13025 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13026 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13027 commands described below.
13028
13029 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13030 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13031 @cindex map an overlay
13032 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13033 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13034 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13035 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13036 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13037 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13038
13039 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13040 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13041 @cindex unmap an overlay
13042 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13043 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13044 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13045 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13046
13047 @item overlay auto
13048 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13049 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13050 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13051 Overlay Debugging}.
13052
13053 @item overlay load-target
13054 @itemx overlay load
13055 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13056 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13057 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13058 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13059 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13060 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13061
13062 @item overlay list-overlays
13063 @itemx overlay list
13064 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13065 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13066 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13067
13068 @end table
13069
13070 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13071 of the function the address falls in:
13072
13073 @smallexample
13074 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13075 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13076 @end smallexample
13077 @noindent
13078 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13079 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13080 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13081 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13082
13083 @smallexample
13084 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13085 No sections are mapped.
13086 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13087 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13088 @end smallexample
13089 @noindent
13090 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13091 name normally:
13092
13093 @smallexample
13094 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13095 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13096 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13097 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13098 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13099 @end smallexample
13100
13101 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13102 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13103 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13104 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13105 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13106
13107 @itemize @bullet
13108 @item
13109 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13110 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13111 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13112 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13113 @item
13114 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13115 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13116 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13117 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13118 breakpoints properly.
13119 @end itemize
13120
13121
13122 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13123 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13124 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13125
13126 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13127 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13128 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13129 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13130 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13131 current state of the overlays.
13132
13133 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13134 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13135
13136 @table @asis
13137
13138 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13139 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13140
13141 @smallexample
13142 struct
13143 @{
13144 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13145 unsigned long vma;
13146
13147 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13148 unsigned long size;
13149
13150 /* The overlay's load address. */
13151 unsigned long lma;
13152
13153 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13154 zero otherwise. */
13155 unsigned long mapped;
13156 @}
13157 @end smallexample
13158
13159 @item @code{_novlys}:
13160 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13161 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13162
13163 @end table
13164
13165 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13166 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13167 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13168 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13169 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13170 currently mapped.
13171
13172 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13173 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13174 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13175 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13176 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13177 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13178 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13179 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13180 are not being executed.
13181
13182 @node Overlay Sample Program
13183 @section Overlay Sample Program
13184 @cindex overlay example program
13185
13186 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13187 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13188 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13189 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13190 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13191 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13192 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13193
13194 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13195 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13196 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13197 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13198
13199 @table @file
13200 @item overlays.c
13201 The main program file.
13202 @item ovlymgr.c
13203 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13204 @item foo.c
13205 @itemx bar.c
13206 @itemx baz.c
13207 @itemx grbx.c
13208 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13209 @item d10v.ld
13210 @itemx m32r.ld
13211 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13212 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13213 @end table
13214
13215 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13216 cross-compiler like this:
13217
13218 @smallexample
13219 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13220 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13221 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13222 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13223 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13224 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13225 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13226 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13227 @end smallexample
13228
13229 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13230 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13231 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13232
13233
13234 @node Languages
13235 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13236 @cindex languages
13237
13238 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13239 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13240 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13241 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13242 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13243 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13244
13245 @cindex working language
13246 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13247 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13248 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13249 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13250 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13251 language}.
13252
13253 @menu
13254 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13255 * Show:: Displaying the language
13256 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13257 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13258 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13259 @end menu
13260
13261 @node Setting
13262 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13263
13264 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13265 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13266 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13267 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13268 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13269 are printed, etc.
13270
13271 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13272 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13273 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13274 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13275 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13276 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13277 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13278 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13279 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13280 Displaying the Language}.
13281
13282 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13283 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13284 another language. In that case, make the
13285 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13286 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13287 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13288
13289 @menu
13290 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13291 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13292 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13293 @end menu
13294
13295 @node Filenames
13296 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13297
13298 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13299 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13300
13301 @table @file
13302 @item .ada
13303 @itemx .ads
13304 @itemx .adb
13305 @itemx .a
13306 Ada source file.
13307
13308 @item .c
13309 C source file
13310
13311 @item .C
13312 @itemx .cc
13313 @itemx .cp
13314 @itemx .cpp
13315 @itemx .cxx
13316 @itemx .c++
13317 C@t{++} source file
13318
13319 @item .d
13320 D source file
13321
13322 @item .m
13323 Objective-C source file
13324
13325 @item .f
13326 @itemx .F
13327 Fortran source file
13328
13329 @item .mod
13330 Modula-2 source file
13331
13332 @item .s
13333 @itemx .S
13334 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13335 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13336 @end table
13337
13338 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13339 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13340
13341 @node Manually
13342 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13343
13344 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13345 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13346 your program.
13347
13348 @kindex set language
13349 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13350 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13351 a language, such as
13352 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13353 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13354
13355 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13356 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13357 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13358 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13359 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13360 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13361 command such as:
13362
13363 @smallexample
13364 print a = b + c
13365 @end smallexample
13366
13367 @noindent
13368 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13369 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13370 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13371 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13372
13373 @node Automatically
13374 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13375
13376 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13377 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13378 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13379 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13380 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13381 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13382 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13383 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13384 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13385
13386 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13387 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13388 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13389 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13390 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13391
13392 @node Show
13393 @section Displaying the Language
13394
13395 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13396 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13397
13398 @table @code
13399 @item show language
13400 @anchor{show language}
13401 @kindex show language
13402 Display the current working language. This is the
13403 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13404 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13405
13406 @item info frame
13407 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13408 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13409 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13410 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13411 information listed here.
13412
13413 @item info source
13414 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13415 Display the source language of this source file.
13416 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13417 information listed here.
13418 @end table
13419
13420 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13421 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13422 with a language explicitly:
13423
13424 @table @code
13425 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13426 @kindex set extension-language
13427 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13428 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13429
13430 @item info extensions
13431 @kindex info extensions
13432 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13433 @end table
13434
13435 @node Checks
13436 @section Type and Range Checking
13437
13438 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13439 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13440 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13441 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13442 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13443 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13444 errors when your program is running.
13445
13446 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13447 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13448 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13449 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13450
13451 @menu
13452 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13453 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13454 @end menu
13455
13456 @cindex type checking
13457 @cindex checks, type
13458 @node Type Checking
13459 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13460
13461 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13462 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13463 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13464 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13465
13466 @smallexample
13467 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13468
13469 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13470 $1 = 2
13471 @exdent but
13472 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13473 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13474 @end smallexample
13475
13476 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13477 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13478
13479 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13480 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13481 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13482 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13483 expressions like the second example above.
13484
13485 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13486 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13487 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13488 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13489 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13490 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13491
13492 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13493
13494 @kindex set check type
13495 @kindex show check type
13496 @table @code
13497 @item set check type on
13498 @itemx set check type off
13499 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13500 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13501 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13502
13503 @item show check type
13504 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13505 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13506 @end table
13507
13508 @cindex range checking
13509 @cindex checks, range
13510 @node Range Checking
13511 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13512
13513 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13514 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13515 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13516 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13517 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13518
13519 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13520 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13521 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13522 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13523
13524 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13525 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13526 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13527 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13528 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13529 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13530
13531 @smallexample
13532 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13533 @end smallexample
13534
13535 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13536 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13537 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13538
13539 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13540
13541 @kindex set check range
13542 @kindex show check range
13543 @table @code
13544 @item set check range auto
13545 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13546 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13547 each language.
13548
13549 @item set check range on
13550 @itemx set check range off
13551 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13552 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13553 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13554 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13555
13556 @item set check range warn
13557 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13558 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13559 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13560 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13561 systems).
13562
13563 @item show range
13564 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13565 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13566 @end table
13567
13568 @node Supported Languages
13569 @section Supported Languages
13570
13571 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13572 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13573 @c This is false ...
13574 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13575 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13576 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13577 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13578 language.
13579
13580 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13581 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13582 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13583 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13584 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13585 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13586 language reference or tutorial.
13587
13588 @menu
13589 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13590 * D:: D
13591 * Go:: Go
13592 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13593 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13594 * Fortran:: Fortran
13595 * Pascal:: Pascal
13596 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13597 * Ada:: Ada
13598 @end menu
13599
13600 @node C
13601 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13602
13603 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13604 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13605
13606 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13607 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13608 together.
13609
13610 @cindex C@t{++}
13611 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13612 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13613 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13614 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13615 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13616 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13617 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13618
13619 @menu
13620 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13621 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13622 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13623 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13624 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13625 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13626 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13627 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13628 @end menu
13629
13630 @node C Operators
13631 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13632
13633 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13634
13635 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13636 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13637 often defined on groups of types.
13638
13639 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13640
13641 @itemize @bullet
13642
13643 @item
13644 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13645 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13646
13647 @item
13648 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13649 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13650
13651 @item
13652 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13653
13654 @item
13655 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13656
13657 @end itemize
13658
13659 @noindent
13660 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13661 in order of increasing precedence:
13662
13663 @table @code
13664 @item ,
13665 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13666 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13667 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13668
13669 @item =
13670 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13671 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13672
13673 @item @var{op}=
13674 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13675 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13676 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
13677 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13678 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13679
13680 @item ?:
13681 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13682 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
13683 integral type.
13684
13685 @item ||
13686 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13687
13688 @item &&
13689 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13690
13691 @item |
13692 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13693
13694 @item ^
13695 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13696
13697 @item &
13698 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13699
13700 @item ==@r{, }!=
13701 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13702 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13703
13704 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13705 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13706 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13707 and non-zero for true.
13708
13709 @item <<@r{, }>>
13710 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13711
13712 @item @@
13713 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13714
13715 @item +@r{, }-
13716 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13717 pointer types.
13718
13719 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13720 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13721 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13722 integral types.
13723
13724 @item ++@r{, }--
13725 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13726 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13727 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13728 operation takes place.
13729
13730 @item *
13731 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13732 @code{++}.
13733
13734 @item &
13735 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13736
13737 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13738 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13739 to examine the address
13740 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13741 stored.
13742
13743 @item -
13744 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13745 precedence as @code{++}.
13746
13747 @item !
13748 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13749 @code{++}.
13750
13751 @item ~
13752 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13753 @code{++}.
13754
13755
13756 @item .@r{, }->
13757 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13758 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13759 pointer based on the stored type information.
13760 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13761
13762 @item .*@r{, }->*
13763 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13764
13765 @item []
13766 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13767 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13768
13769 @item ()
13770 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13771
13772 @item ::
13773 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13774 and @code{class} types.
13775
13776 @item ::
13777 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13778 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13779 above.
13780 @end table
13781
13782 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13783 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13784 predefined meaning.
13785
13786 @node C Constants
13787 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13788
13789 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13790
13791 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13792 following ways:
13793
13794 @itemize @bullet
13795 @item
13796 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13797 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13798 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13799 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13800 @code{long} value.
13801
13802 @item
13803 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13804 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13805 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13806 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13807 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13808 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13809 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13810 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13811 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13812 constant.
13813
13814 @item
13815 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13816 integral equivalents.
13817
13818 @item
13819 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13820 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13821 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13822 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13823 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13824 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13825 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13826 @samp{\n} for newline.
13827
13828 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13829 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13830 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13831 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13832
13833 @item
13834 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13835 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13836 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13837 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13838 characters.
13839
13840 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13841 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13842 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13843
13844 @item
13845 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13846 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13847
13848 @item
13849 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13850 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13851 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13852 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13853 @end itemize
13854
13855 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13856 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13857
13858 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13859 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13860
13861 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13862 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13863 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13864 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13865 @quotation
13866 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13867 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13868 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13869 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13870 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13871 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13872 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13873 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13874 @end quotation
13875
13876 @enumerate
13877
13878 @cindex member functions
13879 @item
13880 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13881
13882 @smallexample
13883 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
13884 @end smallexample
13885
13886 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
13887 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
13888 @item
13889 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
13890 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
13891 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
13892 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
13893 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
13894
13895 @cindex call overloaded functions
13896 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
13897 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
13898 @item
13899 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
13900 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
13901 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
13902 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
13903 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
13904 default arguments.
13905
13906 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
13907 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
13908 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
13909 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
13910 number of function arguments.
13911
13912 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
13913 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
13914 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
13915
13916 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
13917 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
13918 @smallexample
13919 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
13920 @end smallexample
13921
13922 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
13923 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
13924
13925 @cindex reference declarations
13926 @item
13927 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
13928 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
13929 dereferenced.
13930
13931 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
13932 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
13933 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
13934 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
13935 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
13936
13937 @item
13938 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
13939 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
13940 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
13941 necessary, for example in an expression like
13942 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
13943 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
13944 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
13945
13946 @item
13947 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
13948 specification.
13949 @end enumerate
13950
13951 @node C Defaults
13952 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
13953
13954 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
13955
13956 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
13957 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
13958 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13959 selects the working language.
13960
13961 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
13962 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
13963 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
13964 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
13965 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
13966 for further details.
13967
13968 @node C Checks
13969 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
13970
13971 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
13972
13973 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
13974 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
13975 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
13976 constants to pointers.
13977
13978 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
13979 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
13980 that is not itself an array.
13981
13982 @node Debugging C
13983 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
13984
13985 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
13986 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
13987 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
13988 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
13989
13990 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
13991 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
13992 ,Expressions}.
13993
13994 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
13995 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
13996
13997 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
13998
13999 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14000 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14001
14002 @table @code
14003 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14004 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14005 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14006 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14007 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14008 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14009
14010 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14011 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14012 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14013 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14014 classes.
14015 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14016
14017 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14018 @item catch throw
14019 @itemx catch rethrow
14020 @itemx catch catch
14021 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14022 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14023
14024 @cindex inheritance
14025 @item ptype @var{typename}
14026 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14027 @var{typename}.
14028 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14029
14030 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14031 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14032 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14033 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14034 multiple inheritance is in use.
14035
14036 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14037 @item set print demangle
14038 @itemx show print demangle
14039 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14040 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14041 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14042 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14043 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14044
14045 @item set print object
14046 @itemx show print object
14047 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14048 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14049
14050 @item set print vtbl
14051 @itemx show print vtbl
14052 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14053 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14054 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14055 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14056
14057 @kindex set overload-resolution
14058 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14059 @item set overload-resolution on
14060 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14061 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14062 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14063 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14064 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14065 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14066
14067 @item set overload-resolution off
14068 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14069 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14070 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14071 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14072 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14073 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14074 argument types.
14075
14076 @kindex show overload-resolution
14077 @item show overload-resolution
14078 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14079
14080 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14081 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14082 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14083 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14084 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14085 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14086 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14087 @end table
14088
14089 @node Decimal Floating Point
14090 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14091 @cindex decimal floating point format
14092
14093 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14094 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14095 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14096 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14097
14098 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14099 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14100 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14101 configured target.
14102
14103 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14104 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14105 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14106
14107 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14108 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14109 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14110
14111 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14112 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14113 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14114
14115 @node D
14116 @subsection D
14117
14118 @cindex D
14119 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14120 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14121 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14122
14123 @node Go
14124 @subsection Go
14125
14126 @cindex Go (programming language)
14127 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14128 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14129
14130 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14131
14132 @table @code
14133 @cindex current Go package
14134 @item The current Go package
14135 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14136 specifying global variables and functions.
14137
14138 For example, given the program:
14139
14140 @example
14141 package main
14142 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14143 func main () @{
14144 // ...
14145 @}
14146 @end example
14147
14148 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14149
14150 @example
14151 (gdb) p myglob
14152 (gdb) p main.myglob
14153 @end example
14154
14155 @cindex builtin Go types
14156 @item Builtin Go types
14157 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14158 as a string.
14159
14160 @cindex builtin Go functions
14161 @item Builtin Go functions
14162 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14163 function and handles it internally.
14164
14165 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14166 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14167 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14168 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14169 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14170 @end table
14171
14172 @node Objective-C
14173 @subsection Objective-C
14174
14175 @cindex Objective-C
14176 This section provides information about some commands and command
14177 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14178 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14179 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14180
14181 @menu
14182 * Method Names in Commands::
14183 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14184 @end menu
14185
14186 @node Method Names in Commands
14187 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14188
14189 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14190 names as line specifications:
14191
14192 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14193 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14194 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14195 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14196 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14197 @itemize
14198 @item @code{clear}
14199 @item @code{break}
14200 @item @code{info line}
14201 @item @code{jump}
14202 @item @code{list}
14203 @end itemize
14204
14205 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14206
14207 @smallexample
14208 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14209 @end smallexample
14210
14211 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14212 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14213 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14214 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14215 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14216 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14217 debugged, enter:
14218
14219 @smallexample
14220 break -[Fruit create]
14221 @end smallexample
14222
14223 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14224 enter:
14225
14226 @smallexample
14227 list +[NSText initialize]
14228 @end smallexample
14229
14230 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14231 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14232 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14233 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14234
14235 @smallexample
14236 break create
14237 @end smallexample
14238
14239 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14240 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14241 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14242 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14243 none apply.
14244
14245 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14246 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14247
14248 @smallexample
14249 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14250 @end smallexample
14251
14252 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14253 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14254 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14255 @kindex print-object
14256 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14257
14258 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14259
14260 @smallexample
14261 print -[@var{object} hash]
14262 @end smallexample
14263
14264 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14265 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14266 @noindent
14267 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14268 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14269 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14270 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14271 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14272 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14273
14274 @node OpenCL C
14275 @subsection OpenCL C
14276
14277 @cindex OpenCL C
14278 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14279
14280 @menu
14281 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14282 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14283 * OpenCL C Operators::
14284 @end menu
14285
14286 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14287 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14288
14289 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14290 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14291 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14292 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14293 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14294
14295 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14296 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14297
14298 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14299 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14300 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14301 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14302
14303 @node OpenCL C Operators
14304 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14305
14306 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14307 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14308 vector data types.
14309
14310 @node Fortran
14311 @subsection Fortran
14312 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14313
14314 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14315 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14316
14317 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14318 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14319 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14320 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14321 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14322 underscore.
14323
14324 @menu
14325 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14326 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14327 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14328 @end menu
14329
14330 @node Fortran Operators
14331 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14332
14333 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14334
14335 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14336 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14337 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14338
14339 @table @code
14340 @item **
14341 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14342 of the second one.
14343
14344 @item :
14345 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14346 represent a section of array.
14347
14348 @item %
14349 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14350 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14351 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14352 union type.
14353 @end table
14354
14355 @node Fortran Defaults
14356 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14357
14358 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14359
14360 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14361 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14362 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14363 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14364
14365 @node Special Fortran Commands
14366 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14367
14368 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14369
14370 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14371 such as displaying common blocks.
14372
14373 @table @code
14374 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14375 @kindex info common
14376 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14377 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14378 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14379 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14380 printed.
14381 @end table
14382
14383 @node Pascal
14384 @subsection Pascal
14385
14386 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14387 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14388 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14389 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14390 syntax.
14391
14392 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14393 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14394 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14395
14396 @node Modula-2
14397 @subsection Modula-2
14398
14399 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14400
14401 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14402 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14403 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14404 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14405 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14406 table.
14407
14408 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14409 @menu
14410 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14411 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14412 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14413 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14414 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14415 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14416 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14417 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14418 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14419 @end menu
14420
14421 @node M2 Operators
14422 @subsubsection Operators
14423 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14424
14425 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14426 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14427 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14428 following definitions hold:
14429
14430 @itemize @bullet
14431
14432 @item
14433 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14434 their subranges.
14435
14436 @item
14437 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14438
14439 @item
14440 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14441
14442 @item
14443 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14444 @var{type}}.
14445
14446 @item
14447 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14448
14449 @item
14450 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14451
14452 @item
14453 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14454 @end itemize
14455
14456 @noindent
14457 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14458 increasing precedence:
14459
14460 @table @code
14461 @item ,
14462 Function argument or array index separator.
14463
14464 @item :=
14465 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14466 @var{value}.
14467
14468 @item <@r{, }>
14469 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14470 types.
14471
14472 @item <=@r{, }>=
14473 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14474 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14475 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14476
14477 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14478 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14479 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14480 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14481 comment character.
14482
14483 @item IN
14484 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14485 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14486
14487 @item OR
14488 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14489
14490 @item AND@r{, }&
14491 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14492
14493 @item @@
14494 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14495
14496 @item +@r{, }-
14497 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14498 and difference on set types.
14499
14500 @item *
14501 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14502 on set types.
14503
14504 @item /
14505 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14506 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14507
14508 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14509 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14510 precedence as @code{*}.
14511
14512 @item -
14513 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14514
14515 @item ^
14516 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14517
14518 @item NOT
14519 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14520 @code{^}.
14521
14522 @item .
14523 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14524 precedence as @code{^}.
14525
14526 @item []
14527 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14528
14529 @item ()
14530 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14531 as @code{^}.
14532
14533 @item ::@r{, }.
14534 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14535 @end table
14536
14537 @quotation
14538 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14539 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14540 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14541 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14542 @end quotation
14543
14544
14545 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14546 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14547 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14548
14549 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14550 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14551
14552 @table @var
14553
14554 @item a
14555 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14556
14557 @item c
14558 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14559
14560 @item i
14561 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14562
14563 @item m
14564 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14565 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14566 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14567
14568 @item n
14569 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14570
14571 @item r
14572 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14573
14574 @item t
14575 represents a type.
14576
14577 @item v
14578 represents a variable.
14579
14580 @item x
14581 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14582 explanation of the function for details.
14583 @end table
14584
14585 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14586
14587 @table @code
14588 @item ABS(@var{n})
14589 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14590
14591 @item CAP(@var{c})
14592 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14593 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14594
14595 @item CHR(@var{i})
14596 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14597
14598 @item DEC(@var{v})
14599 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14600
14601 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14602 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14603 new value.
14604
14605 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14606 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14607 set.
14608
14609 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14610 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14611
14612 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14613 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14614
14615 @item INC(@var{v})
14616 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14617
14618 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14619 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14620 new value.
14621
14622 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14623 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14624 there. Returns the new set.
14625
14626 @item MAX(@var{t})
14627 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14628
14629 @item MIN(@var{t})
14630 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14631
14632 @item ODD(@var{i})
14633 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14634
14635 @item ORD(@var{x})
14636 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14637 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
14638 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
14639 integral, character and enumerated types.
14640
14641 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14642 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14643
14644 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14645 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14646
14647 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14648 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14649
14650 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14651 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14652 @end table
14653
14654 @quotation
14655 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14656 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14657 an error.
14658 @end quotation
14659
14660 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14661 @node M2 Constants
14662 @subsubsection Constants
14663
14664 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14665 ways:
14666
14667 @itemize @bullet
14668
14669 @item
14670 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14671 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14672 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14673 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14674
14675 @item
14676 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14677 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14678 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14679 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14680 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14681 digits.
14682
14683 @item
14684 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14685 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14686 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14687 followed by a @samp{C}.
14688
14689 @item
14690 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14691 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14692 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14693 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14694 sequences.
14695
14696 @item
14697 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14698
14699 @item
14700 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14701 @code{FALSE}.
14702
14703 @item
14704 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14705
14706 @item
14707 Set constants are not yet supported.
14708 @end itemize
14709
14710 @node M2 Types
14711 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14712 @cindex Modula-2 types
14713
14714 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14715 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14716 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14717 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14718 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14719 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14720
14721 The first example contains the following section of code:
14722
14723 @smallexample
14724 VAR
14725 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14726 r: [20..40] ;
14727 @end smallexample
14728
14729 @noindent
14730 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14731 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14732
14733 @smallexample
14734 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14735 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14736 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14737 SET OF CHAR
14738 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14739 21
14740 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14741 [20..40]
14742 @end smallexample
14743
14744 @noindent
14745 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14746
14747 @smallexample
14748 VAR
14749 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14750 @end smallexample
14751
14752 @noindent
14753 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14754
14755 @smallexample
14756 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14757 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14758 @end smallexample
14759
14760 @noindent
14761 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14762 expressions using the debugger.
14763
14764 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14765 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14766
14767 @smallexample
14768 VAR
14769 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14770 @end smallexample
14771
14772 @smallexample
14773 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14774 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14775 @end smallexample
14776
14777 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14778 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14779 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14780 above.
14781
14782 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14783
14784 @smallexample
14785 TYPE
14786 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14787 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14788 VAR
14789 s: t ;
14790 BEGIN
14791 s := blue ;
14792 @end smallexample
14793
14794 @noindent
14795 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14796 and value of a variable.
14797
14798 @smallexample
14799 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14800 $1 = blue
14801 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14802 type = [blue..yellow]
14803 @end smallexample
14804
14805 @noindent
14806 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14807 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14808 their @code{C} counterparts.
14809
14810 @smallexample
14811 VAR
14812 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14813 BEGIN
14814 s[1] := 1 ;
14815 @end smallexample
14816
14817 @smallexample
14818 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14819 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14820 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14821 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14822 @end smallexample
14823
14824 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14825 pointer types as shown in this example:
14826
14827 @smallexample
14828 VAR
14829 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14830 BEGIN
14831 NEW(s) ;
14832 s^[1] := 1 ;
14833 @end smallexample
14834
14835 @noindent
14836 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14837
14838 @smallexample
14839 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14840 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14841 @end smallexample
14842
14843 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14844 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14845 types:
14846
14847 @smallexample
14848 TYPE
14849 foo = RECORD
14850 f1: CARDINAL ;
14851 f2: CHAR ;
14852 f3: myarray ;
14853 END ;
14854
14855 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14856 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14857 VAR
14858 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14859 @end smallexample
14860
14861 @noindent
14862 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14863 below.
14864
14865 @smallexample
14866 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14867 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14868 f1 : CARDINAL;
14869 f2 : CHAR;
14870 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14871 END
14872 @end smallexample
14873
14874 @node M2 Defaults
14875 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14876 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14877
14878 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14879 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
14880 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14881 selected the working language.
14882
14883 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
14884 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
14885 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
14886 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
14887
14888 @node Deviations
14889 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
14890 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
14891
14892 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
14893 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
14894
14895 @itemize @bullet
14896 @item
14897 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
14898 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
14899 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
14900 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
14901 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
14902 returned a pointer.)
14903
14904 @item
14905 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
14906 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
14907 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
14908 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
14909
14910 @item
14911 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
14912 argument.
14913
14914 @item
14915 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
14916 @end itemize
14917
14918 @node M2 Checks
14919 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
14920 @cindex Modula-2 checks
14921
14922 @quotation
14923 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
14924 range checking.
14925 @end quotation
14926 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
14927
14928 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
14929
14930 @itemize @bullet
14931 @item
14932 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
14933 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
14934
14935 @item
14936 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
14937 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
14938 @end itemize
14939
14940 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
14941 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
14942
14943 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
14944 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
14945
14946 @node M2 Scope
14947 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14948 @cindex scope
14949 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
14950 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
14951 @ifinfo
14952 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
14953 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
14954 @end ifinfo
14955 @ifnotinfo
14956 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
14957 @end ifnotinfo
14958
14959 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
14960 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
14961 similar syntax:
14962
14963 @smallexample
14964
14965 @var{module} . @var{id}
14966 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
14967 @end smallexample
14968
14969 @noindent
14970 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
14971 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
14972 identifier within your program, except another module.
14973
14974 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
14975 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
14976 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
14977 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
14978
14979 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
14980 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
14981 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
14982 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
14983 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
14984 @var{module}.
14985
14986 @node GDB/M2
14987 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14988
14989 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
14990 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
14991 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
14992 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
14993 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
14994 analogue in Modula-2.
14995
14996 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
14997 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
14998 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
14999 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15000 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15001 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15002
15003 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15004 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15005 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15006
15007 @node Ada
15008 @subsection Ada
15009 @cindex Ada
15010
15011 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15012 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15013 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15014 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15015 to be difficult.
15016
15017
15018 @cindex expressions in Ada
15019 @menu
15020 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15021 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15022 in @value{GDBN}.
15023 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15024 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15025 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15026 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15027 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15028 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15029 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15030 Profile
15031 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15032 @end menu
15033
15034 @node Ada Mode Intro
15035 @subsubsection Introduction
15036 @cindex Ada mode, general
15037
15038 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15039 syntax, with some extensions.
15040 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15041
15042 @itemize @bullet
15043 @item
15044 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15045 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15046 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15047 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15048
15049 @item
15050 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15051 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15052
15053 @item
15054 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15055 @end itemize
15056
15057 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15058 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15059 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15060 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15061 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15062
15063 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15064 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15065 was translated from an Ada source file.
15066
15067 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15068 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15069 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15070 middle (to allow based literals).
15071
15072 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15073 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15074 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15075 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15076 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15077 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15078
15079 @node Omissions from Ada
15080 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15081 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15082
15083 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15084
15085 @itemize @bullet
15086 @item
15087 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15088
15089 @itemize @minus
15090 @item
15091 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15092 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15093
15094 @item
15095 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15096
15097 @item
15098 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15099
15100 @item
15101 @t{'Tag}.
15102
15103 @item
15104 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15105 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15106
15107 @item
15108 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15109 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15110
15111 @item
15112 @t{'Address}.
15113 @end itemize
15114
15115 @item
15116 The names in
15117 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15118 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15119 not currently available.
15120
15121 @item
15122 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15123 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15124 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15125 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15126 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15127 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15128 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15129 indeterminate values.
15130
15131 @item
15132 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15133 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15134 are not implemented.
15135
15136 @item
15137 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15138 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15139 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15140 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15141 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15142
15143 @smallexample
15144 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15145 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15146 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15147 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15148 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15149 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15150 @end smallexample
15151
15152 Changing a
15153 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15154 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15155 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15156 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15157 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15158 declared to have a type such as:
15159
15160 @smallexample
15161 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15162 Id : Integer;
15163 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15164 end record;
15165 @end smallexample
15166
15167 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15168 assignments:
15169
15170 @smallexample
15171 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15172 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15173 @end smallexample
15174
15175 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15176 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15177 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15178 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15179 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15180 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15181 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15182 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15183
15184 @item
15185 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15186
15187 @item
15188 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15189 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15190 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15191 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15192 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15193 the proper resolution.
15194
15195 @item
15196 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15197
15198 @item
15199 Entry calls are not implemented.
15200
15201 @item
15202 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15203 formats are not supported.
15204
15205 @item
15206 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15207
15208 @item
15209 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15210 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15211 context.
15212 Should your program
15213 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15214 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15215 @end itemize
15216
15217 @node Additions to Ada
15218 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15219 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15220
15221 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15222 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15223
15224 @itemize @bullet
15225 @item
15226 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15227 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15228 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15229 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15230 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15231 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15232 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15233 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15234
15235 @item
15236 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15237 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15238 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15239
15240 @item
15241 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15242 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15243
15244 @item
15245 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15246 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15247 @end itemize
15248
15249 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15250 additions specific to Ada:
15251
15252 @itemize @bullet
15253 @item
15254 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15255 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15256
15257 @smallexample
15258 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15259 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15260 @end smallexample
15261
15262 @item
15263 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15264 the value of its right-hand operand.
15265 This allows, for example,
15266 complex conditional breaks:
15267
15268 @smallexample
15269 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15270 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15271 @end smallexample
15272
15273 @item
15274 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15275 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15276 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15277 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15278 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15279 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15280 in strings. For example,
15281 @smallexample
15282 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15283 @end smallexample
15284 @noindent
15285 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15286 after each period.
15287
15288 @item
15289 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15290 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15291 to write
15292
15293 @smallexample
15294 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15295 @end smallexample
15296
15297 @item
15298 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15299 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15300 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15301 of 3 might print as
15302
15303 @smallexample
15304 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15305 @end smallexample
15306
15307 @noindent
15308 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15309 clause.
15310
15311 @item
15312 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15313 multi-character subsequence of
15314 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15315 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15316 in place of @t{a'length}.
15317
15318 @item
15319 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15320 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15321 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15322 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15323 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15324 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15325 For example,
15326 @smallexample
15327 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15328 @end smallexample
15329
15330 @item
15331 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15332 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15333 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15334 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15335 object.
15336
15337 @end itemize
15338
15339 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15340 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15341
15342 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15343 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15344 before reaching the main procedure.
15345 As defined in the Ada Reference
15346 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15347 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15348 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15349 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15350
15351 @node Ada Exceptions
15352 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15353
15354 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15355
15356 @table @code
15357 @kindex info exceptions
15358 @item info exceptions
15359 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15360 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15361 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15362 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15363 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15364 @end table
15365
15366 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15367 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15368 argument.
15369
15370 @smallexample
15371 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15372 All defined Ada exceptions:
15373 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15374 program_error: 0x613d20
15375 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15376 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15377 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15378 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15379 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15380 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15381 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15382 @end smallexample
15383
15384 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15385 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15386
15387 @node Ada Tasks
15388 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15389 @cindex Ada, tasking
15390
15391 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15392 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15393
15394 @table @code
15395 @kindex info tasks
15396 @item info tasks
15397 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15398
15399
15400 @smallexample
15401 @iftex
15402 @leftskip=0.5cm
15403 @end iftex
15404 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15405 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15406 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15407 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15408 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15409 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15410
15411 @end smallexample
15412
15413 @noindent
15414 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15415 task currently being inspected.
15416
15417 @table @asis
15418 @item ID
15419 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15420
15421 @item TID
15422 The Ada task ID.
15423
15424 @item P-ID
15425 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15426
15427 @item Pri
15428 The base priority of the task.
15429
15430 @item State
15431 Current state of the task.
15432
15433 @table @code
15434 @item Unactivated
15435 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15436 executing.
15437
15438 @item Runnable
15439 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15440 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15441
15442 @item Terminated
15443 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15444 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15445 terminated themselves.
15446
15447 @item Child Activation Wait
15448 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15449
15450 @item Accept Statement
15451 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15452
15453 @item Waiting on entry call
15454 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15455
15456 @item Async Select Wait
15457 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15458 select statement.
15459
15460 @item Delay Sleep
15461 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15462 alternative open.
15463
15464 @item Child Termination Wait
15465 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15466 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15467 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15468
15469 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15470 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15471 finish terminating.
15472
15473 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15474 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15475 @end table
15476
15477 @item Name
15478 Name of the task in the program.
15479
15480 @end table
15481
15482 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15483 @item info task @var{taskno}
15484 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15485 the following example:
15486 @smallexample
15487 @iftex
15488 @leftskip=0.5cm
15489 @end iftex
15490 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15491 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15492 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15493 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15494 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15495 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15496 Name: task_1
15497 Thread: 0x807f378
15498 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15499 Base Priority: 15
15500 State: Runnable
15501 @end smallexample
15502
15503 @item task
15504 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15505 @cindex current Ada task ID
15506 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15507
15508 @smallexample
15509 @iftex
15510 @leftskip=0.5cm
15511 @end iftex
15512 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15513 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15514 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15515 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15516 (@value{GDBP}) task
15517 [Current task is 2]
15518 @end smallexample
15519
15520 @item task @var{taskno}
15521 @cindex Ada task switching
15522 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15523 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15524 from the current task to the given task.
15525
15526 @smallexample
15527 @iftex
15528 @leftskip=0.5cm
15529 @end iftex
15530 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15531 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15532 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15533 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15534 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15535 [Switching to task 1]
15536 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15537 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15538 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15539 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15540 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15541 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15542 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15543 @end smallexample
15544
15545 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15546 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15547 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15548 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15549 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15550 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15551 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
15552 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
15553 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15554
15555 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15556 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15557 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
15558 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15559 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15560
15561 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15562 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15563 program.
15564
15565 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15566 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15567 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15568
15569 For example,
15570
15571 @smallexample
15572 @iftex
15573 @leftskip=0.5cm
15574 @end iftex
15575 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15576 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15577 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15578 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15579 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15580 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15581 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15582 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15583 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15584 Continuing.
15585 task # 1 running
15586 task # 2 running
15587
15588 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15589 15 flush;
15590 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15591 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15592 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15593 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15594 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15595 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15596 @end smallexample
15597 @end table
15598
15599 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15600 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15601 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15602
15603 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15604 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15605 the platform being used.
15606 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15607 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15608 as usual.
15609
15610 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15611 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15612 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15613 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15614 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15615 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15616
15617 @node Ravenscar Profile
15618 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15619 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15620
15621 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15622 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15623 requirements.
15624
15625 @table @code
15626 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15627 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15628 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15629 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15630 Profile. This is the default.
15631
15632 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15633 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15634 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15635 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15636 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15637 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15638 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15639
15640 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15641 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15642 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15643 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15644
15645 @end table
15646
15647 @node Ada Glitches
15648 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15649 @cindex Ada, problems
15650
15651 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15652 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15653 @value{GDBN},
15654 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15655 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15656
15657 @itemize @bullet
15658 @item
15659 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15660 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15661
15662 @item
15663 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15664 argument lists are treated as positional).
15665
15666 @item
15667 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15668
15669 @item
15670 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15671 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15672 the host machine.
15673
15674 @item
15675 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15676 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15677 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15678 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15679 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15680 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15681 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15682 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15683 you can usually resolve the confusion
15684 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15685 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15686 @end itemize
15687
15688 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15689 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15690 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15691 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15692 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15693 enabled.
15694
15695 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15696 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15697 @table @code
15698
15699 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15700 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15701 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15702 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15703 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15704 This is the default.
15705
15706 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15707 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15708 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15709 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15710 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15711 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15712 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15713
15714 @end table
15715
15716 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15717 @cindex GNAT encoding
15718 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15719 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15720 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15721 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15722 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15723 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15724
15725 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15726 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15727 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15728 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15729 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15730 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15731 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15732 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15733
15734 @table @code
15735
15736 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15737 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15738 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15739 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15740
15741 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15742 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15743 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15744
15745 @end table
15746
15747 @node Unsupported Languages
15748 @section Unsupported Languages
15749
15750 @cindex unsupported languages
15751 @cindex minimal language
15752 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15753 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15754 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15755 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15756 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15757 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15758
15759 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15760 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15761 language.
15762
15763 @node Symbols
15764 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15765
15766 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15767 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15768 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15769 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15770 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15771 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15772 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15773
15774 @cindex symbol names
15775 @cindex names of symbols
15776 @cindex quoting names
15777 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15778 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15779 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15780 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15781 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15782 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15783 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15784 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15785
15786 @smallexample
15787 p 'foo.c'::x
15788 @end smallexample
15789
15790 @noindent
15791 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15792
15793 @table @code
15794 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15795 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15796 @kindex set case-sensitive
15797 @item set case-sensitive on
15798 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15799 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15800 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15801 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15802 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15803 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15804 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15805 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15806 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15807 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15808 case-insensitive matches.
15809
15810 @kindex show case-sensitive
15811 @item show case-sensitive
15812 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15813 lookups.
15814
15815 @kindex set print type methods
15816 @item set print type methods
15817 @itemx set print type methods on
15818 @itemx set print type methods off
15819 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15820 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15821 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15822 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15823 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15824 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15825
15826 @kindex show print type methods
15827 @item show print type methods
15828 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15829 classes.
15830
15831 @kindex set print type typedefs
15832 @item set print type typedefs
15833 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15834 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15835
15836 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15837 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15838 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15839 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15840 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15841 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15842 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15843 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15844 types.
15845
15846 @kindex show print type typedefs
15847 @item show print type typedefs
15848 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15849 printing classes.
15850
15851 @kindex info address
15852 @cindex address of a symbol
15853 @item info address @var{symbol}
15854 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15855 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15856 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15857 is always stored.
15858
15859 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15860 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15861 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15862
15863 @kindex info symbol
15864 @cindex symbol from address
15865 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15866 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15867 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15868 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15869 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15870
15871 @smallexample
15872 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15873 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15874 @end smallexample
15875
15876 @noindent
15877 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15878 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15879
15880 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
15881 library containing the symbol is also printed:
15882
15883 @smallexample
15884 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
15885 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
15886 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
15887 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
15888 @end smallexample
15889
15890 @kindex whatis
15891 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15892 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
15893 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
15894 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15895
15896 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
15897 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
15898 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
15899
15900 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
15901 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
15902 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
15903 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
15904 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
15905 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
15906 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
15907 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
15908 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
15909
15910 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
15911 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
15912 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
15913 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
15914 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
15915 unroll it.
15916
15917 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
15918 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
15919 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
15920
15921 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
15922 Available flags are:
15923
15924 @table @code
15925 @item r
15926 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
15927 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
15928 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
15929
15930 @item m
15931 Do not print methods defined in the class.
15932
15933 @item M
15934 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15935 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
15936
15937 @item t
15938 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
15939 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
15940 names are substituted when printing other types.
15941
15942 @item T
15943 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15944 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
15945 @end table
15946
15947 @kindex ptype
15948 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15949 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
15950 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
15951 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
15952
15953 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
15954 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
15955 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
15956 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
15957 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
15958 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
15959 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
15960 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
15961
15962 For example, for this variable declaration:
15963
15964 @smallexample
15965 typedef double real_t;
15966 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
15967 typedef struct complex complex_t;
15968 complex_t var;
15969 real_t *real_pointer_var;
15970 @end smallexample
15971
15972 @noindent
15973 the two commands give this output:
15974
15975 @smallexample
15976 @group
15977 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
15978 type = complex_t
15979 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
15980 type = struct complex @{
15981 real_t real;
15982 double imag;
15983 @}
15984 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
15985 type = struct complex
15986 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
15987 type = struct complex
15988 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
15989 type = struct complex @{
15990 real_t real;
15991 double imag;
15992 @}
15993 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
15994 type = real_t *
15995 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
15996 type = double *
15997 @end group
15998 @end smallexample
15999
16000 @noindent
16001 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16002 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16003
16004 @cindex incomplete type
16005 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16006 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16007 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16008 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16009 given these declarations:
16010
16011 @smallexample
16012 struct foo;
16013 struct foo *fooptr;
16014 @end smallexample
16015
16016 @noindent
16017 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16018
16019 @smallexample
16020 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16021 $1 = <incomplete type>
16022 @end smallexample
16023
16024 @noindent
16025 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16026 completely specified.
16027
16028 @kindex info types
16029 @item info types @var{regexp}
16030 @itemx info types
16031 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16032 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16033 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16034 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16035 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16036 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16037 name is @code{value}.
16038
16039 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16040 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16041 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16042
16043 @kindex info type-printers
16044 @item info type-printers
16045 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16046 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16047 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16048 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16049 type printers.
16050
16051 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16052
16053 @kindex enable type-printer
16054 @kindex disable type-printer
16055 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16056 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16057 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16058
16059 @kindex info scope
16060 @cindex local variables
16061 @item info scope @var{location}
16062 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16063 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16064 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16065 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16066 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16067
16068 @smallexample
16069 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16070 Scope for command_line_handler:
16071 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16072 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16073 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16074 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16075 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16076 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16077 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16078 @end smallexample
16079
16080 @noindent
16081 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16082 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16083 collect}.
16084
16085 @kindex info source
16086 @item info source
16087 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16088 the function containing the current point of execution:
16089 @itemize @bullet
16090 @item
16091 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16092 @item
16093 the directory it was compiled in,
16094 @item
16095 its length, in lines,
16096 @item
16097 which programming language it is written in,
16098 @item
16099 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16100 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16101 @item
16102 whether the debugging information includes information about
16103 preprocessor macros.
16104 @end itemize
16105
16106
16107 @kindex info sources
16108 @item info sources
16109 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16110 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16111 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16112
16113 @kindex info functions
16114 @item info functions
16115 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16116
16117 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16118 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16119 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16120 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16121 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16122 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16123 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16124 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16125
16126 @kindex info variables
16127 @item info variables
16128 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16129 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16130
16131 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16132 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16133 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16134 @var{regexp}.
16135
16136 @kindex info classes
16137 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16138 @item info classes
16139 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16140 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16141 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16142 expression.
16143
16144 @kindex info selectors
16145 @item info selectors
16146 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16147 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16148 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16149 expression.
16150
16151 @ignore
16152 This was never implemented.
16153 @kindex info methods
16154 @item info methods
16155 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16156 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16157 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16158 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16159 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16160 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16161 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16162 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16163 @end ignore
16164
16165 @cindex opaque data types
16166 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16167 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16168 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16169 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16170 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16171 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16172 another source file. The default is on.
16173
16174 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16175 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16176
16177 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16178 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16179 is printed as follows:
16180 @smallexample
16181 @{<no data fields>@}
16182 @end smallexample
16183
16184 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16185 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16186 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16187
16188 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16189 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16190 @item set print symbol-loading
16191 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16192 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16193 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16194 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16195 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16196 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16197 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16198 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16199 can be annoying.
16200 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16201 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16202 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16203 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16204
16205 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16206 @item show print symbol-loading
16207 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16208 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16209
16210 @kindex maint print symbols
16211 @cindex symbol dump
16212 @kindex maint print psymbols
16213 @cindex partial symbol dump
16214 @kindex maint print msymbols
16215 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16216 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16217 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16218 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16219 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16220 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16221 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16222 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16223 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16224 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16225 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16226 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16227 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16228 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16229 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16230 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16231 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16232 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16233
16234 @kindex maint info symtabs
16235 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16236 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16237 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16238 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16239 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16240 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16241 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16242
16243 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16244 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16245 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16246 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16247 structure in more detail. For example:
16248
16249 @smallexample
16250 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16251 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16252 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16253 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16254 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16255 readin no
16256 fullname (null)
16257 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16258 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16259 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16260 dependencies (none)
16261 @}
16262 @}
16263 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16264 (@value{GDBP})
16265 @end smallexample
16266 @noindent
16267 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16268 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16269 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16270 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16271 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16272
16273 @smallexample
16274 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16275 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16276 line 1574.
16277 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16278 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16279 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16280 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16281 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16282 dirname (null)
16283 fullname (null)
16284 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16285 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16286 debugformat DWARF 2
16287 @}
16288 @}
16289 (@value{GDBP})
16290 @end smallexample
16291 @end table
16292
16293
16294 @node Altering
16295 @chapter Altering Execution
16296
16297 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16298 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16299 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16300 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16301 program.
16302
16303 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16304 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16305 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16306
16307 @menu
16308 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16309 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16310 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16311 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16312 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16313 * Patching:: Patching your program
16314 @end menu
16315
16316 @node Assignment
16317 @section Assignment to Variables
16318
16319 @cindex assignment
16320 @cindex setting variables
16321 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16322 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16323
16324 @smallexample
16325 print x=4
16326 @end smallexample
16327
16328 @noindent
16329 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16330 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16331 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16332 information on operators in supported languages.
16333
16334 @kindex set variable
16335 @cindex variables, setting
16336 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16337 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16338 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16339 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16340 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16341
16342 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16343 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16344 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16345 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16346 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16347 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16348 command @code{set width}:
16349
16350 @smallexample
16351 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16352 type = double
16353 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16354 $4 = 13
16355 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16356 Invalid syntax in expression.
16357 @end smallexample
16358
16359 @noindent
16360 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16361 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16362
16363 @smallexample
16364 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16365 @end smallexample
16366
16367 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16368 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16369 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16370 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16371 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16372 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16373
16374 @smallexample
16375 @group
16376 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16377 type = double
16378 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16379 $1 = 1
16380 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16381 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16382 $2 = 1
16383 (@value{GDBP}) r
16384 The program being debugged has been started already.
16385 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16386 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16387 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16388 Invalid bfd target.
16389 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16390 The current BFD target is "=4".
16391 @end group
16392 @end smallexample
16393
16394 @noindent
16395 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16396 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16397 @code{g}, use
16398
16399 @smallexample
16400 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16401 @end smallexample
16402
16403 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16404 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16405 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16406 same length or shorter.
16407 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16408 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16409
16410 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16411 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16412 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16413 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16414 and representation in memory), and
16415
16416 @smallexample
16417 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16418 @end smallexample
16419
16420 @noindent
16421 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16422
16423 @node Jumping
16424 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16425
16426 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16427 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16428 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16429
16430 @table @code
16431 @kindex jump
16432 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16433 @item jump @var{linespec}
16434 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16435 @itemx jump @var{location}
16436 @itemx j @var{location}
16437 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16438 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16439 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16440 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16441 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16442 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16443
16444 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16445 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16446 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16447 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16448 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16449 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16450 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16451 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16452 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16453 @end table
16454
16455 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16456 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16457 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16458 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16459 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16460 example,
16461
16462 @smallexample
16463 set $pc = 0x485
16464 @end smallexample
16465
16466 @noindent
16467 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16468 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16469 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16470
16471 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16472 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16473 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16474 detail.
16475
16476 @c @group
16477 @node Signaling
16478 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16479 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16480
16481 @table @code
16482 @kindex signal
16483 @item signal @var{signal}
16484 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
16485 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16486 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16487 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16488
16489 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16490 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16491 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16492 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16493 signal.
16494
16495 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16496 after executing the command.
16497 @end table
16498 @c @end group
16499
16500 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16501 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16502 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16503 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16504 passes the signal directly to your program.
16505
16506
16507 @node Returning
16508 @section Returning from a Function
16509
16510 @table @code
16511 @cindex returning from a function
16512 @kindex return
16513 @item return
16514 @itemx return @var{expression}
16515 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16516 command. If you give an
16517 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16518 value.
16519 @end table
16520
16521 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16522 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16523 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16524 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16525
16526 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16527 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16528 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16529 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16530 of functions.
16531
16532 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16533 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16534 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16535 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16536 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16537
16538 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16539 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16540 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16541 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16542 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16543 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16544 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16545 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16546 assignment into the right register(s).
16547
16548 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16549 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16550 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16551 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16552 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16553 into a @code{long long int}:
16554
16555 @smallexample
16556 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16557 29 return 31;
16558 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16559 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16560 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16561 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16562 (@value{GDBP})
16563 @end smallexample
16564
16565 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16566 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16567 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16568 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16569 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16570 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16571 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16572 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16573
16574 @smallexample
16575 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16576 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16577 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16578 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16579 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16580 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16581 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16582 (@value{GDBP})
16583 @end smallexample
16584
16585 @node Calling
16586 @section Calling Program Functions
16587
16588 @table @code
16589 @cindex calling functions
16590 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16591 @item print @var{expr}
16592 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16593 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
16594 debugged.
16595
16596 @kindex call
16597 @item call @var{expr}
16598 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16599 returned values.
16600
16601 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16602 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16603 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16604 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16605 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16606 value history.
16607 @end table
16608
16609 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16610 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16611 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16612 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16613
16614 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16615 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16616 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16617 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16618 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16619 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16620 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16621 in that case is controlled by the
16622 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16623
16624 @table @code
16625 @item set unwindonsignal
16626 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16627 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16628 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16629 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16630 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16631 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16632 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16633 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16634 received.
16635
16636 @item show unwindonsignal
16637 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16638 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16639 @value{GDBN}.
16640
16641 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16642 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16643 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16644 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16645 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16646 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16647 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16648 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16649 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16650 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16651
16652 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16653 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16654 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16655 @value{GDBN}.
16656
16657 @end table
16658
16659 @cindex weak alias functions
16660 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16661 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16662 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16663 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16664 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16665 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16666 function instead.
16667
16668 @node Patching
16669 @section Patching Programs
16670
16671 @cindex patching binaries
16672 @cindex writing into executables
16673 @cindex writing into corefiles
16674
16675 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16676 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16677 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16678 patching your program's binary.
16679
16680 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16681 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16682 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16683 repairs.
16684
16685 @table @code
16686 @kindex set write
16687 @item set write on
16688 @itemx set write off
16689 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16690 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16691 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16692
16693 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16694 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16695 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16696
16697 @item show write
16698 @kindex show write
16699 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16700 as well as reading.
16701 @end table
16702
16703 @node GDB Files
16704 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16705
16706 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16707 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16708 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16709 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16710
16711 @menu
16712 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16713 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16714 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16715 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16716 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16717 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16718 @end menu
16719
16720 @node Files
16721 @section Commands to Specify Files
16722
16723 @cindex symbol table
16724 @cindex core dump file
16725
16726 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16727 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16728 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16729 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16730
16731 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16732 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16733 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16734 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16735 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16736 new files are useful.
16737
16738 @table @code
16739 @cindex executable file
16740 @kindex file
16741 @item file @var{filename}
16742 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16743 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16744 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16745 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16746 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16747 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16748 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16749 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16750
16751 @cindex unlinked object files
16752 @cindex patching object files
16753 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16754 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16755 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16756 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16757 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16758 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16759 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16760 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16761
16762 @item file
16763 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16764 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16765
16766 @kindex exec-file
16767 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16768 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16769 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16770 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16771 discard information on the executable file.
16772
16773 @kindex symbol-file
16774 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16775 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16776 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16777 table and program to run from the same file.
16778
16779 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16780 program's symbol table.
16781
16782 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16783 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16784 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16785 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16786 @value{GDBN}.
16787
16788 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16789 executing it once.
16790
16791 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16792 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16793 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16794 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16795 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16796 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16797 optimized code.
16798
16799 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16800 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16801 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16802 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16803 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16804
16805 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16806 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16807 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16808 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16809 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16810 Warnings and Messages}.)
16811
16812 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16813 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16814 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16815 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16816 in stabs format.
16817
16818 @kindex readnow
16819 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16820 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16821 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16822 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16823 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16824 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16825 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16826 entire symbol table available.
16827
16828 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16829 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16830 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16831 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16832 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16833 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16834 @c files.
16835
16836 @kindex core-file
16837 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16838 @itemx core
16839 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16840 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16841 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16842 executable file itself for other parts.
16843
16844 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16845 to be used.
16846
16847 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16848 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16849 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
16850 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
16851 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
16852
16853 @kindex add-symbol-file
16854 @cindex dynamic linking
16855 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
16856 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
16857 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
16858 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
16859 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
16860 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
16861 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
16862 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
16863 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
16864 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
16865 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
16866 @var{address} as an expression.
16867
16868 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
16869 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
16870 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
16871 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
16872
16873 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
16874
16875 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
16876 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
16877 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
16878 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
16879 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
16880 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
16881 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
16882 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
16883 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
16884
16885 @itemize @bullet
16886 @item
16887 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
16888 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
16889 @item
16890 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
16891 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
16892 @item
16893 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
16894 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16895 @end itemize
16896
16897 @noindent
16898 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
16899 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
16900 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
16901 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
16902 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
16903 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
16904 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
16905 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
16906 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
16907 way.
16908
16909 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16910
16911 @kindex remove-symbol-file
16912 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
16913 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
16914 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
16915 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
16916 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
16917
16918 @smallexample
16919 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
16920 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
16921 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
16922 (y or n) y
16923 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
16924 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
16925 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
16926 (gdb)
16927 @end smallexample
16928
16929
16930 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16931
16932 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
16933 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
16934 @cindex load symbols from memory
16935 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
16936 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
16937 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
16938 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
16939 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
16940 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
16941 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
16942 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
16943 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
16944
16945 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
16946 @kindex assf
16947 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
16948 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
16949 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
16950 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
16951
16952 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
16953 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
16954 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
16955 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
16956 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
16957 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
16958 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
16959 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
16960
16961 @kindex section
16962 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
16963 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
16964 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
16965 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
16966 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
16967 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
16968 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
16969 their addresses.
16970
16971 @kindex info files
16972 @kindex info target
16973 @item info files
16974 @itemx info target
16975 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
16976 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
16977 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
16978 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
16979 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
16980 current ones.
16981
16982 @kindex maint info sections
16983 @item maint info sections
16984 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
16985 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
16986 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
16987 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
16988 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
16989 may be arbitrarily combined):
16990
16991 @table @code
16992 @item ALLOBJ
16993 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
16994 @item @var{sections}
16995 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
16996 @item @var{section-flags}
16997 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
16998 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
16999 @table @code
17000 @item ALLOC
17001 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17002 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17003 @item LOAD
17004 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17005 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17006 @item RELOC
17007 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17008 @item READONLY
17009 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17010 @item CODE
17011 Section contains executable code only.
17012 @item DATA
17013 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17014 @item ROM
17015 Section will reside in ROM.
17016 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17017 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17018 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17019 Section is not empty.
17020 @item NEVER_LOAD
17021 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17022 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17023 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17024 COFF shared library information.
17025 @item IS_COMMON
17026 Section contains common symbols.
17027 @end table
17028 @end table
17029 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17030 @cindex read-only sections
17031 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17032 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17033 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17034 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17035 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17036 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17037 enhancement to debugging performance.
17038
17039 The default is off.
17040
17041 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17042 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17043 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17044 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17045
17046 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17047 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17048 @end table
17049
17050 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17051 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17052 name and remembers it that way.
17053
17054 @cindex shared libraries
17055 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17056 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17057 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17058
17059 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17060 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17061
17062 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17063 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17064 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17065 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17066 debugging a core file).
17067
17068 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17069 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17070
17071 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17072 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17073 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17074
17075 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17076 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17077 particularly large or there are many of them.
17078
17079 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17080 commands:
17081
17082 @table @code
17083 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17084 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17085 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17086 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17087 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17088 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17089 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17090 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17091
17092 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17093 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17094 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17095 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17096 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17097 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17098 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17099 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17100 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17101
17102 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17103 @item show auto-solib-add
17104 Display the current autoloading mode.
17105 @end table
17106
17107 @cindex load shared library
17108 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17109 command:
17110
17111 @table @code
17112 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17113 @kindex info share
17114 @item info share @var{regex}
17115 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17116 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17117 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17118 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17119
17120 @kindex sharedlibrary
17121 @kindex share
17122 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17123 @itemx share @var{regex}
17124 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17125 Unix regular expression.
17126 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17127 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17128 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17129 loaded.
17130
17131 @item nosharedlibrary
17132 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17133 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17134 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17135 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17136 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17137 discarded.
17138 @end table
17139
17140 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17141 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17142 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17143 Catchpoints}).
17144
17145 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17146 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17147 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17148 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17149
17150 @table @code
17151 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17152 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17153 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17154 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17155 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17156 shared library.
17157
17158 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17159 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17160 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17161 library events happen.
17162 @end table
17163
17164 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17165 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17166 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17167 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17168 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17169 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17170 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17171 not.
17172
17173 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17174 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17175 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17176 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17177 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17178
17179 @table @code
17180 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17181 @cindex system root, alternate
17182 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17183 @kindex set sysroot
17184 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17185 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17186 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17187 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17188 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17189 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17190 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17191 under @var{path}.
17192
17193 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17194 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17195 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17196 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17197 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17198 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17199 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17200 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17201 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17202
17203 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17204 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17205 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17206 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17207 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17208
17209 @smallexample
17210 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17211 @end smallexample
17212
17213 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17214 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17215 system:
17216
17217 @smallexample
17218 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17219 @end smallexample
17220
17221 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17222 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17223 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17224 colons:
17225
17226 @smallexample
17227 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17228 @end smallexample
17229
17230 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17231 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17232 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17233 @samp{z}):
17234
17235 @smallexample
17236 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17237 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17238 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17239 @end smallexample
17240
17241 @noindent
17242 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17243 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17244 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17245
17246 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17247 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17248
17249 @smallexample
17250 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17251 @end smallexample
17252
17253 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17254 if you don't want or need to.
17255
17256 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17257 sysroot}.
17258
17259 @cindex default system root
17260 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17261 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17262 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17263 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17264 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17265 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17266 location.
17267
17268 @kindex show sysroot
17269 @item show sysroot
17270 Display the current shared library prefix.
17271
17272 @kindex set solib-search-path
17273 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17274 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17275 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17276 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17277 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17278 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17279 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17280 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17281 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17282 of shared library symbols.
17283
17284 @kindex show solib-search-path
17285 @item show solib-search-path
17286 Display the current shared library search path.
17287
17288 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17289 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17290 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17291 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17292 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17293
17294 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17295 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17296 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17297 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17298 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17299 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17300 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17301 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17302 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17303 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17304 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17305 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17306 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17307 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17308 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17309 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17310 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17311 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17312 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17313 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17314 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17315 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17316
17317 @table @code
17318 @item unix
17319 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17320 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17321 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17322 the forward slash.
17323
17324 @item dos-based
17325 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17326 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17327 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17328 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17329 considered directory separators.
17330
17331 @item auto
17332 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17333 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17334 This is the default.
17335 @end table
17336 @end table
17337
17338 @cindex file name canonicalization
17339 @cindex base name differences
17340 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17341 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17342 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17343 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17344 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17345 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17346 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17347 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17348 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17349 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17350 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17351 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17352 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17353 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17354 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17355
17356 @table @code
17357 @item set basenames-may-differ
17358 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17359 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17360
17361 @item show basenames-may-differ
17362 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17363 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17364 @end table
17365
17366 @node Separate Debug Files
17367 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17368 @cindex separate debugging information files
17369 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17370 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17371 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17372 @cindex global debugging information directories
17373 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17374 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17375
17376 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17377 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17378 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17379 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17380 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17381 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17382 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17383
17384 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17385 file:
17386
17387 @itemize @bullet
17388 @item
17389 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17390 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17391 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17392 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17393 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17394 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17395 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17396 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17397
17398 @item
17399 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17400 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17401 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17402 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17403 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17404 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17405 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17406 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17407 below.
17408 @end itemize
17409
17410 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17411 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17412
17413 @itemize @bullet
17414 @item
17415 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17416 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17417 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17418 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17419 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17420
17421 @item
17422 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17423 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17424 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17425 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17426 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17427 hex characters, not 10.)
17428 @end itemize
17429
17430 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17431 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17432 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17433 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17434 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17435 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17436
17437 @itemize @minus
17438 @item
17439 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17440 @item
17441 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17442 @item
17443 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17444 @item
17445 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17446 @end itemize
17447
17448 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17449 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17450 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17451 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17452 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17453
17454 @table @code
17455
17456 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17457 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17458 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17459 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17460 concatenating them by a path separator.
17461
17462 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17463 @item show debug-file-directory
17464 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17465 information files.
17466
17467 @end table
17468
17469 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17470 @cindex debug link sections
17471 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17472 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17473
17474 @itemize
17475 @item
17476 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17477 a zero byte,
17478 @item
17479 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17480 boundary within the section, and
17481 @item
17482 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17483 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17484 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17485 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17486 @end itemize
17487
17488 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17489 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17490 described above.
17491
17492 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17493 @cindex build ID sections
17494 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17495 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17496 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17497 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17498 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17499 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17500 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17501 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17502 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17503
17504 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17505 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17506 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17507 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17508 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17509 in an ordinary executable.
17510
17511 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17512 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17513 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17514 following commands:
17515
17516 @smallexample
17517 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17518 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17519 @end smallexample
17520
17521 @noindent
17522 These commands remove the debugging
17523 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17524 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17525 two files:
17526
17527 @itemize @bullet
17528 @item
17529 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17530 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17531
17532 @smallexample
17533 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17534 @end smallexample
17535
17536 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17537 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17538 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17539 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17540
17541 @item
17542 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17543 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17544 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17545 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17546 @end itemize
17547
17548 @noindent
17549
17550 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17551 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17552 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17553
17554 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17555 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17556 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17557 @c different ways!
17558 @ifhtml
17559 @display
17560 @html
17561 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17562 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17563 @end html
17564 @end display
17565 @end ifhtml
17566 @ifnothtml
17567 @display
17568 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17569 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17570 @end display
17571 @end ifnothtml
17572
17573 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17574 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17575 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17576 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17577 CRC.
17578
17579 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17580 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
17581 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
17582 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
17583 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
17584 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17585
17586 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17587 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17588 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17589 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17590 @code{0xffffffff}.
17591
17592 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17593 @smallexample
17594 unsigned long
17595 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17596 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17597 @{
17598 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17599 @{
17600 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17601 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17602 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17603 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17604 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17605 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17606 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17607 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17608 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17609 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17610 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17611 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17612 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17613 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17614 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17615 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17616 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17617 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17618 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17619 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17620 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17621 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17622 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17623 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17624 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17625 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17626 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17627 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17628 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17629 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17630 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17631 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17632 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17633 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17634 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17635 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17636 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17637 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17638 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17639 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17640 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17641 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17642 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17643 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17644 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17645 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17646 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17647 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17648 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17649 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17650 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17651 0x2d02ef8d
17652 @};
17653 unsigned char *end;
17654
17655 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17656 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17657 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17658 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17659 @}
17660 @end smallexample
17661
17662 @noindent
17663 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17664
17665 @node MiniDebugInfo
17666 @section Debugging information in a special section
17667 @cindex separate debug sections
17668 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17669
17670 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17671 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17672 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17673 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17674
17675 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17676 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17677 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17678 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17679 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17680 debugging information might be included in the section.
17681
17682 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17683 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17684 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17685
17686 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17687 standard utilities:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17691 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17692 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17693 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17694
17695 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17696 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17697 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17698 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17699 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17700 | sort > funcsyms
17701
17702 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17703 # table.
17704 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17705
17706 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17707 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17708
17709 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17710 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17711 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17712 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17713
17714 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17715 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17716
17717 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17718 # original binary.
17719 xz mini_debuginfo
17720 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 @node Index Files
17724 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17725 @cindex index files
17726 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17727
17728 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17729 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17730 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17731 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17732 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17733 startup.
17734
17735 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17736 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17737 using @command{objcopy}.
17738
17739 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17740
17741 @table @code
17742 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17743 @kindex save gdb-index
17744 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17745 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17746 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17747 @var{directory}.
17748 @end table
17749
17750 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17751 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17752
17753 @smallexample
17754 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17755 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17756 @end smallexample
17757
17758 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17759 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17760 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17761 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17762 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17763 The default is @code{off}.
17764 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17765 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17766
17767 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17768 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17769
17770 @smallexample
17771 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17772 @end smallexample
17773
17774 Instead you must do, for example,
17775
17776 @smallexample
17777 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17778 @end smallexample
17779
17780 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17781 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17782 currently work for programs using Ada.
17783
17784 @node Symbol Errors
17785 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17786
17787 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17788 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17789 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17790 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17791 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17792 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17793 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17794 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17795 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17796 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17797 Messages}).
17798
17799 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17800
17801 @table @code
17802 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17803
17804 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17805 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17806 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17807 in its outer scope blocks.
17808
17809 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17810 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17811 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17812 function.
17813
17814 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17815
17816 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17817 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17818 do so.
17819
17820 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17821 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17822 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17823 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17824 Messages}.)
17825
17826 @item bad block start address patched
17827
17828 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17829 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17830 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17831
17832 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17833 starting on the previous source line.
17834
17835 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17836
17837 @cindex foo
17838 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17839 larger than the size of the string table.
17840
17841 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17842 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17843 with this name.
17844
17845 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17846
17847 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17848 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17849 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17850
17851 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
17852 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
17853 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
17854 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
17855 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
17856 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
17857
17858 @item stub type has NULL name
17859
17860 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
17861
17862 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
17863 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
17864 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
17865 it.
17866
17867 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
17868
17869 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
17870
17871 @end table
17872
17873 @node Data Files
17874 @section GDB Data Files
17875
17876 @cindex prefix for data files
17877 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
17878 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
17879
17880 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
17881 is currently using.
17882
17883 @table @code
17884 @kindex set data-directory
17885 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
17886 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
17887 to @var{directory}.
17888
17889 @kindex show data-directory
17890 @item show data-directory
17891 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
17892 @end table
17893
17894 @cindex default data directory
17895 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
17896 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
17897 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
17898 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17899 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
17900 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17901 location.
17902
17903 The data directory may also be specified with the
17904 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
17905 @xref{Mode Options}.
17906
17907 @node Targets
17908 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
17909
17910 @cindex debugging target
17911 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
17912
17913 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
17914 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
17915 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
17916 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
17917 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
17918 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
17919 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
17920 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
17921
17922 @cindex target architecture
17923 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
17924 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
17925 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
17926 command.
17927
17928 @table @code
17929 @kindex set architecture
17930 @kindex show architecture
17931 @item set architecture @var{arch}
17932 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
17933 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
17934 supported architectures.
17935
17936 @item show architecture
17937 Show the current target architecture.
17938
17939 @item set processor
17940 @itemx processor
17941 @kindex set processor
17942 @kindex show processor
17943 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
17944 and @code{show architecture}.
17945 @end table
17946
17947 @menu
17948 * Active Targets:: Active targets
17949 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
17950 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
17951 @end menu
17952
17953 @node Active Targets
17954 @section Active Targets
17955
17956 @cindex stacking targets
17957 @cindex active targets
17958 @cindex multiple targets
17959
17960 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
17961 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
17962 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
17963 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
17964 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
17965 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
17966 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
17967 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
17968 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
17969
17970 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
17971 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
17972 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
17973 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
17974
17975 @node Target Commands
17976 @section Commands for Managing Targets
17977
17978 @table @code
17979 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
17980 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
17981 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
17982 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
17983 protocol of the target machine.
17984
17985 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
17986 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
17987 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
17988
17989 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
17990 after executing the command.
17991
17992 @kindex help target
17993 @item help target
17994 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
17995 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
17996 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17997
17998 @item help target @var{name}
17999 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18000 select it.
18001
18002 @kindex set gnutarget
18003 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18004 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18005 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18006 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18007 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18008 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18009
18010 @quotation
18011 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18012 you must know the actual BFD name.
18013 @end quotation
18014
18015 @noindent
18016 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18017
18018 @kindex show gnutarget
18019 @item show gnutarget
18020 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18021 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18022 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18023 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18024 @end table
18025
18026 @cindex common targets
18027 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18028 configuration):
18029
18030 @table @code
18031 @kindex target
18032 @item target exec @var{program}
18033 @cindex executable file target
18034 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18035 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18036
18037 @item target core @var{filename}
18038 @cindex core dump file target
18039 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18040 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18041
18042 @item target remote @var{medium}
18043 @cindex remote target
18044 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18045 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18046 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18047
18048 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18049 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18050
18051 @smallexample
18052 target remote /dev/ttya
18053 @end smallexample
18054
18055 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18056 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18057 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18058 clobbered by the download.
18059
18060 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18061 @cindex built-in simulator target
18062 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18063 In general,
18064 @smallexample
18065 target sim
18066 load
18067 run
18068 @end smallexample
18069 @noindent
18070 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18071 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18072 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18073 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18074 Processors}.
18075
18076 @end table
18077
18078 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18079 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18080
18081 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18082 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18083 various aspects of this process.
18084
18085 @table @code
18086
18087 @item set hash
18088 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18089 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18090 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18091 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18092 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18093 monitor.
18094
18095 @item show hash
18096 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18097 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18098
18099 @item set debug monitor
18100 @kindex set debug monitor
18101 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18102 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18103 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18104
18105 @item show debug monitor
18106 @kindex show debug monitor
18107 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18108 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18109 @end table
18110
18111 @table @code
18112
18113 @kindex load @var{filename}
18114 @item load @var{filename}
18115 @anchor{load}
18116 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18117 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18118 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18119 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18120 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18121 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18122
18123 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18124 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18125 target is @dots{}}''
18126
18127 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18128 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18129 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18130 specifies a fixed address.
18131 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18132
18133 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18134 load programs into flash memory.
18135
18136 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18137 @end table
18138
18139 @node Byte Order
18140 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18141
18142 @cindex choosing target byte order
18143 @cindex target byte order
18144
18145 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18146 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18147 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18148 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18149 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18150 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18151
18152 @table @code
18153 @kindex set endian
18154 @item set endian big
18155 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18156
18157 @item set endian little
18158 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18159
18160 @item set endian auto
18161 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18162 executable.
18163
18164 @item show endian
18165 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18166
18167 @end table
18168
18169 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18170 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18171 target system.
18172
18173
18174 @node Remote Debugging
18175 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18176 @cindex remote debugging
18177
18178 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18179 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18180 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18181 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18182 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18183
18184 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18185 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18186 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18187 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18188 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18189 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18190
18191 Other remote targets may be available in your
18192 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18193
18194 @menu
18195 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18196 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18197 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18198 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18199 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18200 @end menu
18201
18202 @node Connecting
18203 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18204
18205 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18206 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18207 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18208 program as the first argument.
18209
18210 @cindex @code{target remote}
18211 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18212 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18213 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18214 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18215 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18216 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18217
18218 @table @code
18219
18220 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18221 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18222 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18223 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18224
18225 @smallexample
18226 target remote /dev/ttyb
18227 @end smallexample
18228
18229 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18230 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18231 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18232 @code{target} command.
18233
18234 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18235 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18236 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18237 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18238 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18239 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18240 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18241 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18242 target.
18243
18244 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18245 @code{manyfarms}:
18246
18247 @smallexample
18248 target remote manyfarms:2828
18249 @end smallexample
18250
18251 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18252 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18253 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18254 port 1234 on your local machine:
18255
18256 @smallexample
18257 target remote :1234
18258 @end smallexample
18259 @noindent
18260
18261 Note that the colon is still required here.
18262
18263 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18264 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18265 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18266 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18267
18268 @smallexample
18269 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18270 @end smallexample
18271
18272 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18273 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18274 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18275 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18276
18277 @item target remote | @var{command}
18278 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18279 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18280 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18281 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18282 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18283 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18284 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18285 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18286
18287 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18288 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18289 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18290
18291 @end table
18292
18293 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18294 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18295 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18296 need to use @kbd{run}.
18297
18298 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18299 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18300 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18301 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18302 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18303 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18304 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18305
18306 @smallexample
18307 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18308 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18309 @end smallexample
18310
18311 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18312 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18313 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18314 goes back to waiting.
18315
18316 @table @code
18317 @kindex detach (remote)
18318 @item detach
18319 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18320 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18321 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18322 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18323 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18324
18325 @kindex disconnect
18326 @item disconnect
18327 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18328 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18329 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18330 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18331 another target.
18332
18333 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18334 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18335 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18336 @kindex monitor
18337 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18338 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18339 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18340 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18341 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18342 and implement.
18343 @end table
18344
18345 @node File Transfer
18346 @section Sending files to a remote system
18347 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18348 @cindex file transfer
18349 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18350
18351 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18352 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18353 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18354 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18355 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18356 the only way to upload or download files.
18357
18358 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18359
18360 @table @code
18361 @kindex remote put
18362 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18363 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18364 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18365
18366 @kindex remote get
18367 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18368 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18369 on the host system.
18370
18371 @kindex remote delete
18372 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18373 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18374
18375 @end table
18376
18377 @node Server
18378 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18379
18380 @kindex gdbserver
18381 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18382 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18383 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18384 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18385
18386 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18387 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18388 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18389 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18390 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18391 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18392 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18393 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18394 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18395 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18396 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18397 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18398 choice for debugging.
18399
18400 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18401 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18402 protocol.
18403
18404 @quotation
18405 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18406 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18407 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18408 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18409 @code{gdbserver}.
18410 @end quotation
18411
18412 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18413 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18414 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18415
18416 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18417 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18418 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18419 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18420 system does all the symbol handling.
18421
18422 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18423 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18424 syntax is:
18425
18426 @smallexample
18427 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18428 @end smallexample
18429
18430 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18431 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18432 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18433 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18434 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18435 @file{/dev/com1}:
18436
18437 @smallexample
18438 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18439 @end smallexample
18440
18441 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18442 with it.
18443
18444 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18445
18446 @smallexample
18447 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18448 @end smallexample
18449
18450 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18451 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18452 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18453 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18454 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18455 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18456 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18457 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18458 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18459 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18460 @code{target remote} command.
18461
18462 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18463 with ssh:
18464
18465 @smallexample
18466 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18467 @end smallexample
18468
18469 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18470 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18471 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18472 You could elide it if you want to.
18473
18474 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18475 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18476 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18477 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18478
18479 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18480 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18481 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18482
18483 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18484 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18485
18486 @smallexample
18487 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18488 @end smallexample
18489
18490 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18491 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18492
18493 @pindex pidof
18494 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18495 @code{pidof} utility:
18496
18497 @smallexample
18498 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18499 @end smallexample
18500
18501 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18502 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18503 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18504
18505 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18506 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18507 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18508
18509 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18510 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18511 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18512 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18513
18514 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18515 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18516 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18517 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18518 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18519 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18520 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18521 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18522 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18523
18524 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18525 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18526 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18527 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18528 the program you want to debug.
18529
18530 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18531 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18532 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18533 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18534 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18535 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18536
18537 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18538
18539 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18540
18541 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18542 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18543 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18544 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18545 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18546 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18547 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18548 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18549
18550 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18551 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18552 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18553
18554 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18555 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18556 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18557 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18558 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18559 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18560 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18561 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18562 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18563 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18564 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18565 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18566
18567 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18568 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18569
18570 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18571 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18572 status information about the debugging process.
18573 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18574 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18575 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18576 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18577
18578 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18579 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18580 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18581 Possible options are:
18582
18583 @table @code
18584 @item none
18585 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18586 @item all
18587 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18588 @item timestamps
18589 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18590 @end table
18591
18592 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18593 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18594
18595 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18596 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18597 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18598 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18599 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18600
18601 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18602 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18603 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18604 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18605
18606 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18607 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18608 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18609 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18610
18611 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18612 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18613 environment:
18614
18615 @smallexample
18616 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18617 @end smallexample
18618
18619 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18620
18621 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18622
18623 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18624 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18625 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18626 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18627
18628 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18629 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18630 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18631 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18632 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18633 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18634 programs.
18635
18636 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18637 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18638 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18639 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18640 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18641 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18642 already on the target.
18643
18644 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18645 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18646 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18647
18648 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18649 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18650 Here are the available commands.
18651
18652 @table @code
18653 @item monitor help
18654 List the available monitor commands.
18655
18656 @item monitor set debug 0
18657 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18658 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18659
18660 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18661 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18662 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18663 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18664
18665 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18666 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18667 Possible options are:
18668
18669 @table @code
18670 @item none
18671 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18672 @item all
18673 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18674 @item timestamps
18675 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18676 @end table
18677
18678 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18679 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18680
18681 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18682 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18683 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18684 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18685 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18686 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18687
18688 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18689 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18690
18691 @item monitor exit
18692 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18693 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18694 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18695 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18696 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18697
18698 @end table
18699
18700 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18701 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18702
18703 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18704 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18705
18706 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18707 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18708 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18709 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18710 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18711 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18712 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18713 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18714 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18715 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18716 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18717 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18718
18719 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18720
18721 @table @code
18722 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18723
18724 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18725 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18726 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18727
18728 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18729
18730 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18731 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18732 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18733 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18734 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18735 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18736
18737 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18738
18739 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18740 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18741 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18742 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18743 command for that. For example:
18744
18745 @smallexample
18746 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18747 @end smallexample
18748
18749 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18750 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18751 @end table
18752
18753 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18754 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18755 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18756 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18757 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18758 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18759 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18760 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18761 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18762 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18763
18764 @smallexample
18765 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18766 @end smallexample
18767
18768 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18769
18770 @smallexample
18771 $ gdb myprogram
18772 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18773 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18774 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18775 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18776 @end smallexample
18777
18778 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18779 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18780 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18781 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18782 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18783 tracing.
18784
18785 @node Remote Configuration
18786 @section Remote Configuration
18787
18788 @kindex set remote
18789 @kindex show remote
18790 This section documents the configuration options available when
18791 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18792 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18793 system-call-allowed}.
18794
18795 @table @code
18796 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18797 @cindex address size for remote targets
18798 @cindex bits in remote address
18799 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18800 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18801 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18802 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18803
18804 @item show remoteaddresssize
18805 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18806
18807 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18808 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18809 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18810 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18811 remote targets.
18812
18813 @item show serial baud
18814 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18815
18816 @item set remotebreak
18817 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18818 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18819 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18820 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18821 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18822 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18823 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18824 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18825
18826 @item show remotebreak
18827 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18828 interrupt the remote program.
18829
18830 @item set remoteflow on
18831 @itemx set remoteflow off
18832 @kindex set remoteflow
18833 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18834 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18835
18836 @item show remoteflow
18837 @kindex show remoteflow
18838 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18839
18840 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18841 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18842 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18843 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
18844 @code{ascii}.
18845
18846 @item show remotelogbase
18847 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
18848 protocol.
18849
18850 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
18851 @cindex record serial communications on file
18852 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
18853 default is not to record at all.
18854
18855 @item show remotelogfile.
18856 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
18857 serial communications.
18858
18859 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
18860 @cindex timeout for serial communications
18861 @cindex remote timeout
18862 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
18863 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
18864
18865 @item show remotetimeout
18866 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
18867 responses.
18868
18869 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
18870 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
18871 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
18872 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
18873 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
18874 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
18875 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
18876 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
18877
18878 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
18879 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
18880 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
18881 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
18882 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
18883 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
18884 as unlimited.
18885
18886 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
18887 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
18888 a remote hardware watchpoint.
18889
18890 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
18891 @itemx show remote exec-file
18892 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
18893 @cindex executable file, for remote target
18894 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
18895 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
18896 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
18897 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
18898
18899 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
18900 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18901 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
18902 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
18903 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
18904 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
18905 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
18906 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
18907 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
18908 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
18909
18910 @item show interrupt-sequence
18911 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
18912 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
18913 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
18914 also known as Magic SysRq g.
18915
18916 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
18917 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
18918 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
18919 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
18920 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
18921 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
18922
18923 @item show interrupt-on-connect
18924 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
18925 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
18926
18927 @kindex set tcp
18928 @kindex show tcp
18929 @item set tcp auto-retry on
18930 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
18931 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
18932 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
18933 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
18934 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
18935 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
18936 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
18937 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
18938
18939 @item set tcp auto-retry off
18940 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
18941
18942 @item show tcp auto-retry
18943 Show the current auto-retry setting.
18944
18945 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
18946 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
18947 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
18948 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
18949 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
18950 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
18951 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
18952 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
18953 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
18954 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
18955 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
18956
18957 @item show tcp connect-timeout
18958 Show the current connection timeout setting.
18959 @end table
18960
18961 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
18962 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
18963 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
18964 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
18965 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
18966 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
18967 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
18968 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
18969 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
18970
18971 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
18972 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
18973 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
18974 @value{GDBN} developers.
18975
18976 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
18977 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
18978 are:
18979
18980 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
18981 @item Command Name
18982 @tab Remote Packet
18983 @tab Related Features
18984
18985 @item @code{fetch-register}
18986 @tab @code{p}
18987 @tab @code{info registers}
18988
18989 @item @code{set-register}
18990 @tab @code{P}
18991 @tab @code{set}
18992
18993 @item @code{binary-download}
18994 @tab @code{X}
18995 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
18996
18997 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
18998 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
18999 @tab @code{info auxv}
19000
19001 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19002 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19003 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19004
19005 @item @code{attach}
19006 @tab @code{vAttach}
19007 @tab @code{attach}
19008
19009 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19010 @tab @code{vCont}
19011 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19012
19013 @item @code{run}
19014 @tab @code{vRun}
19015 @tab @code{run}
19016
19017 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19018 @tab @code{Z0}
19019 @tab @code{break}
19020
19021 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19022 @tab @code{Z1}
19023 @tab @code{hbreak}
19024
19025 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19026 @tab @code{Z2}
19027 @tab @code{watch}
19028
19029 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19030 @tab @code{Z3}
19031 @tab @code{rwatch}
19032
19033 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19034 @tab @code{Z4}
19035 @tab @code{awatch}
19036
19037 @item @code{target-features}
19038 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19039 @tab @code{set architecture}
19040
19041 @item @code{library-info}
19042 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19043 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19044
19045 @item @code{memory-map}
19046 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19047 @tab @code{info mem}
19048
19049 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19050 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19051 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19052
19053 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19054 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19055 @tab @code{info spu}
19056
19057 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19058 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19059 @tab @code{info spu}
19060
19061 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19062 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19063 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19064
19065 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19066 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19067 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19068
19069 @item @code{threads}
19070 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19071 @tab @code{info threads}
19072
19073 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19074 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19075 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19076
19077 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19078 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19079 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19080
19081 @item @code{search-memory}
19082 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19083 @tab @code{find}
19084
19085 @item @code{supported-packets}
19086 @tab @code{qSupported}
19087 @tab Remote communications parameters
19088
19089 @item @code{pass-signals}
19090 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19091 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19092
19093 @item @code{program-signals}
19094 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19095 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19096
19097 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19098 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19099 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19100
19101 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19102 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19103 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19104
19105 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19106 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19107 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19108
19109 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19110 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19111 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19112
19113 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19114 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19115 @tab @code{remote delete}
19116
19117 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19118 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19119 @tab Host I/O
19120
19121 @item @code{noack-packet}
19122 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19123 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19124
19125 @item @code{osdata}
19126 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19127 @tab @code{info os}
19128
19129 @item @code{query-attached}
19130 @tab @code{qAttached}
19131 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19132
19133 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19134 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19135 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19136
19137 @item @code{trace-status}
19138 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19139 @tab @code{tstatus}
19140
19141 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19142 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19143 @tab Traceframe info
19144
19145 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19146 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19147 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19148
19149 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19150 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19151 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19152
19153 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19154 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19155 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19156 @end multitable
19157
19158 @node Remote Stub
19159 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19160
19161 @cindex debugging stub, example
19162 @cindex remote stub, example
19163 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19164 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19165 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19166 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19167 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19168 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19169 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19170 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19171
19172 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19173 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19174 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19175 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19176 program, you need:
19177
19178 @enumerate
19179 @item
19180 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19181 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19182 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19183
19184 @item
19185 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19186 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19187
19188 @item
19189 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19190 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19191 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19192 documentation.
19193 @end enumerate
19194
19195 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19196 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19197 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19198
19199 @table @emph
19200 @item On the host,
19201 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19202 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19203 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19204
19205 @item On the target,
19206 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19207 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19208 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19209
19210 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19211 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19212 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19213 @end table
19214
19215 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19216 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19217 @sc{sparc} boards.
19218
19219 @cindex remote serial stub list
19220 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19221
19222 @table @code
19223
19224 @item i386-stub.c
19225 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19226 @cindex Intel
19227 @cindex i386
19228 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19229
19230 @item m68k-stub.c
19231 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19232 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19233 @cindex m680x0
19234 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19235
19236 @item sh-stub.c
19237 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19238 @cindex Renesas
19239 @cindex SH
19240 For Renesas SH architectures.
19241
19242 @item sparc-stub.c
19243 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19244 @cindex Sparc
19245 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19246
19247 @item sparcl-stub.c
19248 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19249 @cindex Fujitsu
19250 @cindex SparcLite
19251 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19252
19253 @end table
19254
19255 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19256 recently added stubs.
19257
19258 @menu
19259 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19260 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19261 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19262 @end menu
19263
19264 @node Stub Contents
19265 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19266
19267 @cindex remote serial stub
19268 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19269 subroutines:
19270
19271 @table @code
19272 @item set_debug_traps
19273 @findex set_debug_traps
19274 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19275 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19276 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19277 program's startup code.
19278
19279 @item handle_exception
19280 @findex handle_exception
19281 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19282 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19283 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19284 run when a trap is triggered.
19285
19286 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19287 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19288 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19289 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19290 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19291 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19292 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19293 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19294 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19295 machine.
19296
19297 @item breakpoint
19298 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19299 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19300 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19301 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19302 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19303 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19304 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19305 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19306 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19307 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19308 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19309
19310 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19311 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19312 start of your debugging session.
19313 @end table
19314
19315 @node Bootstrapping
19316 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19317
19318 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19319 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19320 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19321 debugging target machine.
19322
19323 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19324 serial port.
19325
19326 @table @code
19327 @item int getDebugChar()
19328 @findex getDebugChar
19329 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19330 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19331 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19332
19333 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19334 @findex putDebugChar
19335 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19336 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19337 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19338 @end table
19339
19340 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19341 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19342 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19343 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19344 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19345 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19346 remote system to stop.
19347
19348 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19349 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19350 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19351 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19352
19353 Other routines you need to supply are:
19354
19355 @table @code
19356 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19357 @findex exceptionHandler
19358 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19359 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19360 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19361 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19362 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19363 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
19364 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19365 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19366 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19367 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19368 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19369 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19370 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19371
19372 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19373 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19374 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19375 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19376 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19377
19378 @item void flush_i_cache()
19379 @findex flush_i_cache
19380 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19381 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19382 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19383
19384 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19385 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19386 @end table
19387
19388 @noindent
19389 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19390
19391 @table @code
19392 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19393 @findex memset
19394 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19395 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19396 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19397 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19398 @end table
19399
19400 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19401 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19402 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19403 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19404
19405
19406 @node Debug Session
19407 @subsection Putting it All Together
19408
19409 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19410 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19411 steps.
19412
19413 @enumerate
19414 @item
19415 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19416 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19417 @display
19418 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19419 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19420 @end display
19421
19422 @item
19423 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19424 procedure is called:
19425
19426 @smallexample
19427 set_debug_traps();
19428 breakpoint();
19429 @end smallexample
19430
19431 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19432 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19433 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19434 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19435 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19436 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19437 progress.
19438
19439 @item
19440 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19441 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19442
19443 @smallexample
19444 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19445 @end smallexample
19446
19447 @noindent
19448 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19449 function in your program, that function is called when
19450 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19451 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19452 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19453
19454 @item
19455 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19456 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19457
19458 @item
19459 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19460 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19461
19462 @item
19463 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19464 @c document that. FIXME.
19465 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19466 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19467
19468 @item
19469 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19470 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19471
19472 @end enumerate
19473
19474 @node Configurations
19475 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19476
19477 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19478 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19479 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19480
19481 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19482 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19483 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19484 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19485 are quite different from each other.
19486
19487 @menu
19488 * Native::
19489 * Embedded OS::
19490 * Embedded Processors::
19491 * Architectures::
19492 @end menu
19493
19494 @node Native
19495 @section Native
19496
19497 This section describes details specific to particular native
19498 configurations.
19499
19500 @menu
19501 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19502 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19503 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19504 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19505 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19506 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19507 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19508 @end menu
19509
19510 @node HP-UX
19511 @subsection HP-UX
19512
19513 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19514 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19515 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19516
19517
19518 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19519 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19520
19521 @cindex libkvm
19522 @cindex kernel memory image
19523 @cindex kernel crash dump
19524
19525 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19526 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19527 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19528 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19529 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19530 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19531 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19532 @code{kvm} target:
19533
19534 @smallexample
19535 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19536 @end smallexample
19537
19538 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19539 argument:
19540
19541 @smallexample
19542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19543 @end smallexample
19544
19545 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19546 available:
19547
19548 @table @code
19549 @kindex kvm
19550 @item kvm pcb
19551 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19552
19553 @item kvm proc
19554 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19555 modern FreeBSD systems.
19556 @end table
19557
19558 @node SVR4 Process Information
19559 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19560 @cindex /proc
19561 @cindex examine process image
19562 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19563
19564 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19565 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19566 process using file-system subroutines.
19567
19568 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19569 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19570 information about the process running your program, or about any
19571 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19572 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19573 not HP-UX, for example.
19574
19575 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19576 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19577
19578 @table @code
19579 @kindex info proc
19580 @cindex process ID
19581 @item info proc
19582 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19583 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19584 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19585 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19586 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19587 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19588 executable file's absolute file name.
19589
19590 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19591 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19592 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19593 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19594 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19595 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19596
19597 @item info proc cmdline
19598 @cindex info proc cmdline
19599 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19600 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19601
19602 @item info proc cwd
19603 @cindex info proc cwd
19604 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19605 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19606
19607 @item info proc exe
19608 @cindex info proc exe
19609 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19610 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19611
19612 @item info proc mappings
19613 @cindex memory address space mappings
19614 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19615 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19616 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19617 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19618 memory access rights to that range.
19619
19620 @item info proc stat
19621 @itemx info proc status
19622 @cindex process detailed status information
19623 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19624 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19625 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19626 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19627 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19628 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19629 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19630
19631 @item info proc all
19632 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19633 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19634
19635 @ignore
19636 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19637 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19638 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19639 @kindex info proc times
19640 @item info proc times
19641 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19642 its children.
19643
19644 @kindex info proc id
19645 @item info proc id
19646 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19647 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19648 @end ignore
19649
19650 @item set procfs-trace
19651 @kindex set procfs-trace
19652 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19653 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19654
19655 @item show procfs-trace
19656 @kindex show procfs-trace
19657 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19658
19659 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19660 @kindex set procfs-file
19661 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19662 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19663 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19664 standard output.
19665
19666 @item show procfs-file
19667 @kindex show procfs-file
19668 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19669
19670 @item proc-trace-entry
19671 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19672 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19673 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19674 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19675 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19676 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19677 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19678 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19679 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19680
19681 @item info pidlist
19682 @kindex info pidlist
19683 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19684 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19685 processes and all the threads within each process.
19686
19687 @item info meminfo
19688 @kindex info meminfo
19689 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19690 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19691 @end table
19692
19693 @node DJGPP Native
19694 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19695 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19696 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19697 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19698
19699 @cindex DPMI
19700 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19701 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19702 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19703 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19704
19705 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19706 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19707 subsection describes those commands.
19708
19709 @table @code
19710 @kindex info dos
19711 @item info dos
19712 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19713 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19714
19715 @kindex sysinfo
19716 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19717 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19718 @item info dos sysinfo
19719 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19720 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19721 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19722
19723 @cindex GDT
19724 @cindex LDT
19725 @cindex IDT
19726 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19727 @cindex descriptor tables display
19728 @item info dos gdt
19729 @itemx info dos ldt
19730 @itemx info dos idt
19731 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19732 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19733 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19734 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19735 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19736 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19737 rights.
19738
19739 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19740 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19741 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19742 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19743 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19744
19745 @cindex garbled pointers
19746 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19747 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19748 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19749 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19750 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19751 debugged program's data segment:
19752
19753 @smallexample
19754 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19755 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19756 @end smallexample
19757
19758 @noindent
19759 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19760 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19761
19762 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19763 @item info dos pde
19764 @itemx info dos pte
19765 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19766 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19767 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19768 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19769 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19770 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19771 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19772 that is currently in use.
19773
19774 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19775 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19776 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19777 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19778 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19779 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19780 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19781
19782 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19783 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19784 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19785 controller.
19786
19787 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19788
19789 @cindex physical address from linear address
19790 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19791 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19792 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19793 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19794 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19795 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19796 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19797
19798 @smallexample
19799 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19800 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19801 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19802 @end smallexample
19803
19804 @noindent
19805 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19806 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19807 attributes of that page.
19808
19809 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19810 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19811 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19812 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19813 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19814 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19815
19816 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19817 transfer buffer:
19818
19819 @smallexample
19820 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19821 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19822 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19823 @end smallexample
19824
19825 @noindent
19826 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19827 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19828 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19829 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19830 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19831
19832 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19833 @end table
19834
19835 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19836 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19837 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19838 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19839
19840 @table @code
19841 @kindex set com1base
19842 @kindex set com1irq
19843 @kindex set com2base
19844 @kindex set com2irq
19845 @kindex set com3base
19846 @kindex set com3irq
19847 @kindex set com4base
19848 @kindex set com4irq
19849 @item set com1base @var{addr}
19850 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
19851 port.
19852
19853 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
19854 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
19855 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
19856
19857 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
19858 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
19859 other 3 COM ports.
19860
19861 @kindex show com1base
19862 @kindex show com1irq
19863 @kindex show com2base
19864 @kindex show com2irq
19865 @kindex show com3base
19866 @kindex show com3irq
19867 @kindex show com4base
19868 @kindex show com4irq
19869 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
19870 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
19871 lines used by the COM ports.
19872
19873 @item info serial
19874 @kindex info serial
19875 @cindex DOS serial port status
19876 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
19877 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
19878 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
19879 counts of various errors encountered so far.
19880 @end table
19881
19882
19883 @node Cygwin Native
19884 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
19885 @cindex MS Windows debugging
19886 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
19887 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
19888
19889 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
19890 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
19891
19892 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
19893 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
19894 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
19895 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
19896 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
19897 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
19898 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
19899 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
19900
19901 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
19902 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
19903 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
19904
19905 @table @code
19906 @kindex info w32
19907 @item info w32
19908 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
19909 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19910
19911 @item info w32 selector
19912 This command displays information returned by
19913 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
19914 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
19915 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
19916 Without argument, this command displays information
19917 about the six segment registers.
19918
19919 @item info w32 thread-information-block
19920 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
19921 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
19922 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
19923
19924 @kindex info dll
19925 @item info dll
19926 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
19927
19928 @kindex dll-symbols
19929 @item dll-symbols
19930 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
19931 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
19932
19933 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
19934 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
19935
19936 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
19937 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
19938 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
19939 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
19940 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
19941 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
19942 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
19943 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
19944 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
19945 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
19946 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
19947
19948 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
19949 @item show cygwin-exceptions
19950 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
19951 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
19952
19953 @kindex set new-console
19954 @item set new-console @var{mode}
19955 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
19956 be started in a new console on next start.
19957 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
19958 be started in the same console as the debugger.
19959
19960 @kindex show new-console
19961 @item show new-console
19962 Displays whether a new console is used
19963 when the debuggee is started.
19964
19965 @kindex set new-group
19966 @item set new-group @var{mode}
19967 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
19968 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
19969 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
19970 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
19971
19972 @kindex show new-group
19973 @item show new-group
19974 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
19975
19976 @kindex set debugevents
19977 @item set debugevents
19978 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
19979 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
19980 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
19981 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
19982 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
19983
19984 @kindex set debugexec
19985 @item set debugexec
19986 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
19987 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
19988
19989 @kindex set debugexceptions
19990 @item set debugexceptions
19991 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
19992 debuggee seen by the debugger.
19993
19994 @kindex set debugmemory
19995 @item set debugmemory
19996 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
19997 and writes by the debugger.
19998
19999 @kindex set shell
20000 @item set shell
20001 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20002 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20003
20004 @kindex show shell
20005 @item show shell
20006 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20007
20008 @end table
20009
20010 @menu
20011 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20012 @end menu
20013
20014 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20015 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20016 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20017 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20018
20019 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20020 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20021 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20022 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20023 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20024 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20025 ``minimal symbols''.
20026
20027 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20028 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20029 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20030 program run once to completion.
20031
20032 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20033
20034 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20035 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20036 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20037 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20038 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20039 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20040 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20041 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20042 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20043
20044 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20045 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20046 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20047 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20048 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20049 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20050
20051 @smallexample
20052 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20053 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20054
20055 Non-debugging symbols:
20056 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20057 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20058 @end smallexample
20059
20060 @smallexample
20061 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20062 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20063
20064 Non-debugging symbols:
20065 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20066 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20067 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20068 [etc...]
20069 @end smallexample
20070
20071 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20072
20073 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20074 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20075 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20076 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20077 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20078 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20079 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20080
20081 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20082 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20083 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20084 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20085 problem:
20086
20087 @smallexample
20088 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20089 $1 = 268572168
20090 @end smallexample
20091
20092 @smallexample
20093 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20094 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20095 @end smallexample
20096
20097 And two possible solutions:
20098
20099 @smallexample
20100 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20101 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20102 @end smallexample
20103
20104 @smallexample
20105 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20106 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20107 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20108 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20109 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20110 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20111 @end smallexample
20112
20113 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20114 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20115 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20116 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20117 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20118
20119 @smallexample
20120 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20121 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20122 @end smallexample
20123
20124 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20125 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20126 safe.
20127
20128 @node Hurd Native
20129 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20130 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20131
20132 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20133 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20134
20135 @table @code
20136 @item set signals
20137 @itemx set sigs
20138 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20139 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20140 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20141 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20142 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20143 @code{signals}.
20144
20145 @item show signals
20146 @itemx show sigs
20147 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20148 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20149 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20150
20151 @item set signal-thread
20152 @itemx set sigthread
20153 @kindex set signal-thread
20154 @kindex set sigthread
20155 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20156 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20157 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20158 signal-thread}.
20159
20160 @item show signal-thread
20161 @itemx show sigthread
20162 @kindex show signal-thread
20163 @kindex show sigthread
20164 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20165 delivered a signal.
20166
20167 @item set stopped
20168 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20169 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20170 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20171 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20172
20173 @item show stopped
20174 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20175 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20176 stopped.
20177
20178 @item set exceptions
20179 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20180 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20181 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20182 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20183 trapping on.
20184
20185 @item show exceptions
20186 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20187 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20188
20189 @item set task pause
20190 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20191 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20192 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20193 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20194 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20195 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20196 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20197 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20198 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20199
20200 @item show task pause
20201 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20202 Show the current state of task suspension.
20203
20204 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20205 @cindex task suspend count
20206 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20207 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20208 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20209
20210 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20211 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20212
20213 @item set task exception-port
20214 @itemx set task excp
20215 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20216 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20217 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20218 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20219
20220 @item set noninvasive
20221 @cindex noninvasive task options
20222 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20223 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20224 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20225 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20226
20227 @item info send-rights
20228 @itemx info receive-rights
20229 @itemx info port-rights
20230 @itemx info port-sets
20231 @itemx info dead-names
20232 @itemx info ports
20233 @itemx info psets
20234 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20235 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20236 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20237 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20238 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20239 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20240 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20241 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20242 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20243
20244 @item set thread pause
20245 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20246 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20247 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20248 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20249 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20250 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20251 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20252 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20253 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20254 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20255 only the current thread.
20256
20257 @item show thread pause
20258 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20259 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20260
20261 @item set thread run
20262 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20263
20264 @item show thread run
20265 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20266
20267 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20268 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20269 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20270 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20271 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20272 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20273 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20274
20275 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20276 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20277 detaching.
20278
20279 @item set thread exception-port
20280 @itemx set thread excp
20281 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20282 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20283 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20284
20285 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20286 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20287 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20288 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20289
20290 @item set thread default
20291 @itemx show thread default
20292 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20293 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20294 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20295 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20296 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20297 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20298 the non-default commands.
20299 @end table
20300
20301 @node Darwin
20302 @subsection Darwin
20303 @cindex Darwin
20304
20305 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20306
20307 @table @code
20308 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20309 @kindex set debug darwin
20310 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20311 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20312
20313 @item show debug darwin
20314 @kindex show debug darwin
20315 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20316
20317 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20318 @kindex set debug mach-o
20319 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20320 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20321 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20322 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20323 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20324 usage.
20325
20326 @item show debug mach-o
20327 @kindex show debug mach-o
20328 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20329
20330 @item set mach-exceptions on
20331 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20332 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20333 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20334 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20335 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20336 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20337
20338 @item show mach-exceptions
20339 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20340 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20341 @end table
20342
20343
20344 @node Embedded OS
20345 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20346
20347 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20348 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20349 architectures.
20350
20351 @menu
20352 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20353 @end menu
20354
20355 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20356 various real-time operating systems.
20357
20358 @node VxWorks
20359 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20360
20361 @cindex VxWorks
20362
20363 @table @code
20364
20365 @kindex target vxworks
20366 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
20367 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
20368 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
20369
20370 @end table
20371
20372 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
20373 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
20374
20375 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
20376 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
20377 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20378 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
20379 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
20380 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
20381 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
20382
20383 @table @code
20384 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
20385 @kindex vxworks-timeout
20386 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
20387 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20388 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
20389 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
20390 of a thin network line.
20391 @end table
20392
20393 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
20394 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
20395 procedures.
20396
20397 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
20398 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
20399 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
20400 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
20401 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
20402 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
20403 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
20404 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
20405 manual.
20406 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
20407
20408 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
20409 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20410 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
20411 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
20412
20413 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20414
20415 @smallexample
20416 (vxgdb)
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 @menu
20420 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
20421 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
20422 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
20423 @end menu
20424
20425 @node VxWorks Connection
20426 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
20427
20428 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
20429 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
20430
20431 @smallexample
20432 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
20433 @end smallexample
20434
20435 @need 750
20436 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20437
20438 @smallexample
20439 Attaching remote machine across net...
20440 Connected to tt.
20441 @end smallexample
20442
20443 @need 1000
20444 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
20445 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
20446 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
20447 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
20448 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
20449
20450 @smallexample
20451 prog.o: No such file or directory.
20452 @end smallexample
20453
20454 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
20455 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
20456 command again.
20457
20458 @node VxWorks Download
20459 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
20460
20461 @cindex download to VxWorks
20462 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
20463 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
20464 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
20465 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
20466 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
20467 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
20468 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
20469 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
20470 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
20471 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
20472 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
20473 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
20474 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
20475 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
20476 program, type this on VxWorks:
20477
20478 @smallexample
20479 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
20480 @end smallexample
20481
20482 @noindent
20483 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20484
20485 @smallexample
20486 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
20487 (vxgdb) load prog.o
20488 @end smallexample
20489
20490 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
20491
20492 @smallexample
20493 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
20494 @end smallexample
20495
20496 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
20497 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
20498 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
20499 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
20500 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
20501 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
20502 table.)
20503
20504 @node VxWorks Attach
20505 @subsubsection Running Tasks
20506
20507 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
20508 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
20509 follows:
20510
20511 @smallexample
20512 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
20513 @end smallexample
20514
20515 @noindent
20516 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
20517 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
20518 the time of attachment.
20519
20520 @node Embedded Processors
20521 @section Embedded Processors
20522
20523 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20524 configurations.
20525
20526 @cindex send command to simulator
20527 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20528 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20529
20530 @table @code
20531 @item sim @var{command}
20532 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20533 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20534 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20535 acceptable commands.
20536 @end table
20537
20538
20539 @menu
20540 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20541 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20542 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20543 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20544 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20545 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20546 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20547 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20548 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20549 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20550 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20551 * CRIS:: CRIS
20552 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20553 @end menu
20554
20555 @node ARM
20556 @subsection ARM
20557 @cindex ARM RDI
20558
20559 @table @code
20560 @kindex target rdi
20561 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20562 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20563 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20564 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20565
20566 @kindex target rdp
20567 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20568 ARM Demon monitor.
20569
20570 @end table
20571
20572 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20573
20574 @table @code
20575 @item set arm disassembler
20576 @kindex set arm
20577 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20578 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20579
20580 @item show arm disassembler
20581 @kindex show arm
20582 Show the current disassembly style.
20583
20584 @item set arm apcs32
20585 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20586 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20587
20588 @item show arm apcs32
20589 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20590
20591 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20592 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20593 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20594
20595 @table @code
20596 @item auto
20597 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20598 @item softfpa
20599 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20600 processors.
20601 @item fpa
20602 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20603 @item softvfp
20604 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20605 @item vfp
20606 VFP co-processor.
20607 @end table
20608
20609 @item show arm fpu
20610 Show the current type of the FPU.
20611
20612 @item set arm abi
20613 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20614
20615 @item show arm abi
20616 Show the currently used ABI.
20617
20618 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20619 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20620 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20621 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20622 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20623 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20624 register).
20625
20626 @item show arm fallback-mode
20627 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20628
20629 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20630 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20631 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20632 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20633 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20634
20635 @item show arm force-mode
20636 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20637
20638 @item set debug arm
20639 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20640 target support subsystem.
20641
20642 @item show debug arm
20643 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20644 @end table
20645
20646 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20647 using the RDI interface:
20648
20649 @table @code
20650 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20651 @kindex rdilogfile
20652 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20653 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20654 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20655 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20656 @file{rdi.log}.
20657
20658 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20659 @kindex rdilogenable
20660 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20661 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20662 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20663 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20664 are logged to a file.
20665
20666 @item set rdiromatzero
20667 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20668 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20669 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20670 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20671 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20672 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20673
20674 @item show rdiromatzero
20675 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20676 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20677
20678 @item set rdiheartbeat
20679 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20680 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20681 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20682 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20683 well as the Angel monitor.
20684
20685 @item show rdiheartbeat
20686 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20687 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20688 @end table
20689
20690 @table @code
20691 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20692 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20693
20694 @table @code
20695 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20696 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
20697 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20698 The default value is @code{all}.
20699
20700 @table @code
20701 @item none
20702 @item demon
20703 @item angel
20704 @item redboot
20705 @item all
20706 @end table
20707 @end table
20708 @end table
20709
20710 @node M32R/D
20711 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20712
20713 @table @code
20714 @kindex target m32r
20715 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20716 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20717
20718 @kindex target m32rsdi
20719 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20720 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20721 @end table
20722
20723 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20724
20725 @table @code
20726 @item set download-path @var{path}
20727 @kindex set download-path
20728 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20729 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20730
20731 @item show download-path
20732 @kindex show download-path
20733 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20734
20735 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20736 @kindex set board-address
20737 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20738 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20739
20740 @item show board-address
20741 @kindex show board-address
20742 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20743
20744 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20745 @kindex set server-address
20746 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20747 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20748 host machine.
20749
20750 @item show server-address
20751 @kindex show server-address
20752 Display the IP address of the download server.
20753
20754 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20755 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20756 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20757 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20758 executable file is uploaded.
20759
20760 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20761 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20762 Test the @code{upload} command.
20763 @end table
20764
20765 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20766
20767 @table @code
20768 @item sdireset
20769 @kindex sdireset
20770 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20771 This command resets the SDI connection.
20772
20773 @item sdistatus
20774 @kindex sdistatus
20775 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20776
20777 @item debug_chaos
20778 @kindex debug_chaos
20779 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20780 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20781
20782 @item use_debug_dma
20783 @kindex use_debug_dma
20784 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20785
20786 @item use_mon_code
20787 @kindex use_mon_code
20788 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20789
20790 @item use_ib_break
20791 @kindex use_ib_break
20792 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20793
20794 @item use_dbt_break
20795 @kindex use_dbt_break
20796 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20797 @end table
20798
20799 @node M68K
20800 @subsection M68k
20801
20802 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20803 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20804
20805 @table @code
20806
20807 @kindex target dbug
20808 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20809 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20810
20811 @end table
20812
20813 @node MicroBlaze
20814 @subsection MicroBlaze
20815 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20816 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20817
20818 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20819 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20820 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20821 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20822 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20823 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20824 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20825 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20826 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20827 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20828 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20829
20830 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20831
20832 @table @code
20833 @item target remote :1234
20834 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20835 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20836
20837 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20838 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20839 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20840
20841 @item load
20842 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20843
20844 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20845 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20846
20847 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20848 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20849 @end table
20850
20851 @node MIPS Embedded
20852 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20853
20854 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20855 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20856 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20857 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20858
20859 @need 1000
20860 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20861
20862 @table @code
20863 @item target mips @var{port}
20864 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20865 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20866 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20867 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20868 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20869 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20870 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20871
20872 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20873 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20874 debugger:
20875
20876 @smallexample
20877 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20878 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20879 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20880 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20881 (@value{GDBP}) run
20882 @end smallexample
20883
20884 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20885 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20886 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20887 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20888 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20889
20890 @item target pmon @var{port}
20891 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20892 PMON ROM monitor.
20893
20894 @item target ddb @var{port}
20895 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20896 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20897
20898 @item target lsi @var{port}
20899 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20900 LSI variant of PMON.
20901
20902 @kindex target r3900
20903 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20904 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20905
20906 @kindex target array
20907 @item target array @var{dev}
20908 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20909
20910 @end table
20911
20912
20913 @noindent
20914 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20915
20916 @table @code
20917 @item set mipsfpu double
20918 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20919 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20920 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20921 @itemx show mipsfpu
20922 @kindex set mipsfpu
20923 @kindex show mipsfpu
20924 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20925 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20926 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20927 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20928 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20929 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20930 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20931 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20932 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20933 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20934 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20935 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20936 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20937
20938 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20939 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20940 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20941
20942 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20943 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20944
20945 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
20946 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
20947 @itemx show timeout
20948 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
20949 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20950 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20951 @kindex set timeout
20952 @kindex show timeout
20953 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
20954 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
20955 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
20956 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
20957 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
20958 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
20959 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
20960 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
20961 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
20962 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
20963
20964 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
20965 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
20966 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
20967 to run before stopping.
20968
20969 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
20970 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20971 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
20972 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
20973 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
20974 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
20975
20976 @item show syn-garbage-limit
20977 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20978 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
20979 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
20980
20981 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
20982 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20983 @cindex remote monitor prompt
20984 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
20985 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
20986 @table @asis
20987 @item pmon target
20988 @samp{PMON}
20989 @item ddb target
20990 @samp{NEC010}
20991 @item lsi target
20992 @samp{PMON>}
20993 @end table
20994
20995 @item show monitor-prompt
20996 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20997 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
20998 remote monitor.
20999
21000 @item set monitor-warnings
21001 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21002 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21003 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21004 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21005 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21006
21007 @item show monitor-warnings
21008 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21009 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21010
21011 @item pmon @var{command}
21012 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21013 @cindex send PMON command
21014 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21015 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21016 @end table
21017
21018 @node PowerPC Embedded
21019 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21020
21021 @cindex DVC register
21022 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21023 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21024
21025 @smallexample
21026 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21027 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21028 @end smallexample
21029
21030 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21031 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21032 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21033 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21034 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21035 or newer.
21036
21037 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21038 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21039 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21040 watching variables of scalar types.
21041
21042 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21043 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21044
21045 @smallexample
21046 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21047 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21048 @end smallexample
21049
21050 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21051 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21052
21053 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21054 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21055 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21056 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21057 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21058 use the @code{break-range} command.
21059
21060 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21061
21062 @table @code
21063 @kindex break-range
21064 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21065 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
21066 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
21067 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21068 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21069 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21070 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21071 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21072 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21073
21074 @kindex set powerpc
21075 @item set powerpc soft-float
21076 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21077 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21078 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21079 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21080
21081 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21082 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21083 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21084 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21085 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21086 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21087 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21088 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21089
21090 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21091 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21092 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21093 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21094 address of its first byte.
21095
21096 @kindex target dink32
21097 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21098 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21099
21100 @kindex target ppcbug
21101 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21102 @kindex target ppcbug1
21103 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21104 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21105
21106 @kindex target sds
21107 @item target sds @var{dev}
21108 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21109 @end table
21110
21111 @cindex SDS protocol
21112 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21113 by @value{GDBN}:
21114
21115 @table @code
21116 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21117 @kindex set sdstimeout
21118 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21119 default is 2 seconds.
21120
21121 @item show sdstimeout
21122 @kindex show sdstimeout
21123 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21124
21125 @item sds @var{command}
21126 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21127 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21128 @end table
21129
21130
21131 @node PA
21132 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21133
21134 @table @code
21135
21136 @kindex target op50n
21137 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21138 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21139
21140 @kindex target w89k
21141 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21142 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21143
21144 @end table
21145
21146 @node Sparclet
21147 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21148
21149 @cindex Sparclet
21150
21151 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21152 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21153 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21154 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21155 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21156
21157 @table @code
21158 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21159 @kindex remotetimeout
21160 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21161 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21162 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21163 @end table
21164
21165 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21166 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21167 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21168 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21169 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21170
21171 @smallexample
21172 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21173 @end smallexample
21174
21175 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21176
21177 @smallexample
21178 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21179 @end smallexample
21180
21181 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21182 Once you have set
21183 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21184 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21185 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21186
21187 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21188
21189 @smallexample
21190 (gdbslet)
21191 @end smallexample
21192
21193 @menu
21194 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21195 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21196 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21197 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21198 @end menu
21199
21200 @node Sparclet File
21201 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21202
21203 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21204
21205 @smallexample
21206 (gdbslet) file prog
21207 @end smallexample
21208
21209 @need 1000
21210 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21211 @value{GDBN} locates
21212 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21213 path.
21214 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21215 files will be searched as well.
21216 @value{GDBN} locates
21217 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21218 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21219 If it fails
21220 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21221
21222 @smallexample
21223 prog: No such file or directory.
21224 @end smallexample
21225
21226 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21227 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21228 @code{target} command again.
21229
21230 @node Sparclet Connection
21231 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21232
21233 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21234 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21235
21236 @smallexample
21237 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21238 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21239 main () at ../prog.c:3
21240 @end smallexample
21241
21242 @need 750
21243 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21244
21245 @smallexample
21246 Connected to ttya.
21247 @end smallexample
21248
21249 @node Sparclet Download
21250 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21251
21252 @cindex download to Sparclet
21253 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21254 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21255 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21256 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21257 command.
21258 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21259 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21260 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21261 of each of the file's sections.
21262 For instance, if the program
21263 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21264 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21265
21266 @smallexample
21267 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21268 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21269 @end smallexample
21270
21271 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21272 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21273 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21274
21275 @node Sparclet Execution
21276 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21277
21278 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21279 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21280 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21281 manual for the list of commands.
21282
21283 @smallexample
21284 (gdbslet) b main
21285 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21286 (gdbslet) run
21287 Starting program: prog
21288 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21289 3 char *symarg = 0;
21290 (gdbslet) step
21291 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21292 (gdbslet)
21293 @end smallexample
21294
21295 @node Sparclite
21296 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21297
21298 @table @code
21299
21300 @kindex target sparclite
21301 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21302 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21303 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21304 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21305 remote protocol.
21306
21307 @end table
21308
21309 @node Z8000
21310 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21311
21312 @cindex Z8000
21313 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21314 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21315
21316 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21317 a Z8000 simulator.
21318
21319 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21320 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21321 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21322 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21323
21324 @table @code
21325 @item target sim @var{args}
21326 @kindex sim
21327 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21328 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21329 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21330 @end table
21331
21332 @noindent
21333 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21334 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21335 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21336 to run your program, and so on.
21337
21338 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21339 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21340 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21341
21342 @table @code
21343
21344 @item cycles
21345 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21346
21347 @item insts
21348 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21349
21350 @item time
21351 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21352
21353 @end table
21354
21355 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21356 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21357 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21358 simulated clock ticks.
21359
21360 @node AVR
21361 @subsection Atmel AVR
21362 @cindex AVR
21363
21364 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21365 following AVR-specific commands:
21366
21367 @table @code
21368 @item info io_registers
21369 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21370 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21371 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21372 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21373 @end table
21374
21375 @node CRIS
21376 @subsection CRIS
21377 @cindex CRIS
21378
21379 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21380 following CRIS-specific commands:
21381
21382 @table @code
21383 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21384 @cindex CRIS version
21385 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21386 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21387 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21388
21389 @item show cris-version
21390 Show the current CRIS version.
21391
21392 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21393 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21394 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21395 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21396 @code{R59}.
21397
21398 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21399 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21400
21401 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21402 @cindex CRIS mode
21403 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21404 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21405 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21406
21407 @item show cris-mode
21408 Show the current CRIS mode.
21409 @end table
21410
21411 @node Super-H
21412 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21413 @cindex Super-H
21414
21415 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21416 commands:
21417
21418 @table @code
21419 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21420 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21421 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21422 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21423 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21424 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21425 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21426 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21427 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21428 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21429 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21430 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21431
21432 @item show sh calling-convention
21433 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21434 Show the current calling convention setting.
21435
21436 @end table
21437
21438
21439 @node Architectures
21440 @section Architectures
21441
21442 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21443 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21444
21445 @menu
21446 * AArch64::
21447 * i386::
21448 * Alpha::
21449 * MIPS::
21450 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21451 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21452 * PowerPC::
21453 * Nios II::
21454 @end menu
21455
21456 @node AArch64
21457 @subsection AArch64
21458 @cindex AArch64 support
21459
21460 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21461 following special commands:
21462
21463 @table @code
21464 @item set debug aarch64
21465 @kindex set debug aarch64
21466 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21467 messages are to be displayed.
21468
21469 @item show debug aarch64
21470 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21471
21472 @end table
21473
21474 @node i386
21475 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21476
21477 @table @code
21478 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21479 @kindex set struct-convention
21480 @cindex struct return convention
21481 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21482 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21483 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21484 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21485 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21486 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21487 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21488 be returned in a register.
21489
21490 @item show struct-convention
21491 @kindex show struct-convention
21492 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21493 from functions.
21494 @end table
21495
21496 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21497 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21498
21499 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21500 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21501 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21502 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21503 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21504 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21505 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21506
21507 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21508 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21509 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21510 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21511 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21512 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21513
21514 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21515 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21516 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21517
21518 @smallexample
21519 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21520 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21521 @end smallexample
21522
21523 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21524 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21525 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21526 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21527 the pointer.
21528
21529 @node Alpha
21530 @subsection Alpha
21531
21532 See the following section.
21533
21534 @node MIPS
21535 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21536
21537 @cindex stack on Alpha
21538 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21539 @cindex Alpha stack
21540 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21541 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21542 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21543 find the beginning of a function.
21544
21545 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21546 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21547 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21548 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21549 commands:
21550
21551 @table @code
21552 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21553 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21554 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21555 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21556 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21557 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21558 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21559 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21560
21561 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21562 Display the current limit.
21563 @end table
21564
21565 @noindent
21566 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21567 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21568
21569 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21570 programs:
21571
21572 @table @code
21573 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21574 @kindex set mips abi
21575 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21576 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21577 values of @var{arg} are:
21578
21579 @table @samp
21580 @item auto
21581 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21582 default).
21583 @item o32
21584 @item o64
21585 @item n32
21586 @item n64
21587 @item eabi32
21588 @item eabi64
21589 @end table
21590
21591 @item show mips abi
21592 @kindex show mips abi
21593 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21594
21595 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21596 @kindex set mips compression
21597 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21598 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21599 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21600 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21601 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21602 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21603 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21604 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21605 provided by the executable.
21606
21607 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21608 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21609 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21610 identified as such.
21611
21612 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21613 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21614 implicitly from an executable.
21615
21616 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21617 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21618 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21619 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21620 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21621
21622 @item show mips compression
21623 @kindex show mips compression
21624 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21625 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21626
21627 @item set mipsfpu
21628 @itemx show mipsfpu
21629 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21630
21631 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21632 @kindex set mips mask-address
21633 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21634 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21635 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21636 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21637 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21638
21639 @item show mips mask-address
21640 @kindex show mips mask-address
21641 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21642 not.
21643
21644 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21645 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21646 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21647 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21648 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21649 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21650
21651 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21652 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21653 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21654
21655 @item set debug mips
21656 @kindex set debug mips
21657 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21658 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21659
21660 @item show debug mips
21661 @kindex show debug mips
21662 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21663 @end table
21664
21665
21666 @node HPPA
21667 @subsection HPPA
21668 @cindex HPPA support
21669
21670 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21671 following special commands:
21672
21673 @table @code
21674 @item set debug hppa
21675 @kindex set debug hppa
21676 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21677 messages are to be displayed.
21678
21679 @item show debug hppa
21680 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21681
21682 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21683 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21684 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21685 given @var{address}.
21686
21687 @end table
21688
21689
21690 @node SPU
21691 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21692 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21693 @cindex SPU
21694
21695 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21696 it provides the following special commands:
21697
21698 @table @code
21699 @item info spu event
21700 @kindex info spu
21701 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21702 and pending event status.
21703
21704 @item info spu signal
21705 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21706 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21707 notification channels.
21708
21709 @item info spu mailbox
21710 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21711 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21712 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21713
21714 @item info spu dma
21715 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21716 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21717 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21718
21719 @item info spu proxydma
21720 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21721 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21722 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21723
21724 @end table
21725
21726 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21727 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21728 special commands:
21729
21730 @table @code
21731 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21732 @kindex set spu
21733 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21734 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21735 function. The default is @code{off}.
21736
21737 @item show spu stop-on-load
21738 @kindex show spu
21739 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21740
21741 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21742 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21743 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21744 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21745 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21746 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21747
21748 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21749 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21750
21751 @end table
21752
21753 @node PowerPC
21754 @subsection PowerPC
21755 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21756
21757 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21758 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21759 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21760 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21761 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21762
21763 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21764 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21765 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21766
21767 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21768 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21769
21770 @node Nios II
21771 @subsection Nios II
21772 @cindex Nios II architecture
21773
21774 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21775 it provides the following special commands:
21776
21777 @table @code
21778
21779 @item set debug nios2
21780 @kindex set debug nios2
21781 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21782 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21783
21784 @item show debug nios2
21785 @kindex show debug nios2
21786 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21787 @end table
21788
21789 @node Controlling GDB
21790 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21791
21792 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21793 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21794 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21795 described here.
21796
21797 @menu
21798 * Prompt:: Prompt
21799 * Editing:: Command editing
21800 * Command History:: Command history
21801 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21802 * Numbers:: Numbers
21803 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21804 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21805 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21806 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21807 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21808 @end menu
21809
21810 @node Prompt
21811 @section Prompt
21812
21813 @cindex prompt
21814
21815 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21816 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21817 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21818 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21819 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21820 which one you are talking to.
21821
21822 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21823 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21824 or a prompt that does not.
21825
21826 @table @code
21827 @kindex set prompt
21828 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21829 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21830
21831 @kindex show prompt
21832 @item show prompt
21833 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21834 @end table
21835
21836 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21837 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21838 are:
21839
21840 @table @code
21841 @kindex set extended-prompt
21842 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21843 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21844 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21845 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21846 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21847 is displayed.
21848
21849 For example:
21850
21851 @smallexample
21852 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21853 @end smallexample
21854
21855 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21856 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21857
21858 @kindex show extended-prompt
21859 @item show extended-prompt
21860 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21861 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21862 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21863 @end table
21864
21865 @node Editing
21866 @section Command Editing
21867 @cindex readline
21868 @cindex command line editing
21869
21870 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21871 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21872 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21873 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21874 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21875 debugging sessions.
21876
21877 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21878 command @code{set}.
21879
21880 @table @code
21881 @kindex set editing
21882 @cindex editing
21883 @item set editing
21884 @itemx set editing on
21885 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21886
21887 @item set editing off
21888 Disable command line editing.
21889
21890 @kindex show editing
21891 @item show editing
21892 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21893 @end table
21894
21895 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21896 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21897 @end ifset
21898 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21899 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21900 @end ifclear
21901 for more details about the Readline
21902 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21903 encouraged to read that chapter.
21904
21905 @node Command History
21906 @section Command History
21907 @cindex command history
21908
21909 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21910 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21911 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21912 history facility.
21913
21914 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21915 package, to provide the history facility.
21916 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21917 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21918 @end ifset
21919 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21920 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21921 @end ifclear
21922 for the detailed description of the History library.
21923
21924 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21925 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21926 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21927 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21928 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21929 pressed on a line by itself.
21930
21931 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21932 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21933 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21934 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21935
21936 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21937 history.
21938
21939 @table @code
21940 @cindex history substitution
21941 @cindex history file
21942 @kindex set history filename
21943 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21944 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21945 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
21946 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
21947 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
21948 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
21949 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
21950 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
21951 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21952 is not set.
21953
21954 @cindex save command history
21955 @kindex set history save
21956 @item set history save
21957 @itemx set history save on
21958 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21959 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21960
21961 @item set history save off
21962 Stop recording command history in a file.
21963
21964 @cindex history size
21965 @kindex set history size
21966 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21967 @item set history size @var{size}
21968 @itemx set history size unlimited
21969 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21970 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21971 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
21972 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
21973 history list is unlimited.
21974 @end table
21975
21976 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21977 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21978 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21979 @end ifset
21980 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21981 @xref{Event Designators},
21982 @end ifclear
21983 for more details.
21984
21985 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21986 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21987 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21988 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21989 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21990 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21991 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21992 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21993
21994 The commands to control history expansion are:
21995
21996 @table @code
21997 @item set history expansion on
21998 @itemx set history expansion
21999 @kindex set history expansion
22000 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22001
22002 @item set history expansion off
22003 Disable history expansion.
22004
22005 @c @group
22006 @kindex show history
22007 @item show history
22008 @itemx show history filename
22009 @itemx show history save
22010 @itemx show history size
22011 @itemx show history expansion
22012 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22013 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22014 @c @end group
22015 @end table
22016
22017 @table @code
22018 @kindex show commands
22019 @cindex show last commands
22020 @cindex display command history
22021 @item show commands
22022 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22023
22024 @item show commands @var{n}
22025 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22026
22027 @item show commands +
22028 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22029 @end table
22030
22031 @node Screen Size
22032 @section Screen Size
22033 @cindex size of screen
22034 @cindex pauses in output
22035
22036 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22037 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22038 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22039 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22040 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22041 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22042 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22043 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22044
22045 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22046 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22047 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22048 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22049 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22050 width} commands:
22051
22052 @table @code
22053 @kindex set height
22054 @kindex set width
22055 @kindex show width
22056 @kindex show height
22057 @item set height @var{lpp}
22058 @itemx set height unlimited
22059 @itemx show height
22060 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22061 @itemx set width unlimited
22062 @itemx show width
22063 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22064 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22065 commands display the current settings.
22066
22067 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22068 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22069 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22070 buffer.
22071
22072 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22073 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22074
22075 @item set pagination on
22076 @itemx set pagination off
22077 @kindex set pagination
22078 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22079 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22080 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22081 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22082
22083 @item show pagination
22084 @kindex show pagination
22085 Show the current pagination mode.
22086 @end table
22087
22088 @node Numbers
22089 @section Numbers
22090 @cindex number representation
22091 @cindex entering numbers
22092
22093 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22094 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22095 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22096 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22097 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22098 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22099 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22100 both input and output with the commands described below.
22101
22102 @table @code
22103 @kindex set input-radix
22104 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22105 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22106 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22107 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22108 example, any of
22109
22110 @smallexample
22111 set input-radix 012
22112 set input-radix 10.
22113 set input-radix 0xa
22114 @end smallexample
22115
22116 @noindent
22117 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22118 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22119 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22120 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22121 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22122 change the radix.
22123
22124 @kindex set output-radix
22125 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22126 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22127 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22128 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22129
22130 @kindex show input-radix
22131 @item show input-radix
22132 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22133
22134 @kindex show output-radix
22135 @item show output-radix
22136 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22137
22138 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22139 @itemx show radix
22140 @kindex set radix
22141 @kindex show radix
22142 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22143 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22144 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22145 default value of 10.
22146
22147 @end table
22148
22149 @node ABI
22150 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22151
22152 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22153 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22154 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22155 current ABI.
22156
22157 @cindex OS ABI
22158 @kindex set osabi
22159 @kindex show osabi
22160 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22161
22162 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22163 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22164 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22165 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22166 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22167 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22168 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22169 platform provides.
22170
22171 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22172 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22173 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22174 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22175
22176 @table @code
22177 @item show osabi
22178 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22179
22180 @item set osabi
22181 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22182
22183 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22184 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22185 @end table
22186
22187 @cindex float promotion
22188
22189 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22190 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22191 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22192 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22193 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22194 @code{double} and then passed.
22195
22196 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22197 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22198 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22199
22200 @table @code
22201 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22202 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22203 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22204 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22205 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22206
22207 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22208 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22209 functions.
22210
22211 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22212 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22213 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22214 @end table
22215
22216 @kindex set cp-abi
22217 @kindex show cp-abi
22218 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22219 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22220 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22221 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22222 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22223 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22224 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22225 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22226 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22227 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22228 ``auto''.
22229
22230 @table @code
22231 @item show cp-abi
22232 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22233
22234 @item set cp-abi
22235 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22236
22237 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22238 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22239 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22240 @end table
22241
22242 @node Auto-loading
22243 @section Automatically loading associated files
22244 @cindex auto-loading
22245
22246 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22247 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22248 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22249 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22250 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22251 sources).
22252
22253 @menu
22254 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22255 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22256
22257 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22258 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22259 @end menu
22260
22261 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22262 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22263 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22264
22265 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22266 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22267 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22268
22269 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22270 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22271
22272 @table @code
22273 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22274 @kindex set auto-load off
22275 @item set auto-load off
22276 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22277 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22278 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22279 @smallexample
22280 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22281 @end smallexample
22282
22283 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22284 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22285 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22286 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22287 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22288 @code{set auto-load no}.
22289
22290 @anchor{show auto-load}
22291 @kindex show auto-load
22292 @item show auto-load
22293 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22294 or disabled.
22295
22296 @smallexample
22297 (gdb) show auto-load
22298 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22299 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22300 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22301 is on.
22302 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22303 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22304 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22305 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22306 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22307 @end smallexample
22308
22309 @anchor{info auto-load}
22310 @kindex info auto-load
22311 @item info auto-load
22312 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22313 not.
22314
22315 @smallexample
22316 (gdb) info auto-load
22317 gdb-scripts:
22318 Loaded Script
22319 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22320 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22321 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22322 loaded.
22323 python-scripts:
22324 Loaded Script
22325 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22326 @end smallexample
22327 @end table
22328
22329 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22330
22331 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22332 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22333 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22334 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22335 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22336 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22337 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22338 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22339 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22340 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22341 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22342 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22343 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22344 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22345 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22346 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22347 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22348 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22349 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22350 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22351 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22352 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22353 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22354 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22355 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22356 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22357 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22358 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22359 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22360 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22361 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22362 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22363 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22364 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22365 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22366 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22367 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22368 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22369 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22370 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22371 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22372 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22373 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22374 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22375 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22376 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22377 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22378 @end multitable
22379
22380 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22381 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22382 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22383
22384 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22385 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22386 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22387
22388 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22389 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22390
22391 @table @code
22392 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22393 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22394 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22395 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22396 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22397
22398 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22399 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22400 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22401 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22402 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22403
22404 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22405 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22406 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22407 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22408 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22409 @end table
22410
22411 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22412 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22413 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22414
22415 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22416
22417 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22418 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22419
22420 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22421 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22422 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22423 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22424 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22425 library.
22426
22427 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22428 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22429
22430 @table @code
22431 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22432 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22433 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22434 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22435
22436 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22437 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22438 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22439 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22440 enabled or disabled.
22441
22442 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22443 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22444 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22445 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22446 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22447 @end table
22448
22449 @node Auto-loading safe path
22450 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22451 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22452
22453 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22454 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22455 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22456 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22457 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22458
22459 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22460 get loaded:
22461
22462 @smallexample
22463 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22464 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22465 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22466 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22467 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22468 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22469 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22470 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22471 @end smallexample
22472
22473 @noindent
22474 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22475 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22476
22477 @smallexample
22478 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22479 @end smallexample
22480
22481 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22482
22483 @table @code
22484 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22485 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22486 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22487 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22488 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22489 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22490 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22491 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22492 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22493 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22494
22495 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22496 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22497 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22498
22499 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22500 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22501 @item show auto-load safe-path
22502 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22503 scripts.
22504
22505 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22506 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22507 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22508 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22509 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22510 host platform path separator in use.
22511 @end table
22512
22513 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22514 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22515 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22516 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22517 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22518
22519 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22520 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22521 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22522 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22523 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22524 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22525 init file in the current directory
22526 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22527
22528 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22529 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22530
22531 @table @asis
22532 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22533 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22534 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22535 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22536
22537 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22538 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22539 @value{GDBN} session.
22540
22541 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22542 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22543 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22544 from trusted sources.
22545
22546 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22547 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22548 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22549 trusted sources.
22550 @end table
22551
22552 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22553 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22554
22555 @table @asis
22556 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22557 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22558
22559 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22560 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22561 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22562 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22563 @end table
22564
22565 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22566 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22567 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22568 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22569 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22570 recommended to be entered.
22571
22572 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22573 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22574 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22575
22576 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22577 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22578 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22579 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22580 be printed.
22581
22582 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22583 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22584 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22585
22586 @smallexample
22587 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22588 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22589 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22590 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22591 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22592 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22593 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22594 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22595 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22596 @end smallexample
22597
22598 @table @code
22599 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22600 @kindex set debug auto-load
22601 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22602 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22603
22604 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22605 @kindex show debug auto-load
22606 @item show debug auto-load
22607 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22608 on or off.
22609 @end table
22610
22611 @node Messages/Warnings
22612 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22613
22614 @cindex verbose operation
22615 @cindex optional warnings
22616 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22617 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22618 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22619 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22620
22621 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22622 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22623 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22624
22625 @table @code
22626 @kindex set verbose
22627 @item set verbose on
22628 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22629
22630 @item set verbose off
22631 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22632
22633 @kindex show verbose
22634 @item show verbose
22635 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22636 @end table
22637
22638 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22639 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22640 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22641 Symbol Files}).
22642
22643 @table @code
22644
22645 @kindex set complaints
22646 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22647 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22648 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22649 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22650 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22651
22652 @kindex show complaints
22653 @item show complaints
22654 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22655
22656 @end table
22657
22658 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22659 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22660 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22661 you try to run a program which is already running:
22662
22663 @smallexample
22664 (@value{GDBP}) run
22665 The program being debugged has been started already.
22666 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22667 @end smallexample
22668
22669 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22670 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22671
22672 @table @code
22673
22674 @kindex set confirm
22675 @cindex flinching
22676 @cindex confirmation
22677 @cindex stupid questions
22678 @item set confirm off
22679 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22680 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22681 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22682
22683 @item set confirm on
22684 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22685
22686 @kindex show confirm
22687 @item show confirm
22688 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22689
22690 @end table
22691
22692 @cindex command tracing
22693 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22694 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22695 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22696 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22697
22698 @table @code
22699 @kindex set trace-commands
22700 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22701 @item set trace-commands on
22702 Enable command tracing.
22703 @item set trace-commands off
22704 Disable command tracing.
22705 @item show trace-commands
22706 Display the current state of command tracing.
22707 @end table
22708
22709 @node Debugging Output
22710 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22711 @cindex optional debugging messages
22712
22713 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22714 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22715 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22716 section documents those commands.
22717
22718 @table @code
22719 @kindex set exec-done-display
22720 @item set exec-done-display
22721 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22722 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22723 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22724 @kindex show exec-done-display
22725 @item show exec-done-display
22726 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22727 notification.
22728 @kindex set debug
22729 @cindex ARM AArch64
22730 @item set debug aarch64
22731 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22732 The default is off.
22733 @kindex show debug
22734 @item show debug aarch64
22735 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22736 ARM AArch64.
22737 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22738 @cindex architecture debugging info
22739 @item set debug arch
22740 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22741 @item show debug arch
22742 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22743 @item set debug aix-solib
22744 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22745 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22746 support module. The default is off.
22747 @item show debug aix-thread
22748 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22749 @item set debug aix-thread
22750 @cindex AIX threads
22751 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22752 module.
22753 @item show debug aix-thread
22754 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22755 @item set debug check-physname
22756 @cindex physname
22757 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22758 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22759 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22760 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22761 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22762 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22763 @item show debug check-physname
22764 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22765 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22766 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22767 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22768 exported symbols. The default is off.
22769 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22770 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22771 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22772 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22773 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22774 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22775 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22776 A value of zero turns off the display.
22777 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22778 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22779 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22780 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22781 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22782 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22783 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22784 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22785 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22786 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22787 @item set debug displaced
22788 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22789 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22790 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22791 @item show debug displaced
22792 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22793 related to displaced stepping.
22794 @item set debug event
22795 @cindex event debugging info
22796 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22797 default is off.
22798 @item show debug event
22799 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22800 info.
22801 @item set debug expression
22802 @cindex expression debugging info
22803 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22804 expression parsing. The default is off.
22805 @item show debug expression
22806 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22807 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22808 @item set debug frame
22809 @cindex frame debugging info
22810 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22811 default is off.
22812 @item show debug frame
22813 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22814 info.
22815 @item set debug gnu-nat
22816 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22817 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22818 @item show debug gnu-nat
22819 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22820 @item set debug infrun
22821 @cindex inferior debugging info
22822 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22823 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22824 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22825 @item show debug infrun
22826 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22827 @item set debug jit
22828 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22829 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22830 @item show debug jit
22831 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22832 @item set debug lin-lwp
22833 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22834 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22835 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22836 @item show debug lin-lwp
22837 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22838 @item set debug mach-o
22839 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22840 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22841 processing. The default is off.
22842 @item show debug mach-o
22843 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22844 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22845 @item set debug notification
22846 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22847 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22848 The default is off.
22849 @item show debug notification
22850 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22851 @item set debug observer
22852 @cindex observer debugging info
22853 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22854 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22855 @item show debug observer
22856 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22857 @item set debug overload
22858 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22859 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22860 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22861 is off.
22862 @item show debug overload
22863 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22864 debugging info.
22865 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22866 @cindex debug expression parser
22867 @item set debug parser
22868 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22869 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22870 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22871 details. The default is off.
22872 @item show debug parser
22873 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22874 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22875 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22876 @cindex debug remote protocol
22877 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22878 @cindex display remote packets
22879 @item set debug remote
22880 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22881 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22882 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22883 @item show debug remote
22884 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22885 @item set debug serial
22886 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22887 default is off.
22888 @item show debug serial
22889 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22890 info.
22891 @item set debug solib-frv
22892 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22893 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22894 @item show debug solib-frv
22895 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22896 messages.
22897 @item set debug symfile
22898 @cindex symbol file functions
22899 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22900 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22901 @item show debug symfile
22902 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22903 @item set debug symtab-create
22904 @cindex symbol table creation
22905 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22906 The default is 0 (off).
22907 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22908 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22909 @item show debug symtab-create
22910 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22911 @item set debug target
22912 @cindex target debugging info
22913 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22914 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22915 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22916 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
22917 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
22918 @item show debug target
22919 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22920 info.
22921 @item set debug timestamp
22922 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22923 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22924 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22925 message.
22926 @item show debug timestamp
22927 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22928 debugging info.
22929 @item set debugvarobj
22930 @cindex variable object debugging info
22931 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22932 info. The default is off.
22933 @item show debugvarobj
22934 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22935 debugging info.
22936 @item set debug xml
22937 @cindex XML parser debugging
22938 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22939 @item show debug xml
22940 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22941 @end table
22942
22943 @node Other Misc Settings
22944 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
22945 @cindex miscellaneous settings
22946
22947 @table @code
22948 @kindex set interactive-mode
22949 @item set interactive-mode
22950 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
22951 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
22952 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
22953 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
22954 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
22955 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
22956 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
22957 is, non-interactively otherwise.
22958
22959 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
22960 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
22961 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
22962 inside a cygwin window.
22963
22964 @kindex show interactive-mode
22965 @item show interactive-mode
22966 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
22967 @end table
22968
22969 @node Extending GDB
22970 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22971 @cindex extending GDB
22972
22973 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
22974 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
22975 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
22976 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
22977 being debugged.
22978
22979 @menu
22980 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
22981 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
22982 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
22983 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
22984 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
22985 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22986 @end menu
22987
22988 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
22989 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22990 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
22991 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22992 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22993 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22994
22995 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22996 setting:
22997
22998 @table @code
22999 @kindex set script-extension
23000 @kindex show script-extension
23001 @item set script-extension off
23002 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23003
23004 @item set script-extension soft
23005 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23006 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23007 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23008 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23009
23010 @item set script-extension strict
23011 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23012 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23013 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23014
23015 @item show script-extension
23016 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23017
23018 @end table
23019
23020 @node Sequences
23021 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23022
23023 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23024 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23025 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23026 files.
23027
23028 @menu
23029 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23030 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23031 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23032 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23033 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23034 @end menu
23035
23036 @node Define
23037 @subsection User-defined Commands
23038
23039 @cindex user-defined command
23040 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23041 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23042 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23043 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23044 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23045 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23046
23047 @smallexample
23048 define adder
23049 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23050 end
23051 @end smallexample
23052
23053 @noindent
23054 To execute the command use:
23055
23056 @smallexample
23057 adder 1 2 3
23058 @end smallexample
23059
23060 @noindent
23061 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23062 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23063 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23064 functions calls.
23065
23066 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23067 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23068 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23069 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23070
23071 @smallexample
23072 define adder
23073 if $argc == 2
23074 print $arg0 + $arg1
23075 end
23076 if $argc == 3
23077 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23078 end
23079 end
23080 @end smallexample
23081
23082 @table @code
23083
23084 @kindex define
23085 @item define @var{commandname}
23086 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23087 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23088 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23089 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23090 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23091 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23092
23093 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23094 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23095 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23096
23097 @kindex document
23098 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23099 @item document @var{commandname}
23100 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23101 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23102 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23103 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23104 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23105 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23106
23107 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23108 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23109 does not change the documentation.
23110
23111 @kindex dont-repeat
23112 @cindex don't repeat command
23113 @item dont-repeat
23114 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23115 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23116 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23117
23118 @kindex help user-defined
23119 @item help user-defined
23120 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23121 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23122 included (if any).
23123
23124 @kindex show user
23125 @item show user
23126 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23127 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23128 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23129 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23130 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23131
23132 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23133 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23134 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23135 @item show max-user-call-depth
23136 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23137 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23138 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23139 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23140 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23141 @end table
23142
23143 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23144 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23145
23146 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23147 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23148 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23149
23150 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23151 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23152 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23153 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23154
23155 @node Hooks
23156 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23157 @cindex command hooks
23158 @cindex hooks, for commands
23159 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23160
23161 @kindex hook
23162 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23163 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23164 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23165 before that command.
23166
23167 @cindex hooks, post-command
23168 @kindex hookpost
23169 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23170 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23171 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23172 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23173 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23174
23175 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23176 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23177
23178 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23179 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23180
23181 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23182 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23183 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23184 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23185 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23186
23187 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23188 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23189 you could define:
23190
23191 @smallexample
23192 define hook-stop
23193 handle SIGALRM nopass
23194 end
23195
23196 define hook-run
23197 handle SIGALRM pass
23198 end
23199
23200 define hook-continue
23201 handle SIGALRM pass
23202 end
23203 @end smallexample
23204
23205 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23206 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23207 you could define:
23208
23209 @smallexample
23210 define hook-echo
23211 echo <<<---
23212 end
23213
23214 define hookpost-echo
23215 echo --->>>\n
23216 end
23217
23218 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23219 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23220 (@value{GDBP})
23221
23222 @end smallexample
23223
23224 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23225 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23226 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23227 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23228 @c or not?
23229 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23230 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23231 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23232
23233 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23234 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23235 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23236
23237 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23238 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23239
23240 @node Command Files
23241 @subsection Command Files
23242
23243 @cindex command files
23244 @cindex scripting commands
23245 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23246 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23247 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23248 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23249 terminal.
23250
23251 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23252 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23253 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23254 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23255 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23256
23257 @table @code
23258 @kindex source
23259 @cindex execute commands from a file
23260 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23261 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23262 @end table
23263
23264 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23265 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23266 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23267 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23268 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23269
23270 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23271 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23272 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23273 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23274 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23275 is not relevant to scripts.
23276
23277 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23278 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23279 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23280 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23281 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23282 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23283 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23284 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23285 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23286 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23287 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23288 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23289 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23290 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23291
23292 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23293 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23294 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23295
23296 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23297 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23298 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23299 when called from command files.
23300
23301 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23302 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23303 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23304 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23305 the next command.
23306
23307 @smallexample
23308 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23309 @end smallexample
23310
23311 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23312 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23313 would be directed to @file{log}.
23314
23315 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23316 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23317 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23318 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23319 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23320 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23321 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23322 conditionally, etc.
23323
23324 @table @code
23325 @kindex if
23326 @kindex else
23327 @item if
23328 @itemx else
23329 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23330 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23331 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23332 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23333 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23334 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23335 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23336
23337 @kindex while
23338 @item while
23339 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23340 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23341 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23342 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23343 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23344 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23345
23346 @kindex loop_break
23347 @item loop_break
23348 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23349 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23350 line.
23351
23352 @kindex loop_continue
23353 @item loop_continue
23354 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23355 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23356 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23357 the controlling expression.
23358
23359 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23360 @item end
23361 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23362 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23363 @end table
23364
23365
23366 @node Output
23367 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23368
23369 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23370 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23371 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23372 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23373 want.
23374
23375 @table @code
23376 @kindex echo
23377 @item echo @var{text}
23378 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23379 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23380 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23381 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23382 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23383 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23384 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23385 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23386 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23387 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23388 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23389
23390 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23391 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23392
23393 @smallexample
23394 echo This is some text\n\
23395 which is continued\n\
23396 onto several lines.\n
23397 @end smallexample
23398
23399 produces the same output as
23400
23401 @smallexample
23402 echo This is some text\n
23403 echo which is continued\n
23404 echo onto several lines.\n
23405 @end smallexample
23406
23407 @kindex output
23408 @item output @var{expression}
23409 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23410 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23411 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23412 on expressions.
23413
23414 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23415 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23416 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23417 Formats}, for more information.
23418
23419 @kindex printf
23420 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23421 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23422 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23423 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23424 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23425 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23426 executing the code below:
23427
23428 @smallexample
23429 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23430 @end smallexample
23431
23432 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23433 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23434 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23435 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23436 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23437 printed.
23438
23439 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23440
23441 @smallexample
23442 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23443 @end smallexample
23444
23445 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23446 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23447 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23448
23449 @itemize @bullet
23450 @item
23451 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23452
23453 @item
23454 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23455 width.
23456
23457 @item
23458 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23459 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23460
23461 @item
23462 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23463 supported.
23464
23465 @item
23466 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23467
23468 @item
23469 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23470 @end itemize
23471
23472 @noindent
23473 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23474 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23475 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23476 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23477
23478 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23479 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23480 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23481 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23482 supported.
23483
23484 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23485 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23486 together with a floating point specifier.
23487 letters:
23488
23489 @itemize @bullet
23490 @item
23491 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23492
23493 @item
23494 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23495
23496 @item
23497 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23498 @end itemize
23499
23500 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23501 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23502 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23503
23504 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23505 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23506
23507 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23508 @smallexample
23509 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23510 @end smallexample
23511
23512 @kindex eval
23513 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23514 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23515 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23516
23517 @end table
23518
23519 @node Auto-loading sequences
23520 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23521 @cindex native script auto-loading
23522
23523 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23524 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23525 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23526 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23527
23528 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23529 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23530
23531 @table @code
23532 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23533 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23534 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23535 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23536
23537 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23538 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23539 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23540 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23541 disabled.
23542
23543 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23544 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23545 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23546 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23547 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23548 auto-loaded.
23549 @end table
23550
23551 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23552 matching names are printed.
23553
23554 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23555 @include python.texi
23556
23557 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23558 @include guile.texi
23559
23560 @node Auto-loading extensions
23561 @section Auto-loading extensions
23562 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23563
23564 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23565 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23566 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23567 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23568 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23569
23570 @menu
23571 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23572 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23573 * Which flavor to choose?::
23574 @end menu
23575
23576 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23577 debugging commands and features.
23578
23579 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23580 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23581 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23582 for more information.
23583 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23584 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23585
23586 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23587 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23588
23589 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23590 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23591 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23592 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23593 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23594
23595 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23596 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23597 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23598 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23599
23600 @table @code
23601 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23602 GDB's own command language
23603 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23604 Python
23605 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23606 Guile
23607 @end table
23608
23609 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23610 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23611 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23612 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23613 script in the specified extension language.
23614
23615 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23616 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23617
23618 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23619 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23620
23621 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23622 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23623 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23624 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23625 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23626 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23627
23628 @table @code
23629 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23630 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23631 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23632 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23633 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23634 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23635
23636 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23637 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23638
23639 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23640 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23641 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23642 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23643
23644 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23645 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23646 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23647 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23648 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23649 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23650 platform.
23651
23652 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23653 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23654 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23655
23656 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23657 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23658 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23659 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23660 @end table
23661
23662 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23663 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23664 @var{objfile} is opened.
23665 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23666 is evaluated more than once.
23667
23668 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23669 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23670 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23671
23672 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23673 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23674 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23675 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23676 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23677 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23678
23679 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23680 current directory and then along the source search path
23681 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23682 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23683 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23684
23685 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23686 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23687
23688 @example
23689 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23690 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23691 asm("\
23692 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23693 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23694 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23695 .popsection \n\
23696 ");
23697 @end example
23698
23699 @noindent
23700 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23701 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23702
23703 @example
23704 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23705 @end example
23706
23707 The script name may include directories if desired.
23708
23709 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23710 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23711
23712 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23713 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23714 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23715 will remove duplicates.
23716
23717 @node Which flavor to choose?
23718 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23719
23720 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23721 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23722
23723 @noindent
23724 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23725
23726 @itemize @bullet
23727 @item
23728 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23729
23730 @item
23731 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23732
23733 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23734 in the source search path.
23735 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23736 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23737
23738 @item
23739 Doesn't require source code additions.
23740 @end itemize
23741
23742 @noindent
23743 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23744
23745 @itemize @bullet
23746 @item
23747 Works with static linking.
23748
23749 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23750 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23751 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23752 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23753 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23754
23755 @item
23756 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23757
23758 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23759 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23760
23761 @item
23762 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23763
23764 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23765 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23766 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23767 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23768 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23769 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23770 @end itemize
23771
23772 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23773 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23774
23775 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23776 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23777 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23778
23779 @subsection Python comes first
23780
23781 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23782 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23783 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23784 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23785 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23786 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23787 pretty-printed form of a value).
23788 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23789 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23790 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23791
23792 @node Aliases
23793 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23794 @cindex aliases for commands
23795
23796 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23797 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23798 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23799 that involves less typing.
23800
23801 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23802 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23803 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23804
23805 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23806 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23807 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23808
23809 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23810
23811 @table @code
23812
23813 @kindex alias
23814 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23815
23816 @end table
23817
23818 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23819 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23820 underscores.
23821
23822 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23823 that is being aliased.
23824
23825 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23826 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23827 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23828
23829 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23830 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23831
23832 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23833 of a command so that there is less to type.
23834 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23835 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23836 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23837 The following will accomplish this.
23838
23839 @smallexample
23840 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23841 @end smallexample
23842
23843 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23844 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23845 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23846 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23847
23848 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23849 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23850 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23851 of a command.
23852
23853 @smallexample
23854 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
23855 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
23856 (gdb) set p elms 20
23857 (gdb) show p elms
23858 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
23859 @end smallexample
23860
23861 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
23862 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
23863 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
23864
23865 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
23866 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
23867
23868 @smallexample
23869 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
23870 @end smallexample
23871
23872 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
23873 alias for a more complex command.
23874 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
23875
23876 @smallexample
23877 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
23878 (gdb) spe 20
23879 @end smallexample
23880
23881 @node Interpreters
23882 @chapter Command Interpreters
23883 @cindex command interpreters
23884
23885 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23886 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23887 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23888
23889 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23890 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23891 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23892 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23893
23894 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23895 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23896 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23897 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23898
23899 @table @code
23900 @item console
23901 @cindex console interpreter
23902 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23903 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23904 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23905
23906 @item mi
23907 @cindex mi interpreter
23908 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23909 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23910 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23911 Interface}.
23912
23913 @item mi2
23914 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23915 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23916
23917 @item mi1
23918 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23919 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23920
23921 @end table
23922
23923 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23924 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23925 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23926 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23927 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23928 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23929 the IDE inoperable!
23930
23931 @kindex interpreter-exec
23932 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23933 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23934 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23935 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23936
23937 @smallexample
23938 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23939 @end smallexample
23940
23941 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23942 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23943
23944 @node TUI
23945 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23946 @cindex TUI
23947 @cindex Text User Interface
23948
23949 @menu
23950 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23951 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23952 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23953 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23954 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23955 @end menu
23956
23957 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23958 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23959 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23960 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23961 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23962 is available.
23963
23964 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23965 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23966 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23967 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23968 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23969
23970 @node TUI Overview
23971 @section TUI Overview
23972
23973 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23974
23975 @table @emph
23976 @item command
23977 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23978 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23979 managed using readline.
23980
23981 @item source
23982 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23983 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23984
23985 @item assembly
23986 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23987
23988 @item register
23989 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23990 when their values change.
23991 @end table
23992
23993 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23994 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23995 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23996 indicates the breakpoint type:
23997
23998 @table @code
23999 @item B
24000 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24001
24002 @item b
24003 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24004
24005 @item H
24006 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24007
24008 @item h
24009 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24010 @end table
24011
24012 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24013
24014 @table @code
24015 @item +
24016 Breakpoint is enabled.
24017
24018 @item -
24019 Breakpoint is disabled.
24020 @end table
24021
24022 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24023 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24024 changes.
24025
24026 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24027 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24028 layouts:
24029
24030 @itemize @bullet
24031 @item
24032 source only,
24033
24034 @item
24035 assembly only,
24036
24037 @item
24038 source and assembly,
24039
24040 @item
24041 source and registers, or
24042
24043 @item
24044 assembly and registers.
24045 @end itemize
24046
24047 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24048
24049 @table @emph
24050 @item target
24051 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24052 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24053
24054 @item process
24055 Gives the current process or thread number.
24056 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24057
24058 @item function
24059 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24060 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24061 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24062 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24063
24064 @item line
24065 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24066 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24067
24068 @item pc
24069 Indicates the current program counter address.
24070 @end table
24071
24072 @node TUI Keys
24073 @section TUI Key Bindings
24074 @cindex TUI key bindings
24075
24076 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24077 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24078 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24079 @end ifset
24080 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24081 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24082 @end ifclear
24083 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24084 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24085
24086 @table @kbd
24087 @kindex C-x C-a
24088 @item C-x C-a
24089 @kindex C-x a
24090 @itemx C-x a
24091 @kindex C-x A
24092 @itemx C-x A
24093 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24094 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24095 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24096 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24097 The screen is then refreshed.
24098
24099 @kindex C-x 1
24100 @item C-x 1
24101 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24102 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24103 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24104
24105 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24106
24107 @kindex C-x 2
24108 @item C-x 2
24109 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24110 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24111 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24112 previous layout and the new one.
24113
24114 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24115
24116 @kindex C-x o
24117 @item C-x o
24118 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24119 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24120 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24121
24122 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24123
24124 @kindex C-x s
24125 @item C-x s
24126 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24127 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24128 @end table
24129
24130 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24131
24132 @table @asis
24133 @kindex PgUp
24134 @item @key{PgUp}
24135 Scroll the active window one page up.
24136
24137 @kindex PgDn
24138 @item @key{PgDn}
24139 Scroll the active window one page down.
24140
24141 @kindex Up
24142 @item @key{Up}
24143 Scroll the active window one line up.
24144
24145 @kindex Down
24146 @item @key{Down}
24147 Scroll the active window one line down.
24148
24149 @kindex Left
24150 @item @key{Left}
24151 Scroll the active window one column left.
24152
24153 @kindex Right
24154 @item @key{Right}
24155 Scroll the active window one column right.
24156
24157 @kindex C-L
24158 @item @kbd{C-L}
24159 Refresh the screen.
24160 @end table
24161
24162 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24163 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24164 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24165 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24166 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24167
24168 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24169 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24170 @cindex TUI single key mode
24171
24172 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24173 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24174 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24175
24176 @table @kbd
24177 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24178 @item c
24179 continue
24180
24181 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24182 @item d
24183 down
24184
24185 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24186 @item f
24187 finish
24188
24189 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24190 @item n
24191 next
24192
24193 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24194 @item q
24195 exit the SingleKey mode.
24196
24197 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24198 @item r
24199 run
24200
24201 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24202 @item s
24203 step
24204
24205 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24206 @item u
24207 up
24208
24209 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24210 @item v
24211 info locals
24212
24213 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24214 @item w
24215 where
24216 @end table
24217
24218 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24219 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24220 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24221 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24222 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24223 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24224
24225
24226 @node TUI Commands
24227 @section TUI-specific Commands
24228 @cindex TUI commands
24229
24230 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24231 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24232 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24233 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24234
24235 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24236 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24237 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24238 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24239 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24240
24241 @table @code
24242 @item info win
24243 @kindex info win
24244 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24245
24246 @item layout next
24247 @kindex layout
24248 Display the next layout.
24249
24250 @item layout prev
24251 Display the previous layout.
24252
24253 @item layout src
24254 Display the source window only.
24255
24256 @item layout asm
24257 Display the assembly window only.
24258
24259 @item layout split
24260 Display the source and assembly window.
24261
24262 @item layout regs
24263 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24264
24265 @item focus next
24266 @kindex focus
24267 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24268
24269 @item focus prev
24270 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24271
24272 @item focus src
24273 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24274
24275 @item focus asm
24276 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24277
24278 @item focus regs
24279 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24280
24281 @item focus cmd
24282 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24283
24284 @item refresh
24285 @kindex refresh
24286 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24287
24288 @item tui reg float
24289 @kindex tui reg
24290 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24291
24292 @item tui reg general
24293 Show the general registers in the register window.
24294
24295 @item tui reg next
24296 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24297 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24298 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24299 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24300
24301 @item tui reg system
24302 Show the system registers in the register window.
24303
24304 @item update
24305 @kindex update
24306 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24307
24308 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24309 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24310 @kindex winheight
24311 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24312 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24313 decrease it.
24314
24315 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24316 @kindex tabset
24317 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24318 @end table
24319
24320 @node TUI Configuration
24321 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24322 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24323
24324 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24325
24326 @table @code
24327 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24328 @kindex set tui border-kind
24329 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24330 The possible values are the following:
24331 @table @code
24332 @item space
24333 Use a space character to draw the border.
24334
24335 @item ascii
24336 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24337
24338 @item acs
24339 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24340 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24341 @end table
24342
24343 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24344 @kindex set tui border-mode
24345 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24346 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24347 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24348 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24349 @table @code
24350 @item normal
24351 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24352
24353 @item standout
24354 Use standout mode.
24355
24356 @item reverse
24357 Use reverse video mode.
24358
24359 @item half
24360 Use half bright mode.
24361
24362 @item half-standout
24363 Use half bright and standout mode.
24364
24365 @item bold
24366 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24367
24368 @item bold-standout
24369 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24370 @end table
24371 @end table
24372
24373 @node Emacs
24374 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24375
24376 @cindex Emacs
24377 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24378 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24379 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24380 @value{GDBN}.
24381
24382 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24383 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24384 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24385 created Emacs buffer.
24386 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24387
24388 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24389 things:
24390
24391 @itemize @bullet
24392 @item
24393 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24394 the GUD buffer.
24395
24396 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24397 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24398
24399 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24400 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24401 in this way.
24402
24403 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24404 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24405 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24406 stop.
24407
24408 @item
24409 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24410
24411 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24412 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24413 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24414 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24415 and the source.
24416
24417 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24418 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24419 @end itemize
24420
24421 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24422 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24423 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24424 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24425
24426 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24427 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24428 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24429 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24430 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24431 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24432 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24433 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24434 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24435
24436 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24437 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24438 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24439 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24440
24441 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24442 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24443 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24444 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24445 one you want.
24446
24447 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24448 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24449
24450 @table @kbd
24451 @item C-h m
24452 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24453
24454 @item C-c C-s
24455 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24456 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24457
24458 @item C-c C-n
24459 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24460 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24461 to show the current file and location.
24462
24463 @item C-c C-i
24464 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24465 display window accordingly.
24466
24467 @item C-c C-f
24468 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24469 @code{finish} command.
24470
24471 @item C-c C-r
24472 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24473 command.
24474
24475 @item C-c <
24476 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24477 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24478 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24479
24480 @item C-c >
24481 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24482 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24483 @end table
24484
24485 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24486 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24487
24488 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24489 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24490 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24491 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24492 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24493 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24494 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24495
24496 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24497 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24498 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24499 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24500 frame.
24501
24502 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24503 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24504 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24505 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24506 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24507 to correspond properly with the code.
24508
24509 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24510 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24511 Emacs Manual}).
24512
24513 @node GDB/MI
24514 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24515
24516 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24517
24518 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24519 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24520 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24521 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24522 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24523 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24524
24525 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24526 in the form of a reference manual.
24527
24528 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24529 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24530 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24531
24532 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24533
24534 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24535 This chapter uses the following notation:
24536
24537 @itemize @bullet
24538 @item
24539 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24540
24541 @item
24542 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24543 it may or may not be given.
24544
24545 @item
24546 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24547 may repeat zero or more times.
24548
24549 @item
24550 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24551 may repeat one or more times.
24552
24553 @item
24554 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24555 @end itemize
24556
24557 @ignore
24558 @heading Dependencies
24559 @end ignore
24560
24561 @menu
24562 * GDB/MI General Design::
24563 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24564 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24565 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24566 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24567 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24568 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24569 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24570 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24571 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24572 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24573 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24574 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24575 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24576 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24577 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24578 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24579 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24580 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24581 @ignore
24582 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24583 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24584 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24585 @end ignore
24586 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24587 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24588 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24589 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24590 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24591 @end menu
24592
24593 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24594 @node GDB/MI General Design
24595 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24596 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24597
24598 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24599 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24600 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24601 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24602 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24603 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24604 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24605 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24606 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24607 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24608
24609 The important examples of notifications are:
24610 @itemize @bullet
24611
24612 @item
24613 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24614 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24615 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24616 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24617 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24618 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24619 command itself was successfully executed.
24620
24621 @item
24622 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24623 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24624 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24625 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24626 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24627 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24628
24629 @item
24630 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24631 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24632 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24633 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24634 orthogonal frontend design.
24635
24636 @end itemize
24637
24638 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24639 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24640 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24641 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24642 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24643 the user interface.
24644
24645
24646 @menu
24647 * Context management::
24648 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24649 * Thread groups::
24650 @end menu
24651
24652 @node Context management
24653 @subsection Context management
24654
24655 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24656
24657 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24658 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24659 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24660 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24661 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24662 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24663 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24664 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24665 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24666
24667 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24668 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24669 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24670 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24671 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24672 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24673 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24674 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24675 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24676 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24677 for thread and frame to operate on.
24678
24679 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24680 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24681 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24682 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24683 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24684 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24685 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24686 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24687 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24688 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24689
24690 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24691 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24692 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24693 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24694 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24695 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24696 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24697 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24698 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24699 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24700 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24701 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24702 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24703 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24704 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24705 @samp{--frame} options.
24706
24707 @subsubsection Language
24708
24709 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24710 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24711 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24712 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24713 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24714 For instance:
24715
24716 @smallexample
24717 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24718 ^done,value="4"
24719 (gdb)
24720 @end smallexample
24721
24722 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24723 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24724 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24725
24726 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24727 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24728
24729 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24730 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24731 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24732 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24733 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24734 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24735 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24736 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24737 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24738
24739 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24740 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24741 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24742 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24743 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24744 are running.
24745
24746 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24747 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24748 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24749 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24750 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24751 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24752 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24753 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24754 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24755 @samp{--thread} option).
24756
24757 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24758 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24759 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24760 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24761
24762 @node Thread groups
24763 @subsection Thread groups
24764 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24765 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24766 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24767 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24768 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24769
24770 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24771 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24772 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24773 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24774 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24775 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24776 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24777 into processes.
24778
24779 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24780 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24781 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24782 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24783 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24784 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24785 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24786 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24787 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24788 the members of specific thread group.
24789
24790 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24791 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24792 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24793 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24794 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24795 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24796 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24797 after attaching to that thread group.
24798
24799 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24800 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24801 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24802 such thread groups.
24803
24804 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24805 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24806 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24807
24808 @menu
24809 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24810 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24811 @end menu
24812
24813 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24814 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24815
24816 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24817 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24818 @table @code
24819 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24820 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24821
24822 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24823 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24824 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24825
24826 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24827 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24828 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24829
24830 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24831 "any sequence of digits"
24832
24833 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24834 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24835
24836 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24837 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24838
24839 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24840 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24841
24842 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24843 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24844 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24845
24846 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24847 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24848
24849 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24850 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24851 @end table
24852
24853 @noindent
24854 Notes:
24855
24856 @itemize @bullet
24857 @item
24858 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24859 output is described below.
24860
24861 @item
24862 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24863 finishes.
24864
24865 @item
24866 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24867 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24868 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24869 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24870 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24871 @end itemize
24872
24873 Pragmatics:
24874
24875 @itemize @bullet
24876 @item
24877 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24878
24879 @item
24880 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24881 @end itemize
24882
24883 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24884 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24885
24886 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24887 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24888 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24889 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24890 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24891 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24892
24893 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24894 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24895 @var{token}.
24896
24897 @table @code
24898 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24899 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24900
24901 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24902 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24903
24904 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24905 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24906
24907 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24908 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24909
24910 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24911 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
24912
24913 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24914 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
24915
24916 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24917 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
24918
24919 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24920 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
24921
24922 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24923 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24924
24925 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24926 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24927 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24928
24929 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24930 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24931
24932 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24933 @code{ @var{string} }
24934
24935 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24936 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24937
24938 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24939 @code{@var{c-string}}
24940
24941 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24942 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24943
24944 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24945 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24946 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24947
24948 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24949 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24950
24951 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24952 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
24953
24954 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24955 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
24956
24957 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24958 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
24959
24960 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24961 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24962
24963 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24964 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24965 @end table
24966
24967 @noindent
24968 Notes:
24969
24970 @itemize @bullet
24971 @item
24972 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24973
24974 @item
24975 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24976 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24977 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24978 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24979 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24980 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24981 prior command.
24982
24983 @item
24984 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24985 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24986 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24987 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24988
24989 @item
24990 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24991 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24992 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24993 @samp{*}.
24994
24995 @item
24996 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24997 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
24998 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
24999 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25000
25001 @item
25002 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25003 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25004 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25005 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25006
25007 @item
25008 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25009 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25010 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25011
25012 @item
25013 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25014 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25015 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25016 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25017
25018 @item
25019 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25020 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25021 @var{values}.
25022
25023
25024 @end itemize
25025
25026 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25027 details about the various output records.
25028
25029 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25030 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25031 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25032
25033 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25034 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25035
25036 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25037 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25038 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25039 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25040 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25041 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25042
25043 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25044 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25045 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25046
25047 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25048 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25049 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25050 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25051
25052 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25053 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25054
25055 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25056 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25057 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25058 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25059 might change.
25060
25061 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25062 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25063 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25064 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25065
25066 @itemize @bullet
25067 @item
25068 New MI commands may be added.
25069
25070 @item
25071 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25072
25073 @item
25074 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25075 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25076
25077 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25078 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25079
25080 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25081 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25082 @end itemize
25083
25084 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25085 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25086 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25087 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25088 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25089
25090 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25091 @c version?
25092
25093 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25094 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25095 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25096 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25097 @cindex mailing lists
25098
25099 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25100 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25101 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25102
25103 @menu
25104 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25105 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25106 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25107 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25108 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25109 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25110 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25111 @end menu
25112
25113 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25114 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25115
25116 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25117 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25118 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25119 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25120
25121 @table @code
25122 @findex ^done
25123 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25124 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25125 values.
25126
25127 @item "^running"
25128 @findex ^running
25129 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25130 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25131 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25132 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25133 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25134 which threads are resumed.
25135
25136 @item "^connected"
25137 @findex ^connected
25138 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25139
25140 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25141 @findex ^error
25142 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25143 the corresponding error message.
25144
25145 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25146 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25147 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25148
25149 @table @samp
25150 @item "undefined-command"
25151 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25152 @end table
25153
25154 @item "^exit"
25155 @findex ^exit
25156 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25157
25158 @end table
25159
25160 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25161 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25162
25163 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25164 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25165 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25166 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25167 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25168
25169 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25170 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25171 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25172 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25173 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25174
25175 @table @code
25176 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25177 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25178 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25179
25180 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25181 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25182 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25183 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25184
25185 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25186 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25187 internals.
25188 @end table
25189
25190 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25191 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25192
25193 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25194 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25195 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25196 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25197 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25198 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25199
25200 The following is the list of possible async records:
25201
25202 @table @code
25203
25204 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25205 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25206 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25207 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25208 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25209 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25210 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25211 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25212 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25213 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25214
25215 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25216 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25217 following values:
25218
25219 @table @code
25220 @item breakpoint-hit
25221 A breakpoint was reached.
25222 @item watchpoint-trigger
25223 A watchpoint was triggered.
25224 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25225 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25226 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25227 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25228 @item function-finished
25229 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25230 @item location-reached
25231 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25232 @item watchpoint-scope
25233 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25234 @item end-stepping-range
25235 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25236 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25237 @item exited-signalled
25238 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25239 @item exited
25240 The inferior exited.
25241 @item exited-normally
25242 The inferior exited normally.
25243 @item signal-received
25244 A signal was received by the inferior.
25245 @item solib-event
25246 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25247 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25248 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25249 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25250 @item fork
25251 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25252 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25253 @item vfork
25254 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25255 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25256 @item syscall-entry
25257 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25258 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25259 @item syscall-entry
25260 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25261 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25262 @item exec
25263 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25264 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25265 @end table
25266
25267 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25268 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25269 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25270 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25271 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25272 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25273 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25274 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25275 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25276 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25277 if such information is not available.
25278
25279 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25280 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25281 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25282 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25283 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25284 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25285 cannot be used in any way.
25286
25287 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25288 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25289 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25290 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25291 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25292 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25293
25294 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25295 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25296 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25297 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25298 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25299 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25300
25301 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25302 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25303 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25304 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25305 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25306
25307 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25308 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25309 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25310 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25311 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25312 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25313 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25314
25315 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25316 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25317 that thread.
25318
25319 @item =library-loaded,...
25320 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25321 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25322 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25323 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25324 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25325 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25326 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25327 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25328 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25329 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25330 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25331 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25332 thread groups.
25333
25334 @item =library-unloaded,...
25335 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25336 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25337 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25338 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25339 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25340 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25341 thread groups.
25342
25343 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25344 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25345 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25346 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25347 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25348
25349 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25350 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25351 initial value @var{initial}.
25352
25353 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25354 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25355 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25356 trace state variables are deleted.
25357
25358 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25359 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25360 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25361 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25362 value of trace state variable is known.
25363
25364 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25365 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25366 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25367 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25368 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25369 user.
25370
25371 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25372 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25373 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25374
25375 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25376 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25377
25378 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25379 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25380 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25381 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25382 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25383
25384 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25385 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25386 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25387 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25388 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25389 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25390
25391 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25392 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25393 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25394 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25395 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25396 executable code.
25397 @end table
25398
25399 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25400 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25401
25402 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25403 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25404 following fields:
25405
25406 @table @code
25407 @item number
25408 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25409 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25410 @samp{1.2}.
25411
25412 @item type
25413 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25414 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25415
25416 @item catch-type
25417 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25418 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25419
25420 @item disp
25421 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25422 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25423 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25424
25425 @item enabled
25426 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25427 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25428 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25429
25430 @item addr
25431 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25432 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25433 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25434 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25435 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25436
25437 @item func
25438 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25439 If not known, this field is not present.
25440
25441 @item filename
25442 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25443 If not known, this field is not present.
25444
25445 @item fullname
25446 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25447 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25448
25449 @item line
25450 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25451 If not known, this field is not present.
25452
25453 @item at
25454 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25455 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25456 by a symbol name.
25457
25458 @item pending
25459 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25460 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25461
25462 @item evaluated-by
25463 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25464 @samp{target}.
25465
25466 @item thread
25467 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25468 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25469
25470 @item task
25471 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25472 field will hold the task identifier.
25473
25474 @item cond
25475 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25476
25477 @item ignore
25478 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25479
25480 @item enable
25481 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25482
25483 @item traceframe-usage
25484 FIXME.
25485
25486 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25487 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25488
25489 @item mask
25490 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25491
25492 @item pass
25493 A tracepoint's pass count.
25494
25495 @item original-location
25496 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25497 This field is optional.
25498
25499 @item times
25500 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25501
25502 @item installed
25503 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25504 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25505 is not.
25506
25507 @item what
25508 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25509
25510 @end table
25511
25512 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25513 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25514
25515 @smallexample
25516 -> -break-insert main
25517 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25518 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25519 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25520 times="0"@}
25521 <- (gdb)
25522 @end smallexample
25523
25524 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25525 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25526
25527 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25528 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25529 fields:
25530
25531 @table @code
25532 @item level
25533 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25534 zero. This field is always present.
25535
25536 @item func
25537 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25538 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25539
25540 @item addr
25541 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25542
25543 @item file
25544 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25545 address. This field may be absent.
25546
25547 @item line
25548 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25549 may be absent.
25550
25551 @item from
25552 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25553 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25554
25555 @end table
25556
25557 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25558 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25559
25560 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25561 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25562
25563 @table @code
25564 @item id
25565 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25566 always present.
25567
25568 @item target-id
25569 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25570
25571 @item details
25572 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25573 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25574 frontend. This field is optional.
25575
25576 @item state
25577 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25578 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25579
25580 @item core
25581 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25582 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25583 @end table
25584
25585 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25586 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25587
25588 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25589 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25590 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25591 the @code{exception-name} field.
25592
25593 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25594 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25595 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25596 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25597
25598 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25599 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25600 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25601 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25602
25603 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25604 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25605
25606 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25607
25608 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25609 information of the breakpoint.
25610
25611 @smallexample
25612 -> -break-insert main
25613 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25614 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25615 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25616 times="0"@}
25617 <- (gdb)
25618 @end smallexample
25619
25620 @subheading Program Execution
25621
25622 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25623 reason that execution stopped.
25624
25625 @smallexample
25626 -> -exec-run
25627 <- ^running
25628 <- (gdb)
25629 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25630 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25631 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25632 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25633 <- (gdb)
25634 -> -exec-continue
25635 <- ^running
25636 <- (gdb)
25637 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25638 <- (gdb)
25639 @end smallexample
25640
25641 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25642
25643 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25644
25645 @smallexample
25646 -> (gdb)
25647 <- -gdb-exit
25648 <- ^exit
25649 @end smallexample
25650
25651 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25652 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25653 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25654 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25655 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25656 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25657
25658 @subheading A Bad Command
25659
25660 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25661
25662 @smallexample
25663 -> -rubbish
25664 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25665 <- (gdb)
25666 @end smallexample
25667
25668
25669 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25670 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25671 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25672
25673 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25674 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25675
25676 @subheading Motivation
25677
25678 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25679
25680 @subheading Introduction
25681
25682 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25683
25684 @subheading Commands
25685
25686 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25687
25688 @subsubheading Synopsis
25689
25690 @smallexample
25691 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25692 @end smallexample
25693
25694 @subsubheading Result
25695
25696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25697
25698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25699
25700 @subsubheading Example
25701
25702 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25703 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25704
25705
25706 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25707 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25708 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25709
25710 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25711 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25712 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25713 breakpoints.
25714
25715 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25716 @findex -break-after
25717
25718 @subsubheading Synopsis
25719
25720 @smallexample
25721 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25722 @end smallexample
25723
25724 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25725 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25726 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25727 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25728
25729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25730
25731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25732
25733 @subsubheading Example
25734
25735 @smallexample
25736 (gdb)
25737 -break-insert main
25738 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25739 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25740 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25741 times="0"@}
25742 (gdb)
25743 -break-after 1 3
25744 ~
25745 ^done
25746 (gdb)
25747 -break-list
25748 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25749 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25750 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25751 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25752 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25753 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25754 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25755 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25756 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25757 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25758 (gdb)
25759 @end smallexample
25760
25761 @ignore
25762 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25763 @findex -break-catch
25764 @end ignore
25765
25766 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25767 @findex -break-commands
25768
25769 @subsubheading Synopsis
25770
25771 @smallexample
25772 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25773 @end smallexample
25774
25775 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25776 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25777 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25778 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25779 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25780 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25781
25782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25783
25784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25785
25786 @subsubheading Example
25787
25788 @smallexample
25789 (gdb)
25790 -break-insert main
25791 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25792 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25793 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25794 times="0"@}
25795 (gdb)
25796 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25797 ^done
25798 (gdb)
25799 @end smallexample
25800
25801 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25802 @findex -break-condition
25803
25804 @subsubheading Synopsis
25805
25806 @smallexample
25807 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25808 @end smallexample
25809
25810 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25811 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25812 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25813 command below).
25814
25815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25816
25817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25818
25819 @subsubheading Example
25820
25821 @smallexample
25822 (gdb)
25823 -break-condition 1 1
25824 ^done
25825 (gdb)
25826 -break-list
25827 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25828 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25829 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25830 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25831 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25832 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25833 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25834 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25835 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25836 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25837 (gdb)
25838 @end smallexample
25839
25840 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25841 @findex -break-delete
25842
25843 @subsubheading Synopsis
25844
25845 @smallexample
25846 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25847 @end smallexample
25848
25849 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25850 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25851
25852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25853
25854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25855
25856 @subsubheading Example
25857
25858 @smallexample
25859 (gdb)
25860 -break-delete 1
25861 ^done
25862 (gdb)
25863 -break-list
25864 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25865 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25866 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25867 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25868 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25869 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25870 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25871 body=[]@}
25872 (gdb)
25873 @end smallexample
25874
25875 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25876 @findex -break-disable
25877
25878 @subsubheading Synopsis
25879
25880 @smallexample
25881 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25882 @end smallexample
25883
25884 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25885 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25886
25887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25888
25889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25890
25891 @subsubheading Example
25892
25893 @smallexample
25894 (gdb)
25895 -break-disable 2
25896 ^done
25897 (gdb)
25898 -break-list
25899 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25900 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25901 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25902 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25903 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25904 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25905 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25906 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25907 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25908 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25909 (gdb)
25910 @end smallexample
25911
25912 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25913 @findex -break-enable
25914
25915 @subsubheading Synopsis
25916
25917 @smallexample
25918 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25919 @end smallexample
25920
25921 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25922
25923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25924
25925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25926
25927 @subsubheading Example
25928
25929 @smallexample
25930 (gdb)
25931 -break-enable 2
25932 ^done
25933 (gdb)
25934 -break-list
25935 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25936 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25937 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25938 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25939 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25940 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25941 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25942 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25943 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25944 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25945 (gdb)
25946 @end smallexample
25947
25948 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25949 @findex -break-info
25950
25951 @subsubheading Synopsis
25952
25953 @smallexample
25954 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25955 @end smallexample
25956
25957 @c REDUNDANT???
25958 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25959
25960 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
25961 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
25962 table.
25963
25964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25965
25966 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25967
25968 @subsubheading Example
25969 N.A.
25970
25971 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25972 @findex -break-insert
25973
25974 @subsubheading Synopsis
25975
25976 @smallexample
25977 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25978 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25979 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
25980 @end smallexample
25981
25982 @noindent
25983 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25984
25985 @itemize @bullet
25986 @item function
25987 @c @item +offset
25988 @c @item -offset
25989 @c @item linenum
25990 @item filename:linenum
25991 @item filename:function
25992 @item *address
25993 @end itemize
25994
25995 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25996
25997 @table @samp
25998 @item -t
25999 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26000 @item -h
26001 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26002 @item -f
26003 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26004 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26005 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26006 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26007 cannot be parsed.
26008 @item -d
26009 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26010 @item -a
26011 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26012 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26013 @item -c @var{condition}
26014 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26015 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26016 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26017 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26018 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26019 @end table
26020
26021 @subsubheading Result
26022
26023 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26024 resulting breakpoint.
26025
26026 Note: this format is open to change.
26027 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26028
26029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26030
26031 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26032 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26033
26034 @subsubheading Example
26035
26036 @smallexample
26037 (gdb)
26038 -break-insert main
26039 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26040 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26041 times="0"@}
26042 (gdb)
26043 -break-insert -t foo
26044 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26045 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26046 times="0"@}
26047 (gdb)
26048 -break-list
26049 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26050 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26051 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26052 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26053 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26054 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26055 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26056 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26057 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26058 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26059 times="0"@},
26060 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26061 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26062 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26063 times="0"@}]@}
26064 (gdb)
26065 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26066 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26067 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26068 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26069 @c times="0"@}
26070 @c (gdb)
26071 @end smallexample
26072
26073 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26074 @findex -dprintf-insert
26075
26076 @subsubheading Synopsis
26077
26078 @smallexample
26079 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26080 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26081 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26082 [ @var{argument} ]
26083 @end smallexample
26084
26085 @noindent
26086 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26087
26088 @itemize @bullet
26089 @item @var{function}
26090 @c @item +offset
26091 @c @item -offset
26092 @c @item @var{linenum}
26093 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26094 @item @var{filename}:function
26095 @item *@var{address}
26096 @end itemize
26097
26098 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26099
26100 @table @samp
26101 @item -t
26102 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26103 @item -f
26104 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26105 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26106 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26107 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26108 cannot be parsed.
26109 @item -d
26110 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26111 @item -c @var{condition}
26112 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26113 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26114 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26115 to @var{ignore-count}.
26116 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26117 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26118 @end table
26119
26120 @subsubheading Result
26121
26122 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26123 resulting breakpoint.
26124
26125 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26126
26127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26128
26129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26130
26131 @subsubheading Example
26132
26133 @smallexample
26134 (gdb)
26135 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26136 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26137 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26138 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26139 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26140 original-location="foo"@}
26141 (gdb)
26142 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26143 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26144 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26145 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26146 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26147 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26148 (gdb)
26149 @end smallexample
26150
26151 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26152 @findex -break-list
26153
26154 @subsubheading Synopsis
26155
26156 @smallexample
26157 -break-list
26158 @end smallexample
26159
26160 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26161
26162 @table @samp
26163 @item Number
26164 number of the breakpoint
26165 @item Type
26166 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26167 @item Disposition
26168 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26169 or @samp{nokeep}
26170 @item Enabled
26171 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26172 @item Address
26173 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26174 @item What
26175 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26176 name, line number
26177 @item Thread-groups
26178 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26179 @item Times
26180 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26181 @end table
26182
26183 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26184 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26185
26186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26187
26188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26189
26190 @subsubheading Example
26191
26192 @smallexample
26193 (gdb)
26194 -break-list
26195 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26196 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26197 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26198 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26199 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26200 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26201 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26202 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26203 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26204 times="0"@},
26205 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26206 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26207 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26208 (gdb)
26209 @end smallexample
26210
26211 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26212
26213 @smallexample
26214 (gdb)
26215 -break-list
26216 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26217 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26218 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26219 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26220 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26221 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26222 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26223 body=[]@}
26224 (gdb)
26225 @end smallexample
26226
26227 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26228 @findex -break-passcount
26229
26230 @subsubheading Synopsis
26231
26232 @smallexample
26233 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26234 @end smallexample
26235
26236 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26237 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26238 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26239 command @samp{passcount}.
26240
26241 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26242 @findex -break-watch
26243
26244 @subsubheading Synopsis
26245
26246 @smallexample
26247 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26248 @end smallexample
26249
26250 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26251 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26252 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26253 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26254 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26255 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26256 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26257 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26258
26259 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26260 breakpoints inserted.
26261
26262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26263
26264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26265 @samp{rwatch}.
26266
26267 @subsubheading Example
26268
26269 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26270
26271 @smallexample
26272 (gdb)
26273 -break-watch x
26274 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26275 (gdb)
26276 -exec-continue
26277 ^running
26278 (gdb)
26279 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26280 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26281 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26282 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26283 (gdb)
26284 @end smallexample
26285
26286 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26287 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26288 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26289
26290 @smallexample
26291 (gdb)
26292 -break-watch C
26293 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26294 (gdb)
26295 -exec-continue
26296 ^running
26297 (gdb)
26298 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26299 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26300 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26301 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26302 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26303 (gdb)
26304 -exec-continue
26305 ^running
26306 (gdb)
26307 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26308 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26309 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26310 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26311 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26312 (gdb)
26313 @end smallexample
26314
26315 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26316 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26317 deleted.
26318
26319 @smallexample
26320 (gdb)
26321 -break-watch C
26322 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26323 (gdb)
26324 -break-list
26325 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26326 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26327 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26328 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26329 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26330 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26331 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26332 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26333 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26334 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26335 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26336 times="1"@},
26337 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26338 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26339 (gdb)
26340 -exec-continue
26341 ^running
26342 (gdb)
26343 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26344 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26345 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26346 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26347 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26348 (gdb)
26349 -break-list
26350 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26351 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26352 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26353 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26354 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26355 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26356 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26357 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26358 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26359 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26360 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26361 times="1"@},
26362 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26363 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26364 (gdb)
26365 -exec-continue
26366 ^running
26367 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26368 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26369 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26370 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26371 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26372 (gdb)
26373 -break-list
26374 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26375 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26376 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26377 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26378 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26379 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26380 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26381 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26382 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26383 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26384 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26385 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26386 (gdb)
26387 @end smallexample
26388
26389
26390 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26391 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26392 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26393
26394 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26395 catchpoints.
26396
26397 @menu
26398 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26399 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26400 @end menu
26401
26402 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26403 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26404
26405 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26406 @findex -catch-load
26407
26408 @subsubheading Synopsis
26409
26410 @smallexample
26411 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26412 @end smallexample
26413
26414 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26415 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26416 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26417 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26418 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26419
26420
26421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26422
26423 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26424
26425 @subsubheading Example
26426
26427 @smallexample
26428 -catch-load -t foo.so
26429 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26430 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26431 (gdb)
26432 @end smallexample
26433
26434
26435 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26436 @findex -catch-unload
26437
26438 @subsubheading Synopsis
26439
26440 @smallexample
26441 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26442 @end smallexample
26443
26444 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26445 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26446 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26447 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26448 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26449
26450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26451
26452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26453
26454 @subsubheading Example
26455
26456 @smallexample
26457 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26458 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26459 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26460 (gdb)
26461 @end smallexample
26462
26463 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26464 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26465
26466 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26467 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26468
26469 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26470 @findex -catch-assert
26471
26472 @subsubheading Synopsis
26473
26474 @smallexample
26475 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26476 @end smallexample
26477
26478 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26479
26480 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26481
26482 @table @samp
26483 @item -c @var{condition}
26484 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26485 @item -d
26486 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26487 @item -t
26488 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26489 @end table
26490
26491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26492
26493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26494
26495 @subsubheading Example
26496
26497 @smallexample
26498 -catch-assert
26499 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26500 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26501 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26502 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26503 (gdb)
26504 @end smallexample
26505
26506 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26507 @findex -catch-exception
26508
26509 @subsubheading Synopsis
26510
26511 @smallexample
26512 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26513 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26514 @end smallexample
26515
26516 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26517 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26518 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26519 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26520 catchpoints.
26521
26522 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26523
26524 @table @samp
26525 @item -c @var{condition}
26526 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26527 @item -d
26528 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26529 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26530 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26531 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26532 @item -t
26533 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26534 @item -u
26535 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26536 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26537 @end table
26538
26539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26540
26541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26542 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26543
26544 @subsubheading Example
26545
26546 @smallexample
26547 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26548 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26549 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26550 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26551 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26552 (gdb)
26553 @end smallexample
26554
26555 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26556 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26557 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26558
26559 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26560 @findex -exec-arguments
26561
26562
26563 @subsubheading Synopsis
26564
26565 @smallexample
26566 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26567 @end smallexample
26568
26569 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26570 @samp{-exec-run}.
26571
26572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26573
26574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26575
26576 @subsubheading Example
26577
26578 @smallexample
26579 (gdb)
26580 -exec-arguments -v word
26581 ^done
26582 (gdb)
26583 @end smallexample
26584
26585
26586 @ignore
26587 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26588 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26589
26590 @subsubheading Synopsis
26591
26592 @smallexample
26593 -exec-show-arguments
26594 @end smallexample
26595
26596 Print the arguments of the program.
26597
26598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26599
26600 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26601
26602 @subsubheading Example
26603 N.A.
26604 @end ignore
26605
26606
26607 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26608 @findex -environment-cd
26609
26610 @subsubheading Synopsis
26611
26612 @smallexample
26613 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26614 @end smallexample
26615
26616 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26617
26618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26619
26620 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26621
26622 @subsubheading Example
26623
26624 @smallexample
26625 (gdb)
26626 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26627 ^done
26628 (gdb)
26629 @end smallexample
26630
26631
26632 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26633 @findex -environment-directory
26634
26635 @subsubheading Synopsis
26636
26637 @smallexample
26638 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26639 @end smallexample
26640
26641 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26642 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26643 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26644 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26645 occurs as normal.
26646 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26647 multiple directories in a single command
26648 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26649 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26650 If blanks are needed as
26651 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26652 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26653 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26654 character must not be used
26655 in any directory name.
26656 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26657
26658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26659
26660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26661
26662 @subsubheading Example
26663
26664 @smallexample
26665 (gdb)
26666 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26667 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26668 (gdb)
26669 -environment-directory ""
26670 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26671 (gdb)
26672 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26673 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26674 (gdb)
26675 -environment-directory -r
26676 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26677 (gdb)
26678 @end smallexample
26679
26680
26681 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26682 @findex -environment-path
26683
26684 @subsubheading Synopsis
26685
26686 @smallexample
26687 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26688 @end smallexample
26689
26690 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26691 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26692 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26693 supplied in addition to the
26694 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26695 occurs as normal.
26696 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26697 multiple directories in a single command
26698 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26699 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26700 If blanks are needed as
26701 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26702 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26703 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26704 character must not be used
26705 in any directory name.
26706 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26707
26708
26709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26710
26711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26712
26713 @subsubheading Example
26714
26715 @smallexample
26716 (gdb)
26717 -environment-path
26718 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26719 (gdb)
26720 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26721 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26722 (gdb)
26723 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26724 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26725 (gdb)
26726 @end smallexample
26727
26728
26729 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26730 @findex -environment-pwd
26731
26732 @subsubheading Synopsis
26733
26734 @smallexample
26735 -environment-pwd
26736 @end smallexample
26737
26738 Show the current working directory.
26739
26740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26741
26742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26743
26744 @subsubheading Example
26745
26746 @smallexample
26747 (gdb)
26748 -environment-pwd
26749 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26750 (gdb)
26751 @end smallexample
26752
26753 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26754 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26755 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26756
26757
26758 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26759 @findex -thread-info
26760
26761 @subsubheading Synopsis
26762
26763 @smallexample
26764 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26765 @end smallexample
26766
26767 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26768 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26769 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26770 also reports the current thread.
26771
26772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26773
26774 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26775 about all threads.
26776
26777 @subsubheading Result
26778
26779 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26780 defined for a given thread:
26781
26782 @table @samp
26783 @item current
26784 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26785
26786 @item id
26787 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26788
26789 @item target-id
26790 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26791
26792 @item details
26793 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26794 field is optional.
26795
26796 @item name
26797 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26798 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26799 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26800 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26801 field is omitted.
26802
26803 @item frame
26804 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26805
26806 @item state
26807 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26808 values:
26809
26810 @table @code
26811 @item stopped
26812 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26813 threads.
26814
26815 @item running
26816 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26817 threads.
26818
26819 @end table
26820
26821 @item core
26822 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26823 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26824
26825 @end table
26826
26827 @subsubheading Example
26828
26829 @smallexample
26830 -thread-info
26831 ^done,threads=[
26832 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26833 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26834 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26835 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26836 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26837 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26838 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26839 state="running"@}],
26840 current-thread-id="1"
26841 (gdb)
26842 @end smallexample
26843
26844 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26845 @findex -thread-list-ids
26846
26847 @subsubheading Synopsis
26848
26849 @smallexample
26850 -thread-list-ids
26851 @end smallexample
26852
26853 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26854 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26855
26856 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26857 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26858
26859 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26860
26861 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26862
26863 @subsubheading Example
26864
26865 @smallexample
26866 (gdb)
26867 -thread-list-ids
26868 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26869 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26870 (gdb)
26871 @end smallexample
26872
26873
26874 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26875 @findex -thread-select
26876
26877 @subsubheading Synopsis
26878
26879 @smallexample
26880 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26881 @end smallexample
26882
26883 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26884 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26885
26886 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26887 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26888
26889 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26890
26891 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26892
26893 @subsubheading Example
26894
26895 @smallexample
26896 (gdb)
26897 -exec-next
26898 ^running
26899 (gdb)
26900 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26901 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26902 (gdb)
26903 -thread-list-ids
26904 ^done,
26905 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26906 number-of-threads="3"
26907 (gdb)
26908 -thread-select 3
26909 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26910 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
26911 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
26912 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
26913 (gdb)
26914 @end smallexample
26915
26916 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26917 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
26918 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
26919
26920 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
26921 @findex -ada-task-info
26922
26923 @subsubheading Synopsis
26924
26925 @smallexample
26926 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
26927 @end smallexample
26928
26929 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
26930 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
26931
26932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26933
26934 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
26935 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
26936
26937 @subsubheading Result
26938
26939 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
26940 defined for each Ada task:
26941
26942 @table @samp
26943 @item current
26944 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26945
26946 @item id
26947 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
26948
26949 @item task-id
26950 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
26951
26952 @item thread-id
26953 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
26954
26955 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
26956 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
26957 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
26958
26959 @item parent-id
26960 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
26961 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
26962
26963 @item priority
26964 The base priority of the task.
26965
26966 @item state
26967 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
26968 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
26969
26970 @item name
26971 The name of the task.
26972
26973 @end table
26974
26975 @subsubheading Example
26976
26977 @smallexample
26978 -ada-task-info
26979 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
26980 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
26981 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
26982 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
26983 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
26984 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
26985 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
26986 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
26987 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
26988 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
26989 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
26990 (gdb)
26991 @end smallexample
26992
26993 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26994 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
26995 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
26996
26997 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
26998 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
26999 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27000 other cases.
27001
27002 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27003 @findex -exec-continue
27004
27005 @subsubheading Synopsis
27006
27007 @smallexample
27008 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27009 @end smallexample
27010
27011 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27012 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27013 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27014 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27015 @itemize @bullet
27016 @item
27017 breakpoints or watchpoints
27018 @item
27019 signals or exceptions
27020 @item
27021 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27022 @item
27023 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27024 @end itemize
27025 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27026 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27027 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27028 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27029 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27030 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27031
27032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27033
27034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27035
27036 @subsubheading Example
27037
27038 @smallexample
27039 -exec-continue
27040 ^running
27041 (gdb)
27042 @@Hello world
27043 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27044 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27045 line="13"@}
27046 (gdb)
27047 @end smallexample
27048
27049
27050 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27051 @findex -exec-finish
27052
27053 @subsubheading Synopsis
27054
27055 @smallexample
27056 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27057 @end smallexample
27058
27059 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27060 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27061 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27062 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27063 function was called.
27064
27065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27066
27067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27068
27069 @subsubheading Example
27070
27071 Function returning @code{void}.
27072
27073 @smallexample
27074 -exec-finish
27075 ^running
27076 (gdb)
27077 @@hello from foo
27078 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27079 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27080 (gdb)
27081 @end smallexample
27082
27083 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27084 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27085 value itself.
27086
27087 @smallexample
27088 -exec-finish
27089 ^running
27090 (gdb)
27091 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27092 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27093 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27094 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27095 (gdb)
27096 @end smallexample
27097
27098
27099 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27100 @findex -exec-interrupt
27101
27102 @subsubheading Synopsis
27103
27104 @smallexample
27105 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27106 @end smallexample
27107
27108 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27109 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27110 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27111 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27112 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27113
27114 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27115 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27116 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27117 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27118
27119 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27120 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27121 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27122 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27123
27124 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27125
27126 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27127
27128 @subsubheading Example
27129
27130 @smallexample
27131 (gdb)
27132 111-exec-continue
27133 111^running
27134
27135 (gdb)
27136 222-exec-interrupt
27137 222^done
27138 (gdb)
27139 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27140 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27141 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27142 (gdb)
27143
27144 (gdb)
27145 -exec-interrupt
27146 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27147 (gdb)
27148 @end smallexample
27149
27150 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27151 @findex -exec-jump
27152
27153 @subsubheading Synopsis
27154
27155 @smallexample
27156 -exec-jump @var{location}
27157 @end smallexample
27158
27159 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27160 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27161 different forms of @var{location}.
27162
27163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27164
27165 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27166
27167 @subsubheading Example
27168
27169 @smallexample
27170 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27171 *running,thread-id="all"
27172 ^running
27173 @end smallexample
27174
27175
27176 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27177 @findex -exec-next
27178
27179 @subsubheading Synopsis
27180
27181 @smallexample
27182 -exec-next [--reverse]
27183 @end smallexample
27184
27185 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27186 of the next source line is reached.
27187
27188 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27189 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27190 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27191 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27192 source line where the function was called.
27193
27194
27195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27196
27197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27198
27199 @subsubheading Example
27200
27201 @smallexample
27202 -exec-next
27203 ^running
27204 (gdb)
27205 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27206 (gdb)
27207 @end smallexample
27208
27209
27210 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27211 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27212
27213 @subsubheading Synopsis
27214
27215 @smallexample
27216 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27217 @end smallexample
27218
27219 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27220 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27221 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27222 printed as well.
27223
27224 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27225 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27226 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27227 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27228 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27229
27230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27231
27232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27233
27234 @subsubheading Example
27235
27236 @smallexample
27237 (gdb)
27238 -exec-next-instruction
27239 ^running
27240
27241 (gdb)
27242 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27243 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27244 (gdb)
27245 @end smallexample
27246
27247
27248 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27249 @findex -exec-return
27250
27251 @subsubheading Synopsis
27252
27253 @smallexample
27254 -exec-return
27255 @end smallexample
27256
27257 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27258 Displays the new current frame.
27259
27260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27261
27262 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27263
27264 @subsubheading Example
27265
27266 @smallexample
27267 (gdb)
27268 200-break-insert callee4
27269 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27270 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27271 (gdb)
27272 000-exec-run
27273 000^running
27274 (gdb)
27275 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27276 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27278 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27279 (gdb)
27280 205-break-delete
27281 205^done
27282 (gdb)
27283 111-exec-return
27284 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27285 args=[@{name="strarg",
27286 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27288 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27289 (gdb)
27290 @end smallexample
27291
27292
27293 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27294 @findex -exec-run
27295
27296 @subsubheading Synopsis
27297
27298 @smallexample
27299 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27300 @end smallexample
27301
27302 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27303 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27304 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27305 the program has exited exceptionally.
27306
27307 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27308 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27309 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27310 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27311 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27312
27313 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27314 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27315 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27316 (@pxref{Starting}).
27317
27318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27319
27320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27321
27322 @subsubheading Examples
27323
27324 @smallexample
27325 (gdb)
27326 -break-insert main
27327 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27328 (gdb)
27329 -exec-run
27330 ^running
27331 (gdb)
27332 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27333 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27334 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27335 (gdb)
27336 @end smallexample
27337
27338 @noindent
27339 Program exited normally:
27340
27341 @smallexample
27342 (gdb)
27343 -exec-run
27344 ^running
27345 (gdb)
27346 x = 55
27347 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27348 (gdb)
27349 @end smallexample
27350
27351 @noindent
27352 Program exited exceptionally:
27353
27354 @smallexample
27355 (gdb)
27356 -exec-run
27357 ^running
27358 (gdb)
27359 x = 55
27360 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27361 (gdb)
27362 @end smallexample
27363
27364 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27365 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27366
27367 @smallexample
27368 (gdb)
27369 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27370 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27371 @end smallexample
27372
27373
27374 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27375
27376
27377 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27378 @findex -exec-step
27379
27380 @subsubheading Synopsis
27381
27382 @smallexample
27383 -exec-step [--reverse]
27384 @end smallexample
27385
27386 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27387 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27388 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27389 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27390 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27391 previously executed source line.
27392
27393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27394
27395 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27396
27397 @subsubheading Example
27398
27399 Stepping into a function:
27400
27401 @smallexample
27402 -exec-step
27403 ^running
27404 (gdb)
27405 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27406 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27407 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27408 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27409 (gdb)
27410 @end smallexample
27411
27412 Regular stepping:
27413
27414 @smallexample
27415 -exec-step
27416 ^running
27417 (gdb)
27418 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27419 (gdb)
27420 @end smallexample
27421
27422
27423 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27424 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27425
27426 @subsubheading Synopsis
27427
27428 @smallexample
27429 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27430 @end smallexample
27431
27432 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27433 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27434 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27435 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27436 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27437 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27438 as well.
27439
27440 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27441
27442 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27443
27444 @subsubheading Example
27445
27446 @smallexample
27447 (gdb)
27448 -exec-step-instruction
27449 ^running
27450
27451 (gdb)
27452 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27453 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27454 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27455 (gdb)
27456 -exec-step-instruction
27457 ^running
27458
27459 (gdb)
27460 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27461 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27462 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27463 (gdb)
27464 @end smallexample
27465
27466
27467 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27468 @findex -exec-until
27469
27470 @subsubheading Synopsis
27471
27472 @smallexample
27473 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27474 @end smallexample
27475
27476 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27477 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27478 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27479 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27480
27481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27482
27483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27484
27485 @subsubheading Example
27486
27487 @smallexample
27488 (gdb)
27489 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27490 ^running
27491 (gdb)
27492 x = 55
27493 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27494 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27495 (gdb)
27496 @end smallexample
27497
27498 @ignore
27499 @subheading -file-clear
27500 Is this going away????
27501 @end ignore
27502
27503 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27504 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27505 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27506
27507 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27508 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27509
27510 @smallexample
27511 -enable-frame-filters
27512 @end smallexample
27513
27514 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27515 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27516 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27517 request that this functionality be enabled.
27518
27519 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27520
27521 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27522 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27523
27524 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27525 @findex -stack-info-frame
27526
27527 @subsubheading Synopsis
27528
27529 @smallexample
27530 -stack-info-frame
27531 @end smallexample
27532
27533 Get info on the selected frame.
27534
27535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27536
27537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27538 (without arguments).
27539
27540 @subsubheading Example
27541
27542 @smallexample
27543 (gdb)
27544 -stack-info-frame
27545 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27546 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27547 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27548 (gdb)
27549 @end smallexample
27550
27551 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27552 @findex -stack-info-depth
27553
27554 @subsubheading Synopsis
27555
27556 @smallexample
27557 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27558 @end smallexample
27559
27560 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27561 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27562
27563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27564
27565 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27566
27567 @subsubheading Example
27568
27569 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27570
27571 @smallexample
27572 (gdb)
27573 -stack-info-depth
27574 ^done,depth="12"
27575 (gdb)
27576 -stack-info-depth 4
27577 ^done,depth="4"
27578 (gdb)
27579 -stack-info-depth 12
27580 ^done,depth="12"
27581 (gdb)
27582 -stack-info-depth 11
27583 ^done,depth="11"
27584 (gdb)
27585 -stack-info-depth 13
27586 ^done,depth="12"
27587 (gdb)
27588 @end smallexample
27589
27590 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27591 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27592 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27593
27594 @subsubheading Synopsis
27595
27596 @smallexample
27597 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27598 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27599 @end smallexample
27600
27601 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27602 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27603 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27604 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27605 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27606 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27607 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27608 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27609
27610 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27611 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27612 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27613 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27614 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27615 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27616
27617 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27618 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27619 are still displayed, however.
27620
27621 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27622 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27623
27624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27625
27626 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27627 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27628 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27629
27630 @subsubheading Example
27631
27632 @smallexample
27633 (gdb)
27634 -stack-list-frames
27635 ^done,
27636 stack=[
27637 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27638 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27639 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27640 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27641 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27642 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27643 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27644 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27645 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27646 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27647 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27648 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27649 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27650 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27651 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27652 (gdb)
27653 -stack-list-arguments 0
27654 ^done,
27655 stack-args=[
27656 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27657 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27658 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27659 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27660 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27661 (gdb)
27662 -stack-list-arguments 1
27663 ^done,
27664 stack-args=[
27665 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27666 frame=@{level="1",
27667 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27668 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27669 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27670 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27671 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27672 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27673 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27674 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27675 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27676 (gdb)
27677 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27678 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27679 (gdb)
27680 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27681 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27682 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27683 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27684 (gdb)
27685 @end smallexample
27686
27687 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27688
27689
27690 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27691 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27692 @findex -stack-list-frames
27693
27694 @subsubheading Synopsis
27695
27696 @smallexample
27697 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27698 @end smallexample
27699
27700 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27701 following info:
27702
27703 @table @samp
27704 @item @var{level}
27705 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27706 @item @var{addr}
27707 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27708 @item @var{func}
27709 Function name.
27710 @item @var{file}
27711 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27712 @item @var{fullname}
27713 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27714 @item @var{line}
27715 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27716 @item @var{from}
27717 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27718 if the frame's function is not known.
27719 @end table
27720
27721 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27722 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27723 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27724 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27725 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27726 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27727 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27728 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27729 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27730
27731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27732
27733 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27734
27735 @subsubheading Example
27736
27737 Full stack backtrace:
27738
27739 @smallexample
27740 (gdb)
27741 -stack-list-frames
27742 ^done,stack=
27743 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27744 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27745 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27746 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27747 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27748 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27749 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27750 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27751 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27752 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27753 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27754 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27755 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27756 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27757 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27758 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27759 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27760 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27761 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27762 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27763 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27764 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27765 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27766 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27767 (gdb)
27768 @end smallexample
27769
27770 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27771
27772 @smallexample
27773 (gdb)
27774 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27775 ^done,stack=
27776 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27777 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27778 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27779 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27780 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27781 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27782 (gdb)
27783 @end smallexample
27784
27785 Show a single frame:
27786
27787 @smallexample
27788 (gdb)
27789 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27790 ^done,stack=
27791 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27792 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27793 (gdb)
27794 @end smallexample
27795
27796
27797 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27798 @findex -stack-list-locals
27799 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27800
27801 @subsubheading Synopsis
27802
27803 @smallexample
27804 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27805 @end smallexample
27806
27807 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27808 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27809 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27810 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27811 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27812 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27813 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27814 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27815 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27816 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27817
27818 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27819 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27820 variables are still displayed, however.
27821
27822 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27823 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27824
27825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27826
27827 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27828
27829 @subsubheading Example
27830
27831 @smallexample
27832 (gdb)
27833 -stack-list-locals 0
27834 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27835 (gdb)
27836 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27837 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27838 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27839 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27840 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27841 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27842 (gdb)
27843 @end smallexample
27844
27845 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
27846 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27847 @findex -stack-list-variables
27848
27849 @subsubheading Synopsis
27850
27851 @smallexample
27852 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27853 @end smallexample
27854
27855 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27856 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27857 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27858 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27859 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27860 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27861 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27862
27863 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27864 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
27865 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
27866
27867 @subsubheading Example
27868
27869 @smallexample
27870 (gdb)
27871 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27872 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27873 (gdb)
27874 @end smallexample
27875
27876
27877 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27878 @findex -stack-select-frame
27879
27880 @subsubheading Synopsis
27881
27882 @smallexample
27883 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27884 @end smallexample
27885
27886 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27887 the stack.
27888
27889 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27890 option to every command.
27891
27892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27893
27894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27895 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27896
27897 @subsubheading Example
27898
27899 @smallexample
27900 (gdb)
27901 -stack-select-frame 2
27902 ^done
27903 (gdb)
27904 @end smallexample
27905
27906 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27907 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
27908 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
27909
27910 @ignore
27911
27912 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27913
27914 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
27915 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
27916 used by @code{Insight}.
27917
27918 The two main reasons for that are:
27919
27920 @enumerate 1
27921 @item
27922 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
27923
27924 @item
27925 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
27926 now).
27927 @end enumerate
27928
27929 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
27930 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
27931 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
27932 hints about their use.
27933
27934 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
27935 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
27936 least, the following operations:
27937
27938 @itemize @bullet
27939 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
27940 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
27941 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
27942 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
27943 @end itemize
27944
27945 @end ignore
27946
27947 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
27948
27949 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27950
27951 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
27952 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
27953 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
27954 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
27955 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
27956 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
27957 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
27958 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
27959 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
27960 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
27961 object, or to change display format.
27962
27963 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
27964 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
27965 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
27966 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
27967 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
27968 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
27969 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
27970 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
27971 child will be created.
27972
27973 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
27974 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
27975 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
27976 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
27977 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
27978
27979 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
27980 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
27981 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
27982 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
27983 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
27984 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
27985 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
27986 variables that frontend has created.
27987
27988 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
27989 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
27990 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
27991 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
27992 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
27993 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
27994 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
27995 implicitly updated.
27996
27997 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
27998 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
27999 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28000 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28001 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28002 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28003 frame. Consider this example:
28004
28005 @smallexample
28006 void do_work(...)
28007 @{
28008 struct work_state state;
28009
28010 if (...)
28011 do_work(...);
28012 @}
28013 @end smallexample
28014
28015 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28016 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28017 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28018 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28019 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28020
28021 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28022 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28023 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28024 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28025 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28026 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28027
28028 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28029 access this functionality:
28030
28031 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28032 @item @strong{Operation}
28033 @tab @strong{Description}
28034
28035 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28036 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28037 @item @code{-var-create}
28038 @tab create a variable object
28039 @item @code{-var-delete}
28040 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28041 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28042 @tab set the display format of this variable
28043 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28044 @tab show the display format of this variable
28045 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28046 @tab tells how many children this object has
28047 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28048 @tab return a list of the object's children
28049 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28050 @tab show the type of this variable object
28051 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28052 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28053 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28054 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28055 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28056 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28057 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28058 @tab get the value of this variable
28059 @item @code{-var-assign}
28060 @tab set the value of this variable
28061 @item @code{-var-update}
28062 @tab update the variable and its children
28063 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28064 @tab set frozeness attribute
28065 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28066 @tab set range of children to display on update
28067 @end multitable
28068
28069 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28070 how it can be used.
28071
28072 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28073
28074 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28075 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28076
28077 @smallexample
28078 -enable-pretty-printing
28079 @end smallexample
28080
28081 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28082 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28083 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28084 request that this functionality be enabled.
28085
28086 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28087
28088 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28089 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28090
28091 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28092 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28093
28094 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28095 @findex -var-create
28096
28097 @subsubheading Synopsis
28098
28099 @smallexample
28100 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28101 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28102 @end smallexample
28103
28104 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28105 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28106 register.
28107
28108 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28109 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28110 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28111 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28112 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28113
28114 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28115 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28116 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28117 object must be created.
28118
28119 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28120 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28121
28122 @itemize @bullet
28123 @item
28124 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28125
28126 @item
28127 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28128
28129 @item
28130 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28131 @end itemize
28132
28133 @cindex dynamic varobj
28134 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28135 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28136 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28137 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28138 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28139 compatibility for existing clients.
28140
28141 @subsubheading Result
28142
28143 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28144 are:
28145
28146 @table @samp
28147 @item name
28148 The name of the varobj.
28149
28150 @item numchild
28151 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28152 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28153 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28154
28155 @item value
28156 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28157 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28158 will not be interesting.
28159
28160 @item type
28161 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28162 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28163 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28164 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28165 @emph{declared} one.
28166
28167 @item thread-id
28168 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28169 thread's identifier.
28170
28171 @item has_more
28172 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28173 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28174
28175 @item dynamic
28176 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28177 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28178 then this attribute will not be present.
28179
28180 @item displayhint
28181 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28182 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28183 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28184 @end table
28185
28186 Typical output will look like this:
28187
28188 @smallexample
28189 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28190 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28191 @end smallexample
28192
28193
28194 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28195 @findex -var-delete
28196
28197 @subsubheading Synopsis
28198
28199 @smallexample
28200 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28201 @end smallexample
28202
28203 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28204 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28205
28206 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28207
28208
28209 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28210 @findex -var-set-format
28211
28212 @subsubheading Synopsis
28213
28214 @smallexample
28215 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28216 @end smallexample
28217
28218 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28219 @var{format-spec}.
28220
28221 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28222 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28223
28224 @smallexample
28225 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28226 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28227 @end smallexample
28228
28229 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28230 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28231 for pointers, etc.).
28232
28233 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28234 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28235
28236 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28237 @findex -var-show-format
28238
28239 @subsubheading Synopsis
28240
28241 @smallexample
28242 -var-show-format @var{name}
28243 @end smallexample
28244
28245 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28246
28247 @smallexample
28248 @var{format} @expansion{}
28249 @var{format-spec}
28250 @end smallexample
28251
28252
28253 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28254 @findex -var-info-num-children
28255
28256 @subsubheading Synopsis
28257
28258 @smallexample
28259 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28260 @end smallexample
28261
28262 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28263
28264 @smallexample
28265 numchild=@var{n}
28266 @end smallexample
28267
28268 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28269 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28270 be available.
28271
28272
28273 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28274 @findex -var-list-children
28275
28276 @subsubheading Synopsis
28277
28278 @smallexample
28279 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28280 @end smallexample
28281 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28282
28283 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28284 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28285 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28286 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28287 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28288 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28289 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28290 and unions.
28291
28292 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28293 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28294 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28295 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28296 reported.
28297
28298 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28299 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28300 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28301 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28302 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28303 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28304 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28305 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28306 the visible items.
28307
28308 For each child the following results are returned:
28309
28310 @table @var
28311
28312 @item name
28313 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28314
28315 @item exp
28316 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28317 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28318
28319 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28320 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28321
28322 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28323 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28324 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28325 type and value are not present.
28326
28327 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28328 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28329 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28330
28331 @item numchild
28332 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28333 0.
28334
28335 @item type
28336 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28337 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28338 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28339 @emph{declared} one.
28340
28341 @item value
28342 If values were requested, this is the value.
28343
28344 @item thread-id
28345 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28346 Otherwise this result is not present.
28347
28348 @item frozen
28349 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28350
28351 @item displayhint
28352 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28353 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28354 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28355
28356 @item dynamic
28357 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28358 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28359 then this attribute will not be present.
28360
28361 @end table
28362
28363 The result may have its own attributes:
28364
28365 @table @samp
28366 @item displayhint
28367 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28368 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28369 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28370
28371 @item has_more
28372 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28373 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28374 @end table
28375
28376 @subsubheading Example
28377
28378 @smallexample
28379 (gdb)
28380 -var-list-children n
28381 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28382 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28383 (gdb)
28384 -var-list-children --all-values n
28385 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28386 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28387 @end smallexample
28388
28389
28390 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28391 @findex -var-info-type
28392
28393 @subsubheading Synopsis
28394
28395 @smallexample
28396 -var-info-type @var{name}
28397 @end smallexample
28398
28399 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28400 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28401 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28402
28403 @smallexample
28404 type=@var{typename}
28405 @end smallexample
28406
28407
28408 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28409 @findex -var-info-expression
28410
28411 @subsubheading Synopsis
28412
28413 @smallexample
28414 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28415 @end smallexample
28416
28417 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28418 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28419 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28420
28421 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28422 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28423
28424 @smallexample
28425 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28426 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28427 @end smallexample
28428
28429 @noindent
28430 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28431 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28432
28433 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28434 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28435 is of limited use.
28436
28437 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28438 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28439
28440 @subsubheading Synopsis
28441
28442 @smallexample
28443 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28444 @end smallexample
28445
28446 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28447 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28448 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28449 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28450 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28451 watchpoint from a variable object.
28452
28453 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28454 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28455
28456 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28457 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28458 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28459 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28460 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28461 @smallexample
28462 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28463 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28464 @end smallexample
28465
28466 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28467 @findex -var-show-attributes
28468
28469 @subsubheading Synopsis
28470
28471 @smallexample
28472 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28473 @end smallexample
28474
28475 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28476
28477 @smallexample
28478 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28479 @end smallexample
28480
28481 @noindent
28482 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28483
28484 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28485 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28486
28487 @subsubheading Synopsis
28488
28489 @smallexample
28490 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28491 @end smallexample
28492
28493 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28494 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28495 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28496 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28497 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28498 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28499 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28500
28501 @smallexample
28502 value=@var{value}
28503 @end smallexample
28504
28505 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28506 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28507
28508 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28509 @findex -var-assign
28510
28511 @subsubheading Synopsis
28512
28513 @smallexample
28514 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28515 @end smallexample
28516
28517 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28518 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28519 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28520 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28521
28522 @subsubheading Example
28523
28524 @smallexample
28525 (gdb)
28526 -var-assign var1 3
28527 ^done,value="3"
28528 (gdb)
28529 -var-update *
28530 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28531 (gdb)
28532 @end smallexample
28533
28534 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28535 @findex -var-update
28536
28537 @subsubheading Synopsis
28538
28539 @smallexample
28540 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28541 @end smallexample
28542
28543 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28544 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28545 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28546 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28547 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28548 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28549 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28550 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28551 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28552 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28553 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28554 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28555 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28556
28557 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28558 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28559 diagnostic.
28560
28561 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28562 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28563
28564 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28565 @samp{changelist}.
28566
28567 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28568
28569 @table @samp
28570 @item name
28571 The name of the varobj.
28572
28573 @item value
28574 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28575 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28576
28577 @item in_scope
28578 @anchor{-var-update}
28579 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28580
28581 @table @code
28582 @item "true"
28583 The variable object's current value is valid.
28584
28585 @item "false"
28586 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28587 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28588 scope.
28589
28590 @item "invalid"
28591 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28592 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28593 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28594 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28595 objects.
28596 @end table
28597
28598 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28599 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28600
28601 @item type_changed
28602 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28603 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28604 be @samp{false}.
28605
28606 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28607 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28608 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28609 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28610 unset.
28611
28612 @item new_type
28613 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28614 hold the new type.
28615
28616 @item new_num_children
28617 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28618 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28619
28620 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28621 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28622 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28623 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28624 children which may be available.
28625
28626 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28627 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28628 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28629 only happen at the end of the update range).
28630
28631 @item displayhint
28632 The display hint, if any.
28633
28634 @item has_more
28635 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28636 available outside the varobj's update range.
28637
28638 @item dynamic
28639 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28640 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28641 then this attribute will not be present.
28642
28643 @item new_children
28644 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28645 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28646 be listed in this attribute.
28647 @end table
28648
28649 @subsubheading Example
28650
28651 @smallexample
28652 (gdb)
28653 -var-assign var1 3
28654 ^done,value="3"
28655 (gdb)
28656 -var-update --all-values var1
28657 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28658 type_changed="false"@}]
28659 (gdb)
28660 @end smallexample
28661
28662 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28663 @findex -var-set-frozen
28664 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28665
28666 @subsubheading Synopsis
28667
28668 @smallexample
28669 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28670 @end smallexample
28671
28672 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28673 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28674 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28675 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28676 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28677 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28678 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28679 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28680 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28681 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28682 @code{-var-update} does.
28683
28684 @subsubheading Example
28685
28686 @smallexample
28687 (gdb)
28688 -var-set-frozen V 1
28689 ^done
28690 (gdb)
28691 @end smallexample
28692
28693 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28694 @findex -var-set-update-range
28695 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28696
28697 @subsubheading Synopsis
28698
28699 @smallexample
28700 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28701 @end smallexample
28702
28703 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28704 @code{-var-update}.
28705
28706 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28707 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28708 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28709 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28710
28711 @subsubheading Example
28712
28713 @smallexample
28714 (gdb)
28715 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28716 ^done
28717 @end smallexample
28718
28719 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28720 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28721 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28722
28723 @subsubheading Synopsis
28724
28725 @smallexample
28726 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28727 @end smallexample
28728
28729 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28730
28731 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28732 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28733
28734 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28735 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28736 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28737 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28738 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28739 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28740 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28741
28742 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28743 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28744 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28745 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28746
28747 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28748 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28749 can be used to check this.
28750
28751 @subsubheading Example
28752
28753 Resetting the visualizer:
28754
28755 @smallexample
28756 (gdb)
28757 -var-set-visualizer V None
28758 ^done
28759 @end smallexample
28760
28761 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28762
28763 @smallexample
28764 (gdb)
28765 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28766 ^done
28767 @end smallexample
28768
28769 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28770 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28771
28772 @smallexample
28773 (gdb)
28774 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28775 ^done
28776 @end smallexample
28777
28778 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28779 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28780 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28781
28782 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28783 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28784 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28785 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28786
28787 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28788 @c @subheading -data-assign
28789 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28790 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28791 @c set variable
28792 @c @subsubheading Example
28793 @c N.A.
28794
28795 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28796 @findex -data-disassemble
28797
28798 @subsubheading Synopsis
28799
28800 @smallexample
28801 -data-disassemble
28802 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28803 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28804 -- @var{mode}
28805 @end smallexample
28806
28807 @noindent
28808 Where:
28809
28810 @table @samp
28811 @item @var{start-addr}
28812 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28813 @item @var{end-addr}
28814 is the end address
28815 @item @var{filename}
28816 is the name of the file to disassemble
28817 @item @var{linenum}
28818 is the line number to disassemble around
28819 @item @var{lines}
28820 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28821 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28822 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28823 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28824 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28825 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28826 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28827 are displayed.
28828 @item @var{mode}
28829 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28830 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28831 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28832 @end table
28833
28834 @subsubheading Result
28835
28836 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
28837 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
28838 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
28839
28840 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
28841 following fields:
28842
28843 @table @code
28844 @item address
28845 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
28846
28847 @item func-name
28848 The name of the function this instruction is within.
28849
28850 @item offset
28851 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
28852
28853 @item inst
28854 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
28855
28856 @item opcodes
28857 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
28858 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
28859
28860 @end table
28861
28862 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
28863 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
28864
28865 @table @code
28866 @item line
28867 The line number within @samp{file}.
28868
28869 @item file
28870 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
28871 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
28872 used.
28873
28874 @item fullname
28875 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
28876 using the source file search path
28877 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
28878 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
28879
28880 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
28881 present in the debug information.
28882
28883 @item line_asm_insn
28884 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
28885 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
28886 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
28887 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
28888 @samp{opcodes}.
28889
28890 @end table
28891
28892 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
28893 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
28894 adjust its format.
28895
28896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28897
28898 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
28899
28900 @subsubheading Example
28901
28902 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28903
28904 @smallexample
28905 (gdb)
28906 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
28907 ^done,
28908 asm_insns=[
28909 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28910 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28911 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28912 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28913 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
28914 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
28915 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
28916 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28917 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
28918 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
28919 (gdb)
28920 @end smallexample
28921
28922 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
28923 @code{main}.
28924
28925 @smallexample
28926 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
28927 ^done,asm_insns=[
28928 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28929 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28930 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28931 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28932 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28933 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28934 [@dots{}]
28935 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
28936 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
28937 (gdb)
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
28941
28942 @smallexample
28943 (gdb)
28944 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
28945 ^done,asm_insns=[
28946 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28947 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28948 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28949 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28950 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28951 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
28952 (gdb)
28953 @end smallexample
28954
28955 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
28956
28957 @smallexample
28958 (gdb)
28959 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
28960 ^done,asm_insns=[
28961 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
28962 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28963 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28964 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
28965 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
28966 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
28967 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28968 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28969 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
28970 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28971 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28972 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
28973 (gdb)
28974 @end smallexample
28975
28976
28977 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
28978 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
28979
28980 @subsubheading Synopsis
28981
28982 @smallexample
28983 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
28984 @end smallexample
28985
28986 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
28987 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
28988 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
28989
28990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28991
28992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
28993 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
28994 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
28995
28996 @subsubheading Example
28997
28998 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
28999 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29000 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29001 output.
29002
29003 @smallexample
29004 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29005 211^done,value="1"
29006 (gdb)
29007 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29008 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29009 (gdb)
29010 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29011 411^done,value="4"
29012 (gdb)
29013 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29014 511^done,value="4"
29015 (gdb)
29016 @end smallexample
29017
29018
29019 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29020 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29021
29022 @subsubheading Synopsis
29023
29024 @smallexample
29025 -data-list-changed-registers
29026 @end smallexample
29027
29028 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29029
29030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29031
29032 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29033 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29034
29035 @subsubheading Example
29036
29037 On a PPC MBX board:
29038
29039 @smallexample
29040 (gdb)
29041 -exec-continue
29042 ^running
29043
29044 (gdb)
29045 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29046 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29047 line="5"@}
29048 (gdb)
29049 -data-list-changed-registers
29050 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29051 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29052 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29053 (gdb)
29054 @end smallexample
29055
29056
29057 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29058 @findex -data-list-register-names
29059
29060 @subsubheading Synopsis
29061
29062 @smallexample
29063 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29064 @end smallexample
29065
29066 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29067 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29068 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29069 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29070 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29071 include empty register names.
29072
29073 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29074
29075 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29076 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29077 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29078
29079 @subsubheading Example
29080
29081 For the PPC MBX board:
29082 @smallexample
29083 (gdb)
29084 -data-list-register-names
29085 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29086 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29087 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29088 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29089 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29090 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29091 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29092 (gdb)
29093 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29094 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29095 (gdb)
29096 @end smallexample
29097
29098 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29099 @findex -data-list-register-values
29100
29101 @subsubheading Synopsis
29102
29103 @smallexample
29104 -data-list-register-values
29105 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29106 @end smallexample
29107
29108 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
29109 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
29110 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
29111 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be
29112 returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option indicates that only
29113 the available registers are to be returned.
29114
29115 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29116
29117 @table @code
29118 @item x
29119 Hexadecimal
29120 @item o
29121 Octal
29122 @item t
29123 Binary
29124 @item d
29125 Decimal
29126 @item r
29127 Raw
29128 @item N
29129 Natural
29130 @end table
29131
29132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29133
29134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29135 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29136
29137 @subsubheading Example
29138
29139 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29140 don't appear in the actual output):
29141
29142 @smallexample
29143 (gdb)
29144 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29145 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29146 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29147 (gdb)
29148 -data-list-register-values x
29149 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29150 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29151 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29152 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29153 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29154 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29155 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29156 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29157 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29158 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29159 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29160 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29161 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29162 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29163 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29164 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29165 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29166 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29167 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29168 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29169 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29170 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29171 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29172 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29173 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29174 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29175 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29176 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29177 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29178 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29179 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29180 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29181 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29182 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29183 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29184 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29185 (gdb)
29186 @end smallexample
29187
29188
29189 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29190 @findex -data-read-memory
29191
29192 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29193
29194 @subsubheading Synopsis
29195
29196 @smallexample
29197 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29198 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29199 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29200 @end smallexample
29201
29202 @noindent
29203 where:
29204
29205 @table @samp
29206 @item @var{address}
29207 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29208 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29209 quoted using the C convention.
29210
29211 @item @var{word-format}
29212 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29213 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29214 ,Output Formats}).
29215
29216 @item @var{word-size}
29217 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29218
29219 @item @var{nr-rows}
29220 The number of rows in the output table.
29221
29222 @item @var{nr-cols}
29223 The number of columns in the output table.
29224
29225 @item @var{aschar}
29226 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29227 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29228 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29229 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29230
29231 @item @var{byte-offset}
29232 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29233 @end table
29234
29235 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29236 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29237 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29238 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29239 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29240 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29241 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29242 @samp{addr}.
29243
29244 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29245 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29246 @samp{prev-page}.
29247
29248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29249
29250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29251 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29252
29253 @subsubheading Example
29254
29255 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29256 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29257 word. Display each word in hex.
29258
29259 @smallexample
29260 (gdb)
29261 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29262 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29263 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29264 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29265 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29266 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29267 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29268 (gdb)
29269 @end smallexample
29270
29271 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29272 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29273
29274 @smallexample
29275 (gdb)
29276 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29277 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29278 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29279 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29280 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29281 (gdb)
29282 @end smallexample
29283
29284 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29285 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29286 used as the non-printable character.
29287
29288 @smallexample
29289 (gdb)
29290 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29291 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29292 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29293 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29294 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29295 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29296 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29297 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29298 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29299 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29300 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29301 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29302 (gdb)
29303 @end smallexample
29304
29305 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29306 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29307
29308 @subsubheading Synopsis
29309
29310 @smallexample
29311 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29312 @var{address} @var{count}
29313 @end smallexample
29314
29315 @noindent
29316 where:
29317
29318 @table @samp
29319 @item @var{address}
29320 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29321 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29322 quoted using the C convention.
29323
29324 @item @var{count}
29325 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29326
29327 @item @var{byte-offset}
29328 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29329 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29330 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29331 perform address arithmetics itself.
29332
29333 @end table
29334
29335 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29336 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29337 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29338 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29339 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29340 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29341
29342 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29343 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29344 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29345 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29346 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29347 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29348 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29349 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29350
29351 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29352 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29353 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29354 and has the following fields:
29355
29356 @table @code
29357 @item begin
29358 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29359
29360 @item end
29361 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29362
29363 @item offset
29364 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29365 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29366
29367 @item contents
29368 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29369
29370 @end table
29371
29372
29373
29374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29375
29376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29377
29378 @subsubheading Example
29379
29380 @smallexample
29381 (gdb)
29382 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29383 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29384 end="0xbffff15e",
29385 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29386 (gdb)
29387 @end smallexample
29388
29389
29390 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29391 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29392
29393 @subsubheading Synopsis
29394
29395 @smallexample
29396 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29397 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29398 @end smallexample
29399
29400 @noindent
29401 where:
29402
29403 @table @samp
29404 @item @var{address}
29405 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29406 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29407 quoted using the C convention.
29408
29409 @item @var{contents}
29410 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29411
29412 @item @var{count}
29413 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29414 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29415 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29416
29417 @end table
29418
29419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29420
29421 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29422
29423 @subsubheading Example
29424
29425 @smallexample
29426 (gdb)
29427 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29428 ^done
29429 (gdb)
29430 @end smallexample
29431
29432 @smallexample
29433 (gdb)
29434 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29435 ^done
29436 (gdb)
29437 @end smallexample
29438
29439 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29440 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29441 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29442
29443 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29444 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29445
29446 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29447 @findex -trace-find
29448
29449 @subsubheading Synopsis
29450
29451 @smallexample
29452 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29456 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29457 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29458
29459 @table @samp
29460
29461 @item none
29462 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29463
29464 @item frame-number
29465 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29466 that index.
29467
29468 @item tracepoint-number
29469 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29470 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29471
29472 @item pc
29473 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29474 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29475 address.
29476
29477 @item pc-inside-range
29478 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29479 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29480 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29481
29482 @item pc-outside-range
29483 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29484 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29485 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29486
29487 @item line
29488 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29489 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29490 the specified location.
29491
29492 @end table
29493
29494 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29495 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29496
29497 @table @samp
29498 @item found
29499 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29500 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29501
29502 @item traceframe
29503 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29504 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29505
29506 @item tracepoint
29507 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29508 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29509
29510 @item frame
29511 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29512 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29513 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29514
29515 @end table
29516
29517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29518
29519 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29520
29521 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29522 @findex -trace-define-variable
29523
29524 @subsubheading Synopsis
29525
29526 @smallexample
29527 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29528 @end smallexample
29529
29530 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29531 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29532 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29533 with the @samp{$} character.
29534
29535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29536
29537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29538
29539 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29540 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29541
29542 @subsubheading Synopsis
29543
29544 @smallexample
29545 -trace-frame-collected
29546 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29547 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29548 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29549 [--memory-contents]
29550 @end smallexample
29551
29552 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29553 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29554 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29555 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29556 See the output description table below for more details.
29557
29558 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29559 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29560 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29561 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29562 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29563
29564 For instance, if the actions were
29565 @smallexample
29566 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29567 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29568 @end smallexample
29569
29570 @noindent
29571 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29572 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29573 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29574 objects would be computed expressions.
29575
29576 An example output would be:
29577
29578 @smallexample
29579 (gdb)
29580 -trace-frame-collected
29581 ^done,
29582 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29583 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29584 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29585 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29586 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29587 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29588 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29589 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29590 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29591 ...
29592 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29593 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29594 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29595 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29596 (gdb)
29597 @end smallexample
29598
29599 Where:
29600
29601 @table @code
29602 @item explicit-variables
29603 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29604 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29605 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29606 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29607 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29608 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29609 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29610 arrays, structures and unions.
29611
29612 @item computed-expressions
29613 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29614 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29615 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29616 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29617
29618 @item registers
29619 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29620 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29621 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29622 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29623 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29624
29625 @item tvars
29626 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29627 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29628 current value are returned.
29629
29630 @item memory
29631 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29632 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29633 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29634
29635 @table @code
29636 @item address
29637 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29638
29639 @item length
29640 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29641
29642 @item contents
29643 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29644 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29645
29646 @end table
29647
29648 @end table
29649
29650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29651
29652 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29653
29654 @subsubheading Example
29655
29656 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29657 @findex -trace-list-variables
29658
29659 @subsubheading Synopsis
29660
29661 @smallexample
29662 -trace-list-variables
29663 @end smallexample
29664
29665 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29666 table has the following fields:
29667
29668 @table @samp
29669 @item name
29670 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29671
29672 @item initial
29673 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29674 field is always present.
29675
29676 @item current
29677 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29678 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29679 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29680 presently running.
29681
29682 @end table
29683
29684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29685
29686 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29687
29688 @subsubheading Example
29689
29690 @smallexample
29691 (gdb)
29692 -trace-list-variables
29693 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29694 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29695 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29696 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29697 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29698 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29699 (gdb)
29700 @end smallexample
29701
29702 @subheading -trace-save
29703 @findex -trace-save
29704
29705 @subsubheading Synopsis
29706
29707 @smallexample
29708 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29709 @end smallexample
29710
29711 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29712 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29713 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29714 to perform the save.
29715
29716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29717
29718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29719
29720
29721 @subheading -trace-start
29722 @findex -trace-start
29723
29724 @subsubheading Synopsis
29725
29726 @smallexample
29727 -trace-start
29728 @end smallexample
29729
29730 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29731 have any fields.
29732
29733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29734
29735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29736
29737 @subheading -trace-status
29738 @findex -trace-status
29739
29740 @subsubheading Synopsis
29741
29742 @smallexample
29743 -trace-status
29744 @end smallexample
29745
29746 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29747 the following fields:
29748
29749 @table @samp
29750
29751 @item supported
29752 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29753 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29754 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29755 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29756 started. This field is always present.
29757
29758 @item running
29759 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29760 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29761 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29762
29763 @item stop-reason
29764 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29765 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29766 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29767 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29768 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29769 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29770 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29771 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29772 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29773
29774 @item stopping-tracepoint
29775 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29776 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29777 @samp{passcount}.
29778
29779 @item frames
29780 @itemx frames-created
29781 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29782 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29783 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29784 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29785
29786 @item buffer-size
29787 @itemx buffer-free
29788 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29789 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29790
29791 @item circular
29792 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29793 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29794 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29795 and may fill up.
29796
29797 @item disconnected
29798 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29799 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29800 that the trace run will stop.
29801
29802 @item trace-file
29803 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29804 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29805
29806 @end table
29807
29808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29809
29810 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29811
29812 @subheading -trace-stop
29813 @findex -trace-stop
29814
29815 @subsubheading Synopsis
29816
29817 @smallexample
29818 -trace-stop
29819 @end smallexample
29820
29821 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29822 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29823 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29824
29825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29826
29827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29828
29829
29830 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29831 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29832 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29833
29834
29835 @ignore
29836 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29837 @findex -symbol-info-address
29838
29839 @subsubheading Synopsis
29840
29841 @smallexample
29842 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29843 @end smallexample
29844
29845 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29846
29847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29848
29849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29850
29851 @subsubheading Example
29852 N.A.
29853
29854
29855 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
29856 @findex -symbol-info-file
29857
29858 @subsubheading Synopsis
29859
29860 @smallexample
29861 -symbol-info-file
29862 @end smallexample
29863
29864 Show the file for the symbol.
29865
29866 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29867
29868 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
29869 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
29870
29871 @subsubheading Example
29872 N.A.
29873
29874
29875 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
29876 @findex -symbol-info-function
29877
29878 @subsubheading Synopsis
29879
29880 @smallexample
29881 -symbol-info-function
29882 @end smallexample
29883
29884 Show which function the symbol lives in.
29885
29886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29887
29888 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
29889
29890 @subsubheading Example
29891 N.A.
29892
29893
29894 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29895 @findex -symbol-info-line
29896
29897 @subsubheading Synopsis
29898
29899 @smallexample
29900 -symbol-info-line
29901 @end smallexample
29902
29903 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
29904
29905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29906
29907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
29908 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
29909
29910 @subsubheading Example
29911 N.A.
29912
29913
29914 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
29915 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
29916
29917 @subsubheading Synopsis
29918
29919 @smallexample
29920 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
29921 @end smallexample
29922
29923 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
29924
29925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29926
29927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
29928
29929 @subsubheading Example
29930 N.A.
29931
29932
29933 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
29934 @findex -symbol-list-functions
29935
29936 @subsubheading Synopsis
29937
29938 @smallexample
29939 -symbol-list-functions
29940 @end smallexample
29941
29942 List the functions in the executable.
29943
29944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29945
29946 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
29947 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29948
29949 @subsubheading Example
29950 N.A.
29951 @end ignore
29952
29953
29954 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
29955 @findex -symbol-list-lines
29956
29957 @subsubheading Synopsis
29958
29959 @smallexample
29960 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
29961 @end smallexample
29962
29963 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
29964 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
29965 ascending PC order.
29966
29967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29968
29969 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29970
29971 @subsubheading Example
29972 @smallexample
29973 (gdb)
29974 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
29975 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
29976 (gdb)
29977 @end smallexample
29978
29979
29980 @ignore
29981 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
29982 @findex -symbol-list-types
29983
29984 @subsubheading Synopsis
29985
29986 @smallexample
29987 -symbol-list-types
29988 @end smallexample
29989
29990 List all the type names.
29991
29992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29993
29994 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
29995 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29996
29997 @subsubheading Example
29998 N.A.
29999
30000
30001 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30002 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30003
30004 @subsubheading Synopsis
30005
30006 @smallexample
30007 -symbol-list-variables
30008 @end smallexample
30009
30010 List all the global and static variable names.
30011
30012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30013
30014 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30015
30016 @subsubheading Example
30017 N.A.
30018
30019
30020 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30021 @findex -symbol-locate
30022
30023 @subsubheading Synopsis
30024
30025 @smallexample
30026 -symbol-locate
30027 @end smallexample
30028
30029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30030
30031 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30032
30033 @subsubheading Example
30034 N.A.
30035
30036
30037 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30038 @findex -symbol-type
30039
30040 @subsubheading Synopsis
30041
30042 @smallexample
30043 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30044 @end smallexample
30045
30046 Show type of @var{variable}.
30047
30048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30049
30050 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30051 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30052
30053 @subsubheading Example
30054 N.A.
30055 @end ignore
30056
30057
30058 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30059 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30060 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30061
30062 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30063 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30064
30065 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30066 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30067
30068 @subsubheading Synopsis
30069
30070 @smallexample
30071 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30072 @end smallexample
30073
30074 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30075 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30076 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30077 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30078 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30079 notification.
30080
30081 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30082
30083 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30084
30085 @subsubheading Example
30086
30087 @smallexample
30088 (gdb)
30089 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30090 ^done
30091 (gdb)
30092 @end smallexample
30093
30094
30095 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30096 @findex -file-exec-file
30097
30098 @subsubheading Synopsis
30099
30100 @smallexample
30101 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30102 @end smallexample
30103
30104 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30105 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30106 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30107 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30108 notification.
30109
30110 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30111
30112 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30113
30114 @subsubheading Example
30115
30116 @smallexample
30117 (gdb)
30118 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30119 ^done
30120 (gdb)
30121 @end smallexample
30122
30123
30124 @ignore
30125 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30126 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30127
30128 @subsubheading Synopsis
30129
30130 @smallexample
30131 -file-list-exec-sections
30132 @end smallexample
30133
30134 List the sections of the current executable file.
30135
30136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30137
30138 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30139 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30140 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30141
30142 @subsubheading Example
30143 N.A.
30144 @end ignore
30145
30146
30147 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30148 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30149
30150 @subsubheading Synopsis
30151
30152 @smallexample
30153 -file-list-exec-source-file
30154 @end smallexample
30155
30156 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30157 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30158 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30159 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30160
30161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30162
30163 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30164
30165 @subsubheading Example
30166
30167 @smallexample
30168 (gdb)
30169 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30170 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30171 (gdb)
30172 @end smallexample
30173
30174
30175 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30176 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30177
30178 @subsubheading Synopsis
30179
30180 @smallexample
30181 -file-list-exec-source-files
30182 @end smallexample
30183
30184 List the source files for the current executable.
30185
30186 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30187 name) of a source file.
30188
30189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30190
30191 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30192 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30193
30194 @subsubheading Example
30195 @smallexample
30196 (gdb)
30197 -file-list-exec-source-files
30198 ^done,files=[
30199 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30200 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30201 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30202 (gdb)
30203 @end smallexample
30204
30205 @ignore
30206 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30207 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30208
30209 @subsubheading Synopsis
30210
30211 @smallexample
30212 -file-list-shared-libraries
30213 @end smallexample
30214
30215 List the shared libraries in the program.
30216
30217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30218
30219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30220
30221 @subsubheading Example
30222 N.A.
30223
30224
30225 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30226 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30227
30228 @subsubheading Synopsis
30229
30230 @smallexample
30231 -file-list-symbol-files
30232 @end smallexample
30233
30234 List symbol files.
30235
30236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30237
30238 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30239
30240 @subsubheading Example
30241 N.A.
30242 @end ignore
30243
30244
30245 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30246 @findex -file-symbol-file
30247
30248 @subsubheading Synopsis
30249
30250 @smallexample
30251 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30252 @end smallexample
30253
30254 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30255 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30256 produced, except for a completion notification.
30257
30258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30259
30260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30261
30262 @subsubheading Example
30263
30264 @smallexample
30265 (gdb)
30266 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30267 ^done
30268 (gdb)
30269 @end smallexample
30270
30271 @ignore
30272 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30273 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30274 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30275
30276 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30277
30278 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30279
30280 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30281
30282 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30283
30284 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30285
30286 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30287
30288 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30289
30290 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30291
30292 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30293 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30294 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30295
30296 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30297
30298 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30299
30300 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30301
30302 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30303 @end ignore
30304
30305
30306 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30307 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30308 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30309
30310
30311 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30312 @findex -target-attach
30313
30314 @subsubheading Synopsis
30315
30316 @smallexample
30317 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30318 @end smallexample
30319
30320 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30321 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30322 group, the id previously returned by
30323 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30324
30325 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30326
30327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30328
30329 @subsubheading Example
30330 @smallexample
30331 (gdb)
30332 -target-attach 34
30333 =thread-created,id="1"
30334 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30335 ^done
30336 (gdb)
30337 @end smallexample
30338
30339 @ignore
30340 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30341 @findex -target-compare-sections
30342
30343 @subsubheading Synopsis
30344
30345 @smallexample
30346 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30347 @end smallexample
30348
30349 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30350 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30351
30352 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30353
30354 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30355
30356 @subsubheading Example
30357 N.A.
30358 @end ignore
30359
30360
30361 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30362 @findex -target-detach
30363
30364 @subsubheading Synopsis
30365
30366 @smallexample
30367 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30368 @end smallexample
30369
30370 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30371 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30372 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30373
30374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30375
30376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30377
30378 @subsubheading Example
30379
30380 @smallexample
30381 (gdb)
30382 -target-detach
30383 ^done
30384 (gdb)
30385 @end smallexample
30386
30387
30388 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30389 @findex -target-disconnect
30390
30391 @subsubheading Synopsis
30392
30393 @smallexample
30394 -target-disconnect
30395 @end smallexample
30396
30397 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30398 generally not resumed.
30399
30400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30401
30402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30403
30404 @subsubheading Example
30405
30406 @smallexample
30407 (gdb)
30408 -target-disconnect
30409 ^done
30410 (gdb)
30411 @end smallexample
30412
30413
30414 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30415 @findex -target-download
30416
30417 @subsubheading Synopsis
30418
30419 @smallexample
30420 -target-download
30421 @end smallexample
30422
30423 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30424 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30425
30426 @table @samp
30427 @item section
30428 The name of the section.
30429 @item section-sent
30430 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30431 @item section-size
30432 The size of the section.
30433 @item total-sent
30434 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30435 @item total-size
30436 The size of the overall executable to download.
30437 @end table
30438
30439 @noindent
30440 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30441 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30442
30443 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30444 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30445
30446 @table @samp
30447 @item section
30448 The name of the section.
30449 @item section-size
30450 The size of the section.
30451 @item total-size
30452 The size of the overall executable to download.
30453 @end table
30454
30455 @noindent
30456 At the end, a summary is printed.
30457
30458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30459
30460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30461
30462 @subsubheading Example
30463
30464 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30465 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30466
30467 @smallexample
30468 (gdb)
30469 -target-download
30470 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30471 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30472 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30473 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30474 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30475 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30476 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30477 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30478 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30479 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30480 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30481 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30482 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30483 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30484 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30485 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30486 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30487 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30488 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30489 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30490 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30491 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30492 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30493 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30494 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30495 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30496 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30497 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30498 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30499 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30500 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30501 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30502 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30503 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30504 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30505 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30506 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30507 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30508 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30509 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30510 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30511 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30512 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30513 write-rate="429"
30514 (gdb)
30515 @end smallexample
30516
30517
30518 @ignore
30519 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30520 @findex -target-exec-status
30521
30522 @subsubheading Synopsis
30523
30524 @smallexample
30525 -target-exec-status
30526 @end smallexample
30527
30528 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30529 not, for instance).
30530
30531 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30532
30533 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30534
30535 @subsubheading Example
30536 N.A.
30537
30538
30539 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30540 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30541
30542 @subsubheading Synopsis
30543
30544 @smallexample
30545 -target-list-available-targets
30546 @end smallexample
30547
30548 List the possible targets to connect to.
30549
30550 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30551
30552 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30553
30554 @subsubheading Example
30555 N.A.
30556
30557
30558 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30559 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30560
30561 @subsubheading Synopsis
30562
30563 @smallexample
30564 -target-list-current-targets
30565 @end smallexample
30566
30567 Describe the current target.
30568
30569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30570
30571 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30572 other things).
30573
30574 @subsubheading Example
30575 N.A.
30576
30577
30578 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30579 @findex -target-list-parameters
30580
30581 @subsubheading Synopsis
30582
30583 @smallexample
30584 -target-list-parameters
30585 @end smallexample
30586
30587 @c ????
30588 @end ignore
30589
30590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30591
30592 No equivalent.
30593
30594 @subsubheading Example
30595 N.A.
30596
30597
30598 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30599 @findex -target-select
30600
30601 @subsubheading Synopsis
30602
30603 @smallexample
30604 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30605 @end smallexample
30606
30607 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30608
30609 @table @samp
30610 @item @var{type}
30611 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30612 @item @var{parameters}
30613 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30614 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30615 @end table
30616
30617 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30618 which the target program is, in the following form:
30619
30620 @smallexample
30621 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30622 args=[@var{arg list}]
30623 @end smallexample
30624
30625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30626
30627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30628
30629 @subsubheading Example
30630
30631 @smallexample
30632 (gdb)
30633 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30634 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30635 (gdb)
30636 @end smallexample
30637
30638 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30639 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30640 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30641
30642
30643 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30644 @findex -target-file-put
30645
30646 @subsubheading Synopsis
30647
30648 @smallexample
30649 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30650 @end smallexample
30651
30652 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30653 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30654
30655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30656
30657 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30658
30659 @subsubheading Example
30660
30661 @smallexample
30662 (gdb)
30663 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30664 ^done
30665 (gdb)
30666 @end smallexample
30667
30668
30669 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30670 @findex -target-file-get
30671
30672 @subsubheading Synopsis
30673
30674 @smallexample
30675 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30676 @end smallexample
30677
30678 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30679 on the host system.
30680
30681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30682
30683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30684
30685 @subsubheading Example
30686
30687 @smallexample
30688 (gdb)
30689 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30690 ^done
30691 (gdb)
30692 @end smallexample
30693
30694
30695 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30696 @findex -target-file-delete
30697
30698 @subsubheading Synopsis
30699
30700 @smallexample
30701 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30702 @end smallexample
30703
30704 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30705
30706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30707
30708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30709
30710 @subsubheading Example
30711
30712 @smallexample
30713 (gdb)
30714 -target-file-delete remotefile
30715 ^done
30716 (gdb)
30717 @end smallexample
30718
30719
30720 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30721 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30722 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30723
30724 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30725 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30726
30727 @subsubheading Synopsis
30728
30729 @smallexample
30730 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30731 @end smallexample
30732
30733 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30734 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30735 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30736
30737 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30738
30739 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30740
30741 @subsubheading Result
30742
30743 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30744 defined for each exception:
30745
30746 @table @samp
30747 @item name
30748 The name of the exception.
30749
30750 @item address
30751 The address of the exception.
30752
30753 @end table
30754
30755 @subsubheading Example
30756
30757 @smallexample
30758 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30759 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30760 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30761 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30762 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30763 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30764 @end smallexample
30765
30766 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30767
30768 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30769 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30770 Catchpoint Commands}.
30771
30772
30773 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30774 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30775 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30776
30777 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30778 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30779 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30780 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30781
30782 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30783 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30784 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30785
30786 @subsubheading Synopsis
30787
30788 @smallexample
30789 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30790 @end smallexample
30791
30792 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30793
30794 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30795 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30796 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30797 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30798 dash.
30799
30800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30801
30802 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30803
30804 @subsubheading Result
30805
30806 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30807
30808 @table @samp
30809 @item exists
30810 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30811 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30812
30813 @end table
30814
30815 @subsubheading Example
30816
30817 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30818
30819 @smallexample
30820 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30821 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30822 @end smallexample
30823
30824 @noindent
30825 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30826 to the debugger:
30827
30828 @smallexample
30829 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
30830 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
30831 @end smallexample
30832
30833 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
30834 @findex -list-features
30835 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
30836
30837 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
30838 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
30839 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
30840 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
30841 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
30842 startup.
30843
30844 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
30845 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
30846 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
30847 is given below.
30848
30849 Example output:
30850
30851 @smallexample
30852 (gdb) -list-features
30853 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
30854 @end smallexample
30855
30856 The current list of features is:
30857
30858 @ftable @samp
30859 @item frozen-varobjs
30860 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
30861 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
30862 of @code{-varobj-create}.
30863 @item pending-breakpoints
30864 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
30865 command.
30866 @item python
30867 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
30868 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30869 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30870 @item thread-info
30871 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
30872 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30873 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30874 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30875 @item breakpoint-notifications
30876 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
30877 CLI will be announced via async records.
30878 @item ada-task-info
30879 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
30880 @item language-option
30881 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
30882 option (@pxref{Context management}).
30883 @item info-gdb-mi-command
30884 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
30885 @item undefined-command-error-code
30886 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
30887 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
30888 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
30889 @item exec-run-start-option
30890 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
30891 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
30892 @end ftable
30893
30894 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30895 @findex -list-target-features
30896
30897 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30898 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30899 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30900 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30901 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30902 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30903 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
30904 Example output:
30905
30906 @smallexample
30907 (gdb) -list-target-features
30908 ^done,result=["async"]
30909 @end smallexample
30910
30911 The current list of features is:
30912
30913 @table @samp
30914 @item async
30915 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
30916 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
30917 while the target is running.
30918
30919 @item reverse
30920 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
30921 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30922
30923 @end table
30924
30925 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30926 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
30927 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30928
30929 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
30930
30931 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
30932 @findex -gdb-exit
30933
30934 @subsubheading Synopsis
30935
30936 @smallexample
30937 -gdb-exit
30938 @end smallexample
30939
30940 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
30941
30942 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30943
30944 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
30945
30946 @subsubheading Example
30947
30948 @smallexample
30949 (gdb)
30950 -gdb-exit
30951 ^exit
30952 @end smallexample
30953
30954
30955 @ignore
30956 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
30957 @findex -exec-abort
30958
30959 @subsubheading Synopsis
30960
30961 @smallexample
30962 -exec-abort
30963 @end smallexample
30964
30965 Kill the inferior running program.
30966
30967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30968
30969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
30970
30971 @subsubheading Example
30972 N.A.
30973 @end ignore
30974
30975
30976 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
30977 @findex -gdb-set
30978
30979 @subsubheading Synopsis
30980
30981 @smallexample
30982 -gdb-set
30983 @end smallexample
30984
30985 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
30986 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
30987
30988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30989
30990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
30991
30992 @subsubheading Example
30993
30994 @smallexample
30995 (gdb)
30996 -gdb-set $foo=3
30997 ^done
30998 (gdb)
30999 @end smallexample
31000
31001
31002 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31003 @findex -gdb-show
31004
31005 @subsubheading Synopsis
31006
31007 @smallexample
31008 -gdb-show
31009 @end smallexample
31010
31011 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31012
31013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31014
31015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31016
31017 @subsubheading Example
31018
31019 @smallexample
31020 (gdb)
31021 -gdb-show annotate
31022 ^done,value="0"
31023 (gdb)
31024 @end smallexample
31025
31026 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31027
31028
31029 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31030 @findex -gdb-version
31031
31032 @subsubheading Synopsis
31033
31034 @smallexample
31035 -gdb-version
31036 @end smallexample
31037
31038 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31039
31040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31041
31042 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31043 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31044
31045 @subsubheading Example
31046
31047 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31048 @c box in TeX.
31049 @smallexample
31050 (gdb)
31051 -gdb-version
31052 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31053 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31054 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31055 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31056 ~ certain conditions.
31057 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31058 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31059 ~ details.
31060 ~This GDB was configured as
31061 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31062 ^done
31063 (gdb)
31064 @end smallexample
31065
31066 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31067 @findex -list-thread-groups
31068
31069 @subheading Synopsis
31070
31071 @smallexample
31072 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31073 @end smallexample
31074
31075 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31076 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31077 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31078 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31079 top-level thread groups.
31080
31081 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31082 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31083 available on the target.
31084
31085 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31086 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31087 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31088 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31089 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31090 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31091 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31092 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31093
31094 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31095 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31096 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31097 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31098 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31099 @samp{threads} field.
31100
31101 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31102 the following caveats:
31103
31104 @itemize @bullet
31105 @item
31106 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31107 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31108 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31109
31110 @item
31111 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31112 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31113 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31114 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31115 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31116 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31117
31118 @end itemize
31119
31120 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31121 have the following fields:
31122
31123 @table @code
31124 @item id
31125 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31126 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31127 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31128
31129 @item type
31130 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31131 valid type.
31132
31133 @item pid
31134 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31135 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31136
31137 @item num_children
31138 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31139 absent for an available thread group.
31140
31141 @item threads
31142 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31143 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31144 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31145
31146 @item cores
31147 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31148 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31149 such information is not available.
31150
31151 @item executable
31152 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31153 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31154 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31155
31156 @end table
31157
31158 @subheading Example
31159
31160 @smallexample
31161 @value{GDBP}
31162 -list-thread-groups
31163 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31164 -list-thread-groups 17
31165 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31166 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31167 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31168 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31169 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31170 -list-thread-groups --available
31171 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31172 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31173 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31174 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31175 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31176 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31177 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31178 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31179 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31183 @findex -info-os
31184
31185 @subsubheading Synopsis
31186
31187 @smallexample
31188 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31189 @end smallexample
31190
31191 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31192 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31193 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31194 of data of that type.
31195
31196 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31197 system.
31198
31199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31200
31201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31202
31203 @subsubheading Example
31204
31205 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31206 like this:
31207
31208 @smallexample
31209 @value{GDBP}
31210 -info-os
31211 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31212 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31213 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31214 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31215 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31216 col2="Processes"@},
31217 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31218 col2="Process groups"@},
31219 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31220 col2="Threads"@},
31221 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31222 col2="File descriptors"@},
31223 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31224 col2="Sockets"@},
31225 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31226 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31227 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31228 col2="Semaphores"@},
31229 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31230 col2="Message queues"@},
31231 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31232 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31233 @value{GDBP}
31234 -info-os processes
31235 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31236 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31237 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31238 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31239 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31240 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31241 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31242 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31243 ...
31244 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31245 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31246 (gdb)
31247 @end smallexample
31248
31249 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31250 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31251 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31252 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31253 @code{info os} omits it.)
31254
31255 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31256 @findex -add-inferior
31257
31258 @subheading Synopsis
31259
31260 @smallexample
31261 -add-inferior
31262 @end smallexample
31263
31264 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31265 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31266 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31267 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31268 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31269 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31270
31271 @subheading Example
31272
31273 @smallexample
31274 @value{GDBP}
31275 -add-inferior
31276 ^done,inferior="i3"
31277 @end smallexample
31278
31279 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31280 @findex -interpreter-exec
31281
31282 @subheading Synopsis
31283
31284 @smallexample
31285 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31286 @end smallexample
31287 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31288
31289 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31290
31291 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31292
31293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31294
31295 @subheading Example
31296
31297 @smallexample
31298 (gdb)
31299 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31300 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31301 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31302 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31303 ^done
31304 (gdb)
31305 @end smallexample
31306
31307 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31308 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31309
31310 @subheading Synopsis
31311
31312 @smallexample
31313 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31314 @end smallexample
31315
31316 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31317
31318 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31319
31320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31321
31322 @subheading Example
31323
31324 @smallexample
31325 (gdb)
31326 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31327 ^done
31328 (gdb)
31329 @end smallexample
31330
31331 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31332 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31333
31334 @subheading Synopsis
31335
31336 @smallexample
31337 -inferior-tty-show
31338 @end smallexample
31339
31340 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31341
31342 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31343
31344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31345
31346 @subheading Example
31347
31348 @smallexample
31349 (gdb)
31350 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31351 ^done
31352 (gdb)
31353 -inferior-tty-show
31354 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31355 (gdb)
31356 @end smallexample
31357
31358 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31359 @findex -enable-timings
31360
31361 @subheading Synopsis
31362
31363 @smallexample
31364 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31365 @end smallexample
31366
31367 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31368 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31369 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31370 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31371
31372 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31373
31374 No equivalent.
31375
31376 @subheading Example
31377
31378 @smallexample
31379 (gdb)
31380 -enable-timings
31381 ^done
31382 (gdb)
31383 -break-insert main
31384 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31385 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31386 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31387 times="0"@},
31388 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31389 (gdb)
31390 -enable-timings no
31391 ^done
31392 (gdb)
31393 -exec-run
31394 ^running
31395 (gdb)
31396 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31397 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31398 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31399 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31400 (gdb)
31401 @end smallexample
31402
31403 @node Annotations
31404 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31405
31406 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31407 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31408 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31409 relatively high level.
31410
31411 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31412 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31413
31414 @ignore
31415 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31416 @end ignore
31417
31418 @menu
31419 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31420 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31421 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31422 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31423 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31424 * Annotations for Running::
31425 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31426 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31427 @end menu
31428
31429 @node Annotations Overview
31430 @section What is an Annotation?
31431 @cindex annotations
31432
31433 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31434 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31435 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31436 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31437 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31438 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31439 cannot contain newline characters.
31440
31441 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31442 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31443 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31444 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31445 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31446 means those three characters as output.
31447
31448 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31449 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31450 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31451 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31452 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31453 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31454 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31455 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31456 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31457
31458 @table @code
31459 @kindex set annotate
31460 @item set annotate @var{level}
31461 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31462 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31463
31464 @item show annotate
31465 @kindex show annotate
31466 Show the current annotation level.
31467 @end table
31468
31469 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31470
31471 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31472
31473 @smallexample
31474 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31475 GNU gdb 6.0
31476 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31477 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31478 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31479 under certain conditions.
31480 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31481 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31482 for details.
31483 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31484
31485 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31486 (@value{GDBP})
31487 ^Z^Zprompt
31488 @kbd{quit}
31489
31490 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31491 $
31492 @end smallexample
31493
31494 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31495 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31496 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31497 output from @value{GDBN}.
31498
31499 @node Server Prefix
31500 @section The Server Prefix
31501 @cindex server prefix
31502
31503 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31504 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31505 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31506 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31507 a transparent manner.
31508
31509 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31510 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31511 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31512 @code{print} command.
31513
31514 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31515 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31516
31517 @node Prompting
31518 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31519
31520 @cindex annotations for prompts
31521 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31522 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31523 over, etc.
31524
31525 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31526 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31527 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31528 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31529 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31530 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31531 features the following annotations:
31532
31533 @smallexample
31534 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31535 ^Z^Zprompt
31536 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31537 @end smallexample
31538
31539 The input types are
31540
31541 @table @code
31542 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31543 @findex prompt annotation
31544 @findex post-prompt annotation
31545 @item prompt
31546 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31547
31548 @findex pre-commands annotation
31549 @findex commands annotation
31550 @findex post-commands annotation
31551 @item commands
31552 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31553 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31554
31555 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31556 @findex overload-choice annotation
31557 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31558 @item overload-choice
31559 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31560
31561 @findex pre-query annotation
31562 @findex query annotation
31563 @findex post-query annotation
31564 @item query
31565 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31566
31567 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31568 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31569 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31570 @item prompt-for-continue
31571 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31572 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31573 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31574 presence of annotations.
31575 @end table
31576
31577 @node Errors
31578 @section Errors
31579 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31580
31581 @findex quit annotation
31582 @smallexample
31583 ^Z^Zquit
31584 @end smallexample
31585
31586 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31587
31588 @findex error annotation
31589 @smallexample
31590 ^Z^Zerror
31591 @end smallexample
31592
31593 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31594
31595 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31596 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31597 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31598 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31599 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31600 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31601 to the top level.
31602
31603 @findex error-begin annotation
31604 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31605
31606 @smallexample
31607 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31608 @end smallexample
31609
31610 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31611 message.
31612
31613 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31614 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31615 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31616
31617 @node Invalidation
31618 @section Invalidation Notices
31619
31620 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31621 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31622 changed.
31623
31624 @table @code
31625 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31626 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31627
31628 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31629 have changed.
31630
31631 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31632 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31633
31634 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31635 deleted a breakpoint.
31636 @end table
31637
31638 @node Annotations for Running
31639 @section Running the Program
31640 @cindex annotations for running programs
31641
31642 @findex starting annotation
31643 @findex stopping annotation
31644 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31645 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31646
31647 @smallexample
31648 ^Z^Zstarting
31649 @end smallexample
31650
31651 is output. When the program stops,
31652
31653 @smallexample
31654 ^Z^Zstopped
31655 @end smallexample
31656
31657 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31658 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31659
31660 @table @code
31661 @findex exited annotation
31662 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31663 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31664 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31665
31666 @findex signalled annotation
31667 @findex signal-name annotation
31668 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31669 @findex signal-string annotation
31670 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31671 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31672 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31673 annotation continues:
31674
31675 @smallexample
31676 @var{intro-text}
31677 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31678 @var{name}
31679 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31680 @var{middle-text}
31681 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31682 @var{string}
31683 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31684 @var{end-text}
31685 @end smallexample
31686
31687 @noindent
31688 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31689 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31690 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
31691 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31692 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31693
31694 @findex signal annotation
31695 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31696 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31697 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31698 terminated with it.
31699
31700 @findex breakpoint annotation
31701 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31702 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31703
31704 @findex watchpoint annotation
31705 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31706 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31707 @end table
31708
31709 @node Source Annotations
31710 @section Displaying Source
31711 @cindex annotations for source display
31712
31713 @findex source annotation
31714 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31715
31716 @smallexample
31717 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31718 @end smallexample
31719
31720 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31721 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31722 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31723 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31724 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31725 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31726 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31727 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31728 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31729 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31730 depend on the language).
31731
31732 @node JIT Interface
31733 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31734 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31735 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31736
31737 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31738 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31739 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31740 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31741
31742 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31743 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31744 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31745 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31746 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31747 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31748
31749 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31750 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31751 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31752 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31753 LLVM JIT.
31754
31755 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31756 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31757 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31758 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31759 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31760 out about additional code.
31761
31762 @menu
31763 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31764 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31765 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31766 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31767 @end menu
31768
31769 @node Declarations
31770 @section JIT Declarations
31771
31772 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31773 implement the interface:
31774
31775 @smallexample
31776 typedef enum
31777 @{
31778 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31779 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31780 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31781 @} jit_actions_t;
31782
31783 struct jit_code_entry
31784 @{
31785 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31786 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31787 const char *symfile_addr;
31788 uint64_t symfile_size;
31789 @};
31790
31791 struct jit_descriptor
31792 @{
31793 uint32_t version;
31794 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31795 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31796 uint32_t action_flag;
31797 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31798 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31799 @};
31800
31801 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31802 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31803
31804 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31805 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31806 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31807 @end smallexample
31808
31809 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31810 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31811 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31812
31813 @node Registering Code
31814 @section Registering Code
31815
31816 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31817
31818 @itemize @bullet
31819 @item
31820 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31821 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31822
31823 @item
31824 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31825 file.
31826
31827 @item
31828 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31829
31830 @item
31831 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31832
31833 @item
31834 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31835 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31836 @end itemize
31837
31838 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31839 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31840 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31841 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31842
31843 @node Unregistering Code
31844 @section Unregistering Code
31845
31846 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31847
31848 @itemize @bullet
31849 @item
31850 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31851
31852 @item
31853 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31854
31855 @item
31856 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31857 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31858 @end itemize
31859
31860 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31861 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31862
31863 @node Custom Debug Info
31864 @section Custom Debug Info
31865 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31866 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31867
31868 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31869 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31870 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31871 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31872 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31873 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31874 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31875 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31876 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31877
31878 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31879 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31880 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31881 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31882 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31883 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31884 compiler.
31885
31886 @menu
31887 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31888 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31889 @end menu
31890
31891 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31892 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31893 @kindex jit-reader-load
31894 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31895
31896 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31897 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31898
31899 @table @code
31900 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
31901 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}. @var{reader} is a shared
31902 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
31903 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
31904 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
31905 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
31906 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
31907
31908 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
31909 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
31910 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
31911 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
31912 @code{jit-reader-load}.
31913
31914 @item jit-reader-unload
31915 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
31916
31917 @end table
31918
31919 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31920 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31921 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
31922
31923 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
31924 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
31925
31926 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
31927 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
31928 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
31929 the system include directory.
31930
31931 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
31932 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
31933 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
31934
31935 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
31936 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
31937
31938 @findex gdb_init_reader
31939 @smallexample
31940 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
31941 @end smallexample
31942
31943 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
31944
31945 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
31946 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
31947 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
31948 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
31949 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
31950 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
31951
31952 @smallexample
31953 struct gdb_reader_funcs
31954 @{
31955 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
31956 int reader_version;
31957
31958 /* For use by the reader. */
31959 void *priv_data;
31960
31961 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
31962 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
31963 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
31964 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
31965 @};
31966 @end smallexample
31967
31968 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
31969 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
31970
31971 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
31972 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
31973 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
31974 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
31975 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
31976 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
31977 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
31978 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
31979 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
31980 target's address space.
31981
31982 @node In-Process Agent
31983 @chapter In-Process Agent
31984 @cindex debugging agent
31985 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
31986 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
31987 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
31988 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
31989 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
31990 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
31991 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
31992 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
31993 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
31994 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
31995 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
31996 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
31997 behavior without interrupting it.
31998
31999 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32000 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32001 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32002 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32003 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32004 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32005 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32006 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32007 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32008
32009 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32010 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32011 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32012 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32013
32014 @anchor{Control Agent}
32015 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32016 debugging with the following commands:
32017
32018 @table @code
32019 @kindex set agent on
32020 @item set agent on
32021 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32022 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32023 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32024 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32025 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32026 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32027
32028 @kindex set agent off
32029 @item set agent off
32030 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32031 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32032
32033 @kindex show agent
32034 @item show agent
32035 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32036 the in-process agent.
32037 @end table
32038
32039 @menu
32040 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32041 @end menu
32042
32043 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32044 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32045 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32046
32047 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32048 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32049 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32050 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32051 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32052 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32053 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32054 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32055 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32056
32057 @menu
32058 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32059 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32060 @end menu
32061
32062 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32063 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32064 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32065
32066 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32067 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32068
32069 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32070 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32071 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32072 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32073
32074 @enumerate
32075 @item
32076 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32077 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32078 @item
32079 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32080 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32081 the other one.
32082 @end enumerate
32083
32084 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32085
32086 @enumerate
32087 @item
32088 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32089 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32090 @anchor{agent expression object}
32091 @item
32092 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32093 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32094 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32095 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32096 @item
32097 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32098 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32099
32100 @end enumerate
32101
32102 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32103 object:
32104
32105 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32106 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32107 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32108 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32109 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32110 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32111 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32112 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32113 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32114 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32115 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32116 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32117 memory address for collecting.
32118 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32119 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32120 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32121 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32122 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32123 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32124 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32125 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32126 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32127 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32128 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32129 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32130 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32131 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32132 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32133 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32134 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32135 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32136 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32137 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32138 @ref{agent expression object}
32139 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32140 @ref{agent expression object}
32141 @item actions @tab variable
32142 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32143 @end multitable
32144
32145 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32146 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32147 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32148
32149 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32150 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32151
32152 @table @samp
32153
32154 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32155 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32156 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32157 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32158 in IPA finally.
32159
32160 Replies:
32161 @table @samp
32162 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32163 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32164 @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32165 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32166 @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32167 @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32168 @item E @var{NN}
32169 for an error
32170
32171 @end table
32172
32173 @item close
32174 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32175 is about to kill inferiors.
32176
32177 @item qTfSTM
32178 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32179 @item qTsSTM
32180 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32181 @item qTSTMat
32182 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32183 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32184 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32185
32186 Replies:
32187 @table @samp
32188 @item E @var{NN}
32189 for an error
32190 @end table
32191 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32192 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32193 @end table
32194
32195 @node GDB Bugs
32196 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32197 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32198 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32199
32200 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32201
32202 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32203 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32204 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32205 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32206
32207 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32208 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32209
32210 @menu
32211 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32212 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32213 @end menu
32214
32215 @node Bug Criteria
32216 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32217 @cindex bug criteria
32218
32219 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32220
32221 @itemize @bullet
32222 @cindex fatal signal
32223 @cindex debugger crash
32224 @cindex crash of debugger
32225 @item
32226 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32227 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32228
32229 @cindex error on valid input
32230 @item
32231 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32232 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32233 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32234
32235 @cindex invalid input
32236 @item
32237 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32238 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32239 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32240 for traditional practice''.
32241
32242 @item
32243 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32244 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32245 @end itemize
32246
32247 @node Bug Reporting
32248 @section How to Report Bugs
32249 @cindex bug reports
32250 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32251
32252 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32253 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32254 contact that organization first.
32255
32256 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32257 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32258 distribution.
32259 @c should add a web page ref...
32260
32261 @ifset BUGURL
32262 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32263 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32264 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32265 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32266 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32267 be used.
32268
32269 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32270 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32271 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32272 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32273
32274 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32275 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32276 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32277 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32278 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32279 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32280 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32281 bug reports to the mailing list.
32282 @end ifset
32283 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32284 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32285 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32286 @end ifclear
32287 @end ifset
32288
32289 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32290 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32291 fact or leave it out, state it!
32292
32293 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32294 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32295 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32296 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32297 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32298 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32299 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32300 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32301 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32302
32303 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32304 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32305 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32306 self-contained.
32307
32308 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32309 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32310 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32311 bugs properly.
32312
32313 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32314
32315 @itemize @bullet
32316 @item
32317 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32318 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32319 version}.
32320
32321 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32322 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32323
32324 @item
32325 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32326 version number.
32327
32328 @item
32329 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32330 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32331 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32332 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32333
32334 @item
32335 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32336 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32337
32338 @item
32339 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32340 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32341 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32342 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32343 those compilers.
32344
32345 @item
32346 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32347 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32348 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32349 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32350
32351 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32352 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32353
32354 @item
32355 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32356 reproduce the bug.
32357
32358 @item
32359 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32360 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32361
32362 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32363 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32364 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32365 a chance to make a mistake.
32366
32367 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32368 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32369 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32370 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32371 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32372 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32373 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32374 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32375
32376 @pindex script
32377 @cindex recording a session script
32378 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32379 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32380 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32381 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32382
32383 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32384 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32385
32386 @item
32387 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32388 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32389 it by context, not by line number.
32390
32391 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32392 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32393
32394 @end itemize
32395
32396 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32397
32398 @itemize @bullet
32399 @item
32400 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32401
32402 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32403 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32404 changes will not affect it.
32405
32406 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32407 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32408 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32409 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32410
32411 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32412 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32413 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32414 less time, and so on.
32415
32416 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32417 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32418
32419 @item
32420 A patch for the bug.
32421
32422 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32423 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32424 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32425 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32426
32427 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32428 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32429 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32430 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32431
32432 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32433 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32434 help us to understand.
32435
32436 @item
32437 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32438
32439 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32440 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32441 @end itemize
32442
32443 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32444 @c and consists of the two following files:
32445 @c rluser.texi
32446 @c hsuser.texi
32447 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32448 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32449 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32450 @include rluser.texi
32451 @include hsuser.texi
32452 @end ifclear
32453
32454 @node In Memoriam
32455 @appendix In Memoriam
32456
32457 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32458 contributors:
32459
32460 @table @code
32461 @item Fred Fish
32462 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32463 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32464 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32465
32466 @item Michael Snyder
32467 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32468 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32469 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32470 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32471 @end table
32472
32473 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32474 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32475
32476 @node Formatting Documentation
32477 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32478
32479 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32480 @cindex reference card
32481 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32482 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32483 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32484 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32485 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32486 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32487
32488 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32489 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32490
32491 @smallexample
32492 make refcard.dvi
32493 @end smallexample
32494
32495 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32496 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32497 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32498 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32499 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32500
32501 @cindex documentation
32502
32503 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32504 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32505 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32506 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32507 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32508 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32509
32510 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32511 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32512 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32513 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32514 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32515 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32516 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32517 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32518
32519 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32520 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32521 @code{makeinfo}.
32522
32523 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32524 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32525 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32526
32527 @smallexample
32528 cd gdb
32529 make gdb.info
32530 @end smallexample
32531
32532 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32533 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32534 Texinfo definitions file.
32535
32536 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32537 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32538 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32539 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32540 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32541 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32542 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32543
32544 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32545 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32546 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32547 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32548 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32549 directory.
32550
32551 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32552 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32553 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32554 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32555
32556 @smallexample
32557 make gdb.dvi
32558 @end smallexample
32559
32560 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32561
32562 @node Installing GDB
32563 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32564 @cindex installation
32565
32566 @menu
32567 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32568 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32569 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32570 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32571 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32572 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32573 @end menu
32574
32575 @node Requirements
32576 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32577 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32578
32579 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32580 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32581
32582 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32583 @table @asis
32584 @item ISO C90 compiler
32585 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32586 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32587
32588 @end table
32589
32590 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32591 @table @asis
32592 @item Expat
32593 @anchor{Expat}
32594 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32595 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32596 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32597 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32598 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32599 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32600
32601 Expat is used for:
32602
32603 @itemize @bullet
32604 @item
32605 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32606 @item
32607 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32608 @item
32609 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32610 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32611 @item
32612 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32613 @item
32614 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32615 @item
32616 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32617 @end itemize
32618
32619 @item zlib
32620 @cindex compressed debug sections
32621 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32622 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32623 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32624 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32625 information in such binaries.
32626
32627 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32628 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32629 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32630
32631 @item iconv
32632 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32633 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32634 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32635 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32636
32637 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32638 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32639 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32640 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32641
32642 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32643 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32644 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32645
32646 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32647 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32648 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32649 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32650 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32651 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32652 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32653 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32654 @end table
32655
32656 @node Running Configure
32657 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32658 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32659 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32660 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32661 build the @code{gdb} program.
32662 @iftex
32663 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32664 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32665 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32666 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32667 @end iftex
32668
32669 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32670 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32671 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32672
32673 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32674 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32675
32676 @table @code
32677 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32678 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32679
32680 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32681 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32682
32683 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32684 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32685
32686 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32687 @sc{gnu} include files
32688
32689 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32690 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32691
32692 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32693 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32694
32695 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32696 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32697
32698 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32699 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32700
32701 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32702 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32703 @end table
32704
32705 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32706 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32707 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32708
32709 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32710 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32711 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32712 argument.
32713
32714 For example:
32715
32716 @smallexample
32717 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32718 ./configure @var{host}
32719 make
32720 @end smallexample
32721
32722 @noindent
32723 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32724 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32725 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32726 correct value by examining your system.)
32727
32728 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32729 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32730 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32731 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32732
32733 @need 750
32734 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32735 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32736 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32737
32738 @smallexample
32739 sh configure @var{host}
32740 @end smallexample
32741
32742 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32743 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32744 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32745 @file{configure}
32746 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32747 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32748
32749 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32750 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32751 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32752 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32753 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32754 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32755 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32756 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32757 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32758
32759 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32760 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32761 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32762 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32763 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32764
32765 @node Separate Objdir
32766 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32767
32768 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32769 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32770 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32771 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32772 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32773 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32774 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32775 program specified there.
32776
32777 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32778 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32779 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32780 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32781 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32782 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32783
32784 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32785 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32786
32787 @smallexample
32788 @group
32789 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32790 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32791 cd ../gdb-sun4
32792 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32793 make
32794 @end group
32795 @end smallexample
32796
32797 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32798 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32799 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32800 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32801 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32802 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32803
32804 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32805 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32806 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32807 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32808 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32809
32810 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32811 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32812 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32813 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32814 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32815 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32816
32817 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32818 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32819 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32820
32821 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32822 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32823 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32824 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32825 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32826
32827 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32828 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32829 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32830 with each other.
32831
32832 @node Config Names
32833 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32834
32835 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32836 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32837 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32838 of information in the following pattern:
32839
32840 @smallexample
32841 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32842 @end smallexample
32843
32844 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32845 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32846 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32847
32848 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32849 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32850 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32851 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32852 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32853 abbreviations---for example:
32854
32855 @smallexample
32856 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32857 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32858 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32859 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32860 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32861 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32862 % sh config.sub sun4
32863 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32864 % sh config.sub sun3
32865 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32866 % sh config.sub i986v
32867 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32868 @end smallexample
32869
32870 @noindent
32871 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32872 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32873
32874 @node Configure Options
32875 @section @file{configure} Options
32876
32877 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32878 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32879 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32880 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32881
32882 @smallexample
32883 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32884 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32885 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32886 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32887 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32888 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32889 @var{host}
32890 @end smallexample
32891
32892 @noindent
32893 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32894 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32895 @samp{--}.
32896
32897 @table @code
32898 @item --help
32899 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32900
32901 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32902 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32903 @file{@var{dir}}.
32904
32905 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
32906 Configure the source to install programs under directory
32907 @file{@var{dir}}.
32908
32909 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
32910 @need 2000
32911 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
32912 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
32913 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
32914 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
32915 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
32916 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
32917 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
32918 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
32919 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
32920 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
32921 @var{dirname}.
32922
32923 @item --norecursion
32924 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
32925 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
32926
32927 @item --target=@var{target}
32928 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
32929 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
32930 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
32931
32932 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
32933
32934 @item @var{host} @dots{}
32935 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
32936
32937 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
32938 @end table
32939
32940 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
32941 needed for special purposes only.
32942
32943 @node System-wide configuration
32944 @section System-wide configuration and settings
32945 @cindex system-wide init file
32946
32947 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
32948 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
32949 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
32950
32951 Here is the corresponding configure option:
32952
32953 @table @code
32954 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
32955 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
32956 @var{file}.
32957 @end table
32958
32959 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
32960 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
32961
32962 @itemize @bullet
32963 @item
32964 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
32965 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
32966 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
32967 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
32968 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
32969 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
32970
32971 @item
32972 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
32973 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
32974 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32975 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32976 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
32977 @end itemize
32978
32979 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
32980 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
32981 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
32982 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
32983 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
32984 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
32985 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
32986 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
32987 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
32988 reread.
32989
32990 @menu
32991 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
32992 @end menu
32993
32994 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
32995 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
32996 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
32997
32998 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
32999 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33000 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33001 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33002 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33003 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33004
33005 The following scripts are currently available:
33006 @itemize @bullet
33007
33008 @item @file{elinos.py}
33009 @pindex elinos.py
33010 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33011 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33012 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33013 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33014 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33015 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33016
33017 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33018 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33019 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33020 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33021 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33022 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33023
33024 @end itemize
33025
33026 @node Maintenance Commands
33027 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33028 @cindex maintenance commands
33029 @cindex internal commands
33030
33031 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33032 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33033 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33034 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33035 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33036
33037 @table @code
33038 @kindex maint agent
33039 @kindex maint agent-eval
33040 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33041 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33042 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33043 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33044 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33045 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33046 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33047 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33048 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33049 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33050 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33051 addition and return the sum.
33052 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33053 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33054
33055 @kindex maint agent-printf
33056 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33057 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33058 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33059 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33060 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33061
33062 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33063 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33064 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33065 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33066 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33067 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33068 is shown:
33069
33070 @table @code
33071 @item breakpoint
33072 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33073
33074 @item watchpoint
33075 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33076
33077 @item longjmp
33078 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33079 @code{longjmp} calls.
33080
33081 @item longjmp resume
33082 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33083
33084 @item until
33085 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33086
33087 @item finish
33088 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33089
33090 @item shlib events
33091 Shared library events.
33092
33093 @end table
33094
33095 @kindex maint info bfds
33096 @item maint info bfds
33097 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33098 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33099
33100 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33101 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33102 @cindex displaced stepping support
33103 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33104 @item set displaced-stepping
33105 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33106 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33107 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33108 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33109 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33110 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33111
33112 @table @code
33113 @item set displaced-stepping on
33114 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33115 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33116
33117 @item set displaced-stepping off
33118 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33119 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33120
33121 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33122 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33123 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33124 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33125 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33126 @end table
33127
33128 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33129 @item maint check-psymtabs
33130 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33131 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33132
33133 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33134 @item maint check-symtabs
33135 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33136
33137 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33138 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33139 Expand symbol tables.
33140 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33141 names matching @var{regexp}.
33142
33143 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33144 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33145 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33146
33147 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33148 @item maint cplus namespace
33149 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33150
33151 @kindex maint demangle
33152 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33153 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33154
33155 @kindex maint deprecate
33156 @kindex maint undeprecate
33157 @cindex deprecated commands
33158 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33159 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33160 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33161 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33162 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33163 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33164 the replacement as part of the warning.
33165
33166 @kindex maint dump-me
33167 @item maint dump-me
33168 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33169 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33170 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33171 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33172
33173 @kindex maint internal-error
33174 @kindex maint internal-warning
33175 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33176 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33177 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
33178 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
33179 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
33180 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
33181 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
33182 @value{GDBN} session.
33183
33184 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33185 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33186
33187 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33188
33189 @smallexample
33190 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33191 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33192 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33193 debugging may prove unreliable.
33194 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33195 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33196 (@value{GDBP})
33197 @end smallexample
33198
33199 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33200 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33201
33202 @kindex maint set internal-error
33203 @kindex maint show internal-error
33204 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33205 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33206 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33207 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33208 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33209 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33210 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33211 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33212 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33213 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33214 described in the table below.
33215
33216 @table @samp
33217 @item quit
33218 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33219 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33220
33221 @item corefile
33222 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33223 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33224 @end table
33225
33226 @kindex maint packet
33227 @item maint packet @var{text}
33228 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33229 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33230 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33231 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33232 checksum.
33233
33234 @kindex maint print architecture
33235 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33236 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33237 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33238
33239 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33240 @item maint print c-tdesc
33241 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33242 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33243 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33244
33245 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33246 @item maint print dummy-frames
33247 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33248
33249 @smallexample
33250 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33251 @dots{}
33252 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33253 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33254 58 return (a + b);
33255 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33256 @dots{}
33257 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33258 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
33259 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
33260 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
33261 (@value{GDBP})
33262 @end smallexample
33263
33264 Takes an optional file parameter.
33265
33266 @kindex maint print registers
33267 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33268 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33269 @kindex maint print register-groups
33270 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33271 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33272 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33273 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33274 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33275 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33276 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33277
33278 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33279 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33280 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33281 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33282 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33283 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33284 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33285 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33286
33287 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33288 write the information.
33289
33290 @kindex maint print reggroups
33291 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33292 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33293 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33294 information.
33295
33296 The register groups info looks like this:
33297
33298 @smallexample
33299 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33300 Group Type
33301 general user
33302 float user
33303 all user
33304 vector user
33305 system user
33306 save internal
33307 restore internal
33308 @end smallexample
33309
33310 @kindex flushregs
33311 @item flushregs
33312 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33313
33314 @kindex maint print objfiles
33315 @cindex info for known object files
33316 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33317 Print a dump of all known object files.
33318 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33319 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33320 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33321
33322 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33323 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33324 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33325 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33326 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33327 matching @var{regexp}.
33328 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33329 and the full path if known.
33330 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33331
33332 @kindex maint print statistics
33333 @cindex bcache statistics
33334 @item maint print statistics
33335 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33336 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33337 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33338 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33339 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33340 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33341 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33342 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33343 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33344 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33345 lengths.
33346
33347 @kindex maint print target-stack
33348 @cindex target stack description
33349 @item maint print target-stack
33350 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33351 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33352 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33353 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33354 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33355 address.
33356
33357 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33358 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33359
33360 @kindex maint print type
33361 @cindex type chain of a data type
33362 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33363 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33364 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33365 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33366 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33367 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33368
33369 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33370 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33371 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33372 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33373 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33374 information.
33375
33376 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33377 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33378 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33379 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33380 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33381 always see the disassembly form.
33382
33383 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33384
33385 @smallexample
33386 (gdb) info addr argc
33387 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33388 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33389 @end smallexample
33390
33391 For more information on these expressions, see
33392 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33393
33394 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33395 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33396 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33397 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33398 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33399
33400 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33401 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33402 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33403 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33404 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33405 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33406 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33407 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33408 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33409
33410 @kindex maint set profile
33411 @kindex maint show profile
33412 @cindex profiling GDB
33413 @item maint set profile
33414 @itemx maint show profile
33415 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33416
33417 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33418 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33419 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33420 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33421 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33422 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33423 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33424
33425 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33426 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33427
33428 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33429 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33430 @cindex hardware debug registers
33431 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33432 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33433 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33434 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33435 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33436 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33437 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33438
33439 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33440 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33441 @item maint set show-all-tib
33442 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33443 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33444 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33445 command.
33446
33447 @kindex maint set per-command
33448 @kindex maint show per-command
33449 @item maint set per-command
33450 @itemx maint show per-command
33451 @cindex resources used by commands
33452
33453 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33454 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33455
33456 @table @code
33457 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33458 @itemx maint show per-command space
33459 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33460 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33461 took, following the command's own output.
33462 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33463 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33464
33465 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33466 @itemx maint show per-command time
33467 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33468 for each command.
33469 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33470 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33471 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33472 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33473 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33474 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33475 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33476 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33477 spent by the program been debugged.
33478 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33479 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33480
33481 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33482 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33483 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33484 for each command.
33485 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33486
33487 @enumerate a
33488 @item
33489 number of symbol tables
33490 @item
33491 number of primary symbol tables
33492 @item
33493 number of blocks in the blockvector
33494 @end enumerate
33495 @end table
33496
33497 @kindex maint space
33498 @cindex memory used by commands
33499 @item maint space @var{value}
33500 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33501 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33502
33503 @kindex maint time
33504 @cindex time of command execution
33505 @item maint time @var{value}
33506 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33507 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33508
33509 @kindex maint translate-address
33510 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33511 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33512 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33513 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33514 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33515 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33516 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33517
33518 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33519 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33520 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33521
33522 @end table
33523
33524 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33525 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33526
33527 @table @code
33528 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33529 @kindex set watchdog
33530 @cindex watchdog timer
33531 @cindex timeout for commands
33532 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33533 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33534 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33535
33536 @item show watchdog
33537 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33538 @end table
33539
33540 @node Remote Protocol
33541 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33542
33543 @menu
33544 * Overview::
33545 * Packets::
33546 * Stop Reply Packets::
33547 * General Query Packets::
33548 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33549 * Tracepoint Packets::
33550 * Host I/O Packets::
33551 * Interrupts::
33552 * Notification Packets::
33553 * Remote Non-Stop::
33554 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33555 * Examples::
33556 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33557 * Library List Format::
33558 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33559 * Memory Map Format::
33560 * Thread List Format::
33561 * Traceframe Info Format::
33562 * Branch Trace Format::
33563 @end menu
33564
33565 @node Overview
33566 @section Overview
33567
33568 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33569 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33570 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33571 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33572
33573 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33574 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33575
33576 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33577 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33578 @cindex remote serial protocol
33579 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33580 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33581 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33582 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33583 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33584
33585 @smallexample
33586 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33587 @end smallexample
33588 @noindent
33589
33590 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33591 @noindent
33592 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33593 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33594 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33595
33596 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33597 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33598
33599 @smallexample
33600 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33601 @end smallexample
33602
33603 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33604 @noindent
33605 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33606 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33607 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33608
33609 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33610 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33611 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33612 retransmission):
33613
33614 @smallexample
33615 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33616 <- @code{+}
33617 @end smallexample
33618 @noindent
33619
33620 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33621 once a connection is established.
33622 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33623
33624 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33625 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33626 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33627 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33628 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33629 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33630 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33631
33632 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33633 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33634 exceptions).
33635
33636 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33637 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33638 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33639 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33640
33641 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33642 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33643 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33644
33645 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33646 @anchor{Binary Data}
33647 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33648 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33649 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33650 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33651 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33652 binary data.
33653
33654 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33655 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33656 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33657 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33658 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33659 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33660 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33661 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33662 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33663 (described next).
33664
33665 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33666 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33667 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33668 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33669 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33670 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33671 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33672 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33673 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33674 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33675 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33676 3}} more times.
33677
33678 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33679 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33680 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33681 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33682 @samp{0*"00}.
33683
33684 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33685 error number. That number is not well defined.
33686
33687 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33688 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33689 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33690 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33691 on that response.
33692
33693 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33694 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33695 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33696 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33697 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33698 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33699
33700 @node Packets
33701 @section Packets
33702
33703 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33704 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33705 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33706 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33707
33708 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33709 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33710 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33711 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33712 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33713 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33714 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33715 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33716 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33717 @var{baz}.
33718
33719 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33720 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33721 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33722 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33723 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33724 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33725 pick any thread.
33726
33727 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33728 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33729 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33730 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33731 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33732 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33733 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33734 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33735 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33736 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33737 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33738 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33739 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33740
33741 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33742 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33743 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33744 more information.
33745
33746 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33747 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33748
33749 Here are the packet descriptions.
33750
33751 @table @samp
33752
33753 @item !
33754 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33755 @anchor{extended mode}
33756 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33757 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33758 debugged.
33759
33760 Reply:
33761 @table @samp
33762 @item OK
33763 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33764 @end table
33765
33766 @item ?
33767 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33768 @anchor{? packet}
33769 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33770 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33771 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33772
33773 Reply:
33774 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33775
33776 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33777 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33778 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33779 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33780 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33781
33782 Reply:
33783 @table @samp
33784 @item OK
33785 The arguments were set.
33786 @item E @var{NN}
33787 An error occurred.
33788 @end table
33789
33790 @item b @var{baud}
33791 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33792 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33793 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33794
33795 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33796 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33797 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33798
33799 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33800 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33801 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33802 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33803 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33804
33805 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33806 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33807 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33808 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33809
33810 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33811 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33812
33813 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33814 @anchor{bc}
33815 @item bc
33816 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33817 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33818
33819 Reply:
33820 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33821
33822 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33823 @anchor{bs}
33824 @item bs
33825 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33826 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33827
33828 Reply:
33829 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33830
33831 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33832 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33833 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
33834 resume at current address.
33835
33836 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33837 packet}.
33838
33839 Reply:
33840 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33841
33842 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33843 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33844 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33845 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33846
33847 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33848 packet}.
33849
33850 Reply:
33851 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33852
33853 @item d
33854 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33855 Toggle debug flag.
33856
33857 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33858 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33859
33860 @item D
33861 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33862 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33863 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33864 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33865 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33866
33867 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33868 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33869 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33870 big-endian hex string.
33871
33872 Reply:
33873 @table @samp
33874 @item OK
33875 for success
33876 @item E @var{NN}
33877 for an error
33878 @end table
33879
33880 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
33881 @cindex @samp{F} packet
33882 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
33883 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
33884 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
33885
33886 @item g
33887 @anchor{read registers packet}
33888 @cindex @samp{g} packet
33889 Read general registers.
33890
33891 Reply:
33892 @table @samp
33893 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33894 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
33895 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
33896 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
33897 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
33898 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
33899 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
33900
33901 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
33902 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
33903 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
33904 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
33905 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
33906 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
33907 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
33908 have been collected, and both have zero value:
33909
33910 @smallexample
33911 -> @code{g}
33912 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
33913 @end smallexample
33914
33915 @item E @var{NN}
33916 for an error.
33917 @end table
33918
33919 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
33920 @cindex @samp{G} packet
33921 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
33922 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
33923
33924 Reply:
33925 @table @samp
33926 @item OK
33927 for success
33928 @item E @var{NN}
33929 for an error
33930 @end table
33931
33932 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
33933 @cindex @samp{H} packet
33934 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
33935 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
33936 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
33937 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
33938 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
33939 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
33940 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33941
33942 Reply:
33943 @table @samp
33944 @item OK
33945 for success
33946 @item E @var{NN}
33947 for an error
33948 @end table
33949
33950 @c FIXME: JTC:
33951 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
33952 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
33953 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
33954 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
33955 @c described. For example:
33956 @c
33957 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33958 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
33959 @c otherwise returns current registers.
33960 @c
33961 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33962 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
33963 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
33964
33965 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
33966 @anchor{cycle step packet}
33967 @cindex @samp{i} packet
33968 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
33969 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
33970 step starting at that address.
33971
33972 @item I
33973 @cindex @samp{I} packet
33974 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
33975 step packet}.
33976
33977 @item k
33978 @cindex @samp{k} packet
33979 Kill request.
33980
33981 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
33982
33983 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
33984 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
33985
33986 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
33987
33988 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
33989 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
33990 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
33991
33992 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
33993 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
33994 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
33995
33996 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
33997 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
33998 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
33999 (@pxref{? packet}).
34000
34001 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34002 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34003 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34004 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34005
34006 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34007 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34008 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34009 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34010 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34011 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34012 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34013 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34014
34015 Reply:
34016 @table @samp
34017 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34018 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34019 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34020 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34021 @item E @var{NN}
34022 @var{NN} is errno
34023 @end table
34024
34025 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34026 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34027 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34028 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34029 hexadecimal number.
34030
34031 Reply:
34032 @table @samp
34033 @item OK
34034 for success
34035 @item E @var{NN}
34036 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34037 written).
34038 @end table
34039
34040 @item p @var{n}
34041 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34042 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34043 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34044 register value is encoded.
34045
34046 Reply:
34047 @table @samp
34048 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34049 the register's value
34050 @item E @var{NN}
34051 for an error
34052 @item @w{}
34053 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34054 @end table
34055
34056 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34057 @anchor{write register packet}
34058 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34059 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34060 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34061 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34062
34063 Reply:
34064 @table @samp
34065 @item OK
34066 for success
34067 @item E @var{NN}
34068 for an error
34069 @end table
34070
34071 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34072 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34073 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34074 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34075 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34076 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34077
34078 @item r
34079 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34080 Reset the entire system.
34081
34082 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34083
34084 @item R @var{XX}
34085 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34086 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34087 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34088
34089 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34090
34091 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34092 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34093 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
34094 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34095
34096 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34097 packet}.
34098
34099 Reply:
34100 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34101
34102 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34103 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34104 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34105 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34106 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34107
34108 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34109 packet}.
34110
34111 Reply:
34112 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34113
34114 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34115 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34116 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34117 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
34118 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
34119
34120 @item T @var{thread-id}
34121 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34122 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34123
34124 Reply:
34125 @table @samp
34126 @item OK
34127 thread is still alive
34128 @item E @var{NN}
34129 thread is dead
34130 @end table
34131
34132 @item v
34133 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34134 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34135
34136 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34137 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34138 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34139 The process ID is a
34140 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34141 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34142 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34143
34144 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34145 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34146 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34147 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34148 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34149 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34150 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34151 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34152
34153 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34154
34155 Reply:
34156 @table @samp
34157 @item E @var{nn}
34158 for an error
34159 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34160 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34161 @item OK
34162 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34163 @end table
34164
34165 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34166 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34167 @anchor{vCont packet}
34168 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34169 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34170 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34171 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34172 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34173 Specifying multiple
34174 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34175 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34176
34177 Currently supported actions are:
34178
34179 @table @samp
34180 @item c
34181 Continue.
34182 @item C @var{sig}
34183 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34184 @item s
34185 Step.
34186 @item S @var{sig}
34187 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34188 @item t
34189 Stop.
34190 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34191 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34192 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34193 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34194 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34195 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34196
34197 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34198 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34199 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34200 jumps to @var{start}).
34201
34202 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34203 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34204 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34205
34206 @end table
34207
34208 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34209 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34210 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34211
34212 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34213 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34214 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34215 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34216 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34217 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34218 as an implementation detail.
34219
34220 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34221 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34222 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34223 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34224 @var{thread-id}.
34225
34226 Reply:
34227 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34228
34229 @item vCont?
34230 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34231 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34232
34233 Reply:
34234 @table @samp
34235 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34236 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34237 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34238 @item @w{}
34239 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34240 @end table
34241
34242 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34243 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34244 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34245 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34246
34247 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34248 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34249 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34250 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34251 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34252 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34253 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34254 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34255 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34256 packet is received.
34257
34258 Reply:
34259 @table @samp
34260 @item OK
34261 for success
34262 @item E @var{NN}
34263 for an error
34264 @end table
34265
34266 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34267 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34268 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34269 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34270 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34271 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34272 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34273 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34274 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34275 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34276 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34277 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34278
34279
34280 Reply:
34281 @table @samp
34282 @item OK
34283 for success
34284 @item E.memtype
34285 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34286 @item E @var{NN}
34287 for an error
34288 @end table
34289
34290 @item vFlashDone
34291 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34292 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34293 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34294 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34295 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34296 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34297 request is completed.
34298
34299 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34300 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34301 @anchor{vKill packet}
34302 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
34303 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34304 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34305 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34306
34307 Reply:
34308 @table @samp
34309 @item E @var{nn}
34310 for an error
34311 @item OK
34312 for success
34313 @end table
34314
34315 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34316 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34317 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34318 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34319 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34320 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34321 state.
34322
34323 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34324
34325 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34326
34327 Reply:
34328 @table @samp
34329 @item E @var{nn}
34330 for an error
34331 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34332 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34333 @end table
34334
34335 @item vStopped
34336 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34337 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34338
34339 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34340 @anchor{X packet}
34341 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34342 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34343 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
34344 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34345
34346 Reply:
34347 @table @samp
34348 @item OK
34349 for success
34350 @item E @var{NN}
34351 for an error
34352 @end table
34353
34354 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34355 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34356 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34357 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34358 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34359 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34360 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34361
34362 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34363 separately.
34364
34365 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34366 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34367 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34368 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34369 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34370 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34371
34372 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34373 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34374 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34375 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34376 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34377 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34378
34379 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34380 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34381 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34382 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34383 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34384 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34385 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34386 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34387 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34388 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34389
34390 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34391 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34392
34393 @table @samp
34394
34395 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34396 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34397 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34398
34399 @end table
34400
34401 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34402 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34403 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34404 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34405 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34406 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34407 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34408
34409 @table @samp
34410
34411 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34412 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34413 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34414
34415 @end table
34416
34417 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34418
34419 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34420 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34421 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34422 target, is not defined.}
34423
34424 Reply:
34425 @table @samp
34426 @item OK
34427 success
34428 @item @w{}
34429 not supported
34430 @item E @var{NN}
34431 for an error
34432 @end table
34433
34434 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34435 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34436 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34437 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34438 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34439 address @var{addr}.
34440
34441 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34442 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
34443 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34444
34445 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34446 movement.}
34447
34448 Reply:
34449 @table @samp
34450 @item OK
34451 success
34452 @item @w{}
34453 not supported
34454 @item E @var{NN}
34455 for an error
34456 @end table
34457
34458 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34459 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34460 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34461 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34462 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34463 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34464
34465 Reply:
34466 @table @samp
34467 @item OK
34468 success
34469 @item @w{}
34470 not supported
34471 @item E @var{NN}
34472 for an error
34473 @end table
34474
34475 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34476 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34477 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34478 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34479 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34480 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34481
34482 Reply:
34483 @table @samp
34484 @item OK
34485 success
34486 @item @w{}
34487 not supported
34488 @item E @var{NN}
34489 for an error
34490 @end table
34491
34492 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34493 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34494 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34495 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34496 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34497 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34498
34499 Reply:
34500 @table @samp
34501 @item OK
34502 success
34503 @item @w{}
34504 not supported
34505 @item E @var{NN}
34506 for an error
34507 @end table
34508
34509 @end table
34510
34511 @node Stop Reply Packets
34512 @section Stop Reply Packets
34513 @cindex stop reply packets
34514
34515 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34516 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34517 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34518 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34519 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34520 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34521 @value{GDBN} source code.
34522
34523 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34524 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34525 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34526 components.
34527
34528 @table @samp
34529
34530 @item S @var{AA}
34531 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34532 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34533 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34534
34535 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34536 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34537 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34538 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34539 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34540 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34541 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34542 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34543
34544 @itemize @bullet
34545 @item
34546 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34547 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
34548 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34549 two-digit hex number.
34550
34551 @item
34552 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34553 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34554
34555 @item
34556 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34557 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34558
34559 @item
34560 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34561 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34562 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34563 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34564
34565 @item
34566 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34567 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34568 future.
34569 @end itemize
34570
34571 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34572
34573 @table @samp
34574 @item watch
34575 @itemx rwatch
34576 @itemx awatch
34577 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34578 hex.
34579
34580 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34581 @item library
34582 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34583 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34584 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
34585
34586 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34587 @item replaylog
34588 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34589 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34590 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34591 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34592 for more information.
34593 @end table
34594
34595 @item W @var{AA}
34596 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34597 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34598 applicable to certain targets.
34599
34600 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34601 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34602 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34603 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34604
34605 @item X @var{AA}
34606 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34607 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34608
34609 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34610 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34611 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34612 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34613
34614 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34615 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34616 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34617 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34618 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34619
34620 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34621 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34622 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34623 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34624 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34625 system calls.
34626
34627 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34628 this very system call.
34629
34630 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34631 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34632 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34633 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34634 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34635 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34636
34637 @end table
34638
34639 @node General Query Packets
34640 @section General Query Packets
34641 @cindex remote query requests
34642
34643 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34644 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34645 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34646 sending information to and from the stub.
34647
34648 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34649 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34650 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34651 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34652 conventions:
34653
34654 @itemize @bullet
34655 @item
34656 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34657 @item
34658 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34659 letter.
34660 @item
34661 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34662 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34663 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34664 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34665 @end itemize
34666
34667 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34668 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34669 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34670 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34671 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34672 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34673 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34674 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34675 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34676 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34677 packet.}.
34678
34679 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34680 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34681 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34682 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34683 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34684
34685 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34686
34687 @table @samp
34688
34689 @item QAgent:1
34690 @itemx QAgent:0
34691 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34692 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34693
34694 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34695 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34696 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34697 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34698 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34699 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34700 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34701 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34702 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34703 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34704 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34705
34706 @item qC
34707 @cindex current thread, remote request
34708 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34709 Return the current thread ID.
34710
34711 Reply:
34712 @table @samp
34713 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34714 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34715 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34716 @item @r{(anything else)}
34717 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34718 @end table
34719
34720 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34721 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34722 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34723 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34724 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34725 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34726 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34727
34728 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34729 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34730 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34731 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34732 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34733 detect trailing zeros.
34734
34735 Reply:
34736 @table @samp
34737 @item E @var{NN}
34738 An error (such as memory fault)
34739 @item C @var{crc32}
34740 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34741 @end table
34742
34743 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34744 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34745 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34746 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34747 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34748 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34749 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34750 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34751 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34752 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34753 randomization.
34754
34755 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34756
34757 Reply:
34758 @table @samp
34759 @item OK
34760 The request succeeded.
34761
34762 @item E @var{nn}
34763 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34764
34765 @item @w{}
34766 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34767 by the stub.
34768 @end table
34769
34770 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34771 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34772 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34773 address space randomization.
34774
34775 @item qfThreadInfo
34776 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34777 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34778 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34779 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34780 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34781 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34782 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34783 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34784 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34785 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34786
34787 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34788
34789 Reply:
34790 @table @samp
34791 @item m @var{thread-id}
34792 A single thread ID
34793 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34794 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34795 @item l
34796 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34797 @end table
34798
34799 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34800 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34801 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34802 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34803 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34804 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34805 fields.
34806
34807 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34808 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34809 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34810 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34811 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34812
34813 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34814 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34815
34816 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34817 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34818 information associated with the variable.)
34819
34820 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34821 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34822 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34823 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34824 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34825 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34826
34827 Reply:
34828 @table @samp
34829 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34830 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34831 local storage requested.
34832
34833 @item E @var{nn}
34834 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34835
34836 @item @w{}
34837 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34838 @end table
34839
34840 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34841 @cindex get thread information block address
34842 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34843 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34844
34845 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34846
34847 Reply:
34848 @table @samp
34849 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34850 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34851 thread information block.
34852
34853 @item E @var{nn}
34854 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34855 address could not be retrieved.
34856
34857 @item @w{}
34858 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34859 @end table
34860
34861 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34862 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34863 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34864 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34865 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34866 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34867 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
34868
34869 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
34870
34871 Reply:
34872 @table @samp
34873 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
34874 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
34875 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
34876 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
34877 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
34878 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
34879 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
34880 @end table
34881
34882 @item qOffsets
34883 @cindex section offsets, remote request
34884 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
34885 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
34886 image.
34887
34888 Reply:
34889 @table @samp
34890 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
34891 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
34892 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
34893 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
34894 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
34895 segments by the supplied offsets.
34896
34897 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
34898 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
34899 to the @code{Bss} section.}
34900
34901 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
34902 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
34903 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
34904 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
34905 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
34906 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
34907 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
34908 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
34909 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
34910 @end table
34911
34912 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
34913 @cindex thread information, remote request
34914 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
34915 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
34916 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
34917 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
34918
34919 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
34920 (see below).
34921
34922 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
34923
34924 @item QNonStop:1
34925 @itemx QNonStop:0
34926 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
34927 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
34928 @anchor{QNonStop}
34929 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
34930 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
34931
34932 Reply:
34933 @table @samp
34934 @item OK
34935 The request succeeded.
34936
34937 @item E @var{nn}
34938 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34939
34940 @item @w{}
34941 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
34942 the stub.
34943 @end table
34944
34945 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34946 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34947 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
34948 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
34949
34950 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34951 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
34952 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
34953 @anchor{QPassSignals}
34954 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
34955 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
34956 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
34957 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
34958 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
34959 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
34960 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
34961 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
34962 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
34963
34964 Reply:
34965 @table @samp
34966 @item OK
34967 The request succeeded.
34968
34969 @item E @var{nn}
34970 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34971
34972 @item @w{}
34973 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
34974 the stub.
34975 @end table
34976
34977 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
34978 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
34979 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34980 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34981
34982 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34983 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
34984 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
34985 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
34986 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
34987 Others should be silently discarded.
34988
34989 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
34990 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
34991 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
34992 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
34993 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
34994 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
34995 signals.
34996
34997 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
34998 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
34999
35000 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35001 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35002 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35003 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35004 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35005
35006 Reply:
35007 @table @samp
35008 @item OK
35009 The request succeeded.
35010
35011 @item E @var{nn}
35012 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
35013
35014 @item @w{}
35015 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35016 by the stub.
35017 @end table
35018
35019 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35020 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35021 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35022 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35023
35024 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35025 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35026 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35027 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35028 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35029 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35030 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35031 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35032 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35033
35034 Reply:
35035 @table @samp
35036 @item OK
35037 A command response with no output.
35038 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35039 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35040 @item E @var{NN}
35041 Indicate a badly formed request.
35042 @item @w{}
35043 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35044 @end table
35045
35046 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35047 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35048 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35049 packets.)
35050
35051 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35052 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35053 @ifnotinfo
35054 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35055 @end ifnotinfo
35056 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35057 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35058 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35059 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
35060 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
35061
35062 Reply:
35063 @table @samp
35064 @item 0
35065 The pattern was not found.
35066 @item 1,address
35067 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35068 @item E @var{NN}
35069 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35070 @item @w{}
35071 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35072 @end table
35073
35074 @item QStartNoAckMode
35075 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35076 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35077 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35078 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35079
35080 Reply:
35081 @table @samp
35082 @item OK
35083 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35084 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35085 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35086 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35087 @item @w{}
35088 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35089 @end table
35090
35091 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35092 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35093 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35094 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35095 @anchor{qSupported}
35096 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35097 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35098 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35099 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35100 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35101 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35102 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35103 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35104 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35105 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35106 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35107 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35108 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35109 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35110
35111 Reply:
35112 @table @samp
35113 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35114 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35115 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35116 possible forms).
35117 @item @w{}
35118 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35119 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35120 @end table
35121
35122 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35123 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35124 are:
35125
35126 @table @samp
35127 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35128 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35129 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35130 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35131 @item @var{name}+
35132 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35133 need an associated value.
35134 @item @var{name}-
35135 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35136 @item @var{name}?
35137 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35138 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35139 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35140 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35141 @end table
35142
35143 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35144 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35145 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35146 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35147 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35148
35149 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35150 are defined:
35151
35152 @table @samp
35153 @item multiprocess
35154 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35155 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35156 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35157 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35158 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35159
35160 @item xmlRegisters
35161 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35162 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35163 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35164 description.
35165
35166 @item qRelocInsn
35167 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35168 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35169 instruction reply packet}).
35170 @end table
35171
35172 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35173 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35174 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35175 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35176 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35177 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35178 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35179 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35180 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35181 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35182 all the features it supports.
35183
35184 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35185 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35186
35187 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35188 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35189 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35190 form response.
35191
35192 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35193 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35194 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35195 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35196
35197 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35198 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35199 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35200 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35201 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35202
35203 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35204
35205 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35206 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35207 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35208 @item Feature Name
35209 @tab Value Required
35210 @tab Default
35211 @tab Probe Allowed
35212
35213 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35214 @tab Yes
35215 @tab @samp{-}
35216 @tab No
35217
35218 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35219 @tab No
35220 @tab @samp{-}
35221 @tab Yes
35222
35223 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35224 @tab No
35225 @tab @samp{-}
35226 @tab Yes
35227
35228 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35229 @tab No
35230 @tab @samp{-}
35231 @tab Yes
35232
35233 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35234 @tab No
35235 @tab @samp{-}
35236 @tab Yes
35237
35238 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35239 @tab No
35240 @tab @samp{-}
35241 @tab Yes
35242
35243 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35244 @tab No
35245 @tab @samp{-}
35246 @tab No
35247
35248 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35249 @tab No
35250 @tab @samp{-}
35251 @tab Yes
35252
35253 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35254 @tab No
35255 @tab @samp{-}
35256 @tab Yes
35257
35258 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35259 @tab No
35260 @tab @samp{-}
35261 @tab Yes
35262
35263 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35264 @tab No
35265 @tab @samp{-}
35266 @tab Yes
35267
35268 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35269 @tab No
35270 @tab @samp{-}
35271 @tab Yes
35272
35273 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35274 @tab No
35275 @tab @samp{-}
35276 @tab Yes
35277
35278 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35279 @tab No
35280 @tab @samp{-}
35281 @tab Yes
35282
35283 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35284 @tab No
35285 @tab @samp{-}
35286 @tab Yes
35287
35288 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35289 @tab No
35290 @tab @samp{-}
35291 @tab Yes
35292
35293 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35294 @tab No
35295 @tab @samp{-}
35296 @tab Yes
35297
35298 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35299 @tab Yes
35300 @tab @samp{-}
35301 @tab Yes
35302
35303 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35304 @tab Yes
35305 @tab @samp{-}
35306 @tab Yes
35307
35308 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35309 @tab No
35310 @tab @samp{-}
35311 @tab Yes
35312
35313 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35314 @tab No
35315 @tab @samp{-}
35316 @tab Yes
35317
35318 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35319 @tab No
35320 @tab @samp{-}
35321 @tab Yes
35322
35323 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35324 @tab No
35325 @tab @samp{-}
35326 @tab No
35327
35328 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35329 @tab No
35330 @tab @samp{-}
35331 @tab No
35332
35333 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35334 @tab No
35335 @tab @samp{-}
35336 @tab No
35337
35338 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35339 @tab No
35340 @tab @samp{-}
35341 @tab No
35342
35343 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35344 @tab No
35345 @tab @samp{-}
35346 @tab No
35347
35348 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35349 @tab No
35350 @tab @samp{-}
35351 @tab No
35352
35353 @item @samp{QAgent}
35354 @tab No
35355 @tab @samp{-}
35356 @tab No
35357
35358 @item @samp{QAllow}
35359 @tab No
35360 @tab @samp{-}
35361 @tab No
35362
35363 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35364 @tab No
35365 @tab @samp{-}
35366 @tab No
35367
35368 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35369 @tab No
35370 @tab @samp{-}
35371 @tab No
35372
35373 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35374 @tab No
35375 @tab @samp{-}
35376 @tab No
35377
35378 @item @samp{tracenz}
35379 @tab No
35380 @tab @samp{-}
35381 @tab No
35382
35383 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35384 @tab No
35385 @tab @samp{-}
35386 @tab No
35387
35388 @end multitable
35389
35390 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35391
35392 @table @samp
35393 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35394 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35395 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35396 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35397 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35398 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35399 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35400 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35401 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35402 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35403
35404 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35405 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35406 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35407
35408 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35409 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35410 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35411
35412 @item qXfer:features:read
35413 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35414 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35415
35416 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35417 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35418 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35419
35420 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35421 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35422 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35423
35424 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35425 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35426 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35427 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35428
35429 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35430 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35431 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35432
35433 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35434 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35435 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35436
35437 @item qXfer:spu:read
35438 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35439 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35440
35441 @item qXfer:spu:write
35442 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35443 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35444
35445 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35446 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35447 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35448
35449 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35450 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35451 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35452
35453 @item qXfer:threads:read
35454 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35455 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35456
35457 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35458 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35459 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35460
35461 @item qXfer:uib:read
35462 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35463 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35464
35465 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35466 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35467 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35468
35469 @item QNonStop
35470 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35471 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35472
35473 @item QPassSignals
35474 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35475 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35476
35477 @item QStartNoAckMode
35478 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35479 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35480
35481 @item multiprocess
35482 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35483 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35484 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35485 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35486 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35487 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35488 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35489 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35490 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35491 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35492 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35493
35494 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35495 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35496 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35497
35498 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35499 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35500 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35501 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35502
35503 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35504 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35505 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35506
35507 @item ReverseContinue
35508 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35509 (@pxref{bc}).
35510
35511 @item ReverseStep
35512 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35513 (@pxref{bs}).
35514
35515 @item TracepointSource
35516 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35517 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35518
35519 @item QAgent
35520 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35521
35522 @item QAllow
35523 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35524
35525 @item QDisableRandomization
35526 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35527
35528 @item StaticTracepoint
35529 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35530 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35531
35532 @item InstallInTrace
35533 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35534 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35535
35536 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35537 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35538 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35539 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35540
35541 @item QTBuffer:size
35542 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35543 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35544
35545 @item tracenz
35546 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35547 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35548 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35549
35550 @item BreakpointCommands
35551 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35552 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35553 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35554
35555 @item Qbtrace:off
35556 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35557
35558 @item Qbtrace:bts
35559 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35560
35561 @end table
35562
35563 @item qSymbol::
35564 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35565 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35566 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35567 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35568
35569 Reply:
35570 @table @samp
35571 @item OK
35572 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35573 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35574 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35575 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35576 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35577 below.
35578 @end table
35579
35580 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35581 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35582
35583 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35584 target has previously requested.
35585
35586 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35587 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35588 will be empty.
35589
35590 Reply:
35591 @table @samp
35592 @item OK
35593 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35594 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35595 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35596 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35597 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35598 @end table
35599
35600 @item qTBuffer
35601 @itemx QTBuffer
35602 @itemx QTDisconnected
35603 @itemx QTDP
35604 @itemx QTDPsrc
35605 @itemx QTDV
35606 @itemx qTfP
35607 @itemx qTfV
35608 @itemx QTFrame
35609 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35610
35611 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35612
35613 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35614 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35615 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35616 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
35617 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
35618 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
35619 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35620 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35621 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35622 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35623 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35624
35625 Reply:
35626 @table @samp
35627 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35628 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35629 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35630 the thread's attributes.
35631 @end table
35632
35633 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35634 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35635 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35636 packets.)
35637
35638 @item QTNotes
35639 @itemx qTP
35640 @itemx QTSave
35641 @itemx qTsP
35642 @itemx qTsV
35643 @itemx QTStart
35644 @itemx QTStop
35645 @itemx QTEnable
35646 @itemx QTDisable
35647 @itemx QTinit
35648 @itemx QTro
35649 @itemx qTStatus
35650 @itemx qTV
35651 @itemx qTfSTM
35652 @itemx qTsSTM
35653 @itemx qTSTMat
35654 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35655
35656 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35657 @cindex read special object, remote request
35658 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35659 @anchor{qXfer read}
35660 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35661 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35662 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35663 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35664 additional details about what data to access.
35665
35666 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35667 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35668 formats, listed below.
35669
35670 @table @samp
35671 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35672 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35673 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35674 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35675
35676 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35677 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35678
35679 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35680 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35681
35682 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35683 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35684 packet may have one of the following values:
35685
35686 @table @code
35687 @item all
35688 Returns all available branch trace.
35689
35690 @item new
35691 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35692 the last read request.
35693
35694 @item delta
35695 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35696 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35697 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35698 used to stitch traces together.
35699
35700 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35701 @end table
35702
35703 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35704 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35705
35706 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35707 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35708 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35709 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35710 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35711
35712 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35713 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35714
35715 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35716 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35717 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35718 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35719 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35720
35721 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35722 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35723 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35724
35725 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35726 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35727
35728 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35729 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35730 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35731 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35732 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35733 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35734 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35735 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35736
35737 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35738 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35739
35740 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35741 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35742
35743 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35744 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35745 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35746 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35747
35748 @table @code
35749 @item start=@var{address}
35750 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35751 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35752 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35753 chosen as the starting point.
35754
35755 @item prev=@var{address}
35756 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35757 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35758 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35759 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35760 exists prior to the starting point.
35761
35762 @end table
35763
35764 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35765 ignored.
35766
35767 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35768 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35769 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35770 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35771 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35772
35773 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35774 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35775
35776 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35777 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35778
35779 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35780 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35781 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35782 Action Lists}.
35783
35784 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35785 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35786 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35787
35788 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35789 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35790 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35791 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35792 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35793
35794 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35795 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35796 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35797
35798 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35799 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35800 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35801 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35802 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35803 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35804 in that context to be accessed.
35805
35806 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35807 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35808 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35809
35810 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35811 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35812 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35813 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35814 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35815
35816 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35817 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35818
35819 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35820 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35821
35822 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35823 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35824 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35825
35826 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35827 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35828
35829 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35830 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
35831
35832 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
35833 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
35834
35835 This packet is not probed by default.
35836
35837 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35838 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35839 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35840 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35841 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35842
35843 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35844 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35845
35846 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35847 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35848 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35849 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35850
35851 @end table
35852
35853 Reply:
35854 @table @samp
35855 @item m @var{data}
35856 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35857 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35858 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35859 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35860 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35861 request.
35862
35863 @item l @var{data}
35864 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35865 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
35866 than the @var{length} in the request.
35867
35868 @item l
35869 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
35870 There is no more data to be read.
35871
35872 @item E00
35873 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35874
35875 @item E @var{nn}
35876 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
35877 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35878
35879 @item @w{}
35880 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
35881 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
35882 @end table
35883
35884 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35885 @cindex write data into object, remote request
35886 @anchor{qXfer write}
35887 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
35888 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
35889 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
35890 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
35891 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
35892 to access.
35893
35894 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35895 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35896 formats, listed below.
35897
35898 @table @samp
35899 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35900 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
35901 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
35902 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35903 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
35904
35905 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35906 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35907 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35908
35909 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35910 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
35911 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35912 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
35913 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35914 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35915 in that context to be accessed.
35916
35917 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35918 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35919 @end table
35920
35921 Reply:
35922 @table @samp
35923 @item @var{nn}
35924 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
35925 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
35926
35927 @item E00
35928 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35929
35930 @item E @var{nn}
35931 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
35932 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35933
35934 @item @w{}
35935 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
35936 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
35937 @end table
35938
35939 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
35940 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
35941 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
35942 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
35943 must respond with an empty packet.
35944
35945 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
35946 @cindex query attached, remote request
35947 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
35948 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
35949 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
35950 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
35951 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
35952 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
35953 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
35954
35955 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
35956 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
35957 the @code{quit} command.
35958
35959 Reply:
35960 @table @samp
35961 @item 1
35962 The remote server attached to an existing process.
35963 @item 0
35964 The remote server created a new process.
35965 @item E @var{NN}
35966 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35967 @end table
35968
35969 @item Qbtrace:bts
35970 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
35971
35972 Reply:
35973 @table @samp
35974 @item OK
35975 Branch tracing has been enabled.
35976 @item E.errtext
35977 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35978 @end table
35979
35980 @item Qbtrace:off
35981 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
35982
35983 Reply:
35984 @table @samp
35985 @item OK
35986 Branch tracing has been disabled.
35987 @item E.errtext
35988 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35989 @end table
35990
35991 @end table
35992
35993 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35994 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35995
35996 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
35997 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
35998 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
35999
36000 @menu
36001 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36002 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36003 @end menu
36004
36005 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36006 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36007
36008 @menu
36009 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36010 @end menu
36011
36012 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36013 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36014 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36015
36016 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36017
36018 @table @r
36019
36020 @item 2
36021 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36022
36023 @item 3
36024 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36025
36026 @item 4
36027 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36028
36029 @end table
36030
36031 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36032 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36033
36034 @menu
36035 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36036 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36037 @end menu
36038
36039 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36040 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36041 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36042
36043 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36044 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36045 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36046 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36047 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36048 most-significant -- least-significant.
36049
36050 @table @r
36051
36052 @item MIPS32
36053 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36054 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36055 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36056
36057 @item MIPS64
36058 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36059 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36060 as @code{MIPS32}.
36061
36062 @end table
36063
36064 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36065 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36066 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36067
36068 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36069
36070 @table @r
36071
36072 @item 2
36073 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36074
36075 @item 3
36076 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36077
36078 @item 4
36079 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36080
36081 @item 5
36082 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36083
36084 @end table
36085
36086 @node Tracepoint Packets
36087 @section Tracepoint Packets
36088 @cindex tracepoint packets
36089 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36090
36091 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36092 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36093
36094 @table @samp
36095
36096 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36097 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36098 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36099 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36100 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
36101 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36102 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36103 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36104 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36105 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36106 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36107 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36108 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36109 actions.
36110
36111 Replies:
36112 @table @samp
36113 @item OK
36114 The packet was understood and carried out.
36115 @item qRelocInsn
36116 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36117 @item @w{}
36118 The packet was not recognized.
36119 @end table
36120
36121 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36122 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
36123 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36124 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36125 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36126 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36127 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36128
36129 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36130 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36131 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36132 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36133 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36134 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36135 tracepoint actions.
36136
36137 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36138 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36139 following forms:
36140
36141 @table @samp
36142
36143 @item R @var{mask}
36144 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
36145 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36146 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36147 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36148 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36149
36150 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36151 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36152 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36153 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36154 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36155 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36156 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36157
36158 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36159 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36160 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
36161 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36162 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36163 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36164 packet).
36165
36166 @end table
36167
36168 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36169 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36170 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36171 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36172 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36173 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36174 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36175 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36176
36177 Replies:
36178 @table @samp
36179 @item OK
36180 The packet was understood and carried out.
36181 @item qRelocInsn
36182 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36183 @item @w{}
36184 The packet was not recognized.
36185 @end table
36186
36187 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36188 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36189 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36190 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36191 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
36192 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36193 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36194 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36195
36196 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36197 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36198 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36199 fit in a single packet.
36200 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36201 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36202
36203 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36204 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36205 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36206 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36207
36208 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36209 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36210 query packets.
36211
36212 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36213 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36214 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36215 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36216 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36217 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36218 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36219 be found.
36220
36221 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36222 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36223 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36224 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36225 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36226 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36227 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36228 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36229 mentioned in expressions.
36230
36231 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36232 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36233 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36234 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36235 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36236
36237 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36238 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36239 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36240 one of the following forms:
36241
36242 @table @samp
36243 @item F @var{f}
36244 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36245 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36246 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36247
36248 @item T @var{t}
36249 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36250 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36251
36252 @end table
36253
36254 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36255 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36256 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36257 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36258
36259 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36260 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36261 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36262 is a hexadecimal number.
36263
36264 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36265 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36266 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36267 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36268 numbers.
36269
36270 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36271 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36272 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36273
36274 @item qTMinFTPILen
36275 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36276 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36277 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36278 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36279 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36280 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36281 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36282 arrange for that.
36283
36284 Replies:
36285
36286 @table @samp
36287 @item 0
36288 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36289 @item @var{length}
36290 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} is greater
36291 or equal to 1. @var{length} is a hexadecimal number. A reply of 1 means
36292 that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
36293 @item E
36294 An error has occurred.
36295 @item @w{}
36296 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36297 @end table
36298
36299 @item QTStart
36300 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36301 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36302 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36303 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36304 instruction reply packet}).
36305
36306 @item QTStop
36307 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36308 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36309
36310 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36311 @anchor{QTEnable}
36312 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36313 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36314 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36315 of data from it will resume.
36316
36317 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36318 @anchor{QTDisable}
36319 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36320 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36321 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36322 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36323
36324 @item QTinit
36325 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36326 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36327
36328 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36329 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36330 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36331 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36332 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36333
36334 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36335 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36336 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36337 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36338
36339 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36340 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36341 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36342 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36343 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36344 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36345
36346 @item qTStatus
36347 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36348 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36349
36350 The reply has the form:
36351
36352 @table @samp
36353
36354 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36355 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36356 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36357 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36358
36359 @end table
36360
36361 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36362 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36363
36364 @table @samp
36365
36366 @item tnotrun:0
36367 No trace has been run yet.
36368
36369 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36370 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36371 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36372 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36373 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36374
36375 @item tfull:0
36376 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36377
36378 @item tdisconnected:0
36379 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36380
36381 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36382 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36383
36384 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36385 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36386 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36387 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
36388 @var{text} is hex encoded.
36389
36390 @item tunknown:0
36391 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36392
36393 @end table
36394
36395 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36396 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36397 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36398 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36399 trace.
36400
36401 @table @samp
36402
36403 @item tframes:@var{n}
36404 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36405
36406 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36407 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36408 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36409
36410 @item tsize:@var{n}
36411 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36412
36413 @item tfree:@var{n}
36414 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36415
36416 @item circular:@var{n}
36417 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36418 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36419 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36420 and may fill up.
36421
36422 @item disconn:@var{n}
36423 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36424 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36425 that the trace run will stop.
36426
36427 @end table
36428
36429 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36430 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36431 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36432 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36433 address @var{addr}.
36434
36435 Replies:
36436 @table @samp
36437 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36438 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36439 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36440 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36441 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36442
36443 @end table
36444
36445 @item qTV:@var{var}
36446 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36447 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36448 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36449
36450 Replies:
36451 @table @samp
36452 @item V@var{value}
36453 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36454 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36455 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36456 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36457 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36458 program is running.
36459
36460 @item U
36461 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36462 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36463 was not collected.
36464 @end table
36465
36466 @item qTfP
36467 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36468 @itemx qTsP
36469 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36470 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36471 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36472 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36473 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36474 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36475
36476 @item qTfV
36477 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36478 @itemx qTsV
36479 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36480 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36481 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36482 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36483 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36484 trace state variables.
36485
36486 @item qTfSTM
36487 @itemx qTsSTM
36488 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36489 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36490 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36491 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36492 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36493 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36494 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36495 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36496
36497 Reply:
36498 @table @samp
36499 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36500 A single marker
36501 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36502 a comma-separated list of markers
36503 @item l
36504 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36505 @item E @var{nn}
36506 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36507 @item @w{}
36508 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36509 stub.
36510 @end table
36511
36512 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
36513 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36514
36515 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36516 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36517 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36518 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36519 @dfn{last}).
36520
36521 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36522 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36523 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36524 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36525 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36526 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36527 tracepoint markers.
36528
36529 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36530 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36531 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36532 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
36533 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36534 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36535
36536 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36537 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36538 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36539 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36540 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36541 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36542 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36543 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36544 available.
36545
36546 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36547 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36548 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36549
36550 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36551 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36552 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36553 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36554 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36555 use whatever size it prefers.
36556
36557 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36558 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36559 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36560 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36561 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36562
36563 @end table
36564
36565 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36566 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36567 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36568 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36569 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36570 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36571 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36572 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36573 it had executed in the original location.
36574
36575 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36576 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36577 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36578 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36579 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36580 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36581 format of the request is:
36582
36583 @table @samp
36584 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36585
36586 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36587 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36588 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36589 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36590 memory starting at @var{to}.
36591 @end table
36592
36593 Replies:
36594 @table @samp
36595 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36596 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
36597 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36598 @item E @var{NN}
36599 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36600 relocating the instruction.
36601 @end table
36602
36603 @node Host I/O Packets
36604 @section Host I/O Packets
36605 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36606 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36607
36608 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36609 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36610 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36611 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36612 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36613 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36614 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36615 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36616 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36617 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36618
36619 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36620 its arguments. They have this format:
36621
36622 @table @samp
36623
36624 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36625 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36626 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36627 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36628 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36629 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36630 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36631 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36632 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36633
36634 @end table
36635
36636 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36637
36638 @table @samp
36639
36640 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36641 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36642 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36643 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
36644 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36645 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36646 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36647 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36648 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36649 @var{attachment}.
36650
36651 @item @w{}
36652 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36653
36654 @end table
36655
36656 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36657
36658 @table @samp
36659 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36660 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36661 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
36662 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36663 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36664 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36665 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36666
36667 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36668 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36669 -1 if an error occurs.
36670
36671 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36672 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36673 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36674 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36675 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36676 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36677 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36678 @var{count} was zero.
36679
36680 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36681 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36682 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36683 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36684 some characters were escaped.
36685
36686 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36687 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36688 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36689 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36690 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36691 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36692 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36693 error occurred.
36694
36695 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
36696 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
36697 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
36698
36699 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36700 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36701 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36702
36703 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36704 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36705 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36706 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36707 some characters were escaped.
36708
36709 @end table
36710
36711 @node Interrupts
36712 @section Interrupts
36713 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36714
36715 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36716 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36717 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36718 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36719
36720 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36721 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36722 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36723 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36724 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36725
36726 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36727 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36728 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36729 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36730 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36731 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36732 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36733 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36734
36735 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36736 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36737 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36738
36739 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36740 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36741 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36742 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36743 currently-executing threads and processes.
36744 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36745 running program, it should send one of the stop
36746 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36747 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36748 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36749 Interrupts received while the
36750 program is stopped are discarded.
36751
36752 @node Notification Packets
36753 @section Notification Packets
36754 @cindex notification packets
36755 @cindex packets, notification
36756
36757 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36758 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36759 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36760 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36761 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36762 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36763 is not a problem.
36764
36765 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36766 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36767 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36768 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36769 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36770 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36771 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36772
36773 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36774 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36775
36776 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36777 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36778 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36779 not they understand it.
36780
36781 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36782 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36783 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36784 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36785 recipients.
36786
36787 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36788 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36789 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36790 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36791 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36792
36793 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
36794 @table @samp
36795 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
36796 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
36797 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
36798 carrying the specific information about the notification.
36799 @var{name} is the name of the notification.
36800 @item @var{ack}
36801 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
36802 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
36803 @end table
36804
36805 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
36806 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
36807
36808 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
36809 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
36810 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
36811 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
36812 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36813 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36814 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
36815 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36816 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
36817 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
36818
36819 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
36820 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
36821 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36822 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36823 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36824 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36825
36826 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
36827 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
36828 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
36829 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
36830 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
36831
36832 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
36833 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36834 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
36835 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
36836 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
36837 normally.
36838
36839 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
36840 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
36841 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
36842 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
36843 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
36844 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
36845 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
36846 the process shall be repeated.
36847
36848 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
36849 following example:
36850 @smallexample
36851 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
36852 @code{...}
36853 -> @code{vStopped}
36854 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
36855 -> @code{vStopped}
36856 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
36857 -> @code{vStopped}
36858 <- @code{OK}
36859 @end smallexample
36860
36861 The following notifications are defined:
36862 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
36863
36864 @item Notification
36865 @tab Ack
36866 @tab Event
36867 @tab Description
36868
36869 @item Stop
36870 @tab vStopped
36871 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
36872 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
36873 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
36874 @value{GDBN}.
36875 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
36876
36877 @end multitable
36878
36879 @node Remote Non-Stop
36880 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
36881
36882 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
36883 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
36884 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
36885 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36886
36887 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
36888 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
36889 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
36890 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
36891 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
36892 probe the target state after a mode change.
36893
36894 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
36895 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
36896 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
36897 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
36898 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
36899 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
36900 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
36901 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
36902 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
36903 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
36904 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
36905
36906 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
36907 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
36908 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
36909 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
36910 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
36911 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
36912 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
36913 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
36914 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
36915 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
36916 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
36917 @samp{OK}.
36918
36919 @node Packet Acknowledgment
36920 @section Packet Acknowledgment
36921
36922 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36923 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36924 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
36925 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36926 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
36927 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
36928 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
36929
36930 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
36931 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
36932 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
36933 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
36934 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
36935
36936 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
36937 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
36938 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
36939 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
36940
36941 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
36942 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
36943 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
36944 @pxref{qSupported}.
36945 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
36946 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
36947 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
36948 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
36949 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
36950 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
36951 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
36952
36953 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
36954 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
36955 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
36956 connection.
36957 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
36958 new connection is established,
36959 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
36960 for the current connection, once disabled.
36961
36962 @node Examples
36963 @section Examples
36964
36965 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
36966 does not get any direct output:
36967
36968 @smallexample
36969 -> @code{R00}
36970 <- @code{+}
36971 @emph{target restarts}
36972 -> @code{?}
36973 <- @code{+}
36974 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36975 -> @code{+}
36976 @end smallexample
36977
36978 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
36979
36980 @smallexample
36981 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
36982 <- @code{+}
36983 -> @code{s}
36984 <- @code{+}
36985 @emph{time passes}
36986 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36987 -> @code{+}
36988 -> @code{g}
36989 <- @code{+}
36990 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
36991 -> @code{+}
36992 @end smallexample
36993
36994 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36995 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36996 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
36997
36998 @menu
36999 * File-I/O Overview::
37000 * Protocol Basics::
37001 * The F Request Packet::
37002 * The F Reply Packet::
37003 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37004 * Console I/O::
37005 * List of Supported Calls::
37006 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37007 * Constants::
37008 * File-I/O Examples::
37009 @end menu
37010
37011 @node File-I/O Overview
37012 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37013 @cindex file-i/o overview
37014
37015 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37016 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37017 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37018 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37019 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37020 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37021
37022 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37023 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37024 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37025 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37026 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37027
37028 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37029 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37030 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37031 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37032 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37033 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37034 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37035
37036 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37037 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37038 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37039 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37040 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37041
37042 @smallexample
37043 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37044 <- target requests 'system call X'
37045 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37046 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37047 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37048 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37049 @end smallexample
37050
37051 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37052 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37053 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37054 system are not supported by this protocol.
37055
37056 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37057
37058 @node Protocol Basics
37059 @subsection Protocol Basics
37060 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37061
37062 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37063 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37064 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37065 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37066 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37067 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37068 to call the appropriate host system call:
37069
37070 @itemize @bullet
37071 @item
37072 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37073
37074 @item
37075 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37076 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37077 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37078 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37079
37080 @end itemize
37081
37082 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37083
37084 @itemize @bullet
37085 @item
37086 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37087 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37088 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37089 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37090 packet.
37091
37092 @item
37093 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37094 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37095
37096 @item
37097 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37098
37099 @item
37100 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37101
37102 @item
37103 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37104 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37105 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37106 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37107 packet.
37108
37109 @end itemize
37110
37111 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37112 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37113
37114 @itemize @bullet
37115 @item
37116 Return value.
37117
37118 @item
37119 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37120
37121 @item
37122 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37123
37124 @end itemize
37125
37126 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37127 the latest continue or step action.
37128
37129 @node The F Request Packet
37130 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37131 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37132 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37133
37134 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37135
37136 @table @samp
37137 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37138
37139 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37140 This is just the name of the function.
37141
37142 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37143 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37144 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37145 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37146 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37147 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37148 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37149
37150 @end table
37151
37152
37153
37154 @node The F Reply Packet
37155 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37156 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37157 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37158
37159 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37160
37161 @table @samp
37162
37163 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37164
37165 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37166
37167 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37168 representation.
37169 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37170
37171 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37172 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37173 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37174
37175 @smallexample
37176 F0,0,C
37177 @end smallexample
37178
37179 @noindent
37180 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37181
37182 @smallexample
37183 F-1,4,C
37184 @end smallexample
37185
37186 @noindent
37187 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37188
37189 @end table
37190
37191
37192 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37193 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37194 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37195
37196 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37197 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37198 the target should behave as if it had
37199 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37200 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37201 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37202 packet.
37203
37204 It's important for the target to know in which
37205 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37206
37207 @itemize @bullet
37208 @item
37209 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37210
37211 @item
37212 The system call on the host has been finished.
37213
37214 @end itemize
37215
37216 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37217 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37218 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37219 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37220 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37221 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37222
37223 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37224 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37225 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37226 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37227 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37228 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37229 or the full action has been completed.
37230
37231 @node Console I/O
37232 @subsection Console I/O
37233 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37234
37235 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37236 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37237 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37238 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37239 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37240 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37241 conditions is met:
37242
37243 @itemize @bullet
37244 @item
37245 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37246 @code{read}
37247 system call is treated as finished.
37248
37249 @item
37250 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37251 newline.
37252
37253 @item
37254 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37255 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37256
37257 @end itemize
37258
37259 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37260 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37261 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37262 is stopped at the user's request.
37263
37264
37265 @node List of Supported Calls
37266 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37267 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37268
37269 @menu
37270 * open::
37271 * close::
37272 * read::
37273 * write::
37274 * lseek::
37275 * rename::
37276 * unlink::
37277 * stat/fstat::
37278 * gettimeofday::
37279 * isatty::
37280 * system::
37281 @end menu
37282
37283 @node open
37284 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37285 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37286
37287 @table @asis
37288 @item Synopsis:
37289 @smallexample
37290 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37291 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37292 @end smallexample
37293
37294 @item Request:
37295 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37296
37297 @noindent
37298 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37299
37300 @table @code
37301 @item O_CREAT
37302 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37303 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37304 are concerned.
37305
37306 @item O_EXCL
37307 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37308 an error and open() fails.
37309
37310 @item O_TRUNC
37311 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37312 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37313 truncated to zero length.
37314
37315 @item O_APPEND
37316 The file is opened in append mode.
37317
37318 @item O_RDONLY
37319 The file is opened for reading only.
37320
37321 @item O_WRONLY
37322 The file is opened for writing only.
37323
37324 @item O_RDWR
37325 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37326 @end table
37327
37328 @noindent
37329 Other bits are silently ignored.
37330
37331
37332 @noindent
37333 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37334
37335 @table @code
37336 @item S_IRUSR
37337 User has read permission.
37338
37339 @item S_IWUSR
37340 User has write permission.
37341
37342 @item S_IRGRP
37343 Group has read permission.
37344
37345 @item S_IWGRP
37346 Group has write permission.
37347
37348 @item S_IROTH
37349 Others have read permission.
37350
37351 @item S_IWOTH
37352 Others have write permission.
37353 @end table
37354
37355 @noindent
37356 Other bits are silently ignored.
37357
37358
37359 @item Return value:
37360 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37361 occurred.
37362
37363 @item Errors:
37364
37365 @table @code
37366 @item EEXIST
37367 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37368
37369 @item EISDIR
37370 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37371
37372 @item EACCES
37373 The requested access is not allowed.
37374
37375 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37376 @var{pathname} was too long.
37377
37378 @item ENOENT
37379 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37380
37381 @item ENODEV
37382 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37383
37384 @item EROFS
37385 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37386 write access was requested.
37387
37388 @item EFAULT
37389 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37390
37391 @item ENOSPC
37392 No space on device to create the file.
37393
37394 @item EMFILE
37395 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37396
37397 @item ENFILE
37398 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37399 has been reached.
37400
37401 @item EINTR
37402 The call was interrupted by the user.
37403 @end table
37404
37405 @end table
37406
37407 @node close
37408 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37409 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37410
37411 @table @asis
37412 @item Synopsis:
37413 @smallexample
37414 int close(int fd);
37415 @end smallexample
37416
37417 @item Request:
37418 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37419
37420 @item Return value:
37421 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37422
37423 @item Errors:
37424
37425 @table @code
37426 @item EBADF
37427 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37428
37429 @item EINTR
37430 The call was interrupted by the user.
37431 @end table
37432
37433 @end table
37434
37435 @node read
37436 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37437 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37438
37439 @table @asis
37440 @item Synopsis:
37441 @smallexample
37442 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37443 @end smallexample
37444
37445 @item Request:
37446 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37447
37448 @item Return value:
37449 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37450 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37451 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37452
37453 @item Errors:
37454
37455 @table @code
37456 @item EBADF
37457 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37458 reading.
37459
37460 @item EFAULT
37461 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37462
37463 @item EINTR
37464 The call was interrupted by the user.
37465 @end table
37466
37467 @end table
37468
37469 @node write
37470 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37471 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37472
37473 @table @asis
37474 @item Synopsis:
37475 @smallexample
37476 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37477 @end smallexample
37478
37479 @item Request:
37480 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37481
37482 @item Return value:
37483 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37484 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37485 is returned.
37486
37487 @item Errors:
37488
37489 @table @code
37490 @item EBADF
37491 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37492 writing.
37493
37494 @item EFAULT
37495 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37496
37497 @item EFBIG
37498 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37499 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37500
37501 @item ENOSPC
37502 No space on device to write the data.
37503
37504 @item EINTR
37505 The call was interrupted by the user.
37506 @end table
37507
37508 @end table
37509
37510 @node lseek
37511 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37512 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37513
37514 @table @asis
37515 @item Synopsis:
37516 @smallexample
37517 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37518 @end smallexample
37519
37520 @item Request:
37521 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37522
37523 @var{flag} is one of:
37524
37525 @table @code
37526 @item SEEK_SET
37527 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37528
37529 @item SEEK_CUR
37530 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37531 bytes.
37532
37533 @item SEEK_END
37534 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37535 bytes.
37536 @end table
37537
37538 @item Return value:
37539 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37540 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37541 value of -1 is returned.
37542
37543 @item Errors:
37544
37545 @table @code
37546 @item EBADF
37547 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37548
37549 @item ESPIPE
37550 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37551
37552 @item EINVAL
37553 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37554
37555 @item EINTR
37556 The call was interrupted by the user.
37557 @end table
37558
37559 @end table
37560
37561 @node rename
37562 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37563 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37564
37565 @table @asis
37566 @item Synopsis:
37567 @smallexample
37568 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37569 @end smallexample
37570
37571 @item Request:
37572 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37573
37574 @item Return value:
37575 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37576
37577 @item Errors:
37578
37579 @table @code
37580 @item EISDIR
37581 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37582 directory.
37583
37584 @item EEXIST
37585 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37586
37587 @item EBUSY
37588 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37589 process.
37590
37591 @item EINVAL
37592 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37593 of itself.
37594
37595 @item ENOTDIR
37596 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37597 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37598 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37599
37600 @item EFAULT
37601 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37602
37603 @item EACCES
37604 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37605
37606 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37607
37608 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37609
37610 @item ENOENT
37611 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37612
37613 @item EROFS
37614 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37615
37616 @item ENOSPC
37617 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37618 directory entry.
37619
37620 @item EINTR
37621 The call was interrupted by the user.
37622 @end table
37623
37624 @end table
37625
37626 @node unlink
37627 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37628 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37629
37630 @table @asis
37631 @item Synopsis:
37632 @smallexample
37633 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37634 @end smallexample
37635
37636 @item Request:
37637 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37638
37639 @item Return value:
37640 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37641
37642 @item Errors:
37643
37644 @table @code
37645 @item EACCES
37646 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37647
37648 @item EPERM
37649 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37650
37651 @item EBUSY
37652 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37653 being used by another process.
37654
37655 @item EFAULT
37656 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37657
37658 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37659 @var{pathname} was too long.
37660
37661 @item ENOENT
37662 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37663
37664 @item ENOTDIR
37665 A component of the path is not a directory.
37666
37667 @item EROFS
37668 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37669
37670 @item EINTR
37671 The call was interrupted by the user.
37672 @end table
37673
37674 @end table
37675
37676 @node stat/fstat
37677 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37678 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37679 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37680
37681 @table @asis
37682 @item Synopsis:
37683 @smallexample
37684 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37685 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37686 @end smallexample
37687
37688 @item Request:
37689 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37690 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37691
37692 @item Return value:
37693 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37694
37695 @item Errors:
37696
37697 @table @code
37698 @item EBADF
37699 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37700
37701 @item ENOENT
37702 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37703 path is an empty string.
37704
37705 @item ENOTDIR
37706 A component of the path is not a directory.
37707
37708 @item EFAULT
37709 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37710
37711 @item EACCES
37712 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37713
37714 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37715 @var{pathname} was too long.
37716
37717 @item EINTR
37718 The call was interrupted by the user.
37719 @end table
37720
37721 @end table
37722
37723 @node gettimeofday
37724 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37725 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37726
37727 @table @asis
37728 @item Synopsis:
37729 @smallexample
37730 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37731 @end smallexample
37732
37733 @item Request:
37734 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37735
37736 @item Return value:
37737 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37738
37739 @item Errors:
37740
37741 @table @code
37742 @item EINVAL
37743 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37744
37745 @item EFAULT
37746 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37747 @end table
37748
37749 @end table
37750
37751 @node isatty
37752 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37753 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37754
37755 @table @asis
37756 @item Synopsis:
37757 @smallexample
37758 int isatty(int fd);
37759 @end smallexample
37760
37761 @item Request:
37762 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37763
37764 @item Return value:
37765 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37766
37767 @item Errors:
37768
37769 @table @code
37770 @item EINTR
37771 The call was interrupted by the user.
37772 @end table
37773
37774 @end table
37775
37776 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37777 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37778 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37779 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37780 needed.
37781
37782
37783 @node system
37784 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37785 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37786
37787 @table @asis
37788 @item Synopsis:
37789 @smallexample
37790 int system(const char *command);
37791 @end smallexample
37792
37793 @item Request:
37794 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37795
37796 @item Return value:
37797 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37798 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37799 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37800 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37801 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37802 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37803 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37804
37805 @item Errors:
37806
37807 @table @code
37808 @item EINTR
37809 The call was interrupted by the user.
37810 @end table
37811
37812 @end table
37813
37814 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37815 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37816 the host is simplified before it's returned
37817 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37818 is discarded, and the return value consists
37819 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37820
37821 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37822 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37823 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37824
37825 @table @code
37826 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37827 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37828 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37829 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37830
37831 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37832 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37833 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37834 protocol.
37835 @end table
37836
37837 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37838 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37839 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37840
37841 @menu
37842 * Integral Datatypes::
37843 * Pointer Values::
37844 * Memory Transfer::
37845 * struct stat::
37846 * struct timeval::
37847 @end menu
37848
37849 @node Integral Datatypes
37850 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37851 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37852
37853 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37854 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37855 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37856
37857 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37858 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37859
37860 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37861
37862 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
37863 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
37864
37865 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
37866
37867 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
37868 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
37869 byte order.
37870
37871 @node Pointer Values
37872 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
37873 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
37874
37875 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
37876 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
37877 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
37878 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
37879
37880 @smallexample
37881 @code{1aaf/12}
37882 @end smallexample
37883
37884 @noindent
37885 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
37886 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
37887 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
37888 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
37889
37890 @smallexample
37891 @code{123456/d}
37892 @end smallexample
37893
37894 @node Memory Transfer
37895 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
37896 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
37897
37898 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
37899 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
37900 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
37901 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
37902 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
37903 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
37904 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
37905
37906
37907 @node struct stat
37908 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
37909 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
37910
37911 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
37912 is defined as follows:
37913
37914 @smallexample
37915 struct stat @{
37916 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
37917 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
37918 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
37919 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
37920 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
37921 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
37922 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
37923 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
37924 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
37925 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
37926 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
37927 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
37928 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
37929 @};
37930 @end smallexample
37931
37932 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37933 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37934 structure is of size 64 bytes.
37935
37936 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
37937 range of values.
37938
37939 @table @code
37940
37941 @item st_dev
37942 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
37943
37944 @item st_ino
37945 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37946
37947 @item st_mode
37948 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
37949 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
37950
37951 @item st_uid
37952 @itemx st_gid
37953 @itemx st_rdev
37954 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37955
37956 @item st_atime
37957 @itemx st_mtime
37958 @itemx st_ctime
37959 These values have a host and file system dependent
37960 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
37961 support exact timing values.
37962 @end table
37963
37964 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
37965 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
37966 continuing.
37967
37968 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
37969 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
37970 get truncated on the target.
37971
37972 @node struct timeval
37973 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
37974 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
37975
37976 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
37977 is defined as follows:
37978
37979 @smallexample
37980 struct timeval @{
37981 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
37982 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
37983 @};
37984 @end smallexample
37985
37986 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37987 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37988 structure is of size 8 bytes.
37989
37990 @node Constants
37991 @subsection Constants
37992 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
37993
37994 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
37995 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
37996 values before and after the call as needed.
37997
37998 @menu
37999 * Open Flags::
38000 * mode_t Values::
38001 * Errno Values::
38002 * Lseek Flags::
38003 * Limits::
38004 @end menu
38005
38006 @node Open Flags
38007 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38008 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38009
38010 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38011
38012 @smallexample
38013 O_RDONLY 0x0
38014 O_WRONLY 0x1
38015 O_RDWR 0x2
38016 O_APPEND 0x8
38017 O_CREAT 0x200
38018 O_TRUNC 0x400
38019 O_EXCL 0x800
38020 @end smallexample
38021
38022 @node mode_t Values
38023 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38024 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38025
38026 All values are given in octal representation.
38027
38028 @smallexample
38029 S_IFREG 0100000
38030 S_IFDIR 040000
38031 S_IRUSR 0400
38032 S_IWUSR 0200
38033 S_IXUSR 0100
38034 S_IRGRP 040
38035 S_IWGRP 020
38036 S_IXGRP 010
38037 S_IROTH 04
38038 S_IWOTH 02
38039 S_IXOTH 01
38040 @end smallexample
38041
38042 @node Errno Values
38043 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38044 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38045
38046 All values are given in decimal representation.
38047
38048 @smallexample
38049 EPERM 1
38050 ENOENT 2
38051 EINTR 4
38052 EBADF 9
38053 EACCES 13
38054 EFAULT 14
38055 EBUSY 16
38056 EEXIST 17
38057 ENODEV 19
38058 ENOTDIR 20
38059 EISDIR 21
38060 EINVAL 22
38061 ENFILE 23
38062 EMFILE 24
38063 EFBIG 27
38064 ENOSPC 28
38065 ESPIPE 29
38066 EROFS 30
38067 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38068 EUNKNOWN 9999
38069 @end smallexample
38070
38071 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38072 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38073
38074 @node Lseek Flags
38075 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38076 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38077
38078 @smallexample
38079 SEEK_SET 0
38080 SEEK_CUR 1
38081 SEEK_END 2
38082 @end smallexample
38083
38084 @node Limits
38085 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38086 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38087
38088 All values are given in decimal representation.
38089
38090 @smallexample
38091 INT_MIN -2147483648
38092 INT_MAX 2147483647
38093 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38094 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38095 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38096 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38097 @end smallexample
38098
38099 @node File-I/O Examples
38100 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38101 @cindex file-i/o examples
38102
38103 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38104 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38105
38106 @smallexample
38107 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38108 @emph{request memory read from target}
38109 -> @code{m1234,6}
38110 <- XXXXXX
38111 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38112 -> @code{F6}
38113 @end smallexample
38114
38115 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38116 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38117
38118 @smallexample
38119 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38120 @emph{request memory write to target}
38121 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38122 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38123 -> @code{F6}
38124 @end smallexample
38125
38126 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38127 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38128
38129 @smallexample
38130 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38131 -> @code{F-1,9}
38132 @end smallexample
38133
38134 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38135 host is called:
38136
38137 @smallexample
38138 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38139 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38140 <- @code{T02}
38141 @end smallexample
38142
38143 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38144 host is called:
38145
38146 @smallexample
38147 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38148 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38149 <- @code{T02}
38150 @end smallexample
38151
38152 @node Library List Format
38153 @section Library List Format
38154 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38155
38156 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38157 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38158 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38159 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38160 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38161 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38162 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38163 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38164 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38165 are loaded.
38166
38167 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38168 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38169 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38170 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38171
38172 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38173 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38174 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38175 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38176 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38177 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38178
38179 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38180 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38181
38182 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38183 offset, looks like this:
38184
38185 @smallexample
38186 <library-list>
38187 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38188 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38189 </library>
38190 </library-list>
38191 @end smallexample
38192
38193 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38194 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38195
38196 @smallexample
38197 <library-list>
38198 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38199 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38200 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38201 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38202 </library>
38203 </library-list>
38204 @end smallexample
38205
38206 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38207
38208 @smallexample
38209 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38210 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38211 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38212 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38213 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38214 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38215 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38216 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38217 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38218 @end smallexample
38219
38220 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38221 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38222 section for each library.
38223
38224 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38225 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38226 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38227
38228 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38229 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38230 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38231 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38232
38233 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38234 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38235 target, the following parameters are reported:
38236
38237 @itemize @minus
38238 @item
38239 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38240 @code{struct link_map}.
38241 @item
38242 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38243 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38244 @item
38245 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38246 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38247 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38248 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38249 @item
38250 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38251 @end itemize
38252
38253 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38254 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38255 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38256
38257 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38258 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38259
38260 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38261 looks like this:
38262
38263 @smallexample
38264 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38265 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38266 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38267 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38268 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38269 </library-list-svr>
38270 @end smallexample
38271
38272 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38273
38274 @smallexample
38275 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38276 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38277 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38278 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38279 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38280 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38281 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38282 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38283 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38284 @end smallexample
38285
38286 @node Memory Map Format
38287 @section Memory Map Format
38288 @cindex memory map format
38289
38290 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38291 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38292 memory map.
38293
38294 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38295 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38296 lists memory regions.
38297
38298 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38299 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38300
38301 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38302
38303 @smallexample
38304 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38305 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38306 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38307 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38308 <memory-map>
38309 region...
38310 </memory-map>
38311 @end smallexample
38312
38313 Each region can be either:
38314
38315 @itemize
38316
38317 @item
38318 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38319 bytes from there:
38320
38321 @smallexample
38322 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38323 @end smallexample
38324
38325
38326 @item
38327 A region of read-only memory:
38328
38329 @smallexample
38330 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38331 @end smallexample
38332
38333
38334 @item
38335 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38336 bytes in length:
38337
38338 @smallexample
38339 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38340 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38341 </memory>
38342 @end smallexample
38343
38344 @end itemize
38345
38346 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38347 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38348 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38349
38350 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38351
38352 @smallexample
38353 <!-- ................................................... -->
38354 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38355 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38356 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38357 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38358 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38359 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38360 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38361 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38362 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38363 and its type, or device. -->
38364 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38365 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38366 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38367 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38368 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38369 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38370 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38371 @end smallexample
38372
38373 @node Thread List Format
38374 @section Thread List Format
38375 @cindex thread list format
38376
38377 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38378 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38379 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38380 the following structure:
38381
38382 @smallexample
38383 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38384 <threads>
38385 <thread id="id" core="0">
38386 ... description ...
38387 </thread>
38388 </threads>
38389 @end smallexample
38390
38391 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38392 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38393 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38394 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38395 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38396
38397 @node Traceframe Info Format
38398 @section Traceframe Info Format
38399 @cindex traceframe info format
38400
38401 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38402 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38403 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38404 collected in a traceframe.
38405
38406 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38407 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38408
38409 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38410 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38411
38412 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38413
38414 @smallexample
38415 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38416 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38417 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38418 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38419 <traceframe-info>
38420 block...
38421 </traceframe-info>
38422 @end smallexample
38423
38424 Each traceframe block can be either:
38425
38426 @itemize
38427
38428 @item
38429 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38430 @var{length} bytes from there:
38431
38432 @smallexample
38433 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38434 @end smallexample
38435
38436 @item
38437 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38438 collected:
38439
38440 @smallexample
38441 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38442 @end smallexample
38443
38444 @end itemize
38445
38446 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38447
38448 @smallexample
38449 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38450 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38451
38452 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38453 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38454 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38455 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38456 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38457 @end smallexample
38458
38459 @node Branch Trace Format
38460 @section Branch Trace Format
38461 @cindex branch trace format
38462
38463 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38464 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38465 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38466 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38467
38468 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38469 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38470
38471 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38472 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38473
38474 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38475
38476 @smallexample
38477 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38478 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38479 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38480 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38481 <btrace>
38482 block...
38483 </btrace>
38484 @end smallexample
38485
38486 @itemize
38487
38488 @item
38489 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38490 and ending at @var{end}:
38491
38492 @smallexample
38493 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38494 @end smallexample
38495
38496 @end itemize
38497
38498 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38499
38500 @smallexample
38501 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38502 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38503
38504 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38505 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38506 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38507 @end smallexample
38508
38509 @include agentexpr.texi
38510
38511 @node Target Descriptions
38512 @appendix Target Descriptions
38513 @cindex target descriptions
38514
38515 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38516 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38517 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38518 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38519 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38520 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38521 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38522
38523 @itemize @bullet
38524 @item
38525 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38526 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38527 @item
38528 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38529 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38530 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38531 @item
38532 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38533 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38534 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38535 @end itemize
38536
38537 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38538 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38539 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38540 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38541 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38542
38543 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38544 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38545
38546 @menu
38547 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38548 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38549 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38550 descriptions.
38551 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38552 @end menu
38553
38554 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38555 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38556
38557 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38558 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38559 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38560 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38561 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38562 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38563 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38564 Format}.
38565
38566 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38567 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38568 specify a file are:
38569
38570 @table @code
38571 @cindex set tdesc filename
38572 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38573 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38574
38575 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38576 @item unset tdesc filename
38577 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38578 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38579
38580 @cindex show tdesc filename
38581 @item show tdesc filename
38582 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38583 @end table
38584
38585
38586 @node Target Description Format
38587 @section Target Description Format
38588 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38589
38590 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38591 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38592 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38593 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38594 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38595 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38596 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38597
38598 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38599 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38600 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38601 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38602 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38603
38604 Here is a simple target description:
38605
38606 @smallexample
38607 <target version="1.0">
38608 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38609 </target>
38610 @end smallexample
38611
38612 @noindent
38613 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38614 the x86-64 architecture.
38615
38616 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38617 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38618 are explained further below.
38619
38620 @smallexample
38621 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38622 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38623 <target version="1.0">
38624 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38625 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38626 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38627 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38628 </target>
38629 @end smallexample
38630
38631 @noindent
38632 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38633 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38634 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38635 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38636 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38637 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38638 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38639 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38640 the version mismatch.
38641
38642 @subsection Inclusion
38643 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38644 @cindex XInclude
38645 @ifnotinfo
38646 @cindex <xi:include>
38647 @end ifnotinfo
38648
38649 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38650 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38651 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38652 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38653 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38654
38655 @smallexample
38656 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38657 @end smallexample
38658
38659 @noindent
38660 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38661 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38662 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38663 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38664 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38665 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38666 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38667 original description.
38668
38669 @subsection Architecture
38670 @cindex <architecture>
38671
38672 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38673
38674 @smallexample
38675 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38676 @end smallexample
38677
38678 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38679 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38680
38681 @subsection OS ABI
38682 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38683
38684 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38685 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38686
38687 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38688
38689 @smallexample
38690 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38691 @end smallexample
38692
38693 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38694 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38695
38696 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38697 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38698
38699 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38700 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38701
38702 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38703
38704 @smallexample
38705 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38706 @end smallexample
38707
38708 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38709 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38710
38711 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38712 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38713 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38714 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38715 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38716 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38717 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38718
38719 @smallexample
38720 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38721 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38722 @end smallexample
38723
38724 @subsection Features
38725 @cindex <feature>
38726
38727 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38728 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38729 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38730 has this form:
38731
38732 @smallexample
38733 <feature name="@var{name}">
38734 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38735 @var{reg}@dots{}
38736 </feature>
38737 @end smallexample
38738
38739 @noindent
38740 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38741 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38742 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38743 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38744
38745 @subsection Types
38746
38747 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38748 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38749 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38750 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38751 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38752
38753 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38754 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38755 Types must be defined before they are used.
38756
38757 @cindex <vector>
38758 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38759 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38760 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38761 @var{count}:
38762
38763 @smallexample
38764 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38765 @end smallexample
38766
38767 @cindex <union>
38768 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38769 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38770 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38771 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38772
38773 @smallexample
38774 <union id="@var{id}">
38775 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38776 @dots{}
38777 </union>
38778 @end smallexample
38779
38780 @cindex <struct>
38781 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38782 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38783 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38784 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38785 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38786 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38787 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38788 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38789
38790 @smallexample
38791 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38792 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38793 @dots{}
38794 </struct>
38795 @end smallexample
38796
38797 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38798 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38799
38800 @smallexample
38801 <struct id="@var{id}">
38802 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38803 @dots{}
38804 </struct>
38805 @end smallexample
38806
38807 @cindex <flags>
38808 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38809 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38810 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38811 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38812 are supported.
38813
38814 @smallexample
38815 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38816 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38817 @dots{}
38818 </flags>
38819 @end smallexample
38820
38821 @subsection Registers
38822 @cindex <reg>
38823
38824 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38825
38826 @smallexample
38827 <reg name="@var{name}"
38828 bitsize="@var{size}"
38829 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38830 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38831 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38832 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38833 @end smallexample
38834
38835 @noindent
38836 The components are as follows:
38837
38838 @table @var
38839
38840 @item name
38841 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38842
38843 @item bitsize
38844 The register's size, in bits.
38845
38846 @item regnum
38847 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38848 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38849 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38850 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38851 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38852 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38853 in order of increasing register number.
38854
38855 @item save-restore
38856 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38857 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38858 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38859 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38860 ABI.
38861
38862 @item type
38863 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
38864 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
38865 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
38866 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
38867 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
38868 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
38869
38870 @item group
38871 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
38872 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
38873 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
38874 in @code{info registers}.
38875
38876 @end table
38877
38878 @node Predefined Target Types
38879 @section Predefined Target Types
38880 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
38881
38882 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
38883 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
38884 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
38885 types. The currently supported types are:
38886
38887 @table @code
38888
38889 @item int8
38890 @itemx int16
38891 @itemx int32
38892 @itemx int64
38893 @itemx int128
38894 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38895
38896 @item uint8
38897 @itemx uint16
38898 @itemx uint32
38899 @itemx uint64
38900 @itemx uint128
38901 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38902
38903 @item code_ptr
38904 @itemx data_ptr
38905 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
38906 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
38907 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
38908 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
38909 may be marked as data pointers.
38910
38911 @item ieee_single
38912 Single precision IEEE floating point.
38913
38914 @item ieee_double
38915 Double precision IEEE floating point.
38916
38917 @item arm_fpa_ext
38918 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
38919
38920 @item i387_ext
38921 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
38922
38923 @item i386_eflags
38924 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
38925
38926 @item i386_mxcsr
38927 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
38928
38929 @end table
38930
38931 @node Standard Target Features
38932 @section Standard Target Features
38933 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
38934
38935 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
38936 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
38937 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
38938 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
38939 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
38940 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
38941 can recognize them.
38942
38943 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
38944 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
38945 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
38946 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
38947 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
38948 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
38949 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
38950 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
38951
38952 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
38953 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
38954 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
38955
38956 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
38957 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
38958 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
38959 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
38960
38961 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
38962 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
38963 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
38964
38965 @menu
38966 * AArch64 Features::
38967 * ARM Features::
38968 * i386 Features::
38969 * MIPS Features::
38970 * M68K Features::
38971 * Nios II Features::
38972 * PowerPC Features::
38973 * S/390 and System z Features::
38974 * TIC6x Features::
38975 @end menu
38976
38977
38978 @node AArch64 Features
38979 @subsection AArch64 Features
38980 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
38981
38982 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
38983 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
38984 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
38985
38986 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
38987 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
38988 and @samp{fpcr}.
38989
38990 @node ARM Features
38991 @subsection ARM Features
38992 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
38993
38994 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
38995 ARM targets.
38996 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
38997 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
38998
38999 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39000 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39001 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39002 and @samp{xpsr}.
39003
39004 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39005 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39006
39007 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39008 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39009 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39010 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39011
39012 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39013 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39014 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39015 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39016 halves of the double-precision registers.
39017
39018 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39019 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39020 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39021 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39022 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39023 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39024
39025 @node i386 Features
39026 @subsection i386 Features
39027 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39028
39029 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39030 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39031
39032 @itemize @minus
39033 @item
39034 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39035 @item
39036 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39037 @item
39038 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39039 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39040 @item
39041 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39042 @item
39043 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39044 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39045 @end itemize
39046
39047 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39048
39049 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39050 describe registers:
39051
39052 @itemize @minus
39053 @item
39054 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39055 @item
39056 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39057 @item
39058 @samp{mxcsr}
39059 @end itemize
39060
39061 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39062 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39063 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39064
39065 @itemize @minus
39066 @item
39067 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39068 @item
39069 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39070 @end itemize
39071
39072 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39073 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39074
39075 @itemize @minus
39076 @item
39077 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39078 @item
39079 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39080 @end itemize
39081
39082 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39083 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39084
39085 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39086 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39087 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39088
39089 @itemize @minus
39090 @item
39091 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39092 @end itemize
39093
39094 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39095
39096 @itemize @minus
39097 @item
39098 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39099 @end itemize
39100
39101 It should
39102 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39103
39104 @itemize @minus
39105 @item
39106 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39107 @item
39108 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39109 @end itemize
39110
39111 It should
39112 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39113
39114 @itemize @minus
39115 @item
39116 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39117 @end itemize
39118
39119 @node MIPS Features
39120 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39121 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39122
39123 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39124 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39125 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39126 on the target.
39127
39128 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39129 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39130 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39131
39132 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39133 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39134 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39135 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39136
39137 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39138 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39139 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39140 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39141
39142 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39143 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39144 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39145
39146 @node M68K Features
39147 @subsection M68K Features
39148 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39149
39150 @table @code
39151 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39152 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39153 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39154 One of those features must be always present.
39155 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39156 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39157 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39158 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39159
39160 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39161 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39162 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39163 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39164 @end table
39165
39166 @node Nios II Features
39167 @subsection Nios II Features
39168 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39169
39170 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39171 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39172 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39173 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39174 @samp{mpuacc}).
39175
39176 @node PowerPC Features
39177 @subsection PowerPC Features
39178 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39179
39180 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39181 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39182 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39183 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39184
39185 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39186 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39187
39188 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39189 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39190 and @samp{vrsave}.
39191
39192 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39193 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39194 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39195 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39196 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39197 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39198
39199 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39200 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39201 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39202 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39203 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39204 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39205 user.
39206
39207 @node S/390 and System z Features
39208 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39209 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39210 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39211
39212 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39213 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39214 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39215 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39216 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39217 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39218 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39219 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39220 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39221
39222 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39223 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39224 @samp{fpc}.
39225
39226 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39227 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39228
39229 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39230 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39231 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39232 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39233 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39234 32-bit wide.
39235
39236 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39237 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39238 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39239
39240 @node TIC6x Features
39241 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39242 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39243 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39244 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39245 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39246 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39247
39248 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39249 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39250 through @samp{B31}.
39251
39252 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39253 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39254
39255 @node Operating System Information
39256 @appendix Operating System Information
39257 @cindex operating system information
39258
39259 @menu
39260 * Process list::
39261 @end menu
39262
39263 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39264 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39265 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39266 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39267 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39268 on a different aspect of target.
39269
39270 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39271 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39272 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39273 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39274
39275 @node Process list
39276 @appendixsection Process list
39277 @cindex operating system information, process list
39278
39279 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39280 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39281 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39282 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39283
39284 An example document is:
39285
39286 @smallexample
39287 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39288 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39289 <osdata type="processes">
39290 <item>
39291 <column name="pid">1</column>
39292 <column name="user">root</column>
39293 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39294 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39295 </item>
39296 </osdata>
39297 @end smallexample
39298
39299 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39300 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39301 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39302 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39303 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39304 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39305 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39306
39307 @node Trace File Format
39308 @appendix Trace File Format
39309 @cindex trace file format
39310
39311 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39312 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39313
39314 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39315 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39316 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39317 in the future.
39318
39319 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39320 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39321 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39322 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39323 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39324 of this section.
39325
39326 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39327
39328 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39329 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39330 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39331 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39332 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39333 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39334 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39335 endianness.
39336
39337 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39338
39339 @table @code
39340 @item R @var{bytes}
39341 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39342 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39343 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39344 hexadecimal encoding.
39345
39346 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39347 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39348 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39349 @var{length} bytes.
39350
39351 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39352 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39353 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39354
39355 @end table
39356
39357 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39358 of blocks.
39359
39360 @node Index Section Format
39361 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39362 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39363 @cindex index section format
39364
39365 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39366 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39367 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39368 description.
39369
39370 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39371 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39372 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39373 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39374 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39375 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39376
39377 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39378
39379 @enumerate
39380 @item
39381 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39382 unless otherwise noted:
39383
39384 @enumerate
39385 @item
39386 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39387 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39388 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39389 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39390 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39391 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39392 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39393
39394 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39395 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39396 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39397 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39398
39399 @item
39400 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39401
39402 @item
39403 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39404 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39405 to the next offset.
39406
39407 @item
39408 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39409
39410 @item
39411 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39412
39413 @item
39414 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39415 @end enumerate
39416
39417 @item
39418 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39419 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39420 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39421 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39422 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39423 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39424 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39425 CU indices.
39426
39427 @item
39428 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39429 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39430 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39431 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39432
39433 @item
39434 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39435 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39436
39437 @enumerate
39438 @item
39439 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39440
39441 @item
39442 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39443 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39444
39445 @item
39446 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39447 @end enumerate
39448
39449 @item
39450 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39451 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39452
39453 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39454 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39455 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39456 constant pool.
39457
39458 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39459 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39460 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39461
39462 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39463 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39464 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39465 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39466 index version:
39467
39468 @table @asis
39469 @item Version 4
39470 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39471
39472 @item Versions 5 to 7
39473 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39474 @end table
39475
39476 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39477
39478 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39479 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39480 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39481 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39482 collision.
39483
39484 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39485 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39486 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39487 the code.
39488
39489 @item
39490 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39491 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39492 strings.
39493
39494 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39495 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39496 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39497 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39498 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39499 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39500
39501 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39502 @end enumerate
39503
39504 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39505 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39506 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39507
39508 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39509 (bit 0 = LSB):
39510
39511 @table @asis
39512
39513 @item Bits 0-23
39514 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39515 @item Bits 24-27
39516 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39517 @item Bits 28-30
39518 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39519
39520 @table @asis
39521 @item 0
39522 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39523 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39524 with previous versions of the index.
39525 @item 1
39526 The symbol is a type.
39527 @item 2
39528 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39529 @item 3
39530 The symbol is a function.
39531 @item 4
39532 Any other kind of symbol.
39533 @item 5,6,7
39534 These values are reserved.
39535 @end table
39536
39537 @item Bit 31
39538 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39539
39540 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39541 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39542 @value{GDBN} sources.
39543
39544 @end table
39545
39546 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39547 global/static attributes in the index.
39548
39549 @smallexample
39550 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39551 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39552 switch (die->tag)
39553 @{
39554 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39555 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39556 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39557 kind = TYPE;
39558 is_static = 1;
39559 break;
39560 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39561 kind = VARIABLE;
39562 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39563 break;
39564 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39565 kind = FUNCTION;
39566 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39567 break;
39568 case DW_TAG_constant:
39569 kind = VARIABLE;
39570 is_static = ! is_external;
39571 break;
39572 case DW_TAG_variable:
39573 kind = VARIABLE;
39574 is_static = ! is_external;
39575 break;
39576 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39577 kind = TYPE;
39578 is_static = 0;
39579 break;
39580 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39581 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39582 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39583 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39584 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39585 kind = TYPE;
39586 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39587 break;
39588 default:
39589 assert (0);
39590 @}
39591 @end smallexample
39592
39593 @node Man Pages
39594 @appendix Manual pages
39595 @cindex Man pages
39596
39597 @menu
39598 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39599 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39600 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39601 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39602 @end menu
39603
39604 @node gdb man
39605 @heading gdb man
39606
39607 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39608
39609 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39610 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39611 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39612 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39613 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39614 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39615 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39616 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39617 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39618 @c man end
39619
39620 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39621 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39622 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39623 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39624
39625 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39626 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39627
39628 @itemize @bullet
39629 @item
39630 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39631
39632 @item
39633 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39634
39635 @item
39636 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39637
39638 @item
39639 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39640 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39641 @end itemize
39642
39643 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39644 Modula-2.
39645
39646 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39647 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39648 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39649 by using the command @code{help}.
39650
39651 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39652 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39653 executable program as the argument:
39654
39655 @smallexample
39656 gdb program
39657 @end smallexample
39658
39659 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39660
39661 @smallexample
39662 gdb program core
39663 @end smallexample
39664
39665 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39666 to debug a running process:
39667
39668 @smallexample
39669 gdb program 1234
39670 gdb -p 1234
39671 @end smallexample
39672
39673 @noindent
39674 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39675 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39676 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39677
39678 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39679
39680 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39681 @table @env
39682 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39683 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39684
39685 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39686 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39687
39688 @item bt
39689 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39690
39691 @item print @var{expr}
39692 Display the value of an expression.
39693
39694 @item c
39695 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39696
39697 @item next
39698 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39699 function calls in the line.
39700
39701 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39702 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39703
39704 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39705 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39706
39707 @item step
39708 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39709 function calls in the line.
39710
39711 @item help [@var{name}]
39712 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39713 about using @value{GDBN}.
39714
39715 @item quit
39716 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39717 @end table
39718
39719 @ifset man
39720 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39721 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39722 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39723 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39724 @end ifset
39725 @c man end
39726
39727 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39728 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39729 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39730 encountered with no
39731 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39732 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39733 Many options have
39734 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39735 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39736 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39737 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39738 more usual convention.)
39739
39740 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39741 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39742 option is used.
39743
39744 @table @env
39745 @item -help
39746 @itemx -h
39747 List all options, with brief explanations.
39748
39749 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39750 @itemx -s @var{file}
39751 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39752
39753 @item -write
39754 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39755
39756 @item -exec=@var{file}
39757 @itemx -e @var{file}
39758 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39759 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39760 dump.
39761
39762 @item -se=@var{file}
39763 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39764 file.
39765
39766 @item -core=@var{file}
39767 @itemx -c @var{file}
39768 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39769
39770 @item -command=@var{file}
39771 @itemx -x @var{file}
39772 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39773
39774 @item -ex @var{command}
39775 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
39776
39777 @item -directory=@var{directory}
39778 @itemx -d @var{directory}
39779 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
39780
39781 @item -nh
39782 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
39783
39784 @item -nx
39785 @itemx -n
39786 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
39787
39788 @item -quiet
39789 @itemx -q
39790 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
39791 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
39792
39793 @item -batch
39794 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
39795 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
39796 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
39797 commands in the command files.
39798
39799 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
39800 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
39801 more useful, the message
39802
39803 @smallexample
39804 Program exited normally.
39805 @end smallexample
39806
39807 @noindent
39808 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
39809 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
39810
39811 @item -cd=@var{directory}
39812 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
39813 instead of the current directory.
39814
39815 @item -fullname
39816 @itemx -f
39817 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
39818 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
39819 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
39820 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
39821 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
39822 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
39823 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
39824 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
39825
39826 @item -b @var{bps}
39827 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
39828 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
39829
39830 @item -tty=@var{device}
39831 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
39832 @end table
39833 @c man end
39834
39835 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
39836 @ifset man
39837 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
39838 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
39839 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
39840
39841 @smallexample
39842 info gdb
39843 @end smallexample
39844
39845 @noindent
39846 should give you access to the complete manual.
39847
39848 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39849 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
39850 @end ifset
39851 @c man end
39852
39853 @node gdbserver man
39854 @heading gdbserver man
39855
39856 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
39857 @format
39858 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
39859 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
39860
39861 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39862
39863 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39864 @c man end
39865 @end format
39866
39867 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
39868 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
39869 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
39870
39871 @ifclear man
39872 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
39873 @end ifclear
39874 @ifset man
39875 Usage (server (target) side):
39876 @end ifset
39877
39878 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
39879 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
39880 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
39881 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
39882
39883 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
39884 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
39885 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
39886
39887 @smallexample
39888 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
39889 @end smallexample
39890
39891 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
39892
39893 @smallexample
39894 @ifset man
39895 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
39896 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
39897 @end ifset
39898 @ifclear man
39899 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
39900 @end ifclear
39901 @end smallexample
39902
39903 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
39904 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
39905 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
39906
39907 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
39908
39909 @smallexample
39910 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
39911 @end smallexample
39912
39913 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
39914 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
39915 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
39916 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
39917 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
39918 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
39919 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
39920 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
39921 print an error message and exit.
39922
39923 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
39924 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
39925
39926 @smallexample
39927 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39928 @end smallexample
39929
39930 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
39931 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
39932
39933 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
39934 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
39935 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
39936 the program you want to debug.
39937
39938 @smallexample
39939 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39940 @end smallexample
39941
39942 @ifclear man
39943 @subheading Usage (host side)
39944 @end ifclear
39945 @ifset man
39946 Usage (host side):
39947 @end ifset
39948
39949 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
39950 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
39951 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
39952 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
39953 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
39954 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
39955 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
39956 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
39957 descriptor. For example:
39958
39959 @smallexample
39960 @ifset man
39961 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
39962 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
39963 @end ifset
39964 @ifclear man
39965 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
39966 @end ifclear
39967 @end smallexample
39968
39969 @noindent
39970 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
39971
39972 @smallexample
39973 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
39974 @end smallexample
39975
39976 @noindent
39977 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
39978 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
39979 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
39980 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
39981 `Connection refused'.
39982
39983 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
39984 described in
39985 @ifset man
39986 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
39987 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
39988 @end ifset
39989 @ifclear man
39990 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
39991 @end ifclear
39992 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
39993
39994 @smallexample
39995 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
39996 @end smallexample
39997
39998 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
39999 case.
40000 @c man end
40001
40002 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40003 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40004
40005 @itemize @bullet
40006
40007 @item
40008 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40009
40010 @smallexample
40011 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40012 @end smallexample
40013
40014 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40015 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40016 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40017 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40018 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40019 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40020 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40021
40022 @item
40023 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40024 program:
40025
40026 @smallexample
40027 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40028 @end smallexample
40029
40030 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40031 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40032 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40033 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40034
40035 @item
40036 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40037
40038 @smallexample
40039 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40040 @end smallexample
40041
40042 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40043 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40044 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40045 debug several processes in the same session.
40046 @end itemize
40047
40048 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40049
40050 @table @env
40051
40052 @item --help
40053 List all options, with brief explanations.
40054
40055 @item --version
40056 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40057
40058 @item --attach
40059 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40060
40061 @smallexample
40062 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40063 @end smallexample
40064
40065 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40066 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40067
40068 @item --multi
40069 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40070 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40071 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40072 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40073
40074 @smallexample
40075 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40076 @end smallexample
40077
40078 @item --debug
40079 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40080 process.
40081 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40082 the developers.
40083
40084 @item --remote-debug
40085 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40086 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40087 the developers.
40088
40089 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40090 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40091 of debugging output.
40092 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40093
40094 @item --wrapper
40095 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40096 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40097 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40098 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40099
40100 @item --once
40101 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40102 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40103 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40104 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40105
40106 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40107
40108 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40109 @c QDisableRandomization.
40110
40111 @end table
40112 @c man end
40113
40114 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40115 @ifset man
40116 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40117 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40118 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40119
40120 @smallexample
40121 info gdb
40122 @end smallexample
40123
40124 should give you access to the complete manual.
40125
40126 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40127 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40128 @end ifset
40129 @c man end
40130
40131 @node gcore man
40132 @heading gcore
40133
40134 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40135
40136 @format
40137 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40138 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40139 @c man end
40140 @end format
40141
40142 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40143 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40144 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40145 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40146 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40147 running without any change.
40148 @c man end
40149
40150 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40151 @table @env
40152 @item -o @var{filename}
40153 The optional argument
40154 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40155 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40156 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40157 @end table
40158 @c man end
40159
40160 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40161 @ifset man
40162 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40163 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40164 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40165
40166 @smallexample
40167 info gdb
40168 @end smallexample
40169
40170 @noindent
40171 should give you access to the complete manual.
40172
40173 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40174 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40175 @end ifset
40176 @c man end
40177
40178 @node gdbinit man
40179 @heading gdbinit
40180
40181 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40182
40183 @format
40184 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40185 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40186 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40187 @end ifset
40188
40189 ~/.gdbinit
40190
40191 ./.gdbinit
40192 @c man end
40193 @end format
40194
40195 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40196 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40197 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40198 described in
40199 @ifset man
40200 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40201 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40202 @end ifset
40203 @ifclear man
40204 @ref{Sequences}.
40205 @end ifclear
40206
40207 Please read more in
40208 @ifset man
40209 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40210 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40211 @end ifset
40212 @ifclear man
40213 @ref{Startup}.
40214 @end ifclear
40215
40216 @table @env
40217 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40218 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40219 @end ifset
40220 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40221 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40222 @end ifclear
40223 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40224 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40225 See more in
40226 @ifset man
40227 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40228 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40229 @end ifset
40230 @ifclear man
40231 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40232 @end ifclear
40233
40234 @item ~/.gdbinit
40235 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40236 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40237
40238 @item ./.gdbinit
40239 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40240 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40241 See more in
40242 @ifset man
40243 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40244 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40245 @end ifset
40246 @ifclear man
40247 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40248 @end ifclear
40249 @end table
40250 @c man end
40251
40252 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40253 @ifset man
40254 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40255
40256 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40257 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40258 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40259
40260 @smallexample
40261 info gdb
40262 @end smallexample
40263
40264 should give you access to the complete manual.
40265
40266 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40267 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40268 @end ifset
40269 @c man end
40270
40271 @include gpl.texi
40272
40273 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40274 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40275 @include fdl.texi
40276
40277 @node Concept Index
40278 @unnumbered Concept Index
40279
40280 @printindex cp
40281
40282 @node Command and Variable Index
40283 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40284
40285 @printindex fn
40286
40287 @tex
40288 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40289 % meantime:
40290 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40291 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40292 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40293 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40294 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40295 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40296 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40297 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40298 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40299 \page\colophon
40300 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40301 @end tex
40302
40303 @bye
This page took 0.945611 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.